Official Software
Get notified when we add a new ChevroletSilverado Manual

We cover 60 Chevrolet vehicles, were you looking for one of these?

Chevrolet Aveo 2007-2010 Factory Repair Manual PDF
Chevrolet Suburban 2000-2006 FACTORY Service Repair Manual PDF
Chevrolet Cruze Workshop Manual (L4-1.4L Turbo (2011))
Malibu L4-2.4L (2010)
Chevrolet Impala Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L (2008))
TrailBlazer 4WD L6-4.2L VIN S (2002)
Chevrolet Blazer 4wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2005))
Chevrolet Traverse Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.6L (2011))
Chevrolet Equinox Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.4L VIN F (2006))
Chevrolet - S-10 - Workshop Manual - (2001)
Chevrolet - Epica - Workshop Manual - 2008 - 2008
Chevrolet - Spark - Workshop Manual - 2011 - 2011
Chevrolet Malibu Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L VIN 8 (2004))
Chevrolet Impala Workshop Manual (V6-3.8L VIN K (2004))
Chevrolet - Malibu - Workshop Manual - 2007 - 2009
Chevrolet Astro Van 2wd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2002))
Chevrolet - Tahoe - Workshop Manual - 2001 - 2002
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 L4-134 2.2L (1991))
TrailBlazer 2WD L6-4.2L VIN S (2003)
Chevrolet Express 4500 Workshop Manual (V8-6.0L (2010))
Chevrolet Avalanche 1500 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.3L VIN T (2003))
Chevrolet Camaro Workshop Manual (V8-350 5.7L (1989))
Chevrolet Astro Van Awd Workshop Manual (V6-4.3L VIN X (2003))
Chevrolet Caprice Workshop Manual (V8-305 5.0L VIN E TBI (1991))
Chevrolet Chevette Workshop Manual (L4-98 1.6L (1982))
Chevrolet Equinox Awd Workshop Manual (V6-3.4L (2008))
Chevrolet - Cruze - Workshop Manual - 2011 - 2015
Chevrolet Colorado 2wd Workshop Manual (L4-2.8L VIN 8 (2004))
Chevrolet - Monte Carlo - Workshop Manual - (2004)
Uplander FWD V6-3.5L VIN L (2006)
Chevrolet Equinox Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.4L VIN F (2005))
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN Z (1994))
Chevrolet Camaro Workshop Manual (V8-6.2L (2010))
2010 Chevrolet Cruze Body Repair Manual
Tahoe 4WD V8-5.3L VIN T (2004)
Chevrolet K Tahoe 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.7L VIN R (1996))
Chevrolet Chevelle Workshop Manual (Chevelle-Malibu V8-305 5.0L (1983))
Chevrolet G 30 Van Workshop Manual (V8-379 6.2L DSL (1987))
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (L4-2.2L VIN F (2004))
2001-2005--Chevrolet--Impala--6 Cylinders K 3.8L FI OHV--32849802
Chevrolet - Express - Wiring Diagram - 2019 - 2019
Chevrolet Equinox Fwd Workshop Manual (V6-3.0L (2010))
Chevrolet K 1500 Suburban 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-454 7.4L VIN N TBI (1995))
Chevrolet Express 1500 Awd Workshop Manual (V8-5.3L (2008))
Chevrolet Caprice Classic Workshop Manual (V8-305 5.0L VIN E TBI (1991))
Chevrolet Malibu Workshop Manual (V6-191 3.1L VIN M SFI (1997))
Chevrolet Hhr Workshop Manual (L4-2.2L (2007))
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 Blazer 4WD V6-262 4.3L VIN W CPI (1992))
Malibu L4-2.2L VIN F (2005)
Lumina V6-204 3.4L DOHC VIN X SFI (1996)
Chevrolet Tahoe 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.3L (2007))
Chevrolet Impala Workshop Manual (V6-3.4L VIN E (2000))
S10-T10 Blazer 2WD V6-262 4.3L VIN W CPI (1992)
Chevrolet - S-10 - Workshop Manual - (1997)
Chevrolet Chevrolet Cruze Chevrolet Cruze 2012 Workshop Manual
Chevrolet Chevrolet K1500 Chevrolet C K Pick Up Truck 1999 Workshop Manual
Chevrolet S10 Workshop Manual (S10-T10 P-U 2WD L4-151 2.5L (1988))
Tracker 4WD L4-2.0L VIN C (1999)
Chevrolet Impala Workshop Manual (V6-3.5L VIN N (2006))
Chevrolet K 2500 Truck 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-393 6.5L DSL Turbo (1993))
Summary of Content
ai161972345251_22_CHEV_Silverado_2500HD3500HD_COV_en_US_84720406A_2021MAY14.pdf 1 4/29/2021 3:10:54 PM 2022 Scan to Access M Y CM MY CY CMY K • Owner and Warranty Manuals • Connected Services • myChevrolet Mobile App • How To Videos • Vehicle Diagnostics • Schedule Maintenance • Vehicle Features • Many Additional Resources United States Customer Assistance 1-800-222-1020 Roadside Assistance 1-800-243-8872 Canada Customer Assistance 1-800-263-3777 Roadside Assistance 1-800-268-6800 United States and Canada 84767841 A Connected Services 1-888-4-ONSTAR 2022 Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD C Operating, servicing and maintaining a passenger vehicle or off-highway motor vehicle can expose you to chemicals including engine exhaust, carbon monoxide, phthalates, and lead, which are known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. To minimize exposure, avoid breathing exhaust, do not idle engine except as necessary, service your vehicle in a well-ventilated area and wear gloves or wash your hands frequently when servicing your vehicle. For more information go to www.P65Warnings.ca.gov/passenger-vehicle. Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner’s Manual Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Contents Introduction If the vehicle has the Duramax diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement for additional and specific information on this engine. Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Keys, Doors, and Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Seats and Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Instruments and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Infotainment System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 Driving and Operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 Vehicle Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 Service and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391 Technical Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405 Customer Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409 Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420 Connected Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 Index. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428 Litho in U.S.A. Part No. 84767841 A First Printing subsequent to the printing of this owner’s manual, including changes in standard or optional content. The names, logos, emblems, slogans, vehicle model names, and vehicle body designs appearing in this manual including, but not limited to, GM, the GM logo, CHEVROLET, the CHEVROLET Emblem, SILVERADO, and Z71 are trademarks and/or service marks of General Motors LLC, its subsidiaries, affiliates, or licensors. For vehicles first sold in Canada, substitute the name “General Motors of Canada Company” for Chevrolet Motor Division wherever it appears in this manual. This manual describes features that may or may not be on the vehicle because of optional equipment that was not purchased on the vehicle, model variants, country specifications, features/applications that may not be available in your region, or changes Refer to the purchase documentation relating to your specific vehicle to confirm the features. Keep this manual in the vehicle for quick reference. Canadian Vehicle Owners A French language manual can be obtained from your dealer, at www.helminc.com, or from: Propriétaires Canadiens On peut obtenir un exemplaire de ce guide en français auprès du concessionnaire ou à l'adresse suivante: © 2021 General Motors LLC. All Rights Reserved. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 2 Introduction Helm, Incorporated Attention: Customer Service 47911 Halyard Drive Plymouth, MI 48170 USA Caution Caution indicates a hazard that could result in property or vehicle damage. Using this Manual To quickly locate information about the vehicle, use the Index in the back of the manual. It is an alphabetical list of what is in the manual and the page number where it can be found. Danger, Warning, and Caution Warning messages found on vehicle labels and in this manual describe hazards and what to do to avoid or reduce them. { Danger Danger indicates a hazard with a high level of risk which will result in serious injury or death. { Warning Warning indicates a hazard that could result in injury or death. A circle with a slash through it is a safety symbol which means “Do not,” “Do not do this,” or “Do not let this happen.” Symbols The vehicle has components and labels that use symbols instead of text. Symbols are shown along with the text describing the operation or information relating to a specific component, control, message, gauge, or indicator. M : Shown when the owner’s manual has additional instructions or information. * : Shown when the service manual has additional instructions or information. 0 : Shown when there is more information on another page — “see page.” Vehicle Symbol Chart Here are some additional symbols that may be found on the vehicle and what they mean. See the features in this manual for information. u : Air Conditioning System G : Air Conditioning Refrigerant Oil 9 : Airbag Readiness Light ! : Antilock Brake System (ABS) $ : Brake System Warning Light 9 : Dispose of Used Components Properly P : Do Not Apply High Pressure Water B : Engine Coolant Temperature _ : Flame/Fire Prohibited H : Flammable [ : Forward Collision Alert R : Fuse Block Cover Lock Location + : Fuses j : ISOFIX/LATCH System Child Restraints Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Introduction Q : Keep Fuse Block Covers Properly Installed | : Lane Change Alert @ : Lane Departure Warning A : Lane Keep Assist * : Malfunction Indicator Lamp : : Oil Pressure X : Park Assist ~ : Pedestrian Ahead Indicator O : Power 7 : Rear Cross Traffic Alert I : Registered Technician / : Remote Vehicle Start h : Risk of Electrical Fire > : Seat Belt Reminders I : Side Blind Zone Alert 7 : Tire Pressure Monitor d : Traction Control/StabiliTrak/Electronic Stability Control (ESC) a : Under Pressure k : Vehicle Ahead Indicator 3 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 4 Introduction Instrument Panel Overview Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Introduction 1. Tow/Haul Mode (On Some Models). See Driver Mode Control 0 249. Automatic Transfer Case Control (If Equipped). See Four-Wheel Drive 0 240. Driver Mode Control 0 249 (If Equipped). 2. Air Vents 0 207. 3. Turn Signal Lever. See Turn and Lane-Change Signals 0 143. Windshield Wiper/Washer 0 102. 4. Head-Up Display (HUD) 0 127 (If Equipped). 5. Instrument Cluster 0 107. 6. Shift Lever. See Automatic Transmission 0 235. Range Selection Mode. See Manual Mode 0 238. 7. Light Sensor. See Automatic Headlamp System 0 141. 8. Infotainment Controls. See Overview 0 149. 9. Climate Control Systems 0 202 (If Equipped). Dual Automatic Climate Control System 0 204 (If Equipped). 10. Heated and Ventilated Front Seats 0 53 (If Equipped). 11. X Park Assist Switch (If Equipped). See Assistance Systems for Parking or Backing 0 253. g Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control 0 247. | Hazard Warning Flashers 0 142. @ Lane Departure Warning (LDW) 0 268 (If Equipped). 5 Hill Descent Control Switch (If Equipped). See Hill Descent Control (HDC) 0 248. j Power Assist Steps 0 31 (If Equipped). 5 Power Release Tailgate (If Equipped). See Tailgate 0 23. A DC/AC Switch. See Power Outlets 0 103. L Express Window Down Button (If Equipped). See Power Windows 0 42. Tow/Haul Mode 0 240 (On Some Models). Exhaust Brake (If Equipped). See Duramax Diesel Supplement. Power Take-Off (PTO) (If Equipped). See Duramax Diesel Supplement. 5 12. Power Outlet (Alternating Current) (If Equipped). See Power Outlets 0 103. 13. Power Outlets 0 103. 14. USB Port 0 158. 15. Wireless Charging 0 104 (If Equipped). 16. Trailer Brake Control Panel (If Equipped). See “Integrated Trailer Brake Control System” under Towing Equipment 0 281. 17. ENGINE START/STOP. See Ignition Positions (Keyless Access) 0 229 or Ignition Positions (Key Access) 0 227. 18. Steering Wheel Controls 0 101 (If Equipped). Driver Information Center (DIC) Controls. See Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125. 19. Horn 0 102. 20. Hood Release. See Hood 0 308. 21. Steering Wheel Adjustment 0 101 (Out of View). 22. Cruise Control 0 250. Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System 0 263 (If Equipped). Heated Steering Wheel 0 101 (If Equipped). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 6 Introduction 23. Data Link Connector (DLC) (Out of View). See Malfunction Indicator Lamp (Check Engine Light) 0 116. 24. Electric Parking Brake 0 245. 25. Fog Lamps 0 143 (If Equipped). Instrument Panel Illumination Control 0 145. Exterior Cargo Lamps 0 144. Exterior Lamp Controls 0 139. Task Lighting 0 144 (If Equipped). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows Keys, Doors, and Windows Keys and Locks Keys (Key Access) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Keys (Keyless Access) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . 10 Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Doors Tailgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Transporting Items That Can Catch Fire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Power Assist Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Vehicle Security Vehicle Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Vehicle Alarm System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Steering Column Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Immobilizer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Exterior Mirrors Convex Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Manual Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Trailer-Tow Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Folding Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Automatic Dimming Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Blind Spot Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Reverse Tilt Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Interior Mirrors Interior Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Manual Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror . . . 38 Rear Camera Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Truck Bed Camera Rearview Mirror . . . . . 41 Windows Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Manual Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Rear Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Roof Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Keys and Locks Keys (Key Access) { Warning Leaving children in a vehicle with the ignition key is dangerous and children or others could be seriously injured or killed. They could operate the power windows or other controls or make the vehicle move. The windows will function with the keys in the ignition, and children or others could be caught in the path of a closing window. Do not leave children in a vehicle with the ignition key. 7 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 8 Keys, Doors, and Windows { Warning If the key is unintentionally rotated while the vehicle is running, the ignition could be moved out of the RUN position. This could be caused by heavy items hanging from the key ring, or by large or long items attached to the key ring that could be contacted by the driver or steering wheel. If the ignition moves out of the RUN position, the engine will shut off, braking and steering power assist may be impacted, and airbags may not deploy. To reduce the risk of unintentional rotation of the ignition key, do not change the way the ignition key and Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, if equipped, are connected to the provided key rings. The ignition key and key rings, and RKE transmitter, if equipped, are designed to work together as a system to reduce the risk of unintentionally moving the key out of the RUN position. The ignition key has a small hole to allow attachment of the provided key ring. It is important that any replacement ignition keys have a small hole. See your dealer if a replacement key is required. The combination and size of the rings that came with your keys were specifically selected for your vehicle. The rings are connected to the key like two links of a chain to reduce the risk of unintentionally moving the key out of the RUN position. Do not add any additional items to the ring attached to the ignition key. Attach additional items only to the second ring, and limit added items to a few essential keys or small, light items no larger than an RKE transmitter. Interference from radio-frequency identification (RFID) tags may prevent the key from starting the vehicle. Keep RFID tags away from the key when starting the vehicle. The key is used for the ignition, all door locks, and the glove box. If equipped with memory seats, keys 1 and 2 are linked to seating positions of memory 1 or 2. See Memory Seats 0 50. Programming Keys Follow these procedures to program up to eight keys to the vehicle. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows Programming with Two Recognized Keys To program a new key: 1. Insert the original, already programmed key in the ignition and turn the ignition on. 2. Turn the ignition off, and remove the key. 3. Quickly, within five seconds, insert the second original already programmed key in the ignition and turn the ignition on. 4. Turn the ignition off, and remove the key. 5. Insert the key to be programmed and turn the ignition on within five seconds. 6. After a few seconds, the security light will turn off once the key has been programmed. 7. Repeat Steps 1–5 if additional keys are to be programmed. If a key is lost or damaged, see your dealer to have a new key made. Programming without Recognized Keys Program a new key to the vehicle when a recognized key is not available. Canadian regulations require that owners see their dealer. If two currently recognized keys are not available, follow this procedure to program the first key. This procedure will take approximately 30 minutes to complete for the first key. The vehicle must be off and all of the keys you wish to program must be with you. 1. Insert the new vehicle key into the ignition. 2. Turn the ignition on. The security light will come on. 3. Wait 10 minutes until the security light turns off. 4. Turn the ignition off. 5. Repeat Steps 2–4 two more times. After the third time, turn the ignition on; the key is learned and all previously known keys will no longer work with the vehicle. 6. To learn a second key, turn the ignition off, insert the second key to be learned, and turn the ignition on. After two keys are learned, the remaining keys can be learned by following the procedure in “Programming with Two Recognized Keys.” 9 The key has a bar-coded key tag that the dealer or qualified locksmith can use to make new keys. Store this information in a safe place, not in the vehicle. See your dealer if a replacement key or additional key is needed. If it becomes difficult to turn a key, inspect the key blade for debris. Periodically clean with a brush or pick. If locked out of the vehicle, see Roadside Assistance Program 0 412. With an active OnStar or connected service plan, an OnStar Advisor may remotely unlock the vehicle. See OnStar Overview 0 420. Keys (Keyless Access) { Warning Leaving children in a vehicle with an ignition key or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter is dangerous and children or others could be seriously injured or killed. They could operate the power window or other controls or make the vehicle move. The windows will function with the key in the ignition or (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 10 Keys, Doors, and Windows If equipped with memory seats, RKE transmitters 1 and 2 are linked to seating positions of memory 1 or 2. See Memory Seats 0 50. Warning (Continued) with the RKE transmitter in the vehicle, and children or others could be caught in the path of a closing window. Do not leave children in a vehicle with the ignition key or an RKE transmitter. Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System See Radio Frequency Statement 0 417. Press the button to remove the key. Never pull the key out without pressing the button. See your dealer if a replacement key or additional key is needed. If the vehicle has the Keyless Access system, the transmitter has a button on the side of the transmitter used to remove the key. This key is used for the driver door and glove box. If it becomes difficult to turn a key, inspect the key blade for debris. Periodically clean with a brush or pick. With an active OnStar or connected service plan, an OnStar Advisor may remotely unlock the vehicle. See OnStar Overview 0 420. If locked out of the vehicle, see Roadside Assistance Program 0 412. If there is a decrease in the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) operating range: . Check the distance. The transmitter may be too far from the vehicle. . Check the location. Other vehicles or objects may be blocking the signal. . Check the transmitter's battery. See “Battery Replacement” later in this section. . If the transmitter is still not working correctly, see your dealer or a qualified technician for service. Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) The RKE transmitter functions may work up to 60 m (197 ft) away from the vehicle. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows Other conditions can affect the performance of the transmitter. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System 0 10. If enabled, the horn chirps when Q is pressed again within three seconds. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Press and hold K to remotely open the windows, if enabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Pressing Q arms the alarm system. See Vehicle Alarm System 0 31. x : Press twice quickly to release the If equipped with remote mirror folding, pressing and holding Q for one second will fold the mirrors, if enabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. 7 : Press and release to initiate the vehicle K : Press once to unlock only the driver door. If K is pressed again within / : Press and release Q, then immediately press and hold / until the turn signal lamps flash or for at least four seconds. The engine may be started from outside the vehicle using the RKE transmitter. See Remote Vehicle Start 0 20. Q : Press to lock all doors. If enabled, the turn signal lamps may flash and/or the horn may sound on the second press to indicate locking has occurred. 11 three seconds, all remaining doors unlock. The interior lamps may come on and stay on for 20 seconds or until the ignition is turned on. If enabled, the turn signal lamps flash twice to indicate unlocking has occurred. If enabled, the exterior lamps may turn on. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Pressing K on the RKE transmitter disarms the alarm system. See Vehicle Alarm System 0 31. If equipped with remote mirror folding, pressing and holding K for one second will unfold the mirrors, if enabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. tailgate, if equipped. locator. The turn signal lamps flash and the horn sounds three times. Press and hold 7 for more than three seconds to activate the panic alarm. The turn signal lamps flash and the horn sounds repeatedly for 30 seconds. The alarm turns off when the ignition is turned on or 7 is pressed again. The ignition must be off for the panic alarm to work. Programming Transmitters to the Vehicle Only RKE transmitters programmed to this vehicle will work. If a transmitter is lost or stolen, a replacement can be purchased and programmed through your dealer. Each vehicle can have up to eight transmitters programmed to it. See your dealer for transmitter programming. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 12 Keys, Doors, and Windows Battery Replacement { Warning Never allow children to play with the RKE transmitter. The transmitter contains a small battery, which can be a choking hazard. If swallowed, internal burns can occur, resulting in severe injury or death. Seek medical attention immediately if a battery is swallowed. Caution To replace the battery: Always replace the battery with the correct type. Replacing the battery with an incorrect type could potentially create a risk of battery explosion. Dispose of used batteries according to instructions and local laws. Do not attempt to burn, crush, or cut the used battery, and avoid exposing the battery to environments with extremely low air pressures or high temperatures. { Warning To avoid personal injury, do not touch metal surfaces on the RKE transmitter when it has been exposed to extreme heat. These surfaces can be hot to the touch at temperatures above 59 °C (138 °F). Caution When replacing the battery, do not touch any of the circuitry on the transmitter. Static from your body could damage the transmitter. Caution If the RKE transmitter is not reassembled properly, liquids could enter the housing and damage the circuitry, resulting in an RKE transmitter malfunction and/or failure. To prevent damage, always follow the steps for RKE transmitter reassembly in this manual to ensure the transmitter is sealed properly whenever the RKE transmitter is opened. Replace the battery in the transmitter soon if the REPLACE BATTERY IN REMOTE KEY displays in the Driver Information Center (DIC). 1. Separate and remove the back cover of the transmitter with a flat, thin object, such as a coin. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows 2. Press and slide the battery down toward the pocket of the transmitter in the direction of the key ring. Do not use a metal object 3. Remove the battery. 4. Insert the new battery, positive side facing up. Replace with a CR2032 or equivalent battery. 5. Ensure that the silicone mat is correctly positioned with no gaps or wrinkles. 6. Set transmitter button side down on a hard surface and press the other half straight down to force the halves together. Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) The Keyless Access system allows for vehicle entry when the transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft). See “Keyless Access Operation” later in this section. The RKE transmitter functions may work up to 60 m (197 ft) away from the vehicle. Other conditions can affect the performance of the transmitter. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System 0 10. 13 The key that is part of the RKE transmitter can be used for all locks. Remove the key by pressing the button on the side of the RKE transmitter near the bottom and pull the key out. Never pull the key out without pressing the button. See your dealer if a new transmitter is needed. / : Press and release Q, then immediately press and hold / until the turn signal lamps flash or for at least four seconds. The engine may be started from outside the vehicle using the RKE transmitter. See Remote Vehicle Start 0 20. Q : Press to lock all doors and the tailgate, if equipped. If enabled, the turn signal lamps flash and/ or the horn may sound on the second press to indicate locking has occurred. If enabled, the horn chirps when Q is pressed again within three seconds. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 14 Keys, Doors, and Windows If the driver door is open when Q is pressed, all doors will lock and then the driver door will immediately unlock, if enabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. If the passenger door is open when pressed, all doors lock. Q is Pressing Q arms the alarm system. See Vehicle Alarm System 0 31. If equipped with remote mirror folding, pressing and holding Q for one second will fold the mirrors, if enabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. K : Press once to unlock only the driver door. If K is pressed again within three seconds, all remaining doors and the tailgate unlock. The interior lamps may come on and stay on for 20 seconds or until the ignition is turned on. If enabled, the turn signal lamps flash twice to indicate unlocking has occurred. If enabled, the exterior lamps may turn on. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Pressing K on the RKE transmitter disarms the alarm system. See Vehicle Alarm System 0 31. If equipped with remote mirror folding, pressing and holding K for one second will unfold the mirrors, if enabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Press and hold K until the windows fully open, if remote window operation is enabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. x : Press twice quickly to release the tailgate, if equipped. 7 : Press and release to initiate vehicle locator. The turn signal lamps flash and the horn sounds three times. Press and hold 7 for more than three seconds to activate the panic alarm. The turn signal lamps flash and the horn sounds repeatedly for 30 seconds. The alarm turns off when the ignition is turned on or 7 is pressed again. The ignition must be off for the panic alarm to work. Keyless Access Operation The Keyless Access system allows for doors and the tailgate to be accessed without pressing the RKE transmitter button. The RKE transmitter must be within 1 m (3 ft) of the tailgate or door being opened. If the vehicle has this feature, there will be a button on the outside door handles. Keyless Access can be programmed to unlock all doors on the first lock/unlock press from the driver door. Keyless Unlocking can also be turned off. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. If equipped with memory seats, RKE transmitters 1 and 2 are linked to seating positions of memory 1 or 2. See Memory Seats 0 50. Keyless Unlocking/Locking from the Driver Door When the doors are locked and the RKE transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft) of the door handle, pressing the lock/unlock button on the driver door handle will unlock the driver door. If the lock/unlock button is pressed again within five seconds, all passenger doors and the tailgate will unlock. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows unlock all doors. Pressing the lock/unlock button will cause all doors to lock if any of the following occur: . The lock/unlock button was used to unlock all doors. . Any vehicle door has been opened and all doors are now closed. Disable/Enable Keyless Unlocking of Exterior Door Handles and Tailgate Driver Side Shown, Passenger Side Similar Pressing the lock/unlock button will cause all doors to lock if any of the following occur: . It has been more than five seconds since the first lock/unlock button press. . Two lock/unlock button presses were used to unlock all doors. . Any vehicle door has been opened and all doors are now closed. Keyless Unlocking/Locking from the Passenger Doors When the doors are locked and the RKE transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft) of the door handle, pressing the lock/unlock button on a passenger door handle, if equipped, will If equipped, keyless unlocking of the exterior door handles and tailgate can be disabled and enabled. Disabling Keyless Unlocking: With the vehicle off, press and hold Q and K on the RKE transmitter at the same time for approximately three seconds. The turn signal lamps will flash four times quickly to indicate access is disabled. Using any exterior handle to unlock the doors or open the tailgate will cause the turn signal lamps to flash four times quickly, indicating access is disabled. If disabled, disarm the alarm system before starting the vehicle. 15 Enabling Keyless Unlocking: With the vehicle off, press and hold Q and K on the RKE transmitter at the same time for approximately three seconds. The turn signal lamps will flash twice quickly to indicate access is enabled. Passive Locking This feature will lock the vehicle several seconds after all doors are closed, if the vehicle is off and at least one RKE transmitter has been removed from the interior, or none remain in the interior. If other electronic devices interfere with the RKE transmitter signal, the vehicle may not detect the RKE transmitter inside the vehicle. If passive locking is enabled, the doors may lock with the RKE transmitter inside the vehicle. Do not leave the RKE transmitter in an unattended vehicle. To customize the doors to automatically lock when exiting the vehicle, see “Remote Lock, Unlock, Start” under Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Temporary Disable of Passive Locking Temporarily disable passive locking by pressing and holding K on the interior door switch with a door open for at least Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 16 Keys, Doors, and Windows four seconds, or until three chimes are heard. Passive locking will then remain disabled until Q on the interior door is pressed, or until the vehicle is turned on. Remote Left in Vehicle Alert When the vehicle is turned off and an RKE transmitter is left in the vehicle, the horn will chirp three times after all doors are closed. To turn on or off see Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Remote No Longer in Vehicle Alert If the vehicle is on with a door open and then all doors are closed, the vehicle will check for RKE transmitters inside. If an RKE transmitter is not detected, the Driver Information Center (DIC) will display NO REMOTE DETECTED and the horn will chirp three times. This occurs only once each time the vehicle is driven. To turn on or off see Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Key Access To access a vehicle with a dead transmitter battery, see Door Locks 0 21. Programming Transmitters to the Vehicle Only RKE transmitters programmed to the vehicle will work. If a transmitter is lost or stolen, a replacement can be purchased and programmed through your dealer. The vehicle can be reprogrammed so that lost or stolen transmitters no longer work. Each vehicle can have up to eight transmitters matched to it. Programming with Recognized Transmitters A new transmitter can be programmed to the vehicle when there are two recognized transmitters. To program, the vehicle must be off and all transmitters, both currently recognized and new, must be with you. 1. Remove the key from a recognized transmitter. 2. Place the two recognized transmitters in the cupholder or on the passenger seat. 3. Insert the vehicle key into the key lock cylinder on the driver door handle. Then turn the key counterclockwise, to the unlock position, five times within 10 seconds. The DIC displays READY FOR REMOTE#3, 4, 5 ETC. Transmitter Pocket without Bucket Seats (Lower Compartment) Transmitter Pocket with Bucket Seats Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows 4. Place the new transmitter in the transmitter pocket/insert. 5. Press ENGINE START/STOP. When the transmitter is learned, the DIC display will show that it is ready to program the next transmitter. 6. Remove the transmitter from the transmitter pocket and press K or Q on the transmitter. To program additional transmitters, repeat Steps 4–6. When all additional transmitters are programmed, press and hold ENGINE START/STOP for approximately 12 seconds to exit programming mode. 7. Return the key back into the transmitter. Programming without Recognized Transmitters If two currently recognized transmitters are not available, follow this procedure to program up to eight transmitters. This feature is not available in Canada. This procedure will take approximately 30 minutes to complete. The vehicle must be off and all transmitters to be programmed must be with you. 1. Remove the vehicle key from the transmitter. 2. Insert the vehicle key into the key lock cylinder on the driver door handle; then turn the key counterclockwise, to the unlock position, five times within 10 seconds. The DIC displays REMOTE LEARN PENDING, PLEASE WAIT. 3. Wait for 10 minutes until the DIC displays PRESS ENGINE START BUTTON TO LEARN, then press ENGINE START/STOP. The DIC will again display REMOTE LEARN PENDING, PLEASE WAIT. 4. Repeat Step 3 two additional times. After the third time all previously known transmitters will no longer work with the vehicle. Remaining transmitters can be relearned during the next steps. The DIC should now display READY FOR REMOTE # 1. Transmitter Pocket without Bucket Seats (Lower Compartment) Transmitter Pocket with Bucket Seats 17 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 18 Keys, Doors, and Windows 5. Place the new transmitter in the transmitter pocket/insert. 6. Press ENGINE START/STOP. When the transmitter is learned, the DIC display will show that it is ready to program the next transmitter. 7. Remove the transmitter from the transmitter pocket/insert and press K or Q on the transmitter. To program additional transmitters, repeat Steps 5–7. When all additional transmitters are programmed, press and hold ENGINE START/STOP for approximately 12 seconds to exit programming mode. 8. Return the key back into the transmitter. 1. Place the transmitter in the transmitter pocket/insert. 2. With the vehicle in P (Park) or N (Neutral) press the brake pedal and ENGINE START/STOP. Replace the transmitter battery as soon as possible. Battery Replacement { Warning Transmitter Pocket without Bucket Seats (Lower Compartment) Starting the Vehicle with a Low Transmitter Battery { Warning If the transmitter battery is weak or if there is interference with the signal, the DIC may display NO REMOTE DETECTED or NO REMOTE KEY WAS DETECTED PLACE KEY IN TRANSMITTER POCKET THEN START YOUR VEHICLE when starting the vehicle. To start the vehicle: Never allow children to play with the RKE transmitter. The transmitter contains a small battery, which can be a choking hazard. If swallowed, internal burns can occur, resulting in severe injury or death. Seek medical attention immediately if a battery is swallowed. Transmitter Pocket with Bucket Seats To avoid personal injury, do not touch metal surfaces on the RKE transmitter when it has been exposed to extreme heat. These surfaces can be hot to the touch at temperatures above 59 °C (138 °F). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows Caution 19 Caution (Continued) When replacing the battery, do not touch any of the circuitry on the transmitter. Static from your body could damage the transmitter. Caution Always replace the battery with the correct type. Replacing the battery with an incorrect type could potentially create a risk of battery explosion. Dispose of used batteries according to instructions and local laws. Do not attempt to burn, crush, or cut the used battery, and avoid exposing the battery to environments with extremely low air pressures or high temperatures. in this manual to ensure the transmitter is sealed properly whenever the RKE transmitter is opened. Replace the battery in the transmitter soon if the DIC displays REPLACE BATTERY IN REMOTE KEY. To replace the battery: 2. Insert a flat, thin object in the center of the transmitter to separate and remove the back cover. Caution If the RKE transmitter is not reassembled properly, liquids could enter the housing and damage the circuitry, resulting in an RKE transmitter malfunction and/or failure. To prevent damage, always follow the steps for RKE transmitter reassembly (Continued) 1. Press the button on the RKE transmitter to remove the key. Never pull the key out without pressing the button. 3. Lift the battery with a flat object. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 20 Keys, Doors, and Windows 4. Remove the battery. 5. Insert the new battery, positive side toward the back cover. Replace with a CR2032 or equivalent battery. 6. Ensure that the silicone mat is correctly positioned with no gaps or wrinkles. 7. Set transmitter button side down on a hard surface and press the other half straight down to force the halves together. 8. Insert the key back into the RKE transmitter. Remote Vehicle Start If equipped with the remote start feature, the climate control system will come on when the vehicle is started remotely, depending on the outside temperature. The rear defog and heated and ventilated seats, if equipped, may also come on. See Heated and Ventilated Front Seats 0 53 and Vehicle Personalization 0 131. If equipped, the automatic heated steering wheel may also come on. See Heated Steering Wheel 0 101. Laws in some communities may restrict the use of remote starters. Check local regulations for any requirements on remote starting of vehicles. Other conditions can affect the performance of the transmitter. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System 0 10. Do not use remote start if the vehicle is low on fuel. The vehicle may run out of fuel. 1. Press and release The vehicle cannot be remote started if: . The RKE transmitter is inside the vehicle or if the key is in the ignition. . The hood is not closed. . There is an emission control system malfunction and the lamp is on. . The ignition is in any mode other than off. . The hazard warning flashers are on. . Two remote starts or a remote start with an extension have been used. . The vehicle is not in P (Park). The engine will turn off during a remote vehicle start if: . The coolant temperature gets too high. . The oil pressure gets low. The RKE transmitter range may be reduced while the vehicle is running. Starting the Engine Using Remote Start Q. 2. Immediately press and hold / until the turn signal lamps flash or for at least four seconds. When the vehicle starts, the parking lamps will turn on. The doors will be locked and the climate control system may come on. The engine will continue to run for 15 minutes. After 30 seconds, repeat Steps 1 and 2 for a 15-minute time extension. Turn the ignition on to operate the vehicle. Extending Engine Run Time The engine run time can be extended by 15 minutes, for a total of 30 minutes, if during the first 15 minutes Steps 1 and 2 are repeated while the engine is still running. An extension can be requested 30 seconds after starting. A maximum of two remote starts, or a single start with an extension, is allowed between ignition cycles. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows The vehicle's ignition must be turned on and then back off to use remote start again. Canceling a Remote Start To cancel a remote start, do one of the following: . Press and hold / until the parking lamps turn off. . Turn on the hazard warning flashers. . Turn the ignition on and then off. Door Locks { Warning Unlocked doors can be dangerous. . Passengers, especially children, can easily open the doors and fall out of a moving vehicle. The doors can be unlocked and opened while the vehicle is moving. The chance of being thrown out of the vehicle in a crash is increased if the doors are not locked. So, all passengers should wear seat belts properly and the doors should be locked whenever the vehicle is driven. (Continued) Warning (Continued) . Young children who get into unlocked vehicles may be unable to get out. A child can be overcome by extreme heat and can suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat stroke. Always lock the vehicle whenever leaving it. . Outsiders can easily enter through an unlocked door when you slow down or stop the vehicle. Locking the doors can help prevent this from happening. 21 From inside, pull the door handle once to unlock the door. Pull the handle again to open the door. See Vehicle Alarm System 0 31. Keyless Access There are several ways to lock and unlock the vehicle. From outside: . Use the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. . Use Keyless Access, if equipped. . Use the key in the driver door or the passenger door, if equipped. From inside, use the power door locks or the manual door locks. To lock the door with the manual door locks, push down on the manual lock knob. If equipped, the remote key must be within 1 m (3 ft) of the tailgate or door being opened or locked. Press the button on the door handle to open. See “Keyless Access Operation” in Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) 0 10 or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) 0 13. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 22 Keys, Doors, and Windows Free-Turning Locks K : Press to unlock the doors. Automatic Door Locks The door key lock cylinder turns freely when either the wrong key is used, or the correct key is not fully inserted. The free-turning door lock feature prevents the lock from being forced open. To reset the lock, turn it to the vertical position with the correct key fully inserted. Remove the key and insert it again. If this does not reset the lock, turn the key halfway around in the cylinder and repeat the reset procedure. Delayed Locking If equipped, the doors will lock automatically when all doors are closed, the ignition is on, and the vehicle is shifted out of P (Park). Power Door Locks If equipped, this feature delays the locking of the doors until five seconds after all doors are closed. Delayed locking can only be turned on when the Open Door Anti-Lockout feature has been turned off. When Q is pressed on the power door lock switch while the door is open, a chime will sound three times indicating delayed locking is active. The doors will lock automatically five seconds after all doors are closed. If a door is reopened before that time, the five-second timer will reset when all doors are closed again. Press Q on the door lock switch again or press Q on the RKE transmitter to lock the doors immediately. This feature can be programmed. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. If equipped with power door locks. Q : Press to lock the doors. If a vehicle door is unlocked, and then opened and closed, the doors will lock either when your foot is removed from the brake or the vehicle speed becomes faster than 13 km/h (8 mph). To unlock the doors: . Press K on the power door lock switch. . Shift the transmission into P (Park). Automatic door locking cannot be disabled. Automatic door unlocking can be programmed. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Lockout Protection If equipped, the ignition is on or in ACC/ ACCESSORY and the power door lock switch is pressed with the driver door open, all the doors will lock and only the driver door will unlock. If the vehicle is off and locking is requested while a door is open, when all doors are closed the vehicle will check to the Keyless Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows 23 Access function (if equipped). If an RKE transmitter is detected and the number of RKE transmitters inside has not reduced, the driver door will unlock and the horn will chirp three times. When the safety lock is enabled, adults and older children will not be able to open the rear door from the inside. Cancel the safety locks to enable the doors to open from the inside. Lockout Protection can be manually overridden with the driver door open by pressing and holding Q on the power door lock switch. To cancel the safety lock: 1. Unlock the door and open it from the outside. 2. Move the lever up to unlock. Do the same for the other door. Open Door Anti-Lockout If equipped, the Open Door Anti-Lockout is turned on and the vehicle is off, the driver door is open, and locking is requested, all the doors will lock and the driver door will unlock. The Open Door Anti-Lockout feature can be turned on or off. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Safety Locks The rear door safety locks prevent passengers from opening the rear doors from inside the vehicle. The safety lock is on the inside edge of the rear doors. To use the safety lock: 1. Move the lever down to the lock position. 2. Close the door. 3. Do the same for the other rear door. To open a rear door when the safety lock is on: 1. Unlock the door by activating the inside handle, by pressing the power door unlock switch, or by using the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. 2. Open the door from the outside. Doors Tailgate Manual Tailgate { Warning It is extremely dangerous to ride on the tailgate, even when the vehicle is operated at low speeds. People riding on the tailgate can easily lose their balance and fall in response to vehicle maneuvers. Falling from a moving vehicle may result in serious injuries or death. Do not allow people to ride on the tailgate. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a seat belt properly. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 24 Keys, Doors, and Windows Use the key to unlock the tailgate. Open the tailgate by lifting up on its handle while pulling the tailgate down. To shut the tailgate, firmly push it upward until it latches. After closing the tailgate, pull it back to be sure it is latched securely. Some tailgates have an electric latch. If the battery is disconnected or has low voltage, the tailgate will not open. The tailgate will resume operation when the battery is reconnected or recharged. Power Release Tailgate { Warning Make sure there is no one in the way of the power tailgate as it is opening and closing, and keep hands away from the tailgate hinges when in use. You or others could be injured if caught in the path of the power tailgate or tailgate hinges. Caution To avoid damage to the tailgate, make sure the area behind the tailgate is clear before opening it. In the case of a dead battery, the tailgate can be opened manually. Contact your dealer or Roadside Assistance. If equipped, to lock or unlock the tailgate, use the RKE transmitter or the key. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) 0 10 or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) 0 13. . Press 5 on the center stack. The vehicle must be in P (Park). To open the tailgate: x twice quickly on the RKE transmitter until the tailgate moves. . Press . Press the touch pad on the tailgate handle after unlocking all doors. Use the top of the tailgate to pull against if Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows assistance is required. If equipped with Keyless Access, a locked tailgate can be opened if the RKE transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft). To close the tailgate, firmly push it upward until it latches. Pull it back to be sure it is latched securely. Power Tailgate 25 x twice quickly on the RKE transmitter until the tailgate moves. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) 0 10 or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) 0 13. If equipped with Keyless Access, a locked tailgate can be opened if the RKE transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft). . Press { Warning Make sure there is no one in the way of the power tailgate as it is opening and closing, and keep hands away from the tailgate hinges when in use. You or others could be injured if caught in the path of the power tailgate or tailgate hinges. . Press the touch pad on the tailgate handle after unlocking all doors. Caution To avoid damage to the tailgate, make sure the area behind the tailgate is clear before opening it. If equipped with a power open/close tailgate, the tailgate can be opened or closed in several ways. To open the tailgate, do one of the following: . Press 5 on the center stack. To close the tailgate, do one of the following: . Press x on the RKE transmitter once, then quickly press and hold x until the tailgate completely closes. If x is released prior to it being fully closed, the tailgate will reopen. . Press and hold 5 on the center stack until the tailgate is fully closed. If 5 is released prior to the tailgate being fully closed, it will reopen. A chime will sound when the tailgate is fully closed. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 26 Keys, Doors, and Windows . Press the touch pad on the tailgate Lift-to-Close Operation handle. A chime sounds and the taillamps flash during the closing operation. If the warning chime is not functioning, the tailgate will not power close. Power opening is still enabled. See your dealer for service. Manual Operation The power tailgate may be temporarily disabled after repeated power cycling over a short period of time. If this occurs, the tailgate can still be operated manually. The vehicle must be in P (Park) to operate the power tailgate. If the vehicle is shifted out of P (Park) while the power function is in progress, the tailgate will continue to completion. If the vehicle is accelerated while the tailgate is still closing, the tailgate may stop and reverse direction. Make sure the tailgate is closed and latched before driving. If the tailgate encounters multiple obstacles, the power function will deactivate. After removing the obstructions, manually close the tailgate to resume normal power operation. To close the tailgate using the lift-to-close feature, lift the tailgate from the full-open position to at least 10 cm (4 in) and hold it momentarily. Then, the tailgate will start closing automatically. If the tailgate is lifted more than halfway between open and close, then it will not close automatically. Obstacle Detection If the tailgate encounters an obstacle during a power open cycle, it will stop on the obstacle. After removing the obstruction, the tailgate can be allowed to open. If the tailgate encounters an obstacle during the closing cycle, it will stop and reverse to full open. The tailgate can be manually closed from the full-open position when the tailgate is lifted in a continuous motion. If the tailgate motion is stopped between the full-open and half-closed positions, the lift-to-close feature can engage and power close the tailgate. If the touch pad is pressed during power operation, the tailgate will stop and allow manual operation. The tailgate must be held after stopping, or it will continue to open. MultiFlex Tailgate { Warning Make sure there is no one in the way of the power tailgate as it is opening and closing, and keep hands away from the tailgate hinges when in use. You or others could be injured if caught in the path of the power tailgate or tailgate hinges. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows 27 Caution To avoid damage to the tailgate, make sure the area behind the tailgate is clear before opening it. If equipped with this feature, the vehicle must be in P (Park). x twice quickly on the RKE transmitter until the tailgate moves. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) 0 10 or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) 0 13. If equipped with Keyless Access, the tailgate can be opened if the RKE transmitter is within 1 m (3 ft). . Press Switches in the inner tailgate prevent the primary tailgate from being opened when the inner tailgate is not fully closed. To open the primary tailgate: . Press 5 on the center stack. . Press the lower touch pad on the tailgate handle after unlocking all doors. Use the top of the tailgate to pull against if assistance is required. To close the primary tailgate, firmly push it upward until it latches. Pull it back to be sure it is latched securely. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 28 Keys, Doors, and Windows Caution MultiFlex Inner Tailgate Enable/Disable Do not open the inner tailgate with the primary tailgate open if there is a hitch ball or trailer attached. This may damage the tailgate. To close the inner tailgate with the primary tailgate closed, firmly push or pull it upward until it latches. Pull it back to be sure it is latched securely. To open the inner tailgate, press the upper touch pad on the tailgate handle after unlocking all doors. Pull the top of the tailgate to open. To close the inner tailgate with the primary tailgate open: . Hold the primary tailgate and firmly close the inner tailgate. . Raise the inner tailgate so it meets the primary tailgate and close together at the same time. When using the tailgate step as a load stop, the load must be secured as the load could shift. See Cargo Tie-Downs 0 98. The MultiFlex inner tailgate may be equipped with an enable/disable feature to prevent the inner tailgate from being opened when a hitch or other equipment is installed that could damage the inner tailgate. To disable the inner tailgate from opening: ensure that the remote key is within 1 meter (3 ft) of the rear bumper and then hold the upper touchpad on the tailgate handle for three seconds. The tail lamps will flash to alert you that the inner gate has been disabled. The inner and outer tailgate Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows 29 can still be operated like a traditional tailgate, but the inner gate will not be able to be opened alone. To enable the inner tailgate function, hold the upper touchpad on the handle for 3 seconds until the tail lamps flash. The inner tailgate can now be opened separately from the outer tailgate. Tailgate Step { Warning To avoid personal injury, keep hands away from the hinges when operating the tailgate step. With the primary and inner tailgates open, the tailgate step can be lowered to access the pickup bed. Using the Step Caution When using the tailgate as a step, the load rating is 170 kg (375 lb), which includes a person and cargo. Overloading the tailgate step can cause damage to the tailgate system. . To lower the tailgate step, press the button at the center of the step. Make sure it lowers to the fully open position. . To close the tailgate step, lift it firmly. Make sure that both side latches are engaged. Do not place a load on top of the step when using it as a load stop. Using the Assist Handle Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 30 Keys, Doors, and Windows Transporting Items That Can Catch Fire The assist handle helps with entering the pickup box. To use: 1. Lift up on the handle until it locks in the open position. 2. To return the assist handle, pull the release lever toward the ball end of the handle and push the handle back to the closed position. { Warning To avoid personal injury and/or vehicle damage when transporting items that can catch fire, such as leaves, mulch, hay, or cardboard, in the truck bed: Applying Loads to Tailgates . Make sure items are securely Caution Do not put ramp loads on the inner tailgate alone. Damage to the inner tailgate may occur. Alternate Method When applying any load to the tailgate, distribute the weight evenly across the width of the tailgate. This applies to all tailgate types. . Use a load-distributing member (1). . Secure the ramp to the bumper (2). contained inside the truck bed. Never allow them to hang over the sides or fall in between the truck bed and the cab. . Never place items between the cab and the truck bed. They could touch hot exhaust parts and ignite. { Warning Keep cigarettes, sparks, and other ignition sources away from the area between the bed of the truck and cab. They could fall onto the fuel system below and start a fire. You or others could be injured and/ or the vehicle damaged. Preferred Method Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows Power Assist Steps { Warning the assist steps. If the obstruction is not cleared, the assist steps remain extended while driving. To avoid personal injury or property damage, before entering or exiting the vehicle, be sure the power assist step is fully extended. Do not step on the power assist step while it is moving. Never place hands or other body parts between the extended power assist step and the vehicle. If equipped, the power assist steps will deploy when the door is opened and automatically retract three seconds after the door is closed. The power assist steps will retract immediately if the vehicle starts moving. Check the step position before exiting the vehicle. Disable the power assist steps before jacking or placing any object under the vehicle. Keep hands, children, pets, objects, and clothing clear of the power assist steps when in motion. The steps will reverse direction if they encounter an obstruction when opening or closing. Remove the obstruction, then open and close the door on the same side to complete the motion of 31 Ice Buildup Too much ice buildup may prevent deployment of the power assist steps. If this happens, disable the power assist steps, clear the ice, then enable the assist steps and confirm normal function prior to use. Vehicle Security This vehicle has theft-deterrent features; however, they do not make the vehicle impossible to steal. Vehicle Alarm System To extend both power assist steps for cleaning, press j while the vehicle is in P (Park) or N (Neutral). Press j again to retract them. The Driver Information Center (DIC) will display a message. Enable/Disable Press and hold j for four seconds to lock and disable the power assist steps. Press and hold j for four seconds again to enable them. The DIC will display a message. The indicator light, on the instrument panel near the windshield, indicates the status of the system. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 32 Keys, Doors, and Windows Off : Alarm system is disarmed. On Solid : Vehicle is secured during the delay to arm the system. Fast Flash : Vehicle is unsecured. A door or the hood is open. Slow Flash : Alarm system is armed. Arming the Alarm System 1. Turn off the vehicle. 2. Lock the vehicle in one of two ways: . Use the RKE transmitter. . With a door open, press Q on the interior of the door. 3. After 30 seconds, the alarm system will arm and the indicator light will begin to slowly flash. Pressing Q on the RKE transmitter a second time will bypass the 30-second delay and immediately arm the alarm system. The vehicle alarm system will not arm if the doors are locked with the key. If the driver door is opened without first unlocking with the RKE transmitter, the horn will chirp and the lights will flash to indicate pre-alarm. If the vehicle is not started, or the door is not unlocked by pressing K on the RKE transmitter during the 10-second pre-alarm, the alarm will be activated. The alarm will also be activated if a passenger door or the hood is opened without first disarming the system. When the alarm is activated, the turn signals flash and the horn sounds for about 30 seconds. The alarm system will then re-arm to monitor for the next unauthorized event. Disarming the Alarm System To disarm the alarm system or turn off the alarm if it has been activated: . Press K on the RKE transmitter. . Start the vehicle. To avoid setting off the alarm by mistake: . Lock the vehicle after all occupants have exited. . Always unlock a door with the RKE transmitter. Unlocking the driver door with the key will not disarm the system or turn off the alarm. How to Detect a Tamper Condition If K is pressed on the RKE transmitter and the horn chirps three times, an alarm occurred previously while the alarm system was armed. If the alarm has been activated, a message will appear on the DIC. Steering Column Lock If equipped, the steering column lock is a theft-deterrent device. This feature locks the steering column when the vehicle is turned off and the driver door is opened, or when the driver door is opened and then the vehicle is turned off. The steering column unlocks when the vehicle is turned on. The Driver Information Center (DIC) may display one of these messages: . A message to service the steering column lock indicates that an issue has been detected with the column lock feature and the vehicle should be serviced. . A message that the steering column is locked indicates that the engine is running, but the steering column is still locked. It is normal for the column to be locked during a remote start, but the column should unlock after the brake Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows pedal is pressed and the vehicle is started. No message will display during a remote start. . A message that the steering wheel must be turned and the vehicle must be started again indicates that the column lock mechanism is bound, the column locking device was unable to unlock the steering column, and the vehicle did not start. If this happens, immediately turn the steering wheel from side to side to unbind the column lock. If this does not unlock the steering column, turn the vehicle off and open the driver door to reset the system. Then turn the vehicle on and immediately turn the steering wheel side to side for about 15 seconds. In some cases, it may take significant force to unbind the column. To keep the steering column from binding, straighten the front wheels before turning off the vehicle. Immobilizer See Radio Frequency Statement 0 417. Immobilizer Operation This vehicle has a passive theft-deterrent system. The system does not have to be manually armed or disarmed. The vehicle is automatically immobilized when the vehicle is turned off. The system is automatically disarmed when the ignition is turned from off to on. The security light, in the instrument cluster, comes on if there is a problem with arming or disarming the theft-deterrent system. The system has one or more RKE transmitters matched to an immobilizer control unit in your vehicle. Only a correctly matched RKE transmitter will start the vehicle. If the transmitter is ever damaged, you may not be able to start your vehicle. 33 When trying to start the vehicle, the security light may come on briefly when the ignition is turned on. If the engine does not start and the security light stays on, there is a problem with the system. Turn the ignition off and try again. If the vehicle will not change ignition modes (ACC/ACCESSORY, on, off), and the RKE transmitter appears to be undamaged, try another transmitter. Or, you may try placing the transmitter in the transmitter pocket located in the center console. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) 0 10 or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) 0 13. If the ignition mode will not change with the other transmitter or with the transmitter in the transmitter pocket, your vehicle needs service. If the ignition does change modes, the first transmitter may be faulty. See your dealer who can service the theft-deterrent system and have a new RKE transmitter programmed to the vehicle. It is possible for the immobilizer system to learn new or replacement RKE transmitters. Up to eight transmitters can be programmed for the vehicle. To program additional transmitters, see "Programming Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 34 Keys, Doors, and Windows Transmitters to the Vehicle" under Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) 0 10 or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) 0 13 Do not leave the transmitter or device that disarms or deactivates the vehicle theft system in the vehicle. When equipped with a key, if the engine still does not start, and the key appears to be undamaged, try another ignition key. It may be necessary to check the fuse. See Fuses and Circuit Breakers 0 336. If the engine still does not start with the other key, the vehicle needs service. If the vehicle does start, the first key may be faulty. See your dealer. It is possible for the immobilizer system to learn new or replacement keys. Up to eight keys can be programmed for the vehicle. To program additional keys, see Keys (Key Access) 0 7 or Keys (Keyless Access) 0 9. Do not leave the key or device that disarms or deactivates the vehicle theft system in the vehicle. See your dealer to get a new key blank cut exactly as the ignition key that operates the system. Exterior Mirrors Manual Mirrors Convex Mirrors If equipped, adjust manual mirrors by moving the mirror up and down or left to right to see a little of the side of the vehicle and to have a clear view behind the vehicle. { Warning A convex mirror can make things, like other vehicles, look farther away than they really are. If you cut too sharply into the right lane, you could hit a vehicle on the right. Check the inside mirror or glance over your shoulder before changing lanes. Using hood-mounted air deflectors and add-on convex mirror attachments could decrease mirror performance. Trailer-Tow Mirrors Standard Mirrors The passenger side mirror is convex shaped. A convex mirror's surface is curved so more can be seen from the driver seat. Trailer-Tow Mirrors The upper portion of both the driver and passenger mirrors is flat. The lower portion of both the driver and passenger mirrors is convex. A convex mirror’s surface is curved so more can be seen from the driver seat. The lower portion is adjusted manually. Extending Mirrors Trailer tow mirrors can extend out for better visibility when towing a trailer. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows To return the mirror to its original position, reverse the motion. 35 If a popping noise from the mirror is heard, this sound is normal as the manual detents are aligning after a manual extend/retract operation has occurred. Auxiliary Cargo Mirror Lamps If equipped, cargo mirror lamps face rearward to provide more light on the sides of the vehicle, if needed. See Exterior Cargo Lamps 0 144. Advanced Trailering Vision System Side Cameras Manual Extend : If equipped, grasp the mirror housing firmly and pull back in one motion, arching slightly toward the rear of the vehicle. Power Extend : If equipped, press the power extend button to fully extend the mirror. Press again to retract. Resetting the Power Extend Mirrors Reset the power extend mirrors if: . The mirrors are accidentally obstructed while extending/retracting. . The mirrors are accidentally manually extended/retracted. . The mirrors vibrate at normal driving speeds. If equipped, the Advanced Trailering Vision System side cameras are on the bottom of the outside mirrors. See “Surround Vision (360 Degrees)” under Assistance Systems for Parking or Backing 0 253. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 36 Keys, Doors, and Windows Power Mirrors Turn Signal Indicator If equipped, the mirror has turn signal indicator lights, which flash in the direction of the turn or lane change. Task Lighting If equipped, task lighting projects light from the outside mirrors to the sides of the vehicle. See Task Lighting 0 144. Puddle Lamps To adjust each mirror: 1. Press j or | to select the driver or passenger side mirror. The indicator light will illuminate. 2. Press the arrows on the control pad to move the mirror in the desired direction. 3. Adjust each outside mirror so that a little of the vehicle and the area behind it can be seen. 4. Press j or mirror. | again to deselect the If equipped, puddle lamps project light from the bottom of the mirror to the area of ground below the driver and passenger doors. See Entry Lighting 0 146 and Exit Lighting 0 146. Folding Mirrors Manual Folding Mirrors If equipped, push the mirror toward the vehicle to fold. Push the mirror outward to return to its original position. Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage when going through an automatic car wash. Power Folding Mirrors Memory Mirrors The vehicle may have memory mirrors. See Memory Seats 0 50. Lane Change Alert (LCA) The vehicle may have LCA. See Lane Change Alert (LCA) 0 266. If equipped, press g to power fold the mirrors. Press again to unfold. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows Resetting the Power Folding Mirrors Reset the power folding mirrors if: . The mirrors are accidentally obstructed while folding. . The mirrors are accidentally manually folded/unfolded. . The mirrors will not stay in the unfolded position. . The mirrors vibrate at normal driving speeds. Fold and unfold the mirrors one time using the mirror controls to reset them to their normal position. A noise may be heard during the resetting of the power folding mirrors. This sound is normal after a manual folding operation. Remote Mirror Folding If equipped, press and hold Q on the RKE transmitter for approximately one second to remotely fold the exterior mirrors. Press and hold K on the RKE transmitter for approximately one second to unfold. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) 0 10 or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) 0 13. This feature can be turned on or off. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Driving with the Blind Spot Mirror Heated Mirrors 1 REAR : If equipped, the rear window defogger also heats the outside mirrors. W : If equipped, press to turn the heated outside mirrors on or off. See “Rear Window Defogger” under Climate Control Systems 0 202 or Dual Automatic Climate Control System 0 204. Automatic Dimming Mirror If equipped, the driver outside mirror automatically adjusts for the glare of the headlamps from behind. This feature comes on when the vehicle is started. Blind Spot Mirrors If equipped, there is a small convex mirror built into the upper and outer corner of the driver outside mirror. It can show objects that may be in the vehicle's blind zone. Actual Mirror View 37 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 38 Keys, Doors, and Windows 1. When the approaching vehicle is a long distance away, the image in the main mirror is small and near the inboard edge of the mirror. 2. As the vehicle gets closer, the image in the main mirror gets larger and moves outboard. 3. As the vehicle enters the blind zone, the image transitions from the main mirror to the blind spot mirror. 4. When the vehicle is in the blind zone, the image only appears in the blind spot mirror. Using the Outside Mirror with the Blind Spot Mirror 1. Set the main mirror so that the side of the vehicle can just be seen and the blind spot mirror has an unobstructed view. 2. When checking for traffic or before changing a lane, look at the main driver/ passenger side mirror to observe traffic in the adjacent lane, behind your vehicle. Check the blind spot mirror for a vehicle in the blind zone. Then, glance over your shoulder to double check before moving slowly into the adjacent lane. Reverse Tilt Mirrors Manual Rearview Mirror If equipped with reverse tilt mirrors and memory seats, the passenger and/or driver mirror tilts to a preselected position when the vehicle is in R (Reverse). This allows the curb to be seen when parallel parking. If equipped, push the tab forward for daytime use and pull it rearward for nighttime use to avoid glare from the headlamps from behind. The mirror(s) may move from their tilted position when: . The vehicle is shifted out of R (Reverse), or remains in R (Reverse) for about 30 seconds. . The vehicle is turned off. . The vehicle is driven in R (Reverse) above a set speed. To turn this feature on or off, see Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Interior Mirrors Interior Rearview Mirrors Adjust the rearview mirror for a clear view of the area behind the vehicle. Do not spray glass cleaner directly on the mirror. Use a soft towel dampened with water. Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror If equipped, the mirror will automatically reduce the glare of the headlamps from behind. The dimming feature comes on each time the vehicle is started. Rear Camera Mirror If equipped, this automatic dimming mirror provides a wide angle camera view of the area behind the vehicle. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows Pull the tab to turn on the display. Push the tab to turn it off. When off the mirror is automatic dimming. Adjust the mirror for a clear view of the area behind the vehicle while the display is off. Press V to scroll through the adjustment options. . Brightness Press t and u to adjust the settings using the indicators on the mirror. The indicators will remain visible for five seconds after the last button activation, and the settings will remain saved. The adjustment options are: . Zoom 39 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 40 Keys, Doors, and Windows { Warning The Rear Camera Mirror (RCM) has a limited view. Portions of the road, vehicles, and other objects may not be seen. Do not drive or park the vehicle using only this camera. Objects may appear closer than they are. Check the outside mirrors or glance over your shoulder when making lane changes or merging. Failure to use proper care may result in injury, death, or vehicle damage. . Tilt Troubleshooting See your dealer for service if a blue screen and 3 are displayed in the mirror, and the display shuts off. Also, push the tab as indicated to return to the automatic dimming mode. The Rear Camera Mirror may not work properly or display a clear image if: . There is glare from the sun or headlamps. This may obstruct objects from view. If needed, push the tab to turn off the display. . Dirt, snow, or other debris blocks the camera lens. Clean the lens with a soft damp cloth. . The camera’s mounting on the vehicle has been damaged, and/or the position or the mounting angle of the camera has changed. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows . Push the button a second time to zoom the camera’s view. . Push the button a third time to deactivate the display. When the vehicle is in R (Reverse) and button has been pressed, the display will remain on until the driver deactivates it. When not in R (Reverse), the video image will time out after eight seconds. . Push the button at the bottom of the mirror once to activate the display. Once the horizontal guideline is in the desired location, press and hold the button for another three seconds and repeat the above step for the vertical guideline programing. To readjust the horizontal location of the guidelines after adjusting the vertical location, press and hold the button for three seconds. After eight seconds since the last button press, the position of the guidelines is locked into memory. Windows Truck Bed Camera Rearview Mirror If equipped, this automatic dimming mirror provides a video image, when activated, to allow the driver to momentarily check the pickup bed area contents or to align and attach a gooseneck or fifth-wheel trailer. 41 { Warning When in Zoomed Mode, the display features guidelines to help the driver align the vehicle when attaching a trailer. Both the horizontal and vertical guideline’s position can be adjusted by the driver. To adjust the position of the horizontal guideline, press and hold the button for eight seconds until it starts blinking. Each subsequent button press scrolls the position of this line through its range of possible settings. Never leave a child, a helpless adult, or a pet alone in a vehicle, especially with the windows closed in warm or hot weather. They can be overcome by the extreme heat and suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat stroke. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 42 Keys, Doors, and Windows Power Windows { Warning The vehicle aerodynamics are designed to improve fuel economy performance. This may result in a pulsing sound when either rear window is down and the front windows are up. To reduce the sound, open either a front window or the sunroof, if equipped. Children could be seriously injured or killed if caught in the path of a closing window. Never leave the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter or keys in a vehicle with children. When there are children in the rear seat, use the window lockout button to prevent operation of the windows. See Keys (Key Access) 0 7 or Keys (Keyless Access) 0 9. The power windows work when the ignition is on, in ACC/ACCESSORY, or when Retained Accessory Power (RAP) is active. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP) 0 232. Using the window switch, press to open or pull to close the window. The windows may be temporarily disabled if they are used repeatedly within a short time. Window Lockout Manual Windows If equipped, turn the hand crank on each door to manually raise or lower the manual windows. With Power Folding Mirrors, Without Similar This feature stops the rear door passenger window switches from working except from the driver position. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows Press 2 to engage the rear window lockout feature. The indicator light is on when engaged. Press 2 again to disengage. Windows Express Movement All windows can be opened without holding the window switch. Press the switch down fully and quickly release to express open the window. If equipped, pull the window switch up fully and quickly release to express close the window. Briefly press or pull the window switch in the same direction to stop that window’s express movement. Express Window Down L: If equipped, this button will be on the center stack. Press and hold L to open all windows. Release L to stop all movement. Use the power window switches to close each window. 43 Window Automatic Reversal System Programming the Power Windows The express-close feature will reverse window movement if it comes in contact with an object. Extreme cold or ice could cause the window to auto-reverse. The window will operate normally after the object or condition is removed. Programming may be necessary if the vehicle battery has been disconnected or discharged. If the window is unable to express-up, program each express-close window: 1. Close all doors. 2. Turn the ignition on or to ACC/ ACCESSORY. 3. Partially open the window to be programmed. Then close it and continue to pull the switch briefly after the window has fully closed. 4. Open the window and continue to press the switch briefly after the window has fully opened. Automatic Reversal System Override { Warning If automatic reversal system override is active, the window will not reverse automatically. You or others could be injured and the window could be damaged. Before using automatic reversal system override, make sure that all people and obstructions are clear of the window path. When the engine is on, override the automatic reversal system by pulling and holding the window switch if conditions prevent it from closing. Remote Window Operation If equipped, this feature allows the windows to be opened remotely. If enabled in vehicle personalization, press and hold K on the RKE transmitter. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 44 Keys, Doors, and Windows Rear Windows Sun Visors Power Sliding Rear Window Roof Sunroof Pull the sun visor down to block glare. If equipped, detach the sun visor from the center mount to pivot to the side window or to extend along the rod. If equipped, the power sliding rear window works when the ignition has been turned on or to ACC/ACCESSORY, or Retained Accessory Power (RAP) must be active. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP) 0 232. . Press the switch to open the window. . Pull the switch to close the window. The power sliding rear window cannot be operated manually. If equipped, there is a lighted mirror on the sun visor. Lift the cover to open. 1. SLIDE Switch 2. TILT Switch If equipped, the sunroof operates when the ignition is on or in ACC/ACCESSORY, or when Retained Accessory Power (RAP) is active. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP) 0 232. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Keys, Doors, and Windows Slide Switch Express-Open/Express-Close : To express-open the sunroof, fully press and release I (1). Press and release I (1) again to stop the movement. To express-close the sunroof, fully press and release K (1). Press and release K (1) again to stop the movement. Sunroof Comfort Stop Position : This vehicle may be equipped with a comfort stop to prevent excessive wind noise. The sunroof will stop approximately halfway open during an express open. To fully open the sunroof, press and release I (1) again. Open/Close (Manual Mode) : To open the sunroof, press and hold I (1). Release I (1) to stop the movement. Press and hold K (1) to close the sunroof. Release K (1) to stop the movement. Tilt Switch Vent : From the closed position, press J (2) to vent the sunroof. Press K (2) to close the vent. When the sunroof is opened, an air deflector will automatically raise. The air deflector will retract when the sunroof is closed. The sunroof also has a sunshade, which can be pulled forward to block sun rays. The sunshade must be opened and closed manually. Automatic Reversal System The sunroof has an automatic reversal system that is only active when the sunroof is operated in express-close mode. If an object is in the path while express-closing, the reversal system will detect an object, stop, and open the sunroof slightly. If frost or other conditions prevent closing, override the feature by closing the sunroof in manual mode. To stop movement, release K (1). 45 Dirt and debris may collect on the sunroof seal or in the track. This could cause an issue with sunroof operation or noise. It could also plug the water drainage system. Periodically open the sunroof and remove any obstacles or loose debris. Wipe the sunroof seal and roof sealing area using a clean cloth, mild soap, and water. Do not remove grease from the sunroof tracks. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 46 Seats and Restraints Seats and Restraints Head Restraints Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Front Seats Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Center Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Power Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Lumbar Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Memory Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Heated and Ventilated Front Seats . . . . . 53 Rear Seats Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Heated Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Seat Belts Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 How to Wear Seat Belts Properly . . . . . . 56 Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Seat Belt Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . 61 Seat Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Safety System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Seat Belt Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Replacing Seat Belt System Parts after a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Airbag System Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . 65 What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . 66 How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . 66 What Will You See after an Airbag Inflates? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Servicing the Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . 71 Adding Equipment to the Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Airbag System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Replacing Airbag System Parts after a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Child Restraints Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Child Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Replacing LATCH System Parts After a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Rear Seat) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Front Passenger Seat) . . . . . 93 Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Center Front Seat) . . . . . . . . 95 Head Restraints { Warning With head restraints that are not installed and adjusted properly, there is a greater chance that occupants will suffer a neck/spinal injury in a crash. Do not drive until the head restraints for all occupants are installed and adjusted properly. Front Seats The vehicle's front seats have adjustable head restraints in the outboard seating positions. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Adjust the head restraint so that the top of the restraint is at the same height as the top of the occupant's head. This position reduces the chance of a neck injury in a crash. Rear Head Restraints The vehicle’s rear seat has head restraints in the outboard seating positions that cannot be adjusted. 47 If you are installing a child restraint in the rear seat, see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79. Center Headrest The vehicle’s rear seat may be equipped with a headrest in the center seating position that cannot be adjusted. If you are installing a child restraint in the rear seat, see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79. Front Seats Seat Adjustment To raise or lower the head restraint, press the button on the side of the head restraint and pull up or push the head restraint down and release the button. Pull and push on the head restraint after the button is released to make sure that it is locked in place. The front seat outboard head restraints are not removable. The head restraint can be folded forward to allow for better visibility when the rear seat is unoccupied. To fold the head restraint, press the button on the side of the head restraint. When an occupant is in the seat, always return the head restraint to the upright position until it locks into place. Push and pull on the head restraint to make sure that it is locked. { Warning You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to adjust a driver seat while the vehicle is moving. Adjust the driver seat only when the vehicle is not moving. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 48 Seats and Restraints Center Seat Power Seat Adjustment If equipped, the center front seatback doubles as an armrest and cupholder/ storage area for the driver and passenger when the center front seat is not used. To adjust a manual seat: 1. Pull the handle at the front of the seat. 2. Slide the seat to the desired position and release the handle. 3. Try to move the seat back and forth to be sure it is locked in place. To adjust the seatback, see Reclining Seatbacks 0 49. To adjust the lumbar support, if equipped, see Lumbar Adjustment 0 50. Pull the strap on the side of the center seatback to fold the center seatback. Do not use the center seatback as a seating position when the seatback is folded down. To raise the seatback, push the seatback rearward until it locks in the upright position. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is locked. To adjust a power seat, if equipped: . Move the seat forward or rearward by sliding the control forward or rearward. . Raise or lower the front part of the seat cushion by moving the front of the control up or down. . Raise or lower the seat by moving the rear of the control up or down. To adjust the seatback, see Reclining Seatbacks 0 49. To adjust the lumbar support, see Lumbar Adjustment 0 50. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints 49 Some vehicles are equipped with a feature that activates a vibrating pulse alert in the driver seat to help the driver avoid crashes. See Driver Assistance Systems 0 252. Reclining Seatbacks { Warning Sitting in a reclined position when the vehicle is in motion can be dangerous. Even when buckled up, the seat belts cannot do their job. The shoulder belt will not be against your body. Instead, it will be in front of you. In a crash, you could go into it, receiving neck or other injuries. The lap belt could go up over your abdomen. The belt forces would be there, not at your pelvic bones. This could cause serious internal injuries. For proper protection when the vehicle is in motion, have the seatback upright. Then sit well back in the seat and wear the seat belt properly. Do not have a seatback reclined if the vehicle is moving. Manual Reclining Seatbacks { Warning If either seatback is not locked, it could move forward in a sudden stop or crash. That could cause injury to the person sitting there. Always push and pull on the seatbacks to be sure they are locked. To adjust a manual seatback: 1. Lift the lever. The seatback will automatically fold forward. 2. To recline, move the seatback rearward to the desired position, then release the lever to lock the seatback in place. 3. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is locked. To return the seatback to the upright position: 1. Lift the lever fully without applying pressure to the seatback, and the seatback will return to the upright position. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 50 Seats and Restraints 2. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is locked. Power Reclining Seatbacks Lumbar Adjustment Memory Seats Power Lumbar Overview To recline a power seatback, if equipped: . Tilt the top of the control rearward to recline. . Tilt the top of the control forward to raise. To adjust the lumbar support, if equipped: . Press and hold the control forward to increase or rearward to decrease upper and lower lumbar support at the same time. If equipped, the memory seat feature allows drivers to save their unique driving positions and a shared exit position. See “Saving Seating Positions” later in this section. The saved positions can be recalled manually by all drivers, see “Manually Recalling Seating Positions” later in this section, and drivers with RKE transmitters 1 and 2 can also recall them automatically. See “Auto Seat Entry Memory Recall” or “Auto Seat Exit Memory Recall” later in this section. To enable automatic recalls, turn on Seat Entry Memory and/or Seat Exit Memory. See “Enable Automatic Recalls” under “Vehicle Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Personalization Settings” later in this section. The memory recalls may be cancelled at any time during the recall. See “Cancel Memory Seating Recalls” later in this section. Identifying Driver Number The vehicle identifies the current driver by their RKE transmitter number 1–8. The current RKE transmitter number may be identified by Driver Information Center (DIC) welcome message, “You are driver x for memory recalls.” This message is displayed the first few times the vehicle is turned on when a different RKE transmitter is used. For Seat Entry Memory to work properly, save positions to the 1 or 2 memory button matching the driver number of this welcome message. To aid in identifying transmitter IDs, it is recommended to only carry one RKE transmitter when entering the vehicle. Perform the following if the welcome message is not displayed: 1. Move all keys and RKE transmitters away from the vehicle. 2. Start the vehicle with another RKE transmitter. A DIC welcome message should display indicating the driver number of the other RKE transmitter. Turn the vehicle off and remove the other key or RKE transmitter from the vehicle. 3. Start the vehicle with the initial key or RKE transmitter. The DIC welcome message should display the driver number of the initial RKE transmitter. Saving Seating Positions Read these instructions completely before saving memory positions. To save preferred driving positions to 1 and 2: 1. Turn the vehicle on or to ACC/ ACCESSORY. A DIC welcome message may indicate the driver number of the current RKE transmitter. See “Identifying Driver Number” previously in this section. 2. Adjust all available memory features to the desired driving position. 3. Press and release SET; a beep will sound. 4. Immediately upon releasing SET, press and hold memory button 1 or 2 matching the current Driver’s RKE transmitter number until two beeps sound. If too much time passes between releasing SET and pressing 1 or 2, the two beeps will 51 not sound indicating memory position were not saved. Repeat Steps 3 and 4 to try again. 5. Repeat Steps 1–4 for the other RKE transmitter 1 or 2 using the other 1 or 2 memory button. It is recommended to save the preferred driving positions to both 1 and 2 if you are the only driver. To save the common exit seating position to B that is used by all drivers for Manually Recalling Seating Positions and Auto Seat Exit Memory Recall features, repeat Steps 1– 4 using B, the exit button. Manually Recalling Seating Positions Press and hold 1, 2, or B button until the recall is complete, to recall the positions previously saved to that button. Manual Memory recall movement for 1, 2 or B buttons may be initiated and will complete to the saved memory position if the vehicle is in or out of P (Park). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 52 Seats and Restraints Enable Automatic Recalls under Vehicle Personalization Settings . For Seat Entry Memory that begins movement to the preferred driving position of the 1 or 2 button when the vehicle is turned on, select the Settings menu, then Vehicle, then Seating Position, then Seat Entry Memory, and then Select ON or OFF. See “Auto Seat Entry Memory Recall” later in this section. . For Seat Exit Memory that begins movement to the preferred exit position of the B button when the vehicle is turned off and the driver door is open or opened, select the Settings menu, then Vehicle, then Seating Position, then Seat Exit Memory, and then Select ON or OFF. See “Auto Seat Exit Memory Recall” later in this section. . See Vehicle Personalization 0 131 for additional setting information. Auto Seat Entry Memory Recall Seat Entry Memory will automatically begin movement to the seating positions of the 1 or 2 button corresponding to the driver’s RKE Transmitter number 1 or 2 detected by the vehicle when: . The vehicle is turned ON. . Seating positions have been previously saved to the same 1 or 2 button. See “Saving Seating Positions” previously in this section. . Seat Entry Memory is enabled. See “Enable Automatic Recalls” under “Vehicle Personalization Settings” previously in this section. . The shift lever is in P (Park). Seat Entry Memory Recall will continue if the vehicle is shifted out of P (Park) prior to reaching the saved memory position. If the saved memory seat position does not automatically recall, verify the recall is enabled. See “Enable Automatic Recalls” under “Vehicle Personalization Settings” previously in this section. If the memory seat recalls to the wrong position, the driver’s RKE transmitter number 1 or 2 may not match the memory button number positions they were saved to. Try the other RKE transmitter or try saving the positions to the other 1 or 2 memory button. See “Saving Seating Positions” previously in this section. Automatic Seat Entry Memory recalls are only available for driver’s RKE Transmitter numbers 1 and 2. RKE transmitters 3–8 will not provide Seat Entry Memory recalls. Auto Seat Exit Memory Recall Seat Exit Memory will begin movement to the seating position of the B button when: . The vehicle is turned off and the driver door is open or opened within a short time. . A seating position has been previously been saved to the B memory button. See “Saving Seating Positions” previously in this section. . Seat Exit Memory is enabled. See “Enable Automatic Recalls” under “Vehicle Personalization Settings” previously in this section. . The shift lever is in P (Park). Seat Exit Memory recall will continue if the vehicle is shifted out of P (Park) prior to reaching the saved memory position. Seat Exit Memory is not linked to the driver’s RKE transmitter. The seating position saved to B is used for all drivers. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Cancel Memory Seating Recalls . During any memory recall: Press a power seat control Press SET memory button . During Manual memory recall: Release 1, 2, or B memory button . During Auto Seat Entry Memory Recall: Turn vehicle off Press SET, 1, 2, or B memory buttons . During Auto Seat Exit Memory Recall: Press SET, 1, 2, or B memory buttons Obstructions If something has blocked the seat while recalling a memory position, the recall may stop. Remove the obstruction and try the recall again. If the memory position still does not recall, see your dealer. 53 Heated and Ventilated Front Seats { Warning If temperature change or pain to the skin cannot be felt, the seat heater may cause burns. To reduce the risk of burns, use care when using the seat heater, especially for long periods of time. Do not place anything on the seat that insulates against heat, such as a blanket, cushion, cover, or similar item. This may cause the seat heater to overheat. An overheated seat heater may cause a burn or may damage the seat. Heated and Ventilated Seat Buttons Shown, Heated Seat Buttons Similar If equipped, the buttons are on the center stack. To operate, the engine must be running. Press I or + to heat the driver or passenger seatback only. Press J or z to heat the driver or passenger seat cushion and seatback. Press C or { to ventilate the driver or passenger seat. The indicator light on the button comes on when this feature is on. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 54 Seats and Restraints Press the button once for the highest setting. With each press of the button, the seat will change to the next lower setting, and then to the off setting. The indicator lights next to the buttons indicate three for the highest setting and one for the lowest. If the heated seats are on high, their level may automatically be lowered after approximately 30 minutes. The heated or ventilated seats will not turn on during a remote start unless they are enabled in vehicle personalization. See Remote Vehicle Start 0 20 and Vehicle Personalization 0 131. seat; for example, if a child entered the vehicle through the rear door and left the vehicle without the vehicle being shut off. Rear Seats Folding the Rear Seat Cushion Rear Seat Reminder Remote Start Heated and Ventilated Seats Either side of the rear seat cushion can be folded up for added cargo space. If equipped, the message REAR SEAT REMINDER LOOK IN REAR SEAT displays under certain conditions indicating there may be an item or passenger in the rear seat. Check before exiting the vehicle. If equipped, the heated seats will turn on automatically during a remote start if it is cold outside and the ventilated seats will turn on automatically if it is hot outside. If equipped, the heated steering wheel will turn on automatically during a remote start if it is cold outside. The heated and ventilated seat indicators and heated steering wheel indicator may come on during this operation. The heated and ventilated seats and heated steering wheel may cancel when the vehicle is started. These features can be manually selected after the ignition is turned on. The temperature performance of an unoccupied seat may be reduced. This is normal. This feature will activate when a second row door is opened while the vehicle is on or up to 10 minutes before the vehicle is turned on. There will be an alert when the vehicle is turned off. The alert does not directly detect objects in the rear seat; instead, under certain conditions, it detects when a rear door is opened and closed, indicating that there may be something in the rear seat. The feature is active only once each time the vehicle is turned on and off, and will require reactivation by opening and closing the second row doors. There may be an alert even when there is nothing in the rear The feature can be turned on or off. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Caution Folding a rear seat with the seat belts still fastened may cause damage to the seat or the seat belts. Always unbuckle the seat belts and return them to their normal stowed position before folding a rear seat. Make sure that nothing is on the seat cushion. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Heated Rear Seats { Warning If you cannot feel temperature change or pain to the skin, the seat heater may cause burns. See the Warning under Heated and Ventilated Front Seats 0 53. 55 This feature turns on at the highest setting. With each press of the button, the heated seat changes to the next lower setting, and then the off setting. Three lights indicate the highest setting, and one light indicates the lowest. If the heated seats are on high, the level may automatically be lowered after approximately 30 minutes. Seat Belts This section describes how to use seat belts properly, and some things not to do. To fold the seat, slowly pull the seat cushion up. { Warning To return the seat to the normal seating position, slowly pull the seat cushion down. { Warning A seat belt that is improperly routed, not properly attached, or twisted will not provide the protection needed in a crash. The person wearing the belt could be seriously injured. After raising the rear seatback, always check to be sure that the seat belts are properly routed and attached, and are not twisted. If available, the buttons are on the rear of the center console. To operate, the engine must be running. Press M or L to heat the left or right outboard seat cushion. An indicator on the climate control display appears when this feature is on. Do not let anyone ride where a seat belt cannot be worn properly. In a crash, if you or your passenger(s) are not wearing seat belts, injuries can be much worse than if you are wearing seat belts. You can be seriously injured or killed by hitting things inside the vehicle harder or by being ejected from the vehicle. In addition, anyone who is not buckled up can strike other passengers in the vehicle. It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, passengers riding in these (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 56 Seats and Restraints Warning (Continued) areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed. Do not allow passengers to ride in any area of the vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat belts. Always wear a seat belt, and check that all passenger(s) are restrained properly too. This vehicle has indicators as a reminder to buckle the seat belts. See Seat Belt Reminders 0 114. Why Seat Belts Work When riding in a vehicle, you travel as fast as the vehicle does. If the vehicle stops suddenly, you keep going until something stops you. It could be the windshield, the instrument panel, or the seat belts! When you wear a seat belt, you and the vehicle slow down together. There is more time to stop because you stop over a longer distance and, when worn properly, your strongest bones take the forces from the seat belts. That is why wearing seat belts makes such good sense. Questions and Answers About Seat Belts Q: Will I be trapped in the vehicle after a crash if I am wearing a seat belt? A: You could be — whether you are wearing a seat belt or not. Your chance of being conscious during and after a crash, so you can unbuckle and get out, is much greater if you are belted. Q: If my vehicle has airbags, why should I have to wear seat belts? A: Airbags are supplemental systems only. They work with seat belts — not instead of them. Whether or not an airbag is provided, all occupants still have to buckle up to get the most protection. Also, in nearly all states and in all Canadian provinces, the law requires wearing seat belts. How to Wear Seat Belts Properly Follow these rules for everyone's protection. There are additional things to know about seat belts and children, including smaller children and infants. If a child will be riding in the vehicle, see Older Children 0 73 or Infants and Young Children 0 74. Review and follow the rules for children in addition to the following rules. It is very important for all occupants to buckle up. Statistics show that unbelted people are hurt more often in crashes than those who are wearing seat belts. There are important things to know about wearing a seat belt properly. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints { Warning You can be seriously injured, or even killed, by not wearing your seat belt properly. . Sit up straight and always keep your feet on the floor in front of you (if possible). . Wear the lap part of the belt low and snug on the hips, just touching the thighs. In a crash, this applies force to the strong pelvic bones and you would be less likely to slide under the lap belt. If you slid under it, the belt would apply force on your abdomen. This could cause serious or even fatal injuries. . Wear the shoulder belt over the shoulder and across the chest. These parts of the body are best able to take belt restraining forces. The shoulder belt locks if there is a sudden stop or crash. Never allow the lap or shoulder belt to become loose or twisted. 57 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 58 Seats and Restraints { Warning Never wear the shoulder belt under both arms or behind your back. Never route the lap or shoulder belt over an armrest. { Warning The seat belt can be pinched if it is routed under plastic trim on the seat, such as trim around the rear seatback folding handle or side airbag. In a crash, pinched seat belts might not provide adequate protection. Never allow seat belts to be routed under plastic trim pieces. Always use the correct buckle for your seating position. You can be seriously injured or killed if the shoulder belt is worn behind your back, under your legs, or wrapped around your neck. The shoulder belt can tighten but cannot be loosened if it is locked. The shoulder belt locks when it is pulled all the way out of the retractor. It unlocks when the shoulder belt is allowed to go all the way back into the retractor, but it cannot do this if it is wrapped around you. You may have to cut the seat belt if it is locked and tightened around you. Lap-Shoulder Belt All seating positions in the vehicle have a lap-shoulder belt. The following instructions explain how to wear a lap-shoulder belt properly. 1. Adjust the seat, if the seat is adjustable, so you can sit up straight. To see how, see “Seats” in the Index. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints 59 position on the seat, move the seat rearward or recline the seat until the shoulder belt retractor lock releases. Engaging the child restraint locking feature in the front outboard seating position may affect the passenger sensing system, if equipped. See Passenger Sensing System 0 67. 2. Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you. Do not let it get twisted. The lap-shoulder belt may lock if you pull the belt across you very quickly. If this happens, let the belt go back slightly to unlock it. Then pull the belt across you more slowly. If the shoulder portion of a passenger belt is pulled out all the way, the child restraint locking feature may be engaged. See Child Restraint Systems 0 76. If this occurs, let the belt go back all the way and start again. If the locking feature stays engaged after letting the belt go back to stowed If the webbing locks in the latch plate before it reaches the buckle, tilt the latch plate flat to unlock. 3. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks. Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure. If the belt is not long enough, see Seat Belt Extender 0 61. Position the release button on the buckle so that the seat belt could be quickly unbuckled if necessary. If equipped with a shoulder belt height adjuster, move it to the height that is right for you. See "Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster" later in this section for instructions on use and important safety information. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 60 Seats and Restraints To unlatch the belt, push the button on the buckle. The belt should return to its stowed position. Always stow the seat belt slowly. If the seat belt webbing returns quickly to the stowed position, the retractor may lock and cannot be pulled out. If this happens, pull the seat belt straight out firmly to unlock the webbing, and then release it. If the webbing is still locked in the retractor, see your dealer. 4. To make the lap part tight, pull up on the shoulder belt. Before a door is closed, be sure the seat belt is out of the way. If a door is slammed against a seat belt, damage can occur to both the seat belt and the vehicle. Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster The vehicle may have a shoulder belt height adjuster for the driver and front outboard passenger positions. Adjust the height so the shoulder portion of the belt is on the shoulder and not falling off of it. The belt should be close to, but not contacting, the neck. Improper shoulder belt height adjustment could reduce the effectiveness of the seat belt in a crash. See How to Wear Seat Belts Properly 0 56. Push the release button to move the height adjuster to the desired position. After the adjuster is set to the desired position, try to move it down without pushing the release button to make sure it has locked into position. Seat Belt Pretensioners This vehicle has seat belt pretensioners for the front outboard occupants. Although the seat belt pretensioners cannot be seen, they are part of the seat belt assembly. They can help tighten the seat belts during the early stages of a moderate to severe frontal, near frontal, or rear crash if the threshold conditions for pretensioner activation are Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints met. Seat belt pretensioners can also help tighten the seat belts in a side crash or rollover event. Pretensioners work only once. If the pretensioners activate in a crash, the pretensioners and probably other parts of the vehicle's seat belt system will need to be replaced. See Replacing Seat Belt System Parts after a Crash 0 62. Seat Belt Use During Pregnancy Seat Belt Extender Seat belts work for everyone, including pregnant women. Like all occupants, they are more likely to be seriously injured if they do not wear seat belts. If the vehicle's seat belt will fasten around you, you should use it. A pregnant woman should wear a lap-shoulder belt, and the lap portion should be worn as low as possible, below the rounding, throughout the pregnancy. Safety System Check Do not sit on the outboard seat belt while entering or exiting the vehicle or at any time while sitting in the seat. Sitting on the seat belt can damage the webbing and hardware. Rear Seat Belt Comfort Guides Rear seat belt comfort guides may provide added seat belt comfort for older children who have outgrown booster seats and for some adults. When installed on a shoulder belt, the comfort guide positions the shoulder belt away from the neck and head. Comfort guides are available through your dealer for the rear outboard seating positions. Instructions are included with the comfort guides. 61 The best way to protect the fetus is to protect the mother. When a seat belt is worn properly, it is more likely that the fetus will not be hurt in a crash. For pregnant women, as for anyone, the key to making seat belts effective is wearing them properly. But if a seat belt is not long enough, your dealer will order you an extender. Only a GM dealer issued extender should be used. When you go in to order it, take the heaviest coat you will wear, so the extender will be long enough for you. To help avoid personal injury, do not let someone else use it, and use it only for the seat it is made to fit. The extender has been designed for adults. Never use it for securing child restraints. For more information on the proper use and fit of seat belt extenders see the instruction sheet that comes with the extender. Periodically check the seat belt reminder, seat belts, buckles, latch plates, retractors, shoulder belt height adjusters (if equipped), and seat belt anchorages to make sure they are all in working order. Look for any other loose or damaged seat belt system parts that might keep a seat belt system from performing properly. See your dealer to have it repaired. Torn, frayed, or twisted seat belts may not protect you in a crash. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 62 Seats and Restraints Torn or frayed seat belts can rip apart under impact forces. If a belt is torn or frayed, have it replaced immediately. If a belt is twisted, it may be possible to untwist by reversing the latch plate on the webbing. If the twist cannot be corrected, ask your dealer to fix it. Make sure the seat belt reminder light is working. See Seat Belt Reminders 0 114. Keep seat belts clean and dry. See Seat Belt Care 0 62. Seat Belt Care Keep belts clean and dry. Seat belts should be properly cared for and maintained. Seat belt hardware should be kept dry and free of dust or debris. As necessary, exterior hard surfaces and seat belt webbing may be lightly cleaned with mild soap and water. Ensure there is not excessive dust or debris in the mechanism. If dust or debris exists in the system please see the dealer. Parts may need to be replaced to ensure proper functionality of the system. { Warning Do not bleach or dye seat belt webbing. It may severely weaken the webbing. In a crash, they might not be able to provide adequate protection. Clean and rinse seat belt webbing only with mild soap and lukewarm water. Allow the webbing to dry. Replacing Seat Belt System Parts after a Crash { Warning A crash can damage the seat belt system in the vehicle. A damaged seat belt system may not properly protect the person using it, resulting in serious injury or even death in a crash. To help make sure the seat belt systems are working properly after a crash, have them inspected and any necessary replacements made as soon as possible. After a minor crash, replacement of seat belts may not be necessary. But the seat belt assemblies that were used during any crash may have been stressed or damaged. See your dealer to have the seat belt assemblies inspected or replaced. New parts and repairs may be necessary even if the seat belt system was not being used at the time of the crash. Have the seat belt pretensioners checked if the vehicle has been in a crash, or if the airbag readiness light stays on after you start the vehicle or while you are driving. See Airbag Readiness Light 0 114. Airbag System The vehicle has the following airbags: . A frontal airbag for the driver . A frontal airbag for the front outboard passenger . A seat-mounted side impact airbag for the driver . A seat-mounted side impact airbag for the front outboard passenger . A roof-rail airbag for the driver and the passenger seated directly behind the driver Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints . A roof-rail airbag for the front outboard passenger and the passenger seated directly behind the front outboard passenger All vehicle airbags have the word AIRBAG on the trim or on a label near the deployment opening. For frontal airbags, the word AIRBAG is on the center of the steering wheel for the driver and on the instrument panel for the front outboard passenger. For seat-mounted side impact airbags, the word AIRBAG is on the side of the seatback or side of the seat closest to the door. For roof-rail airbags, the word AIRBAG is on the ceiling or trim. Airbags are designed to supplement the protection provided by seat belts. Even though today's airbags are also designed to help reduce the risk of injury from the force of an inflating bag, all airbags must inflate very quickly to do their job. Here are the most important things to know about the airbag system: 63 { Warning Warning (Continued) You can be severely injured or killed in a crash if you are not wearing your seat belt, even with airbags. Airbags are designed to work with seat belts, not replace them. Also, airbags are not designed to inflate in every crash. In some crashes seat belts are the only restraint. See When Should an Airbag Inflate? 0 65. unnecessarily close to any airbag, as you would be if sitting on the edge of the seat or leaning forward. Seat belts help keep you in position before and during a crash. Always wear a seat belt, even with airbags. The driver should sit as far back as possible while still maintaining control of the vehicle. The seat belts and the front outboard passenger airbags are most effective when you are sitting well back and upright in the seat with both feet on the floor. Wearing your seat belt during a crash helps reduce your chance of hitting things inside the vehicle or being ejected from it. Airbags are “supplemental restraints” to the seat belts. Everyone in the vehicle should wear a seat belt properly, whether or not there is an airbag for that person. { Warning Because airbags inflate with great force and faster than the blink of an eye, anyone who is up against, or very close to, any airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or killed. Do not sit (Continued) Occupants should not lean on or sleep against the door or side windows in seating positions with seat-mounted side impact airbags and/or roof-rail airbags. { Warning Children who are up against, or very close to, any airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or killed. Always secure children properly in the vehicle. To read how, see Older Children 0 73 or Infants and Young Children 0 74. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 64 Seats and Restraints The driver frontal airbag is in the center of the steering wheel. There is an airbag readiness light on the instrument cluster, which shows the airbag symbol. The system checks the airbag electrical system for malfunctions. The light tells you if there is an electrical problem. See Airbag Readiness Light 0 114. Where Are the Airbags? Driver Side Shown, Passenger Side Similar The front outboard passenger frontal airbag is in the passenger side instrument panel. The driver and front outboard passenger seat-mounted side impact airbags are in the side of the seatbacks closest to the door. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Warning (Continued) do not attach or put anything on the steering wheel hub or on or near any other airbag covering. Do not use seat accessories that block the inflation path of a seat-mounted side impact airbag. Driver Side Crew Cab Shown, Passenger Side Double and Regular Cabs Similar The roof-rail airbags for the driver, front outboard passenger, and second row outboard passengers are in the ceiling above the side windows. { Warning If something is between an occupant and an airbag, the airbag might not inflate properly or it might force the object into that person causing severe injury or even death. The path of an inflating airbag must be kept clear. Do not put anything between an occupant and an airbag, and (Continued) Never secure anything to the roof of a vehicle with roof-rail airbags by routing a rope or tie‐down through any door or window opening. If you do, the path of an inflating roof-rail airbag will be blocked. When Should an Airbag Inflate? This vehicle is equipped with airbags. See Airbag System 0 62. Airbags are designed to inflate if the impact exceeds the specific airbag system's deployment threshold. Deployment thresholds are used to predict how severe a crash is likely to be in time for the airbags to inflate and help restrain the occupants. The vehicle has electronic sensors that help the airbag system determine the severity of the impact. Deployment thresholds can vary with specific vehicle design. 65 Frontal airbags are designed to inflate in moderate to severe frontal or near frontal crashes to help reduce the potential for severe injuries, mainly to the driver's or front outboard passenger's head and chest. Whether the frontal airbags will or should inflate is not based primarily on how fast the vehicle is traveling. It depends on what is hit, the direction of the impact, and how quickly the vehicle slows down. Frontal airbags may inflate at different crash speeds depending on whether the vehicle hits an object straight on or at an angle, and whether the object is fixed or moving, rigid or deformable, narrow or wide. Frontal airbags are not intended to inflate during vehicle rollovers, rear impacts, or many side impacts. In addition, the vehicle has advanced technology frontal airbags. Advanced technology frontal airbags adjust the restraint according to crash severity. Seat-mounted side impact airbags are designed to inflate in moderate to severe side crashes depending on the location of the impact. Seat-mounted side impact airbags are not designed to inflate in frontal impacts, near frontal impacts, rollovers, Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 66 Seats and Restraints or rear impacts. A seat-mounted side impact airbag is designed to inflate on the side of the vehicle that is struck. Roof-rail airbags are designed to inflate in moderate to severe side crashes depending on the location of the impact. In addition, these roof-rail airbags are designed to inflate during a rollover or in a severe frontal impact. Roof-rail airbags are not designed to inflate in rear impacts. Both roof-rail airbags will inflate when either side of the vehicle is struck or if the sensing system predicts that the vehicle is about to roll over on its side, or in a severe frontal impact. In any particular crash, no one can say whether an airbag should have inflated simply because of the vehicle damage or repair costs. What Makes an Airbag Inflate? In a deployment event, the sensing system sends an electrical signal triggering a release of gas from the inflator. Gas from the inflator fills the airbag causing the bag to break out of the cover. The inflator, the airbag, and related hardware are all part of the airbag module. For airbag locations, see Where Are the Airbags? 0 64. How Does an Airbag Restrain? In moderate to severe frontal or near frontal collisions, even belted occupants can contact the steering wheel or the instrument panel. In moderate to severe side collisions, even belted occupants can contact the inside of the vehicle. Airbags supplement the protection provided by seat belts by distributing the force of the impact more evenly over the occupant's body. Rollover capable roof-rail airbags are designed to help contain the head and chest of occupants in the outboard seating positions in the first and second rows. The rollover capable roof-rail airbags are designed to help reduce the risk of full or partial ejection in rollover events, although no system can prevent all such ejections. But airbags would not help in many types of collisions, primarily because the occupant's motion is not toward those airbags. See When Should an Airbag Inflate? 0 65. Airbags should never be regarded as anything more than a supplement to seat belts. What Will You See after an Airbag Inflates? After frontal and seat-mounted side impact airbags inflate, they quickly deflate, so quickly that some people may not even realize the airbags inflated. Roof-rail airbags may still be at least partially inflated for some time after they inflate. Some components of the airbag module may be hot for several minutes. For location of the airbags, see Where Are the Airbags? 0 64. The parts of the airbag that come into contact with you may be warm, but not too hot to touch. There may be some smoke and dust coming from the vents in the deflated airbags. Airbag inflation does not prevent the driver from seeing out of the windshield or being able to steer the vehicle, nor does it prevent people from leaving the vehicle. { Warning When an airbag inflates, there may be dust in the air. This dust could cause breathing problems for people with a history of asthma or other breathing trouble. To avoid this, everyone in the (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Warning (Continued) vehicle should get out as soon as it is safe to do so. If you have breathing problems but cannot get out of the vehicle after an airbag inflates, then get fresh air by opening a window or a door. If you experience breathing problems following an airbag deployment, you should seek medical attention. The vehicle has a feature that may automatically unlock the doors, turn on the interior lamps and hazard warning flashers, and shut off the fuel system after the airbags inflate. The feature may also activate, without airbag inflation, after an event that exceeds a predetermined threshold. After turning the ignition off and then on again, the fuel system will return to normal operation; the doors can be locked, the interior lamps can be turned off, and the hazard warning flashers can be turned off using the controls for those features. If any of these systems are damaged in the crash they may not operate as normal. { Warning A crash severe enough to inflate the airbags may have also damaged important functions in the vehicle, such as the fuel system, brake and steering systems, etc. Even if the vehicle appears to be drivable after a moderate crash, there may be concealed damage that could make it difficult to safely operate the vehicle. Use caution if you should attempt to restart the engine after a crash has occurred. In many crashes severe enough to inflate the airbag, windshields are broken by vehicle deformation. Additional windshield breakage may also occur from the front outboard passenger airbag. . Airbags are designed to inflate only once. After an airbag inflates, you will need some new parts for the airbag system. If you do not get them, the airbag system will not be there to help protect you in another crash. A new system will include airbag modules and possibly other parts. The service manual for the vehicle covers the need to replace other parts. 67 . The vehicle has a crash sensing and diagnostic module which records information after a crash. See Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy 0 418 and Event Data Recorders 0 419. . Let only qualified technicians work on the airbag systems. Improper service can mean that an airbag system will not work properly. See your dealer for service. Passenger Sensing System The vehicle has a passenger sensing system for the front outboard passenger position. The passenger airbag status indicator will light on the overhead console when the vehicle is started. United States Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 68 Seats and Restraints Whenever possible, children aged 12 and under should be secured in a rear seating position. Canada The words ON and OFF, or the symbols for on and off, will be visible during the system check. When the system check is complete, either the word ON or OFF, or the symbol for on or off, will be visible. See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator 0 115. The passenger sensing system turns off the front outboard passenger frontal airbag under certain conditions. No other airbag is affected by the passenger sensing system. The passenger sensing system works with sensors that are part of the front outboard passenger seat and seat belt. The sensors are designed to detect the presence of a properly seated occupant and determine if the front outboard passenger frontal airbag should be allowed to inflate or not. According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly secured in a rear seat in the correct child restraint for their weight and size. Never put a rear-facing child seat in the front. This is because the risk to the rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag inflates. { Warning A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the passenger frontal airbag inflates. This is because the back of the rear-facing child restraint would be very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a forward-facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the passenger frontal airbag inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward position. Even if the passenger sensing system has turned off the passenger frontal airbag, no system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that an airbag will not deploy under some unusual circumstance, even though the airbag is turned off. (Continued) Warning (Continued) Never put a rear-facing child restraint in the front seat, even if the airbag is off. If securing a forward-facing child restraint in the front outboard passenger seat, always move the seat as far back as it will go. It is better to secure child restraints in the rear seat. Consider using another vehicle to transport the child when a rear seat is not available. If the vehicle does not have a rear seat that will accommodate a rear-facing child restraint, a rear-facing child restraint should not be installed in the vehicle, even if the airbag is off. The passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the front outboard passenger frontal airbag if: . The front outboard passenger seat is unoccupied. . The system determines an infant is present in a child restraint. . A front outboard passenger takes his/her weight off of the seat for a period of time. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints . There is a critical problem with the airbag system or the passenger sensing system. When the passenger sensing system has turned off the front outboard passenger frontal airbag, the OFF indicator will light and stay lit as a reminder that the airbag is off. See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator 0 115. The passenger sensing system is designed to turn on the front outboard passenger frontal airbag anytime the system senses that a person of adult size is sitting properly in the front outboard passenger seat. When the passenger sensing system has allowed the airbag to be enabled, the ON indicator will light and stay lit as a reminder that the airbag is active. For some children, including children in child restraints, and for very small adults, the passenger sensing system may or may not turn off the front outboard passenger frontal airbag, depending upon the person's seating posture and body build. Everyone in the vehicle who has outgrown child restraints should wear a seat belt properly — whether or not there is an airbag for that person. { Warning If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and stays on, it means that something may be wrong with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right away. See Airbag Readiness Light 0 114 for more information, including important safety information. If the On Indicator Is Lit for a Child Restraint The passenger sensing system is designed to turn off the front outboard passenger frontal airbag if the system determines that an infant is present in a child restraint. If a child restraint has been installed and the ON indicator is lit: 1. Turn the vehicle off. 2. Remove the child restraint from the vehicle. 3. Remove any additional items from the seat such as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat heaters, or seat massagers. 69 4. Reinstall the child restraint following the directions provided by the child restraint manufacturer and refer to Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Center Front Seat) 0 95 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Rear Seat) 0 89 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Front Passenger Seat) 0 93. Make sure the seat belt retractor is locked by pulling the shoulder belt all the way out of the retractor when installing the child restraint, even if the child restraint is equipped with a seat belt lock off. When the retractor lock is set, the belt can be tightened but not pulled out of the retractor. 5. If, after reinstalling the child restraint and restarting the vehicle, the ON indicator is still lit, turn the vehicle off. Then slightly recline the vehicle seatback and adjust the seat cushion, if adjustable, to make sure that the vehicle seatback is not pushing the child restraint into the seat cushion. Also make sure the child restraint is not trapped under the vehicle head restraint. If this happens, adjust the head restraint. See Head Restraints 0 46. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 70 Seats and Restraints 6. Restart the vehicle. The passenger sensing system may or may not turn off the airbag for a child in a child restraint depending upon the child’s size. It is better to secure child restraints in the rear seat. Consider using another vehicle to transport the child when a rear seat is not available. Never put a rear-facing child restraint in the front seat, even if the ON indicator is not lit. If the Off Indicator Is Lit for an Adult-Sized Occupant If a person of adult size is sitting in the front outboard passenger seat, but the OFF indicator is lit, it could be because that person is not sitting properly in the seat or that the child restraint locking feature is engaged. Use the following steps to allow the system to detect that person and enable the front outboard passenger frontal airbag: 1. Turn the vehicle off. 2. Remove any additional material from the seat, such as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat heaters, or seat massagers. 3. Place the seatback in the fully upright position. 4. Have the person sit upright in the seat, centered on the seat cushion, with legs comfortably extended. 5. If the shoulder portion of the belt is pulled out all the way, the child restraint locking feature will be engaged. This may unintentionally cause the passenger sensing system to turn the airbag off for some adult-sized occupants. If this happens, unbuckle the belt, let the belt go back all the way, and then buckle the belt again without pulling the belt out all the way. 6. Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in this position for two to three minutes after the ON indicator is lit. { Warning If the front outboard passenger airbag is turned off for an adult-sized occupant, the airbag will not be able to inflate and help protect that person in a crash, resulting in an increased risk of serious injury or even death. An adult-sized occupant should not ride in the front outboard passenger seat, if the passenger airbag OFF indicator is lit. Additional Factors Affecting System Operation Seat belts help keep the passenger in position on the seat during vehicle maneuvers and braking, which helps the passenger sensing system maintain the passenger airbag status. See “Seat Belts” and “Child Restraints” in the Index for additional information about the importance of proper restraint use. A thick layer of additional material, such as a blanket or cushion, or aftermarket equipment such as seat covers, seat heaters, and seat massagers can affect how well the passenger sensing system operates. We recommend that you not use seat covers or other aftermarket equipment except when Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints approved by GM for your specific vehicle. See Adding Equipment to the Airbag-Equipped Vehicle 0 71 for more information about modifications that can affect how the system operates. The ON indicator may be lit if an object, such as a briefcase, handbag, grocery bag, laptop, or other electronic device, is put on an unoccupied seat. If this is not desired, remove the object from the seat. { Warning Stowing articles under the passenger seat or between the passenger seat cushion and seatback may interfere with the proper operation of the passenger sensing system. Servicing the Airbag-Equipped Vehicle Airbags affect how the vehicle should be serviced. There are parts of the airbag system in several places around the vehicle. Your dealer and the service manual have information about servicing the vehicle and the airbag system. To purchase a service manual, see Publication Ordering Information 0 416. { Warning For up to 10 seconds after the vehicle is turned off and the battery is disconnected, an airbag can still inflate during improper service. You can be injured if you are close to an airbag when it inflates. Avoid yellow connectors. They are probably part of the airbag system. Be sure to follow proper service procedures, and make sure the person performing work for you is qualified to do so. Adding Equipment to the Airbag-Equipped Vehicle Adding accessories that change the vehicle's frame, bumper system, height, front end, or side sheet metal, may keep the airbag system from working properly. The operation of the airbag system can also be affected by changing, including improperly repairing or replacing, any parts of the following: . Airbag system, including airbag modules, front or side impact sensors, sensing and diagnostic module, or airbag wiring 71 . Front seats, including stitching, seams, or zippers . Seat belts . Steering wheel, instrument panel, overhead console, ceiling trim, or pillar garnish trim . Inner door seals, including speakers Your dealer and the service manual have information about the location of the airbag modules and sensors, sensing and diagnostic module, and airbag wiring along with the proper replacement procedures. In addition, the vehicle has a passenger sensing system for the front outboard passenger position, which includes sensors that are part of the passenger seat. The passenger sensing system may not operate properly if the original seat trim is replaced with non-GM covers, upholstery, or trim; or with GM covers, upholstery, or trim designed for a different vehicle. Any object, such as an aftermarket seat heater or a comfort-enhancing pad or device, installed under or on top of the seat fabric, could also interfere with the operation of the passenger sensing system. This could either prevent proper deployment of the passenger airbag(s) or prevent the passenger sensing Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 72 Seats and Restraints system from properly turning off the passenger airbag(s). See Passenger Sensing System 0 67. If the vehicle has rollover roof-rail airbags, see Different Size Tires and Wheels 0 360 for additional important information. If a snow plow is added to the vehicle, the airbags should still work properly. The airbag systems were designed to work properly under a wide range of conditions, including snow plowing with vehicles that have the optional snow plow prep package (RPO VYU). Do not change or defeat the snow plow's “tripping mechanism.” If you do, it can damage the snow plow and the vehicle, and may cause an airbag deployment. If the vehicle must be modified because you have a disability and have questions about whether the modifications will affect the vehicle's airbag system, or if you have questions about whether the airbag system will be affected if the vehicle is modified for any other reason, call Customer Assistance. See Customer Assistance Offices 0 411. Airbag System Check The airbag system does not need regularly scheduled maintenance or replacement. Make sure the airbag readiness light is working. See Airbag Readiness Light 0 114. Caution If an airbag covering is damaged, opened, or broken, the airbag may not work properly. Do not open or break the airbag coverings. If there are any opened or broken airbag coverings, have the airbag covering and/or airbag module replaced. For the location of the airbags, see Where Are the Airbags? 0 64. See your dealer for service. Replacing Airbag System Parts after a Crash { Warning A crash can damage the airbag systems in the vehicle. A damaged airbag system may not properly protect you and your passenger(s) in a crash, resulting in serious injury or even death. To help (Continued) Warning (Continued) make sure the airbag systems are working properly after a crash, have them inspected and any necessary replacements made as soon as possible. If an airbag inflates, you will need to replace airbag system parts. See your dealer for service. If the airbag readiness light stays on after the vehicle is started or comes on when you are driving, the airbag system may not work properly. Have the vehicle serviced right away. See Airbag Readiness Light 0 114. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Child Restraints Older Children belt comfort guide, if available. See “Rear Seat Belt Comfort Guides” under Lap-Shoulder Belt 0 58. If a comfort guide is not available, or if the shoulder belt still does not rest on the shoulder, then return to the booster seat. . Does the lap belt fit low and snug on the hips, touching the thighs? If yes, continue. If no, return to the booster seat. . Can proper seat belt fit be maintained for the length of the trip? If yes, continue. If no, return to the booster seat. Q: What is the proper way to wear seat belts? Older children who have outgrown booster seats should wear the vehicle’s seat belts. The manufacturer instructions that come with the booster seat state the weight and height limitations for that booster. Use a booster seat with a lap-shoulder belt until the child passes the fit test below: . Sit all the way back on the seat. Do the knees bend at the seat edge? If yes, continue. If no, return to the booster seat. . Buckle the lap-shoulder belt. Does the shoulder belt rest on the shoulder? If yes, continue. If no, try using the rear seat A: An older child should wear a lap-shoulder belt and get the additional restraint a shoulder belt can provide. The shoulder belt should not cross the face or neck. The lap belt should fit snugly below the hips, just touching the top of the thighs. This applies belt force to the child's pelvic bones in a crash. It should never be worn over the abdomen, which could cause severe or even fatal internal injuries in a crash. Also see “Rear Seat Belt Comfort Guides” under Lap-Shoulder Belt 0 58. 73 According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in a rear seating position. In a crash, children who are not buckled up can strike other people who are buckled up, or can be thrown out of the vehicle. Older children need to use seat belts properly. { Warning Never allow more than one child to wear the same seat belt. The seat belt cannot properly spread the impact forces. In a crash, they can be crushed together and seriously injured. A seat belt must be used by only one person at a time. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 74 Seats and Restraints { Warning Warning (Continued) Never allow a child to wear the seat belt shoulder belt under both arms or behind their back. A child can be seriously injured by not wearing the lap-shoulder belt properly. In a crash, the child would not be restrained by the shoulder belt. The child could move too far forward increasing the chance of head and neck injury. The child might also slide under the lap belt. The belt force would then be applied right on the abdomen. That could cause serious or fatal injuries. The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder and across the chest. their neck. The shoulder belt can tighten but cannot be loosened if it is locked. The shoulder belt locks when it is pulled all the way out of the retractor. It unlocks when the shoulder belt is allowed to go all the way back into the retractor, but it cannot do this if it is wrapped around the child. Never leave children unattended in a vehicle and never allow children to improperly wear, or play with, the seat belts. Infants and Young Children Everyone in a vehicle needs protection! This includes infants and all other children. Neither the distance traveled nor the age and size of the traveler changes the need, for everyone, to use safety restraints. In fact, the law in every state in the United States and in every Canadian province says children up to some age must be restrained while in a vehicle. { Warning Children can be seriously injured or killed if the shoulder belt is worn behind their back, under their legs, or wrapped around (Continued) Every time infants and young children ride in vehicles, they should have the protection provided by appropriate child restraints. Neither the vehicle's seat belt system nor its airbag system is designed for them. Children who are not restrained properly can strike other people, or can be thrown out of the vehicle. { Warning Never hold an infant or a child while riding in a vehicle. Due to crash forces, an infant or a child will become so heavy it (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Warning (Continued) Warning (Continued) is not possible to hold it during a crash. For example, in a crash at only 40 km/h (25 mph), a 5.5 kg (12 lb) infant will suddenly become a 110 kg (240 lb) force on a person's arms. An infant or child should be secured in an appropriate child restraint. outboard seat. Secure a rear-facing child restraint in a rear seat. It is also better to secure a forward-facing child restraint in a rear seat. If you must secure a forward-facing child restraint in the front outboard seat, always move the front passenger seat as far back as it will go. { Warning Child restraints are devices used to restrain, seat, or position children in the vehicle and are sometimes called child seats or car seats. Children who are up against, or very close to, any airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or killed. Never put a rear-facing child restraint in the front (Continued) There are three basic types of child restraints: . Forward-facing child restraints 75 . Rear-facing child restraints . Belt-positioning booster seats The proper child restraint for your child depends on their size, weight, and age, and also on whether the child restraint is compatible with the vehicle in which it will be used. For each types of child restraints, there are many different models available. When purchasing a child restraint, be sure it is designed to be used in a motor vehicle and is certified to comply with US Federal or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. If it is, the child restraint will have a label saying that it meets federal motor vehicle safety standards. The NHTSA website includes a list of registered car seat manufacturers (https://www.nhtsa.gov) and links to their registration pages for consumers. Registration helps manufacturers identify purchasers for recall notices. The instruction manual that is provided with the child restraint states the weight and height limitations for that particular child restraint. In addition, there are many kinds of child restraints available for children with special needs. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 76 Seats and Restraints { Warning Child Restraint Systems To reduce the risk of neck and head injury in a crash, infants and toddlers should be secured in a rear-facing child restraint until age two, or until they reach the maximum height and weight limits of their child restraint. { Warning A young child's hip bones are still so small that the vehicle seat belt may not remain low on the hip bones, as it should. Instead, it may settle up around the child's abdomen. In a crash, the belt would apply force on a body area that is unprotected by any bony structure. This alone could cause serious or fatal injuries. To reduce the risk of serious or fatal injuries during a crash, young children should always be secured in an appropriate child restraint. Forward-Facing Child Restraint Rear-Facing Infant Restraint A rear-facing child restraint provides restraint with the seating surface against the back of the infant. The harness system holds the infant in place and, in a crash, acts to keep the infant positioned in the restraint. A forward-facing child restraint provides restraint for the child's body with the harness. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Securing an Add-On Child Restraint in the Vehicle { Warning Booster Seats A belt-positioning booster seat is used for children who have outgrown their forward-facing child restraint. Boosters are designed to improve the fit of the vehicle's seat belt system until the child is large enough for the vehicle seat belts to fit properly without a booster seat. See the seat belt fit test in Older Children 0 73. A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash if the child restraint is not properly secured in the vehicle. Secure the child restraint properly in the vehicle using the vehicle seat belt or LATCH system, following the instructions that came with that child restraint and the instructions in this manual. To help reduce the chance of injury, the child restraint must be secured in the vehicle. Child restraints must be secured in vehicle seats by lap belts or the lap belt portion of a lap-shoulder belt, or by the LATCH system. See Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79 for more information. Never use a seat belt extender when installing a child restraint. Use only seats and related equipment that are certified to comply with US Federal or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards to secure a child restraint. Children can be endangered in a crash if the child restraint is not properly secured in the vehicle. 77 When securing an add-on child restraint, refer to the following: 1. Instruction labels provided on the child restraint 2. Instruction manual provided with the child restraint 3. This vehicle owner's manual The child restraint instructions are important, so if they are not available, obtain a replacement copy from the manufacturer. Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any child restraint in the vehicle — even when no child is in it. In some areas Certified Child Passenger Safety Technicians (CPSTs) are available to inspect and demonstrate how to correctly use and install child restraints. In the U.S., refer to the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) website to locate the nearest child safety seat inspection station. For CPST availability in Canada, check with Transport Canada or the Provincial Ministry of Transportation office. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 78 Seats and Restraints Securing the Child Within the Child Restraint { Warning A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash if the child is not properly secured in the child restraint. Secure the child properly following the instructions that came with that child restraint. Where to Put the Restraint According to accident statistics, children and infants are safer when properly restrained in an appropriate child restraint secured in a rear seating position. Whenever possible, children aged 12 and under should be secured in a rear seating position. Never put a rear-facing child restraint in the front. This is because the risk to the rear-facing child is so great if the airbag deploys. { Warning A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the front passenger airbag inflates. This is because the back of the rear-facing child restraint would be very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a forward-facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the front passenger airbag inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward position. Even if the passenger sensing system has turned off the front passenger frontal airbag, no system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that an airbag will not deploy under some unusual circumstance, even though it is turned off. Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a forward-facing child restraint in the front seat, always move the front passenger seat as far back as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint in a rear seat. See Passenger Sensing System 0 67 for additional information. { Warning A child in a child restraint in the center front seat can be badly injured or killed by the frontal airbags if they inflate. Never secure a child restraint in the center front seat. It is always better to secure a child restraint in a rear seat. Do not use child restraints in the center front seat position. If the vehicle does not have a rear seat that will accommodate a rear-facing child restraint, a rear-facing child restraint should not be installed in the vehicle, even if the airbag is off. When securing a child restraint with the seat belts in a rear seat position, study the instructions that came with the child restraint to make sure it is compatible with this vehicle. Child restraints and booster seats vary considerably in size, and some may fit in certain seating positions better than others. Do not install a child restraint in any rear seating position where it cannot be installed securely. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Depending on where you place the child restraint and the size of the child restraint, you may not be able to access adjacent seat belts or LATCH anchors for additional passengers or child restraints. Adjacent seating positions should not be used if the child restraint prevents access to or interferes with the routing of the seat belt. The seat in front of an installed child restraint should be adjusted to ensure proper installation according to the child restraint manual. Wherever a child restraint is installed, be sure to follow the instructions that came with the child restraint and secure the child restraint properly. Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any child restraint in the vehicle — even when no child is in it. 79 Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) Make sure to follow the instructions that came with the child restraint, and also the instructions in this manual. The LATCH system secures a child restraint during driving or in a crash. LATCH attachments on the child restraint are used to attach the child restraint to the anchors in the vehicle. This system is designed to make installation of a child restraint easier. When installing a child restraint with a top tether, you must also use either the lower anchors or the seat belts to properly secure the child restraint. A child restraint must never be installed using only the top tether. In order to use the LATCH system in your vehicle, you need a child restraint that has LATCH attachments. LATCH-compatible rear-facing and forward-facing child seats can be properly installed using either the LATCH anchors or the vehicle’s seat belts. Do not use both the seat belts and the LATCH anchorage system to secure a rear-facing or forward-facing child restraint. Booster seats use the vehicle’s seat belts to secure the child and the booster seat. If the manufacturer recommends that the booster seat be secured with the LATCH system, this can be done as long as the booster seat can be positioned properly and there is no interference with the proper positioning of the lap-shoulder belt on the child. For a forward-facing 5-pt harness child restraint where the combined weight of the child and restraint are up to 29.5 kg (65 lb), use either the lower LATCH anchorages with the top tether anchorage, or the seat belt with the top tether anchorage. Where the combined weight of the child and restraint are greater than 29.5 kg (65 lb), use the seat belt with the top tether anchorage only. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 80 Seats and Restraints Recommended Methods for Attaching Child Restraints Restraint Type Combined Weight of the Child + Child Restraint Rear-Facing Child Restraint Up to 29.5 kg (65 lb) Rear-Facing Child Restraint Greater than 29.5 kg (65 lb) Forward-Facing Child Restraint Up to 29.5 kg (65 lb) Forward-Facing Child Restraint Greater than 29.5 kg (65 lb) See Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Center Front Seat) 0 95 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Rear Seat) 0 89 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Front Passenger Seat) 0 93. Child restraints built after March 2014 are labeled with the maximum child weight, with which the LATCH system can be used for installing the child restraint. Use Only Approved Attachment Methods Shown with an X LATCH – Lower Anchors Only X Seat Belt Only LATCH – Lower Anchors and Top Tether Anchor Seat Belt and Top Tether Anchor X X X X X The following explains how to attach a child restraint with these attachments in the vehicle. Not all vehicle seating positions have lower anchors. In this case, the seat belt must be used (with top tether where available) to secure the child restraint. See Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Center Front Seat) 0 95 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Rear Seat) 0 89 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Front Passenger Seat) 0 93. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Lower Anchors Top Tether Anchor top tether always to be attached. In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be attached. Be sure to read and follow the instructions for your child restraint. Lower Anchor and Top Tether Anchor Locations Lower anchors (1) are metal bars built into the vehicle. There are two lower anchors for each LATCH seating position that will accommodate a child restraint with lower attachments (2). A top tether (3, 4) is used to secure the top of the child restraint to the vehicle. A top tether anchor is built into the vehicle. The top tether attachment hook (2) on the child restraint connects to the top tether anchor in the vehicle in order to reduce the forward movement and rotation of the child restraint during driving or in the event of a crash. The child restraint may have a single tether (3) or a dual tether (4). Either will have a single attachment hook (2) to secure the top tether to the anchor. Some child restraints with a top tether are designed for use with or without the top tether being attached. Others require the 81 Regular Cab — Bucket Seat Only Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 82 Seats and Restraints To assist in locating the lower anchors on double and crew cab models, each seating position with lower anchors has two labels near the crease between the seatback and the seat cushion. Regular Cab — Three-Passenger Front Seat Double and Crew Cab Rear Seat I : Seating positions with top tether I : Seating positions with top tether anchors. anchors. Do not install a child restraint in the center front seating position. See Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Center Front Seat) 0 95 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Rear Seat) 0 89 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Front Passenger Seat) 0 93 for more information. H : Seating positions with two lower anchors. For regular cab models, there are top tether anchor symbols to assist you in locating the top tether anchors. Do not install a child restraint in the center seating position. See Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Center Front Seat) 0 95 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Rear Seat) 0 89 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Front Passenger Seat) 0 93 for more information. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Regular Cab For regular cab models, the top tether anchors are on the back panel behind the passenger seat(s) or center seat. Be sure to use an anchor directly behind the seating position where the child restraint will be placed. Driver Side Anchor and Loop (Double and Crew Cab) 83 Passenger Side Loop (Double and Crew Cab) For double and crew cab models, the top tether is routed through loops (2) to the top tether anchors (1). Be sure to use the correct anchor for the seating position where the child restraint will be placed. Be sure to read the following instructions to properly install a child restraint using these loops and anchors. Center Anchor and Loop (Double and Crew Cab) Do not secure a child restraint in a position without a top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the top tether be attached, or if the instructions that come with the child restraint say that the top tether must be attached. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 84 Seats and Restraints According to accident statistics, children and infants are safer when properly restrained in a child restraint system or infant restraint system secured in a rear seating position. See Where to Put the Restraint 0 78 for additional information. Securing a Child Restraint Designed for the LATCH System { Warning A child could be seriously injured or killed in a crash if the child restraint is not properly attached to the vehicle using either the LATCH anchors or the vehicle seat belt. Follow the instructions that came with the child restraint and the instructions in this manual. { Warning Do not attach more than one child restraint to a single anchor, except for the center top tether anchors in the crew cab models. Attaching more than one child restraint to a single anchor could cause the anchor or attachment to come loose or even break during a crash. (Continued) Warning (Continued) Warning (Continued) A child or others could be injured. To reduce the risk of serious or fatal injuries during a crash, attach only one child restraint per anchor. tighten the belt behind the child restraint after the child restraint has been installed. Caution { Warning Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck. The shoulder belt can tighten but cannot be loosened if it is locked. The shoulder belt locks when it is pulled all the way out of the retractor. It unlocks when the shoulder belt is allowed to go all the way back into the retractor, but it cannot do this if it is wrapped around a child’s neck. If the shoulder belt is locked and tightened around a child’s neck, the only way to loosen the belt is to cut it. Buckle any unused seat belts behind the child restraint so children cannot reach them. Pull the shoulder belt all the way out of the retractor to set the lock, and (Continued) Do not let the LATCH attachments rub against the vehicle’s seat belts. This may damage these parts. If necessary, move buckled seat belts to avoid rubbing the LATCH attachments. Do not fold the rear seat cushion when the seat is occupied. Do not fold the empty rear seat with a seat belt buckled. This could damage the seat belt or the seat. Unbuckle and return the seat belt to its stowed position, before folding the seat. If you need to secure more than one child restraint in the rear seat, see Where to Put the Restraint 0 78. Regular Cab Models 1. For models without a rear seat, forward-facing child restraints should only be installed in the right front Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints seating position with belts and a top tether. See Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Center Front Seat) 0 95 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Rear Seat) 0 89 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Front Passenger Seat) 0 93. If the child restraint manufacturer recommends that the top tether be attached, adjust the top tether to its full length and attach it to the anchor. Refer to the child restraint instructions and the following steps: 1.1. Find the top tether anchor. 1.2. Route, attach, and tighten the top tether according to your child restraint instructions and the following instructions: If the position you are using has an adjustable headrest or head restraint, adjust it accordingly to allow proper fitment. If you are using a dual tether, route the tether around the headrest or head restraint posts. If the child restraint is installed next to a center seat, make sure the top tether does not interfere with the center seating position shoulder belt/retractor. If it does, find another suitable seating position to install the child restraint. If the position you are using has an adjustable headrest or head restraint, adjust it accordingly to allow proper fitment. If you are 85 using a single tether, route the tether in between the headrest or head restraint posts. 2. Make sure the child restraint top tether hook is completely closed and secured to the top tether anchor. 3. Secure the child restraint in the right front seating position with the vehicle belts. See Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Center Front Seat) 0 95 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Rear Seat) 0 89 or Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Front Passenger Seat) 0 93. 4. Before placing a child in the child restraint, make sure it is securely held in place. To check, grasp the child restraint at the belt path and attempt to move it side to side and back and forth. There should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of movement for proper installation. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 86 Seats and Restraints Double and Crew Cab Models 1. Attach and tighten the lower attachments to the lower anchors. If the child restraint does not have lower attachments or the desired seating position does not have lower anchors, secure the child restraint with the top tether and the seat belt. Refer to the child restraint manufacturer instructions and the instructions in this manual. 1.1. Find the lower anchors for the desired seating position. 1.2. Put the child restraint on the seat. 1.3. Attach and tighten the lower attachments on the child restraint to the lower anchors. 2. For forward-facing child restraints, attach and tighten the top tether to the top tether anchor, if your vehicle has one. Follow the child restraint instructions and the vehicle LATCH anchor weight limits described at the beginning of this section, and the following steps: 2.1.1. Remove the driver side head restraint and center headrest. See “Head Restraint or Headrest Removal and Reinstallation” later in this section. Rear Driver Side Position Rear Driver Side Position 2.1. For a top tether in the rear driver side position: 2.1.2. For first time use, remove and discard the rubber band from the top tether loop (2). 2.1.3. Route the top tether (3) through the loop (2). 2.1.4. Attach the top tether (3) to the driver side of the center top tether metal anchor (1). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints 2.2.4. Make sure the child restraint top tether hook is completely closed and secured to the top tether anchor. 2.1.5. Make sure the child restraint top tether hook is completely closed and secured to the top tether anchor. Rear Passenger Side Position Rear Passenger Side Position 87 2.2. For a top tether in the rear passenger side position: 2.2.1. Remove the passenger side head restraint and center headrest. See “Head Restraint or Headrest Removal and Reinstallation” later in this section. 2.2.2. Route the top tether (3) through the loop (2). 2.2.3. Attach the top tether (3) to the passenger side of the center top tether metal anchor (1). Rear Center Position Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 88 Seats and Restraints Rear Center Position 2.3. For a top tether in the rear center position: 2.3.1. Remove the driver side head restraint and center headrest. See “Head Restraint or Headrest Removal and Reinstallation” later in this section. 2.3.2. Route the top tether (1) through the center loop (2). 2.3.3. Attach the top tether (1) to the driver side top tether metal anchor (3). 2.3.4. Make sure the child restraint top tether hook is completely closed and secured to the top tether anchor. 3. Tighten the top tether per the child restraint manufacturer's instructions. When the top tether is properly tightened, the loop may bend. This is normal and will not damage the vehicle. If child restraints are installed in both outboard positions, both top tethers can be attached to the center anchor. Top tethers can be attached for child restraints in all three rear seating positions at the same time, following the routing instructions above. 4. Before placing a child in the child restraint, make sure it is securely held in place. To check, grasp the child restraint at the LATCH path and attempt to move it side to side and back and forth. There should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of movement for proper installation. Head Restraint or Headrest Removal and Reinstallation The second row outboard head restraints or center headrest can be removed if they interfere with the proper installation of the child restraint. To remove the second row head restraints or center headrest: 1. Press both buttons on the head restraint or headrest posts at the same time, and pull up on the head restraint or headrest. 2. Store the head restraint or headrest in a secure place. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints 3. When the child restraint is removed, reinstall the head restraint or headrest before the seating position is used. { Warning With head restraints that are not installed and adjusted properly, there is a greater chance that occupants will suffer a neck/spinal injury in a crash. Do not drive until the head restraints for all occupants are installed and adjusted properly. To reinstall the head restraint or headrest: 1. Insert the head restraint or headrest posts into the holes in the top of the seatback. The notches on the posts must face the driver side of the vehicle. 2. Push the head restraint or headrest down. 3. Try to move the head restraint or headrest to make sure that it is locked in place. Replacing LATCH System Parts After a Crash { Warning A crash can damage the LATCH system in the vehicle. A damaged LATCH system may not properly secure the child restraint, resulting in serious injury or even death in a crash. To help make sure the LATCH system is working properly after a crash, see your dealer to have the system inspected and any necessary replacements made as soon as possible. If the vehicle has the LATCH system and it was being used during a crash, new LATCH system parts may be needed. 89 New parts and repairs may be necessary even if the LATCH system was not being used at the time of the crash. Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Rear Seat) When securing a child restraint with the seat belts in a rear seat position, study the instructions that came with the child restraint to make sure it is compatible with this vehicle. If the child restraint has the LATCH system, see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79 for how and where to install the child restraint using LATCH. If a child restraint is secured in the vehicle using a seat belt and it uses a top tether, see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79 for top tether anchor locations. Do not secure a child seat in a position without a top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that come with the child restraint say that the top tether must be anchored. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 90 Seats and Restraints In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be attached. If the child restraint or vehicle seat position does not have the LATCH system, you will be using the seat belt to secure the child restraint. Be sure to follow the instructions that came with the child restraint. If more than one child restraint needs to be installed in the rear seat, be sure to read Where to Put the Restraint 0 78. Double Cab 1. Remove the head restraint or headrest prior to installing a forward-facing child restraint in an outboard rear seating position. See “Head Restraint or Headrest Removal and Reinstallation” under Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79. 2. Put the child restraint on the seat. 3. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and shoulder portions of the vehicle seat belt through or around the child restraint. The child restraint instructions will show you how. 4. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks. Position the release button on the buckle, away from the child restraint, so that the seat belt could be quickly unbuckled if necessary. The push button used to release the latch plate must be visible and not obscured by the child restraint. There must not be direct contact of the child restraint to the push button. 5. Pull the shoulder belt all the way out of the retractor to set the lock. When the retractor lock is set, the belt can be tightened but not pulled out of the retractor. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints anchor weight limits, and instructions listed in Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79. 8. Before placing a child in the child restraint, make sure it is securely held in place. To check, grasp the child restraint at the seat belt path and attempt to move it side to side and back and forth. When the child restraint is properly installed, there should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of movement. 6. To tighten the belt, push down on the child restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to tighten the lap portion of the belt, and feed the shoulder belt back into the retractor. When installing a forward-facing child restraint, it may be helpful to use your knee to push down on the child restraint as you tighten the belt. Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is locked. If the retractor is not locked, repeat Steps 5 and 6. 7. For forward-facing child restraints, attach and tighten the top tether to the top tether anchor (loop). Refer to the child restraint instructions, the vehicle LATCH To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicle seat belt and let it return to the stowed position. If the top tether is attached to a top tether anchor, disconnect it. Reinstall the head restraint or headrest before the seating position is used. See “Head Restraint or Headrest Removal and Reinstallation” under Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79 for additional information on installing the headrest properly. Crew Cab 1. Put the child restraint on the seat. 91 2. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and shoulder portions of the vehicle seat belt through or around the child restraint. The child restraint instructions will show you how. 3. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks. Position the release button on the buckle, away from the child restraint, so that the seat belt could be quickly unbuckled if necessary. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 92 Seats and Restraints tether. See Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79 for more information on using the top tether anchors. 7. Before placing a child in the child restraint, make sure it is securely held in place. To check, grasp the child restraint at the seat belt path and attempt to move it side to side and back and forth. When the child restraint is properly installed, there should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of movement. 4. Pull the shoulder belt all the way out of the retractor to set the lock. When the retractor lock is set, the belt can be tightened but not pulled out of the retractor. 5. To tighten the belt, push down on the child restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to tighten the lap portion of the belt, and feed the shoulder belt back into the retractor. When installing a forward-facing child restraint, it may be helpful to use your knee to push down on the child restraint as you tighten the belt. Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is locked. If the retractor is not locked, repeat Steps 4 and 5. 6. If the child restraint has a top tether, follow the child restraint manufacturer's instructions regarding the use of the top To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicle seat belt and let it return to the stowed position. If the top tether is attached to a top tether anchor, disconnect it. For outboard rear seating positions, if the child restraint cannot be installed properly with the head restraint in place, the head restraint may be removed. See your dealer for assistance with removal, and store the removed head restraint in a secure place. When the child restraint is removed, reinstall the head restraint before the seating position is used. For reinstallation instructions, see “Head Restraint or Headrest Removal and Reinstallation” under Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Front Passenger Seat) This vehicle has airbags. A rear seat is a safer place to secure a forward-facing child restraint. See Where to Put the Restraint 0 78. In addition, the vehicle has a passenger sensing system which is designed to turn off the front outboard passenger frontal airbag under certain conditions. See Passenger Sensing System 0 67 and Passenger Airbag Status Indicator 0 115 for more information, including important safety information. Never put a rear-facing child restraint in the front. This is because the risk to the rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys. { Warning A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the front outboard passenger frontal airbag inflates. This is because the back of the rear-facing child restraint would be very (Continued) Warning (Continued) close to the inflating airbag. A child in a forward-facing child restraint can be seriously injured or killed if the front outboard passenger frontal airbag inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward position. Even if the passenger sensing system has turned off the front outboard passenger frontal airbag, no system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that an airbag will not deploy under some unusual circumstance, even though it is turned off. Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a forward-facing child restraint in the front outboard passenger seat, always move the seat as far back as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint in a rear seat. See Passenger Sensing System 0 67 for additional information. 93 If the vehicle does not have a rear seat that will accommodate a rear-facing child restraint, a rear-facing child restraint should not be installed in the vehicle, even if the airbag is off. If the child restraint uses a top tether, see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79 for top tether anchor locations. Do not secure a child seat in a position without a top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that come with the child restraint say that the top tether must be anchored. In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be attached. When using the lap-shoulder belt to secure the child restraint in this position, follow the instructions that came with the child restraint and the following instructions: 1. Move the seat as far back as it will go before securing the forward-facing child restraint. Move the seat upward or the seatback to an upright position, if needed, to get a tight installation of the child restraint. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 94 Seats and Restraints The push button used to release the latch plate must be visible and not obscured by the child restraint. There must not be direct contact of the child restraint to the push button. When the passenger sensing system has turned off the front outboard passenger frontal airbag, the OFF indicator on the passenger airbag status indicator should light and stay lit when you start the vehicle. See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator 0 115. 2. Put the child restraint on the seat. 3. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and shoulder portions of the vehicle seat belt through or around the child restraint. The child restraint instructions will show you how. Position the release button on the buckle, away from the child restraint, so that the seat belt could be quickly unbuckled if necessary. Tilt the latch plate to adjust the belt if needed. 5. Pull the shoulder belt all the way out of the retractor to set the lock. When the retractor lock is set, the belt can be tightened but not pulled out of the retractor. 4. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Seats and Restraints anchor. Refer to the instructions that came with the child restraint and to Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) 0 79. 8. Before placing a child in the child restraint, make sure it is securely held in place. To check, grasp the child restraint at the seat belt path and attempt to move it side to side and back and forth. When the child restraint is properly installed, there should be no more than 2.5 cm (1 in) of movement. 6. To tighten the belt, push down on the child restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to tighten the lap portion of the belt, and feed the shoulder belt back into the retractor. When installing a forward-facing child restraint, it may be helpful to use your knee to push down on the child restraint as you tighten the belt. Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is locked. If the retractor is not locked, repeat Steps 5 and 6. 7. If the vehicle does not have a rear seat and the child restraint manufacturer recommends using a top tether anchor, attach the top tether to the top tether If the airbag is off, the OFF indicator in the passenger airbag status indicator will come on and stay on when the vehicle is started. If a child restraint has been installed and the ON indicator is lit, see “If the On Indicator Is Lit for a Child Restraint” under Passenger Sensing System 0 67. To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicle seat belt and let it return to the stowed position. Securing Child Restraints (With the Seat Belt in the Center Front Seat) { Warning A child in a child restraint in the center front seat can be badly injured or killed by the frontal airbags if they inflate. Never secure a child restraint in the center front seat. It is always better to secure a child restraint in a rear seat. Do not use child restraints in the center front seat position. 95 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 96 Storage Storage Storage Compartments { Warning Storage Compartments Storage Compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Underseat Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Rear Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Center Console Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Floor Console Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Do not store heavy or sharp objects in storage compartments. In a crash, these objects may cause the cover to open and could result in injury. Cupholders Front There may be cupholders on the center front seat console armrest. Rear Glove Box Additional Storage Features Cargo Tie-Downs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 If equipped, pull the rear seat armrest down to access the cupholders. To access the upper glove box, pull up on the handle. To access the lower glove box, unlock with the key and pull up on the handle. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Storage Underseat Storage Rear Storage There may be storage under the rear passenger seat. Lift up on the seat bench to access. Push the seat bench toward the floor to close. There may be storage in the rear seat. Pull the tab to access. Push the storage door to close. The storage door must be closed before installing child restraints. 97 Center Console Storage Bench Seat Pull the strap on the side of the center seatback to access the storage area and cupholders. Do not use the center seatback as a seating position when the seatback is folded down. To raise the seatback, push the seatback rearward until it locks in the upright position. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is locked. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 98 Storage Press the latch and lift to open. Floor Console Storage Additional Storage Features Cargo Tie-Downs Bench Seat If equipped with storage, press the latch and lift to open. If equipped with front center seat storage, unlock with the ignition key, press the latch, and lift to open. This vehicle is equipped with 12 fixed cargo tie-downs. Caution The truck bed walls will collapse if the tie-downs are overloaded. Any of the 12 locations inside the truck bed can be used. The maximum load per corner is 227 kg (500 lb). Bucket Seat Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Storage Accessory Tie-Downs Additional Accessory Tie-Down Points Any of the nine holes inside the truck bed can be used for tie-downs. The maximum load is 113 kg (250 lb) per tie-down. Caution The truck bed walls will collapse if the tie-downs are overloaded. To install: 1. Insert a tie-down loop assembly until it is flush with the truck bed wall. 2. Turn the tie-down loop clockwise to tighten. The tie-down will be hard to turn until the toggle moves past the installation point on the toggle guide. 3. Fasten the tie-down firmly by hand only. Do not use tools. 99 To remove: 1. Remove the tie-down loop completely by turning counterclockwise while holding the backing plate against the truck bed wall. 2. Pull the backing plate away from the truck bed wall until a click is heard. This locks the toggle into position on the toggle guide. 3. Push the backing plate against the truck bed wall. This allows the toggle nut to spin. 4. Remove the backing plate, toggle guide, and toggle nut from the truck bed wall completely. 5. Reinstall the tie-down loop through the backing plate into the toggle nut for reuse. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 100 Instruments and Controls Instruments and Controls Controls Steering Wheel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Heated Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Windshield Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Wireless Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Fuel Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Engine Oil Pressure Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge . . . . 113 Voltmeter Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Seat Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Airbag Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . 115 Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Malfunction Indicator Lamp (Check Engine Light) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Brake System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Electric Parking Brake Light . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Service Electric Parking Brake Light . . . . 118 Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Four-Wheel-Drive Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Hill Descent Control Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Lane Departure Warning (LDW) Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Vehicle Ahead Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Traction Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Traction Control System (TCS)/Electronic Stability Control Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Driver Mode Control Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Tire Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Engine Oil Pressure Light (Uplevel Cluster) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Security Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 High-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Front Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Lamps On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Cruise Control Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Door Ajar Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Information Displays Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Head-Up Display (HUD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Vehicle Messages Vehicle Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Engine Power Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Vehicle Speed Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Vehicle Personalization Vehicle Personalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Universal Remote System Universal Remote System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Universal Remote System Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Universal Remote System Operation . . . 137 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls Controls Tilt and Telescoping Wheel 101 Steering Wheel Controls The infotainment system can be operated by using the steering wheel controls. See Steering Wheel Controls 0 151. Steering Wheel Adjustment Heated Steering Wheel To 1. 2. 3. adjust the steering wheel: Pull the lever down. Move the steering wheel up or down. Pull the lever up to lock the steering wheel in place. To adjust the tilt and telescoping steering wheel, if equipped: 1. Pull the lever down. 2. Move the steering wheel up or down. 3. Pull or push the steering wheel closer or away from you. 4. Pull the lever up to lock the steering wheel in place. Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving. ( : If equipped, press to turn it on or off. A light next to the button displays when the feature is turned on. The steering wheel takes about three minutes to start heating. Remote Start Heated Steering Wheel If equipped with remote start, the heated steering wheel will turn on automatically during a remote start along with the heated Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 102 Instruments and Controls seats when it is cold outside. The heated steering wheel indicator light may not come on. LO : Use for slow wipes. 3 : Turn the band up for more frequent See Heated and Ventilated Front Seats 0 53. intermittent wipes or down for less frequent intermittent wipes. Horn OFF : Use to turn the wipers off. To sound the horn, press steering wheel. a on the Windshield Wiper/Washer The windshield wiper control is on the turn signal lever. The windshield wipers are controlled by turning the band with N on it. With the ignition on or in ACC/ACCESSORY, turn the N band to select the wiper speed. HI : Use for fast wipes. { Warning In freezing weather, do not use the washer until the windshield is warmed. Otherwise the washer fluid can form ice on the windshield, blocking your vision. 1x : For a single wipe, briefly turn the N band down. For several wipes, hold the band down. L : Press L on the windshield wiper control to spray windshield washer fluid and activate the wipers. The wipers will continue until L is released or the maximum wash time is reached. When L is released, additional wipes may occur depending on how long the windshield washer had been activated. See Washer Fluid 0 321 for information on filling the windshield washer fluid reservoir. Clear snow and ice from the wiper blades before using them. If frozen to the windshield, carefully loosen or thaw them. Damaged blades should be replaced. See Wiper Blade Replacement 0 328. Heavy snow or ice can overload the wiper motor. { Warning Before driving the vehicle, always clear snow and ice from the hood, windshield, washer nozzles, roof, and rear of the vehicle, including all lamps and windows. Reduced visibility from snow and ice buildup could lead to a crash. Wipe Parking If the ignition is turned off while the wipers are on LO, HI, or 3, they will immediately stop. If the windshield wiper control is ON then moved to OFF before the driver door is opened or within 10 minutes, the wipers will restart and move to the base of the windshield. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls If the ignition is turned off while the wipers are performing wipes due to windshield washing, the wipers continue to run until they reach the base of the windshield. Compass Power Outlets Accessory power outlets can be used to plug in electrical equipment, such as a cell phone or MP3 player. The vehicle may have a compass display on the Driver Information Center (DIC). The compass receives its heading and other information from the Global Positioning System (GPS) antenna, Electronic Stability Control (ESC), and vehicle speed information. The compass system is designed to operate for a certain number of miles or degrees of turn before needing a signal from the GPS satellites. When the compass display shows CAL, drive the vehicle for a short distance in an open area where it can receive a GPS signal. The compass system will automatically determine when a GPS signal is restored and provide a heading again. Clock Set the time and date using the infotainment system. See "Time / Date" under Settings 0 184. 103 { Warning Power is always supplied to the outlets. Do not leave electrical equipment plugged in when the vehicle is not in use because the vehicle could catch fire and cause injury or death. Caution Rear of Front Center Console The vehicle has one accessory power outlet under the climate control system and one accessory power outlet on the rear of the center console, if equipped, or on the rear of the bench seat, if equipped. Lift the cover to access and replace when not in use. Leaving electrical equipment plugged in for an extended period of time while the vehicle is off will drain the battery. Always unplug electrical equipment when not in use and do not plug in equipment that exceeds the maximum 15 amp rating. Certain power accessory plugs may not be compatible with the accessory power outlet and could overload vehicle or adapter fuses. If a problem is experienced, see your dealer. When adding electrical equipment, be sure to follow the proper installation instructions included with the equipment. See Add-On Electrical Equipment 0 303. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 104 Instruments and Controls An indicator light on the outlet illuminates when power is provided to the outlet and no system fault is detected. The outlets will not operate when the ignition is off, the DC/AC switch is not pressed, or the plug is not fully seated into the outlet. Caution Hanging heavy equipment from the power outlet can cause damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. The power outlets are designed for accessory power plugs only, such as cell phone charge cords. If equipment is connected using more than 400 watts or a system fault is detected, a protection circuit shuts off the power supply and the indicator light turns off. Power Outlet 110/120-Volt Alternating Current If equipped, the vehicle has two alternating current power outlets. Truck Bed Power Outlet When the ignition is on, power is supplied to the outlets after the DC/AC switch is pressed. A green indicator light on the DC/ AC switch indicates when the DC/AC operation is active. One power outlet can be used with electrical equipment that uses a maximum of 400 watts. If both outlets are being used, 400 watts will be shared between the outlets. Ensure that all connected devices do not exceed 400 watts. In Cab Power Outlet and DC/AC Switch The power outlet can be turned off by pressing the DC/AC switch. The power outlet can be turned back on after 10 seconds, during which the indicator light on the switch will flash. Do not use a power outlet with a missing or damaged cover. The power outlet is not designed for the following, and may not work properly if they are plugged in: . Equipment with high initial peak wattage, such as compressor-driven refrigerators and electric power tools . Other equipment requiring an extremely stable power supply, such as microcomputer-controlled electric blankets and touch sensor lamps . Medical equipment Wireless Charging If equipped and enabled, the vehicle has wireless charging on the center console in front of the cupholders. The system Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls operates at 145 kHz and wirelessly charges one Qi compatible smartphone. The power output of the system is capable of charging at a rate up to 3 amp (15 W), as requested by the compatible smartphone. See Radio Frequency Statement 0 417. { Warning Wireless charging may affect the operation of an implanted pacemaker or other medical devices. If you have one, it is recommended to consult with your doctor before using the wireless charging system. The vehicle must be on, in ACC/ACCESSORY, or Retained Accessory Power (RAP) must be active. The wireless charging feature may not correctly indicate charging when the vehicle is in RAP, during a Bluetooth phone call, or when phone projection (e.g. Apple CarPlay / Android Auto) is active. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP) 0 232. The operating temperature is −40 °C (−40 °F) to 85 °C (185 °F) for the charging system and 0 °C (32 °F) to 35 °C (95 °F) for the phone. A charging stopped alert may be displayed on the infotainment screen, if the wireless charger or smartphone are outside of 105 normal operating temperature. Charging will automatically resume when a normal operating temperature is reached. { Warning Remove all objects from the charger before charging your compatible smartphone. Objects, such as coins, keys, rings, paper clips, or cards, between the smartphone and charger may become very hot. On the rare occasion that the charging system does not detect an object, and the object gets wedged between the smartphone and charger, remove the smartphone and allow the object to cool before removing it from the charger, to prevent burns. To charge a compatible smartphone: 1. Confirm the smartphone is capable of wireless charging. 2. Remove all objects from the charging pad. The system may not charge if there are any objects between the smartphone and charger. 3. Place the smartphone face up against the rear of the charger. To maximize the charge rate, ensure the smartphone is fully seated and centered in the holder with nothing under it. A thick smartphone case may prevent the charger from working, or reduce the charging performance. See your dealer for additional information. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 106 Instruments and Controls 4. A green ] will appear on the infotainment display, next to the phone icon. This indicates that the smartphone is detected. 5. If a smartphone is placed on the charger and ] turns off or turns yellow, remove the smartphone and any objects from the pad. Turn the smartphone 180 degrees and wait a few seconds before placing/aligning it on the pad again. 6. If a smartphone is placed on the charger and ] turns red, the charger and/or the smartphone is overheated. Remove the smartphone and any objects from the charger in order to cool the system. The smartphone may become warm during charging. This is normal. In warmer temperatures, the speed of charging may be reduced. Software Acknowledgements Certain Wireless Charging Module product from LG Electronics, Inc. ("LGE") contains the open source software detailed below. Refer to the indicated open source licenses (as are included following this notice) for the terms and conditions of their use. OSS Notice Information To obtain the source code that is contained in this product, please visit http://opensource.lge.com. In addition to the source code, all referred license terms, warranty disclaimers and copyright notices are available for download. LG Electronics will also provide open source code to you on CD-ROM for a charge covering the cost of performing such distribution (such as the cost of media, shipping, and handling) upon email request to [email protected]. This offer is valid for three (3) years from the date on which you purchased the product. Freescale-WCT library Copyright (c) 2012-2014 Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.. All rights reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. 3. Neither the name of the copyright holder nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators 107 Instrument Cluster Warning lights and gauges can signal that something is wrong before it becomes serious enough to cause an expensive repair or replacement. Paying attention to the warning lights and gauges could prevent injury. Some warning lights come on briefly when the engine is started to indicate they are working. When one of the warning lights comes on and stays on while driving, or when one of the gauges shows there may be a problem, check the section that explains what to do. Waiting to do repairs can be costly and even dangerous. Base Cluster English Shown, Metric Similar 1. Tachometer 0 111 2. Engine Oil Pressure Gauge 0 112 3. Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge 0 113 4. Fuel Gauge 0 111 5. Voltmeter Gauge 0 113 6. Speedometer 0 111 7. Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 108 Instruments and Controls Midlevel Cluster English Shown, Metric Similar 1. Tachometer 0 111 2. Engine Oil Pressure Gauge 0 112 3. Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge 0 113 4. Fuel Gauge 0 111 5. Voltmeter Gauge 0 113 6. Speedometer 0 111 7. Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls 109 Use the right steering wheel control to open and scroll through the different items and displays. Uplevel Cluster English Standard Shown, Metric Similar 1. Tachometer 0 111 2. Engine Oil Pressure Gauge 0 112 3. Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge 0 113 4. Fuel Gauge 0 111 5. Voltmeter Gauge 0 113 6. Speedometer 0 111 7. Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125 Cluster Menu (Midlevel and Uplevel) There is an interactive display area in the center of the instrument cluster. Press S or T to access the cluster applications. Use the thumbwheel to scroll through the list of available features. Press the thumbwheel to select. Not all applications will be available on all vehicles. . Home . Info App. This is where the selected Driver Information Center (DIC) displays can be viewed. See Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125. . Audio Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 110 Instruments and Controls . Navigation . Phone . Options Home Information displayed here can be customized from the Options menu. Speedometer : Displays how fast the vehicle is moving in either kilometers per hour (km/h) or miles per hour (mph). Speed Sign : Shows sign information, which comes from a roadway database in the onboard navigation, if equipped. Time : Displays the current time. Fuel Range : Displays the approximate distance the vehicle can be driven without refueling. The fuel range estimate is based on an average of the vehicle’s fuel economy over recent driving history and the amount of fuel remaining in the fuel tank. Fuel range cannot be reset. Audio In the Audio menu, use the thumbwheel to scroll through options, browse for music, select from favorites, or change the audio source. In the main view, scroll to change the station or go to the next or previous track. Navigation In the Navigation menu, if there is no active route, a compass will be displayed. If there is an active route, press the thumbwheel to cancel or resume route guidance, mute or unmute voice guidance, or access Recents or Favorites. Phone In the Phone menu, if there is no active phone call, view recent calls, scroll through contacts, select from the favorites, or change the phone source. If there is an active call, mute the phone or switch to handset operation. Options Use the thumbwheel to scroll through items in the Options menu. Head-up Display (HUD) : If equipped, this feature allows for adjusting the angle of the HUD image and changing or turning off the Speed Limit Sign. HUD Rotation: Press the thumbwheel while Adjust Rotation is highlighted to enter Adjust Mode. Scroll to adjust the angle of the HUD display. Press the thumbwheel to confirm and save the setting. This feature may only be available in P (Park). Speed Limit Style: Press the thumbwheel while Speed Limit Style is highlighted to change the speed sign style or to turn it off. Units : Press the thumbwheel while Units is displayed to enter the Units menu. Choose US or metric units by pressing the thumbwheel while the desired item is highlighted. A selected mark will be displayed next to the selected item. Info Page Options : Press the thumbwheel while Info Page Options is displayed to enter and select the items to be displayed in the Info app. A selected mark will be displayed next to the selected item. Home : Press the thumbwheel to select the available elements to display. Not all elements will be available on all vehicles: Speedometer, Speed Sign, Time, and Fuel Range. Display (Uplevel) : Press the thumbwheel to enter the Display menu. Select to turn on or off the compass or speed sign. Speed Warning : The Speed Warning display allows the driver to set a speed that they do not want to exceed. To set the Speed Warning, press the thumbwheel when Speed Warning is displayed, or press the thumbwheel on the main view to set the Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls speed value. Scroll to adjust the value. Press the thumbwheel to set the speed. Once the speed is set, this feature can be turned off by pressing the thumbwheel while viewing this page. If the selected speed limit is exceeded, a pop-up warning is displayed with a chime. Software Information : Press the thumbwheel while Software Information is highlighted to display open source software information. Speedometer The trip odometer is accessed and reset through the Driver Information Center (DIC). See Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125. Tachometer The tachometer displays the engine speed in revolutions per minute (rpm). Fuel Gauge Uplevel English Fuel Gauge Shown, Base Level and Midlevel Fuel Gauge Similar The speedometer shows the vehicle's speed in either kilometers per hour (km/h) or miles per hour (mph). When the ignition is on, the fuel gauge indicates about how much fuel is left in the tank. Odometer There is an arrow near the fuel gauge pointing to the side of the vehicle the fuel door is on. The odometer shows how far the vehicle has been driven, in either kilometers or miles. Trip Odometer The trip odometer shows how far the vehicle has been driven since the trip odometer was last reset. 111 When the indicator nears empty, the low fuel light comes on. There still is a little fuel left, but the vehicle should be refueled soon. Uplevel Metric Fuel Gauge Shown, Base Level and Midlevel Fuel Gauge Similar Here are three things that some owners ask about. None of these show a problem with the fuel gauge: Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 112 Instruments and Controls . It takes a little more, or less fuel to fill up indicates oil pressure outside the normal operating range, check the vehicle's oil as soon as possible. than the gauge indicated. For example, the gauge may have indicated the tank was half full, but it actually took a little more, or less than half the tank's capacity to fill the tank. . The gauge moves a little while turning a corner, speeding up or braking. . The gauge takes a few seconds to stabilize after the ignition is turned on and goes back to empty when the ignition is turned off. Engine Oil Pressure Gauge See Engine Oil 0 311. Caution Uplevel English Shown, Base Level and Midlevel Similar The engine oil pressure gauge shows the engine oil pressure in kPa (kilopascals) or psi (pounds per square inch) when the engine is running. Oil pressure can vary with engine speed, outside temperature, coolant temperature, and oil viscosity. Uplevel Metric Shown, Base Level and Midlevel Similar On some models, the oil pump will vary engine oil pressure according to engine needs. Oil pressure may change quickly as the engine speed or load varies. This is normal. If the oil pressure warning light or Driver Information Center (DIC) message Lack of proper engine oil maintenance can damage the engine. Driving with the engine oil low can also damage the engine. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Check the oil level as soon as possible. Add oil if required, but if the oil level is within the operating range and the oil pressure is still low, have the vehicle serviced. Always follow the maintenance schedule for changing engine oil. If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge Voltmeter Gauge Uplevel English Shown, Base Level and Midlevel Similar Uplevel Metric Shown, Base Level and Midlevel Similar 113 This gauge measures the temperature of the vehicle's engine coolant. While driving under normal operating conditions, if the needle moves into the red warning area, the engine is too hot. Pull off the road, stop the vehicle, and turn off the engine as soon as possible. Uplevel Shown, Base Level and Midlevel Similar When the ignition is on, this gauge indicates the battery voltage. When the engine is running, this gauge shows the condition of the charging system. The gauge can transition from a higher to lower or a lower to higher reading. This is normal. If the vehicle is operating outside the normal operating range, the charging system light comes on. See Charging System Light 0 116. The voltmeter gauge may also read lower when in fuel economy mode. This is normal. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 114 Instruments and Controls Readings outside the normal operating range can also occur when a large number of electrical accessories are operating in the vehicle and the engine is left idling for an extended period. This condition is normal since the charging system is not able to provide full power at engine idle. As engine speeds are increased, this condition should correct itself as higher engine speeds allow the charging system to create maximum power. The vehicle can only be driven for a short time with the readings outside the normal operating range. If the vehicle must be driven, turn off all accessories, such as the radio and air conditioner. Readings outside the normal operating range indicate a possible problem in the electrical system. Have the vehicle serviced as soon as possible. Seat Belt Reminders Driver Seat Belt Reminder Light There is a driver seat belt reminder light on the instrument cluster. When the vehicle is started, this light flashes and a chime may come on to remind passengers to fasten their seat belt. When the vehicle is started, this light flashes and a chime may come on to remind the driver to fasten their seat belt. Then the light stays on solid until the belt is buckled. This cycle may continue several times if the driver remains or becomes unbuckled while the vehicle is moving. If the driver seat belt is buckled, neither the light nor the chime comes on. Front Passenger Seat Belt Reminder Light The vehicle may have a front passenger seat belt reminder light near the passenger airbag status indicator. See Passenger Sensing System 0 67. Then the light stays on solid until the belt is buckled. This cycle continues several times if the front passenger remains or becomes unbuckled while the vehicle is moving. If the front passenger seat belt is buckled, neither the chime nor the light comes on. The front passenger seat belt reminder light and chime may come on if an object is put on the seat such as a briefcase, handbag, grocery bag, laptop, or other electronic device. To turn off the reminder light and/or chime, remove the object from the seat or buckle the seat belt. Airbag Readiness Light This light shows if there is an electrical problem with the airbag system. It is located in the instrument cluster. The system check includes the airbag sensor(s), the passenger sensing system, the pretensioners, the airbag modules, the wiring, and the crash sensing and diagnostic module. For more information on the airbag system, see Airbag System 0 62. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls Passenger Airbag Status Indicator The airbag readiness light comes on for several seconds when the vehicle is started. If the light does not come on then, have it fixed immediately. The vehicle has a passenger sensing system. See Passenger Sensing System 0 67 for important safety information. The overhead console has a passenger airbag status indicator. If there is a problem with the airbag system, a Driver Information Center (DIC) message may also come on. will light either ON or OFF, or either the on or off symbol, to let you know the status of the front outboard passenger frontal airbag. If the word ON or the on symbol is lit on the passenger airbag status indicator, it means that the front outboard passenger frontal airbag is allowed to inflate. If the word OFF or the off symbol is lit on the passenger airbag status indicator, it means that the passenger sensing system has turned off the front outboard passenger frontal airbag. { Warning If the airbag readiness light stays on after the vehicle is started or comes on while driving, it means the airbag system might not be working properly. The airbags in the vehicle might not inflate in a crash, or they could even inflate without a crash. To help avoid injury, have the vehicle serviced right away. 115 United States If, after several seconds, both status indicator lights remain on, or if there are no lights at all, there may be a problem with the lights or the passenger sensing system. See your dealer for service. { Warning Canada When the vehicle is started, the passenger airbag status indicator will light ON and OFF, or the symbols for on and off, for several seconds as a system check. Then, after several more seconds, the status indicator If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and stays on, it means that something may be wrong with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right away. See Airbag Readiness Light 0 114 for more information, including important safety information. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 116 Instruments and Controls Charging System Light The charging system light comes on briefly when the ignition is turned on, but the engine is not running, as a check to show the light is working. It should go out when the engine is started. Malfunction Indicator Lamp (Check Engine Light) This light is part of the vehicle’s emission control on-board diagnostic system. If this light is on while the engine is running, a malfunction has been detected and the vehicle may require service. The light should come on to show that it is working when the ignition is on and the engine is not running. See Ignition Positions (Keyless Access) 0 229 or Ignition Positions (Key Access) 0 227. If the light stays on, or comes on while driving, there may be a problem with the electrical charging system. Have it checked by your dealer. Driving while this light is on could drain the battery. When this light comes on, or is flashing, the Driver Information Center (DIC) also displays a message. If a short distance must be driven with the light on, be sure to turn off all accessories, such as the radio and air conditioner. Find a safe place to stop the vehicle. Malfunctions are often indicated by the system before any problem is noticeable. Being aware of the light and seeking service promptly when it comes on may prevent damage. Caution If the vehicle is driven continually with this light on, the emission control system may not work as well, the fuel economy may be lower, and the vehicle may not run smoothly. This could lead to costly repairs that might not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Caution Modifications to the engine, transmission, exhaust, intake, or fuel system, or the use of replacement tires that do not meet the original tire specifications, can cause this light to come on. This could lead to costly repairs not covered by the vehicle warranty. This could also affect the vehicle’s ability to pass an Emissions Inspection/Maintenance test. See Accessories and Modifications 0 307. If the light is flashing : A malfunction has been detected that could damage the emission control system and increase vehicle emissions. Diagnosis and service may be required. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls To help prevent damage, reduce vehicle speed and avoid hard accelerations and uphill grades. If towing a trailer, reduce the amount of cargo being hauled as soon as possible. If the light continues to flash, find a safe place to park. Turn the vehicle off and wait at least 10 seconds before restarting the engine. If the light is still flashing, follow the previous guidelines and see your dealer for service as soon as possible. If the light is on steady : A malfunction has been detected. Diagnosis and service may be required. Check the following: . If fuel has been added to the vehicle using the capless funnel adapter, make sure that it has been removed. See “Filling the Tank with a Portable Gas Can” under Filling the Tank (Chassis Cab and Box Delete Models) 0 272 or Filling the Tank (Pickup Models) 0 271. The diagnostic system can detect if the adapter has been left installed in the vehicle, allowing fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere. A few driving trips with the adapter removed may turn off the light. . Poor fuel quality can cause inefficient engine operation and poor driveability, which may go away once the engine is warmed up. If this occurs, change the fuel brand. It may require at least one full tank of the proper fuel to turn the light off. See Recommended Fuel 0 269. If the light remains on, see your dealer. Emissions Inspection and Maintenance Programs If the vehicle requires an Emissions Inspection/Maintenance test, the test equipment will likely connect to the vehicle's Data Link Connector (DLC). 117 operation. See Add-On Electrical Equipment 0 303. See your dealer if assistance is needed. The vehicle may not pass inspection if: . The light is on when the engine is running. . The light does not come on when the ignition is on while the engine is off. . Critical emission control systems have not been completely diagnosed. If this happens, the vehicle would not be ready for inspection and might require several days of routine driving before the system is ready for inspection. This can happen if the 12-volt battery has recently been replaced or run down, or if the vehicle has been recently serviced. See your dealer if the vehicle will not pass or cannot be made ready for the test. Brake System Warning Light The DLC is under the instrument panel to the left of the steering wheel. Connecting devices that are not used to perform an Emissions Inspection/Maintenance test or to service the vehicle may affect vehicle Metric English Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 118 Instruments and Controls This light should come on briefly when the vehicle is turned on. If it does not come on then, have it fixed so it will be ready to warn you if there is a problem. Electric Parking Brake Light If the light comes on and stays on at start up, there is a brake problem. Have the brake system inspected right away. If the light comes on while driving, pull off the road and stop carefully. The brake pedal might be harder to push, or the brake pedal may go closer to the floor. It could take longer to stop. If the light is still on, have the vehicle towed for service. See Towing the Vehicle 0 377. { Warning The brake system might not be working properly if the brake system warning light is on. Driving with the brake system warning light on can lead to a crash. If the light is still on after the vehicle has been pulled off the road and carefully stopped, have the vehicle towed for service. Metric English This light comes on when the parking brake is applied. If the light continues flashing after the parking brake is released, or while driving, there is a problem with the Electric Parking Brake system. A message may also display in the Driver Information Center (DIC). This light should come on briefly when the vehicle is turned on. If it does not come on, have it fixed so it will be ready to warn if there is a problem. If this light stays on or comes on while driving, there is a problem with the Electric Parking Brake (EPB). Take the vehicle to a dealer as soon as possible. In addition to the parking brake, other safety functions that utilize the EPB may also be degraded. A message may also display in the Driver Information Center (DIC). See Electric Parking Brake 0 245. Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light If the light does not come on, or remains flashing, see your dealer. Service Electric Parking Brake Light This warning light should come on briefly when the vehicle is turned on. If the light does not come on, have it fixed so it will be ready to warn if there is a problem. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls If the light comes on while driving, safely stop as soon as it is possible and turn off the vehicle. Then turn on the vehicle again to reset the system. If the ABS warning light stays on, or comes on again while driving, the vehicle needs service. A chime may also sound when the light stays on. If equipped, the four-wheel-drive light displays what mode the vehicle is in. The light will show each mode: 2WD, 4HI, AUTO (all transfer cases); 4LOW and N (two-speed transfer case only). 119 Lane Departure Warning (LDW) Light The light will flash when a shift is in progress. Once the shift is complete the light will be steady. If the ABS warning light is the only light on, the vehicle has regular brakes, but ABS is not functioning. If the light turns amber, there may be a malfunction with the four-wheel-drive system. See your dealer. If both the ABS warning light and the brake system warning light are on, ABS is not functioning and there is a problem with the regular brakes. See your dealer for service. See Four-Wheel Drive 0 240. Hill Descent Control Light This light is green if LDW is on and ready to operate. This light changes to amber and flashes to indicate that the lane marking has been crossed without using a turn signal in that direction. See Brake System Warning Light 0 117. See Lane Departure Warning (LDW) 0 268. Four-Wheel-Drive Light Vehicle Ahead Indicator If equipped, the Hill Descent Control light comes on when the system is ready for use. When the light flashes, the system is active. Auto Mode Shown, Other Modes Similar See Hill Descent Control (HDC) 0 248. If equipped, this indicator will display green when a vehicle is detected ahead and amber when you are following a vehicle ahead much too closely. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 120 Instruments and Controls See Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System 0 263. Traction Control System (TCS)/ Electronic Stability Control Light Trailer Sway Control Light (Uplevel Cluster) This light comes on briefly when the vehicle is turned on. This light will flash when Trailer Sway Control is active. See Trailer Sway Control (TSC) 0 291. Traction Off Light This light comes on briefly when the vehicle is turned on. If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer. If the system is working normally, the indicator light then turns off. The traction off light comes on when the Traction Control System (TCS) has been turned off. If Electronic Stability Control (ESC) is turned off, TCS is also turned off. To turn TCS and ESC off and on, see Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control 0 247. If TCS is off, wheel spin is not limited unless necessary to help protect the driveline from damage. Adjust driving accordingly. If the light does not come on, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer. If the system is working normally, the indicator light turns off. If the light is on and not flashing, the TCS and potentially the ESC system are not fully operational and may not assist in maintaining control. Adjust driving accordingly. If the condition persists, see your dealer as soon as possible. A Driver Information Center (DIC) message may display. The light flashes when the TCS and/or the ESC system is actively working. See Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control 0 247. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Off Light This light comes on briefly when the vehicle is turned on. If the light does not come on, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer. If the system is working normally, the indicator light then turns off. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls serviced by your dealer. If the system is working normally, the indicator light then turns off. This light comes on when the Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system is turned off. If ESC is off, the Traction Control System (TCS) is also off. To turn ESC off and on, see Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control 0 247. If ESC and TCS are off, the systems do not assist in controlling the vehicle. Adjust driving accordingly. Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Light Caution The engine coolant temperature warning light indicates that the vehicle has overheated. Driving with this light on can damage the engine and it may not be covered by the vehicle warranty. See Engine Overheating 0 318. This light comes on when Off-Road Mode is selected. The engine coolant temperature warning light comes on when the engine has overheated. If this happens, pull over and turn off the engine as soon as possible. See Engine Overheating 0 318. Driver Mode Control Light This light comes on when the Tow/Haul Mode is selected. Tire Pressure Light This light comes on briefly while starting the vehicle. If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer. If the system is working normally the indicator light goes off. 121 This light comes on when Snow Mode is selected. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 122 Instruments and Controls For vehicles with the Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS), this light comes on briefly when the vehicle is started. It provides information about tire pressures and the TPMS. When the Light Is On Steady This indicates that one or more of the tires are significantly underinflated. A Driver Information Center (DIC) tire pressure message may also display. Stop as soon as possible, and inflate the tires to the pressure value shown on the Tire and Loading Information label. See Tire Pressure 0 349. When the Light Flashes First and Then Is On Steady If the light flashes for about a minute and then stays on, there may be a problem with the TPMS. If the problem is not corrected, the light will come on at every ignition cycle. See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation 0 351. Engine Oil Pressure Light (Uplevel Cluster) Caution Lack of proper engine oil maintenance can damage the engine. Driving with the engine oil low can also damage the engine. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Check the oil level as soon as possible. Add oil if required, but if the oil level is within the operating range and the oil pressure is still low, have the vehicle serviced. Always follow the maintenance schedule for changing engine oil. If the light comes on and stays on, it means that oil is not flowing through the engine properly. The vehicle could be low on oil and might have some other system problem. See your dealer. Low Fuel Warning Light A Low Fuel Warning Light near the fuel gauge comes on briefly when the ignition is turned on as a check to show it is working. It also comes on when the fuel gauge indicator nears empty. The light turns off when fuel is added. If it does not, have the vehicle serviced. Security Light This light should come on briefly as the engine is started. If it does not come on, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls The security light should come on briefly as the engine is started. If it does not come on, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer. If the system is working normally, the indicator light turns off. This light comes on when the IntelliBeam system, if equipped, is enabled. See Exterior Lamp Controls 0 139. 123 Cruise Control Light Front Fog Lamp Light If the light stays on and the engine does not start, there could be a problem with the theft-deterrent system. See Immobilizer Operation 0 33. High-Beam On Light For vehicles with fog lamps, this light comes on when the fog lamps are turned on. The light goes out when the fog lamps are turned off. See Fog Lamps 0 143. For vehicles with cruise control, the cruise control light is white when the cruise control is on and ready, and turns green when the cruise control is set and active. The light turns off when the cruise control is turned off. See Cruise Control 0 250. Door Ajar Light Lamps On Reminder This light comes on when the high-beam headlamps are in use. See Headlamp High/ Low-Beam Changer 0 141. IntelliBeam Light This light comes on when the exterior lamps are in use, except when only the Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) are active. See Exterior Lamp Controls 0 139. This light comes on when a door is open or not securely latched. Before driving, check that all doors are properly closed. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 124 Instruments and Controls Information Displays Digital Speedometer Tire Pressure Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) The speedometer shows how fast the vehicle is moving in either kilometers per hour (km/h) or miles per hour (mph). The speedometer cannot be reset. Turn the trip odometer reset stem until a vehicle with the approximate pressures of all four tires displays. Tire pressure is displayed in either kilopascal (kPa) or in pounds per square inch (psi). The DIC displays are shown in the center of the instrument cluster. The displays show the status of many vehicle systems. The trip odometer reset stem in the instrument cluster is used to access the DIC menu items. If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement for more information. DIC Menu Items Turn the trip odometer reset stem to scroll through the following menu items: . Digital Speedometer . Trip 1/2 . Fuel Range . Tire Pressure . Remaining Oil Life . Air Filter Life . Brake Pad Life Trip 1 or 2 and Average Fuel Economy Turn the trip odometer reset stem until TRIP 1 or TRIP 2 displays. The current distance traveled, in either kilometers (km) or miles (mi), since the last reset for the trip odometer is shown, as well as the average fuel economy. The trip odometer and the average fuel economy can be reset by pressing and holding the trip odometer reset stem. Fuel Range This display shows the approximate distance the vehicle can be driven without refueling. The fuel range estimate is based on an average of the vehicle's fuel economy over recent driving history and the amount of fuel remaining in the fuel tank. Fuel range cannot be reset. See Tire Pressure Monitor System 0 350 and Tire Pressure Monitor Operation 0 351. Remaining Oil Life Turn the trip odometer reset stem until REMAINING OIL LIFE displays. An estimate of the oil's remaining useful life is shown. REMAINING OIL LIFE 99% means 99% of the current oil life remains. When the remaining oil life is low, the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message will appear on the display. The oil should be changed as soon as possible. See Engine Oil 0 311. In addition to the engine oil life system monitoring the oil life, additional maintenance is recommended. See Maintenance Schedule 0 392. The Oil Life display must be reset after each oil change. It will not reset itself. Do not reset the Oil Life display at any time other than when the oil has just been changed. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls 125 It cannot be reset accurately until the next oil change. To reset, see Engine Oil Life System 0 313. Brake Pad Life display after replacing the brake pads. See Brake Pad Life System 0 322. y or z : Use the thumbwheel to scroll up Air Filter Life Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) Info Page Options Turn the trip odometer reset stem until AIR FILTER LIFE displays. This displays an estimate of the engine air filter’s remaining useful life and the state of the system. Engine Air Filter Life 95% means 95% of the current air filter life remains. Messages will display based on the engine air filter life and the state of the system. The DIC displays are shown in the center of the instrument cluster in the Info app. See Instrument Cluster 0 107. The displays show the status of many vehicle systems. If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. When the REPLACE AT NEXT OIL CHANGE message displays, the engine air filter should be replaced at the time of the next oil change. When the REPLACE SOON message displays, the engine air filter should be replaced at the earliest convenience. The info pages on the DIC can be turned on or off through the Options menu. 1. Press T to scroll to the Options application. 2. Scroll y or z to choose Info pages and press the thumbwheel. 3. Scroll y or z to move through the list of possible information displays. 4. Press the thumbwheel while an item is highlighted to select or deselect that item. The info pages can also be turned on or off through the DIC page Info Page Options. The Air Filter Life display must be reset after the engine air filter replacement. To reset, see Engine Air Filter Life System 0 314. Info Pages Brake Pad Life This displays an estimate of the remaining life of the front and rear brake pads. Messages will display based on brake pad wear and the state of the system. Reset the or down in a list. Press the thumbwheel to select. S or T : Press to move left or right between the interactive display zones in the cluster. Press the thumbwheel to select. The following is the list of all possible DIC info page displays. Some may not be available for your particular vehicle. Some items may not be turned on by default but can be turned on through the Options app. See “Info Page Options” earlier in this section. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 126 Instruments and Controls While in the Info Page Options menu, the info pages can be restored to the default factory settings by pressing and holding K on the left steering wheel controls and the thumbwheel on the right steering wheel controls at the same time. approximate average fuel economy that the vehicle has right now, and will change as driving conditions change. Speed : Shows the vehicle speed in either kilometers per hour (km/h) or miles per hour (mph). The vehicle odometer is also shown on this page. If equipped, press the thumbwheel to open the menu and select to display speed limit signs. Fuel Range : Shows the approximate distance the vehicle can be driven without refueling. LOW will be displayed when the vehicle is low on fuel. The fuel range estimate is based on an average of the vehicle's fuel economy over recent driving history and the amount of fuel remaining in the fuel tank. Speed limit signs in your vehicle display may vary from actual road speed depending on the version of your current navigation map. Trip 1 or Trip 2, and Average Fuel Economy : Shows the current distance traveled, in either kilometers (km) or miles (mi), since the trip odometer was last reset. The Average Fuel Economy display shows the approximate average liters per 100 kilometers (L/100 km), kilometers per liter (km/L), or miles per gallon (mpg). This number is calculated based on the value recorded since the last time this menu item was reset. This number reflects only the Press the thumbwheel while this display is active to reset the trip odometer and the average fuel economy. Timer : This display can be used as a timer. To start the timer, press the thumbwheel while this display is active. The display will show the amount of time that has passed since the timer was last reset. To stop the timer, press the thumbwheel briefly while this display is active and the timer is running. Press the thumbwheel while this display is active to reset the timer. Oil Life : Shows an estimate of the oil's remaining useful life. If REMAINING OIL LIFE 99% is displayed, that means 99% of the current oil life remains. When the remaining oil life is low, the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message will appear on the display. The oil should be changed as soon as possible. See Engine Oil 0 311. In addition to the engine oil life system monitoring the oil life, additional maintenance is recommended. See Maintenance Schedule 0 392. The Oil Life display must be reset after each oil change. It will not reset itself. Do not reset the Oil Life display at any time other than when the oil has just been changed. It cannot be reset accurately until the next oil change. To reset, see Engine Oil Life System 0 313. Tire Pressure : Shows the approximate pressures of all four tires. Tire pressure is displayed in either kilopascal (kPa) or in pounds per square inch (psi). If the pressure is low, the value for that tire is shown in amber. See Tire Pressure Monitor System 0 350 and Tire Pressure Monitor Operation 0 351. Air Filter Life : Shows an estimate of the engine air filter’s remaining useful life and the state of the system. Engine Air Filter Life 95% means 95% of the current air filter life remains. Messages will display based on the engine air filter life and the state of the Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls 127 system. When the REPLACE AT NEXT OIL CHANGE message displays, the engine air filter should be replaced at the time of the next oil change. When the REPLACE SOON message displays, the engine air filter should be replaced at the earliest convenience. Engine Hours (Hourmeter) : Shows the total number of hours the engine has run. This display also shows the engine idle hours. Driver Assistance : If equipped, shows information for Lane Departure Warning (LDW) and Forward Collision Alert (FCA). Transmission Fluid Temperature : Shows the temperature of the automatic transmission fluid in either degrees Celsius (°C) or degrees Fahrenheit (°F). Info Page Options : Scroll to choose which info pages appear on the DIC. Press the thumbwheel to select or deselect. The Air Filter Life display must be reset after the engine air filter replacement. To reset, see Engine Air Filter Life System 0 314. Trailer Brake : On vehicles with the Integrated Trailer Brake Control (ITBC) system, the trailer brake display appears in the DIC. Brake Pad Life : This displays an estimate of the remaining life of the front and rear brake pads. Messages will display based on brake pad wear and the state of the system. Reset the Brake Pad Life display after replacing the brake pads. See Brake Pad Life System 0 322. Fuel Economy : Displays average fuel economy, the best fuel economy over the selected distance, and a bar graph showing instantaneous fuel economy. Press the thumbwheel to change the selected distance. Press and hold the thumbwheel while this display is active to reset the best fuel economy and average fuel economy. This display can also be reset by selecting reset in the menu. TRAILER GAIN shows the trailer gain setting. This setting can be adjusted from 0.0 to 10.0 with either a trailer connected or disconnected. TRAILER OUTPUT shows the power output to the trailer any time a trailer with electric brakes is connected. Output is displayed as a bar graph. Dotted lines may appear in the OUTPUT display if a trailer is not connected. Off Road : Displays vehicle pitch and roll information, road wheel angle, and four-wheel drive (4WD) status. Follow Distance : If equipped, the current follow time to the vehicle ahead is displayed as a time value on this page. Blank Page : Shows no information. Head-Up Display (HUD) { Warning If the HUD image is too bright or too high in your field of view, it may take you more time to see things you need to see when it is dark outside. Be sure to keep the HUD image dim and placed low in your field of view. If equipped with HUD, some information about the operation of the vehicle is projected onto the windshield. The image is projected through the HUD lens on top of the instrument panel. The information appears as an image focused out toward the front of the vehicle. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 128 Instruments and Controls Caution If you try to use the HUD image as a parking aid, you may misjudge the distance and damage your vehicle. Do not use the HUD image as a parking aid. The HUD information can be displayed in various languages. The speedometer reading and other numerical values can be displayed in either English or metric units. The language selection is changed through the radio, and the units of measurement is changed through the instrument cluster. See Settings 0 184 and “Options” under Instrument Cluster 0 107. Depending on how the vehicle is equipped, the HUD may display some of the following vehicle information and vehicle messages or alerts: . Speed . Audio . Phone . Navigation . Driver Assistance Features . Vehicle Messages Some vehicle messages or alerts displayed in the HUD may be cleared by using the steering wheel controls. 3. Use the following settings to adjust the HUD. $ : Press or pull to center the HUD image. The HUD image can only be adjusted up and down, not side to side. ! : Press to select the display view. Each press will change the display view. D : Pull and hold to brighten the display. Press and hold to dim the display. Continue to hold to turn the display off. The HUD image will automatically dim and brighten to compensate for outside lighting. Use D to adjust as needed. The HUD image can temporarily light up depending on the angle and position of sunlight on the HUD display. This is normal. Polarized sunglasses could make the HUD image harder to see. Head-Up Display (HUD) Rotation Option The HUD control is to the left of the steering wheel. HUD Display on the Windshield To adjust the HUD image: 1. Adjust the driver seat. 2. Start the engine. If equipped, this feature under the Options menu of the instrument cluster allows for adjusting the angle of the HUD image and changing or turning off the Speed Limit Sign. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls HUD Rotation: Press the thumbwheel while Adjust Rotation is highlighted to enter Adjust Mode. Scroll to adjust the angle of the HUD display. Press the thumbwheel to confirm and save the setting. This feature may only be available in P (Park). 129 Speed View : This displays the speedometer reading in English or metric units, and speed limit. Some information only appears on vehicles that have these features, and when they are active. Speed Limit Style Adjustment If equipped, the speed limit style can be changed to a speed limit bar or speed limit sign from the Options menu in the instrument cluster. Press the thumbwheel while Speed Limit Style is highlighted to change the speed sign style or to turn it off. HUD Views There are four views in the HUD. Some vehicle information and vehicle messages or alerts may be displayed in any view. English Shown, Metric Similar English Shown, Metric Similar English Shown, Metric Similar Active Safety View : This displays the speed view along with a driver assistance graphic on the left. Driver assistance graphics show your vehicle, vehicle ahead, gap setting, and lane status information. In addition to driver assistance graphics, pedestrian advisory and trailer sway indicators will be displayed. Navigation/Active OnStar View : This displays the speed view along with indicators for vehicle ahead, Lane Departure Warning/Lane Keep Assist, trailer sway, and pedestrian advisory. Turn-by-Turn navigation information is shown during active route. The compass heading is displayed when navigation routing is not active. Navigation Turn-by-Turn Alerts shown in the instrument cluster may also be displayed in any HUD view. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 130 Instruments and Controls . The HUD brightness setting is not too dim or too bright. . The HUD is adjusted to the proper height. . Polarized sunglasses are not worn. . The windshield and HUD lens are clean. If the HUD image is not correct, contact your dealer. English Shown, Metric Similar Off Road View : This displays the speed view along with indicators for vehicle ahead, Lane Departure Warning/Lane Keep Assist, trailer sway, four-wheel drive status, and pedestrian advisory. Off-road information such as pitch angle, steering angle, and rolling angle is also shown. Care of the HUD Clean the inside of the windshield to remove any dirt or film that could reduce the sharpness or clarity of the HUD image. Clean the HUD lens with a soft cloth sprayed with glass cleaner. Wipe the lens gently, then dry it. The windshield is part of the HUD system. See Windshield Replacement 0 329. Vehicle Messages Messages displayed on the Driver Information Center (DIC) indicate the status of the vehicle or some action that may be needed to correct a condition. Multiple messages may appear one after another. The messages that do not require immediate action can be acknowledged and cleared by pressing the thumbwheel. The messages that require immediate action cannot be cleared until that action is performed. HUD Troubleshooting All messages should be taken seriously; clearing the message does not correct the problem. Check that: . Nothing is covering the HUD lens. If a SERVICE message appears, see your dealer. Follow the instructions given in the messages. The system displays messages regarding the following topics: . Service Messages . Fluid Levels . Vehicle Security . Brakes . Steering . Ride Control Systems . Driver Assistance Systems . Cruise Control . Lighting and Bulb Replacement . Wiper/Washer Systems . Doors and Windows . Seat Belts . Airbag Systems . Engine and Transmission . Tire Pressure . Battery Engine Power Messages ENGINE POWER IS REDUCED This message displays when the vehicle's propulsion power is reduced. A reduction in propulsion power can affect the vehicle's ability to accelerate. If this message is on, Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls but there is no observed reduction in performance, proceed to your destination. Under certain conditions the performance may be reduced the next time the vehicle is driven. The vehicle may be driven while this message is on, but maximum acceleration and speed may be reduced. Anytime this message stays on, or displays repeatedly, the vehicle should be taken to your dealer for service as soon as possible. For System, Apps, and Personal features and functions, see Settings 0 184. Under certain operating conditions, propulsion will be disabled. Try restarting after the ignition has been off for 30 seconds. 9 or R to turn a feature off or on. 5. Touch z to go to the top level of the Vehicle Speed Messages The menu may contain the following: SPEED LIMITED TO XXX KM/H (MPH) This message shows that the vehicle speed has been limited to the speed displayed. The limited speed is a protection for various propulsion and vehicle systems, such as lubrication, thermal, brakes, suspension, Teen Driver if equipped, or tires. Vehicle Personalization The following are all possible vehicle personalization features. Depending on the vehicle, some may not be available. To access the vehicle personalization menu: 1. Touch the Settings icon on the Home Page of the infotainment display. 2. Touch Vehicle to display a list of available options. 3. Touch to select the desired feature setting. 4. Touch Settings menu. Rear Seat Reminder This allows for a chime and a message when the rear door has been opened before or during operation of the vehicle. Touch Off or On. Climate and Air Quality Touch and the following may display: . Auto Fan Speed . Auto Defog . Auto Rear Defog 131 Auto Fan Speed This setting specifies the amount of airflow when the climate control fan setting is Auto Fan. Touch Low, Medium, or High. Auto Defog This setting automatically directs air to the windshield to assist in defogging, based on temperature and humidity conditions. Touch Off or On. Auto Rear Defog This setting automatically turns the rear defogger on based on temperature and humidity conditions. Touch Off or On. Collision/Detection Systems Touch and the following may display: . Alert Type . Forward Collision System . Lane Change Alert . Park Assist . Rear Camera Park Assist Symbols . Rear Cross Traffic Alert Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 132 Instruments and Controls Alert Type Rear Cross Traffic Alert This feature sets the type of alert from the driver assistance systems to help avoid crashes. Touch Beeps or Safety Alert Seat. This allows the Rear Cross Traffic Alert feature to be turned on or off. See Assistance Systems for Parking or Backing 0 253. Forward Collision System Touch Off or On. This setting can alert of a potential crash with a detected vehicle ahead and can apply brakes to help reduce a collision’s severity. Comfort and Convenience Touch Off, Alert, or Alert and Brake. Lane Change Alert Touch and the following may display: . Chime Volume . Reverse Tilt Mirror . Remote Mirror Folding This allows the feature to be turned on or off. See Lane Change Alert (LCA) 0 266. Chime Volume Touch Off or On. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to adjust the volume. Park Assist This allows the feature to be turned on or off. See Assistance Systems for Parking or Backing 0 253. Select Off, On, or On with Towbar. Rear Camera Park Assist Symbols This setting enables the Rear Camera Park Assist Symbols. See Assistance Systems for Parking or Backing 0 253. Touch Off or On. This determines the chime volume level. Reverse Tilt Mirror When on, the driver, passenger, or both driver and passenger outside mirrors will tilt downward when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse) to improve visibility of the ground near the rear wheels. They may move from their tilted position when the vehicle is shifted out of R (Reverse) or turned off. See Reverse Tilt Mirrors 0 38. Touch Off, On - Driver and Passenger, On Driver, or On - Passenger. Remote Mirror Folding When on, the outside mirrors will remotely fold or unfold when the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter Q or K button is pressed and held. See Folding Mirrors 0 36. Touch Off or On. Lighting Touch and the following may display: . Vehicle Locator Lights . Exit Lighting . Automatic High Beam Assist Vehicle Locator Lights This setting flashes the vehicle’s headlamps when K is pressed on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. Touch Off or On. Exit Lighting This setting specifies how long the headlamps stay on after the vehicle is turned off and exited. Touch Off, 30 Seconds, 60 Seconds, or 120 Seconds. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls 133 Automatic High Beam Assist Delayed Door Lock Remote Lock Feedback This setting specifies how the high beams adjust based on the vehicle environment. When on, this feature will delay the locking of the doors. To override the delay, press the power door lock switch on the door. This allows selection of what type of feedback is given when locking the vehicle with the RKE transmitter. Touch Off or On. Touch Off, Lights and Horn, Lights Only, or Horn Only. Touch IntelliBeam or Adaptive Headlight System. Power Door Locks Remote Lock, Unlock, and Start Touch and the following may display: . Open Door Anti Lock Out . Auto Door Unlock . Delayed Door Lock Touch and the following may display: . Remote Unlock Light Feedback . Remote Lock Feedback . Remote Door Unlock . Remote Start Auto Cool Seats . Remote Start Auto Heat Seats . Remote Window Operation . Passive Door Unlock . Passive Door Lock . Remote Left in Vehicle Alert . Remote Removed from Vehicle Alert Open Door Anti Lock Out This setting prevents the driver door from locking when the door is open. If this setting is on, the Delayed Door Lock menu will not be available. If this setting is turned off, the Delayed Door Lock menu may not be available until the next ignition cycle. Touch Off or On. Remote Unlock Light Feedback Auto Door Unlock When on, the exterior lamps will flash when unlocking the vehicle with the RKE transmitter. This setting allows selection of which doors will automatically unlock when the vehicle is shifted into P (Park). Touch Off, All Doors, or Driver Door. Touch Off or Flash Lights. Remote Door Unlock This allows selection of which doors will unlock when pressing K on the RKE transmitter. Touch All Doors or Driver Door. Remote Start Auto Cool Seats If equipped and turned on, this feature will turn on the ventilated seats when using remote start on warm days. See Heated and Ventilated Front Seats 0 53 and Remote Vehicle Start 0 20. Touch Off or On. Remote Start Auto Heat Seats If equipped and turned on, this feature will turn on the heated seats when using remote start on cold days. See Heated and Ventilated Front Seats 0 53 and Remote Vehicle Start 0 20. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 134 Instruments and Controls If equipped with Auto Heated Steering Wheel, this feature will turn on when the Remote Start Auto Heated Seats turn on. Touch Off or On. Remote Window Operation If equipped, this feature enables remote operation of the windows with the RKE transmitter. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) 0 10 or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) 0 13. Touch Off or On. Remote Left in Vehicle Alert Automatic Running Boards This feature sounds an alert when the RKE transmitter is left in the vehicle. This menu also enables Remote No Longer In Vehicle Alert. This feature specifies the position and use of the running boards. Touch Off or On. Remote Removed from Vehicle Alert This feature beeps the horn 3 times when exiting a running vehicle with the remote key. Touch Off or On. Touch Off or On. Deploy Running Boards This feature moves the running boards to a deployed position so they can be used with the doors closed. Touch Off or Deploy. Seating Position Touch and the following may display: . Seat Entry Memory . Seat Exit Memory Passive Door Unlock Ride Height This allows the selection of what doors will unlock when using the button on the driver door to unlock the vehicle. Touch and the following may display: . Automatic Entry/Egress Touch Off, All Doors or Driver Door Only. This feature specifies if the vehicle will automatically lower to make it easier to enter or exit the vehicle. This feature automatically recalls the previously stored 1 or 2 button positions when the ignition is changed from off to on or ACC/ACCESSORY. See Memory Seats 0 50. Touch Off or On. Touch Off or On. Passive Door Lock This allows passive locking to be turned on or off and selects feedback. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) 0 10 or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) 0 13. Touch Off, On with Horn Chirp, or On. Automatic Entry/Egress Running Boards Touch and the following may display: . Automatic Running Boards . Deploy Running Boards Seat Entry Memory Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls 135 Seat Exit Memory . Bed View Camera Lighting 3. Re-enter the four-digit code. This feature automatically recalls the previously stored exit button position when the ignition is changed from on or ACC/ ACCESSORY to off and the driver door is open. See Memory Seats 0 50. Side Trailer Camera Touch Lock or Unlock to lock or unlock the system. Touch Back to go back to the previous menu. Touch Off or On. This feature specifies if using the turn signal during a lane change will also display an applicable side view of the trailer and vehicle. See Assistance Systems for Parking or Backing 0 253. Suspension Touch Off or On. Touch and the following may display: . Service Mode . Alignment Mode Bed View Camera Lighting Service Mode This feature specifies if the truck bed rail lights are turned on when the Bed View Camera is active. See Assistance Systems for Parking or Backing 0 253. This feature disables the air suspension system and is used to prevent unintended raising or lowering of the suspension.. Teen Driver Touch Off or On. See “Teen Driver” under Settings 0 184. Alignment Mode Valet Mode This feature will optimize the vehicle height to provide the most accurate wheel alignment. This will lock the infotainment system and steering wheel controls. It may also limit access to vehicle storage locations, if equipped. Touch Off or On. Trailering Touch and the following may display: . Side Trailer Camera Universal Remote System See Radio Frequency Statement 0 417. Universal Remote System Programming Touch Off or On. To enable valet mode: 1. Enter a four-digit code on the keypad. 2. Select Enter to go to the confirmation screen. If equipped, these buttons are in the overhead console. This system can replace up to three remote control transmitters used to activate devices such as garage door openers, security Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 136 Instruments and Controls systems, and home automation devices. These instructions refer to a garage door opener, but can be used for other devices. Do not use the Universal Remote system with any garage door opener that does not have the stop and reverse feature. This includes any garage door opener model manufactured before April 1, 1982. Keep the original hand-held transmitter for use in other vehicles as well as for future programming. Erase the programming when vehicle ownership is terminated. See “Erasing Universal Remote System Buttons” later in this section. To program a garage door opener, park outside directly in line with and facing the garage door opener receiver. Clear all people and objects near the garage door. Make sure the hand-held transmitter has a new battery for quick and accurate transmission of the radio-frequency signal. Programming the Universal Remote System Programming involves time-sensitive actions and may time out, requiring the procedure to be repeated. Read these instructions completely before programming the Universal Remote system. It may help to have another person assist with the programming process. 1. Hold the end of the hand-held transmitter about 3 to 8 cm (1 to 3 in) away from the Universal Remote system buttons with the indicator light in view. The hand-held transmitter was supplied by the manufacturer of the garage door opener receiver. 2. Press and release one of the three Universal Remote system buttons to be programmed. Press and hold the hand-held transmitter button. Do not release the hand-held transmitter button until the indicator light changes from a slow to a rapid flash or continuous light. Then release the hand-held transmitter button. Some garage door openers may require substitution of Step 2 with the procedure under “Radio Signals for Some Gate Operators” later in this section. 3. Press and hold the newly programmed Universal Remote system button for five seconds while watching the indicator light and garage door activation. . If the indicator light stays on continuously or the garage door moves when the button is pressed, then programming is complete. There is no need to complete Steps 4–6. . If the indicator light does not come on or the garage door does not move, a second button press may be required. For a second time, press and hold the newly programmed button for five seconds. If the indicator light stays on continuously or the garage door moves when the button is pressed, then programming is complete. There is no need to complete Steps 4–6. . If the garage door does not move, continue with programming Steps 4–6. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 Instruments and Controls For questions or programming help, see www.homelink.com/gm or call 1-800-355-3515. For calls placed outside the U.S., Canada, or Puerto Rico, international rates will apply and may differ based on landline or mobile phone. Radio Signals for Some Gate Operators Learn or Smart Button 4. After completing Steps 1–3, locate the Learn or Smart button inside garage on the garage door opener receiver. The name and color of the button may vary by manufacturer. 5. Press and release the Learn or Smart button. Step 6 must be completed within 30 seconds of pressing this button. 6. Return to the vehicle and firmly press and hold the trained Universal Remote system button for two seconds and release. Repeat the “press/hold/release” sequence up to three times to complete the training process. The Universal Remote system should now activate the garage door. Repeat the process for programming the remaining two buttons. Some gate operators and radio-frequency laws require transmitter signals to time out or quit after several seconds of transmission. This may not be long enough for the Universal Remote system to pick up the signal during programming. If the programming did not work, replace Step 2 under “Programming the Universal Remote System” with the following: Press and hold the Universal Remote system button while pressing and releasing the hand-held transmitter button every two seconds until the signal has been successfully accepted by the Universal Remote system. The Universal Remote system indicator light will flash slowly at first and then change to a rapid flash or continuous solid-light. Proceed with Step 3 under “Programming the Universal Remote System” to complete. 137 Universal Remote System Operation Using the Universal Remote System Press and hold the appropriate Universal Remote system button for at least one-half second. The indicator light will come on while the signal is being transmitted. Erasing Universal Remote System Buttons Erase all programmed buttons when vehicle ownership is terminated. To erase: 1. Press and hold the two outside buttons until the indicator light begins to flash. This should take about 10 seconds. 2. Release both buttons. Reprogramming a Single Universal Remote System Button To reprogram any of the system buttons: 1. Press and hold any one of the buttons. Do not release the button. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/12/21 138 Instruments and Controls 2. The indicator light will begin to flash after 20 seconds. Without releasing the button, proceed with Step 1 under “Programming the Universal Remote System.” Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Lighting Lighting Exterior Lighting Exterior Lighting Exterior Lamp Controls Exterior Lamp Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Exterior Lamps Off Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer . . . . 141 Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . 141 Automatic Headlamp System . . . . . . . . . . 141 Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . 143 Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Task Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Auxiliary Roof-Mounted Lamp . . . . . . . . . 144 Exterior Cargo Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Interior Lighting Instrument Panel Illumination Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Dome Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Lighting Features Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Battery Load Management . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Battery Power Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . 147 139 AUTO : Automatically turns on the headlamps, parking lamps, taillamps, instrument panel lights, roof marker lamps (if equipped), front/rear sidemarker lamps, and license plate lamps. ; : Turns on the parking lamps including all lamps, except the headlamps and fog lamps, if equipped. For some trim levels and series of trucks first sold in Canada, the headlamps may turn on with the parking lamps. 2 : Turns on the headlamps together with The exterior lamp control is on the instrument panel to the left of the steering wheel. O : Turns off the automatic headlamps and Daytime Running Lamps (DRL). Turn the headlamp control to O again to turn the automatic headlamps or DRL back on. For vehicles first sold in Canada, off will only work when the vehicle is in P (Park). the parking lamps, taillamps, instrument panel lights, roof marker lamps (if equipped), front/rear sidemarker lamps, and license plate lamps. When the headlamps are turned on while the vehicle is on, the headlamps turn off automatically 10 minutes after the ignition is turned off. When the headlamps are turned on while the vehicle is off, the headlamps will stay on for 10 minutes before turning off to prevent the battery from being drained. Turn the headlamp control off and then back to the headlamp on position to make the headlamps stay on Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 140 Lighting for an additional 10 minutes. To keep the lamps on for more than 10 minutes, the ignition must be on or in ACC/ACCESSORY. K : If equipped, turns on the task lighting. See Task Lighting 0 144. IntelliBeam System If equipped, this system turns the vehicle's high-beam headlamps on and off according to surrounding traffic conditions. The system turns the high-beam headlamps on when it is dark enough and there is no other traffic present. This light b comes on in the instrument cluster when the IntelliBeam system is enabled. Turning On and Enabling IntelliBeam To enable the IntelliBeam system, press b on the turn signal lever when it is dark outside and the exterior lamp control is in AUTO or 2. Driving with IntelliBeam The system only activates the high beams when driving over 40 km/h (25 mph). The blue high-beam on light appears on the instrument cluster when the high beams are on. There is a sensor near the top center of the windshield that automatically controls the system. Keep this area of the windshield clear of debris to allow for best system performance. The high-beam headlamps remain on, under the automatic control, until one of the following situations occurs: . The system detects an approaching vehicle's headlamps. . The system detects a preceding vehicle's taillamps. . The outside light is bright enough that high-beam headlamps are not required. . The vehicle's speed drops below 20 km/h (12 mph). . The IntelliBeam system is disabled by the button on the turn signal lever. If this happens, press b on the turn signal lever when the exterior lamp control is in the AUTO or 2 position to reactivate the IntelliBeam system. The instrument cluster light will come on to indicate the IntelliBeam system is reactivated. The high beams may not turn off automatically if the system cannot detect another vehicle's lamps because of any of the following: . The other vehicle's lamps are missing, damaged, obstructed from view, or otherwise undetected. . The other vehicle's lamps are covered with dirt, snow, and/or road spray. . The other vehicle's lamps cannot be detected due to dense exhaust, smoke, fog, snow, road spray, mist, or other airborne obstructions. . The vehicle's windshield is dirty, cracked, or obstructed by something that blocks the view of the light sensor. . The vehicle is loaded such that the front end points upward, causing the light sensor to aim high and not detect headlamps and taillamps. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Lighting . Driving on winding or hilly roads. Flash-to-Pass The automatic high-beam headlamps may need to be disabled if any of the above conditions exist. This feature lets you use the high-beam headlamps to signal a driver in front of you that you want to pass. It works even if the headlamps are in the automatic position. Exterior Lamps Off Reminder A reminder chime sounds when the headlamps or parking lamps are manually turned on, the vehicle is turned off, and a door is open. To disable the chime, turn the lamps off. Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer Push the turn signal lever toward the instrument panel to change the headlamps from low to high beam. Pull or push the turn signal lever to return to low-beam headlamps. When the high-beam headlamps are on, this indicator light on the instrument cluster will also be on. To use it, pull the turn signal lever toward you, then release it. If the headlamps are in the automatic position or on low beam, the high-beam headlamps will turn on. Depending on the type of headlamp, they will either turn off after a short duration or stay on as long as you hold the lever toward you. The high-beam indicator on the instrument cluster will come on. Release the lever to return to normal operation. Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) DRL can make it easier for others to see the front of the vehicle during the day. Fully functional DRL are required on all vehicles first sold in Canada. 141 The DRL system comes on when the following conditions are met: . The vehicle is on. . The exterior lamp control is in AUTO. . The transmission is not in P (Park). . The light sensor determines it is daytime. When the DRL system is on, only the DRL are on. The taillamps, sidemarker lamps, instrument panel lights, and other lamps will not turn on. When it begins to get dark, the automatic headlamp system switches from DRL to the headlamps. To turn off the DRL, turn the exterior lamp control to O and then release. For vehicles first sold in Canada, turning off the DRL will only work when the vehicle is parked. Automatic Headlamp System When the exterior lamp control is set to AUTO and it is dark enough outside, the headlamps come on automatically. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 142 Lighting illumination control is in the full bright position. See Instrument Panel Illumination Control 0 145. Hazard Warning Flashers When it is bright enough outside, the headlamps will turn off or may change to DRL. The automatic headlamp system turns off when the exterior lamp control is turned to O or the ignition is off. Lights On with Wipers There is a light sensor on top of the instrument panel. Do not cover the sensor, otherwise the headlamps will come on when they are not needed. The system may also turn on the headlamps when driving through a parking garage or tunnel. If the vehicle is started in a dark garage, the automatic headlamp system comes on immediately. If it is light outside when the vehicle leaves the garage, there is a slight delay before the automatic headlamp system changes to the Daytime Running Lamps (DRL). During that delay, the instrument cluster may not be as bright as usual. Make sure the instrument panel If the windshield wipers are activated in daylight with the engine on, and the exterior lamp control is in AUTO, the headlamps, parking lamps, and other exterior lamps come on. The transition time for the lamps coming on varies based on wiper speed. When the wipers are not operating, these lamps turn off. Move the exterior lamp control to O or ; to disable this feature. | : Press this button to make the front and rear turn signal lamps flash on and off. Press again to turn the flashers off. When the hazard warning flashers are on, the vehicle's turn signals will not work. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Lighting Turn and Lane-Change Signals If after signaling a turn or a lane change the arrows flash rapidly or do not come on, a signal bulb could be burned out. If equipped with LED turn signals, see your dealer. 143 Fog Lamps Replace any burned out bulbs. If a bulb is not burned out, check the fuse. See Fuses and Circuit Breakers 0 336. Turn Signal On Chime An arrow on the instrument cluster flashes in the direction of the turn or lane change. Move the turn signal lever all the way up or down to signal a turn. Partially raise or lower the lever for less than one second until the arrow starts to flash to signal a lane change. This causes the turn signals to automatically flash three times. It will flash six times if Tow/Haul Mode is active. Holding the turn signal lever for more than one second will cause the turn signals to flash until the lever is released. The lever returns to its starting position whenever it is released. If the turn signal is left on for more than 1.2 km (0.75 mi), a chime sounds at each flash of the turn signal. A message may appear in the Driver Information Center (DIC). See Vehicle Messages 0 130. To turn the chime and message off, move the turn signal lever to the off position. If equipped, the fog lamp control is near the exterior lamp control to the left of the steering column. The vehicle must be on for the fog lamps to come on. # : Press to turn the fog lamps on or off. A light will come on in the instrument cluster. When the fog lamps are turned on, the parking lamps automatically turn on. When the headlamps are changed to high beam, the fog lamps also go off. When the high-beam headlamps are turned off, the fog lamps will come on again. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 144 Lighting Some localities have laws that require the headlamps to be on with the fog lamps. If the vehicle is off, the lights will stay on for approximately 10 minutes. Task Lighting If any Task lights are on, if the button has not been pressed after approximately 5 seconds, pressing it again will turn off all Task Lights. Exterior Cargo Lamps Auxiliary Roof-Mounted Lamp If equipped, this button includes wiring provisions for a dealer or a qualified service center to install an auxiliary roof lamp. The cargo lamps provide more light in the cargo area or on the sides of the vehicle, if needed. The lamps inside the pickup box, in the tailgate handle, for the hitch, and/or the cargo mirror lamps also turn on, if equipped. If equipped, task lighting projects light from the outside mirrors away from the vehicle. While the vehicle is parked, press K to select one of the following options: . Left and Right Task Lights Illuminated . Left Task Light Illuminated . Right Task Light Illuminated . Left and Right Task Lights Off If the vehicle leaves a parked position, the lights will immediately turn off. For information on roof-mounted emergency lamp installation, see www.gmupfitter.com or contact your dealer. If the vehicle has this button, the vehicle may have the snow plow prep package. See Add-On Electrical Equipment 0 303. If the vehicle is in P (Park), R (Reverse), or N (Neutral) the Cargo Lamp Switch causes the lights to cycle through the following states for each button press: - Initial Press: - CHMSL/Cargo Bed Lights - On - Cargo Mirror Lights - On - Cargo Switch Indicator (if equipped) - On Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Lighting Dome Lamps - Next Press: (if with in 5 seconds of the previous button press): Interior Lighting - CHMSL/Cargo Bed Lights - On Instrument Panel Illumination Control - Cargo Mirror Lights - Off 145 - Cargo Switch Indicator (if equipped) - On - Next Press: - CHMSL/Cargo Bed Lights - Off - Cargo Mirror Lights - Off - Cargo Switch Indicator (if equipped) - Off Become familiar with and follow all state and local laws that apply to cargo lamp operation. The dome lamp controls are in the overhead console. To operate, press the following buttons: This feature adjusts the brightness of all illuminated controls. The instrument panel illumination control is next to the exterior lamp control. D : Press D + to brighten or dim the lights. D − to This feature is functional at night, or when the headlamps or parking lamps are on. j OFF : Turns off the dome lamps when any door is opened, K on the remote key is pressed, or when the vehicle is turned off. An indicator light on the button turns on when the dome lamp override is activated. Press j OFF again to deactivate this feature. +ON/OFF : Turns the dome lamps on or off manually. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 146 Lighting Reading Lamps All lamps will gradually fade out after about 30 seconds. There are reading lamps on the overhead console and over the rear seats. These lamps come on when any door is opened, K on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) Transmitter is pressed, or when the vehicle is turned off. To operate, the vehicle must be on, or in Accessory mode, or using Retained Accessory Power (RAP). Entry lighting can be disabled manually by closing all doors, pressing Q on the RKE transmitter, or starting the vehicle. This feature can be changed. See “Vehicle Locator Lights” under Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Rear Reading Lamps The rear reading lamps are over the rear seats. Press the lamp lens to turn the rear reading lamps on or off. Lighting Features Entry Lighting Front Reading Lamps The front reading lamps are in the overhead console. Press the lamp lenses to turn the front reading lamps on or off. The interior lamps turn on when pressing K on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter or opening any doors, and the dome lamp control is in the DOOR position. Some exterior lamps also turn on when pressing K on the RKE transmitter or opening any doors. Low-Beam lamps will only turn on briefly at night, or in areas with limited lighting. Exit Lighting Some exterior lamps and interior lamps turn on when the key is removed from the ignition. The exterior and interior lamps remain on for a set amount of time, then automatically turn off. If equipped with Keyless Access, the exterior lamps automatically turn on when the driver door is opened after the ignition is turned off. The interior lights turn on when the ignition is turned off. The exterior lamps turn off immediately by turning the exterior lamp control off. This feature can be changed. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Lighting Battery Load Management The vehicle has Electric Power Management (EPM), which estimates the battery's temperature and state of charge. It then adjusts the voltage for best performance and extended life of the battery. When the battery's state of charge is low, the voltage is raised slightly to quickly bring the charge back up. When the state of charge is high, the voltage is lowered slightly to prevent overcharging. The voltmeter gauge or the voltage display on the Driver Information Center (DIC), if equipped, may show the voltage moving up or down. This is normal. If there is a problem, an alert will be displayed. The battery can be discharged at idle if the electrical loads are very high. This is true for all vehicles. This is because the generator (alternator) may not be spinning fast enough at idle to produce all the power that is needed for very high electrical loads. A high electrical load occurs when several of the following are on, such as: headlamps, high beams, fog lamps, rear window defogger, climate control fan at high speed, 147 heated seats, engine cooling fans, trailer loads, and loads plugged into accessory power outlets. . The doors are closed and then re-opened. EPM works to prevent excessive discharge of the battery. It does this by balancing the generator's output and the vehicle's electrical needs. It can increase engine idle speed to generate more power, whenever needed. It can temporarily reduce the power demands of some accessories. The exterior lamps turn off about 10 minutes after the ignition is turned off, if the parking lamps or headlamps have been manually left on. This protects against draining the battery. To restart the 10-minute timer, turn the exterior lamp control to the O position and then back to the ; or 2 position. Normally, these actions occur in steps or levels, without being noticeable. In rare cases at the highest levels of corrective action, this action may be noticeable to the driver. If so, a DIC message might be displayed and it is recommended that the driver reduce the electrical loads as much as possible. To keep the lamps on for more than 10 minutes, the ignition must be on or in ACC/ACCESSORY. Battery Power Protection This feature helps prevent the battery from being drained, if the interior courtesy lamps or reading lamps are accidentally left on. If any of these lamps are left on, they automatically turn off after 10 minutes, if the ignition is off. The lamps will not come back on again until one of the following occurs: . The ignition is turned on. Exterior Lighting Battery Saver Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 148 Infotainment System Infotainment System Introduction Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Using the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Software Updates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Radio AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 HD Radio Technology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Radio Data System (RDS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Fixed Mast Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Multi-Band Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Audio Players Avoiding Untrusted Media Devices . . . . . 158 USB Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Auxiliary Jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Bluetooth Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Navigation Using the Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . 162 Maps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Navigation Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Global Positioning System (GPS) . . . . . . . 172 Vehicle Positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Problems with Route Guidance . . . . . . . . 172 If the System Needs Service . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Map Data Updates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Database Coverage Explanations . . . . . . . 173 Introduction Read the following pages to become familiar with the features. Voice Recognition Voice Recognition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Phone Bluetooth (Overview) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 Bluetooth (Pairing and Using a Phone) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 Apple CarPlay and Android Auto . . . . . . . 183 Settings Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Teen Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 Trademarks and License Agreements Trademarks and License Agreements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 { Warning Taking your eyes off the road for too long or too often while using any infotainment feature can cause a crash. You or others could be injured or killed. Do not give extended attention to infotainment tasks while driving. Limit your glances at the vehicle displays and focus your attention on driving. Use voice commands whenever possible. The infotainment system has built-in features intended to help avoid distraction by disabling some features when driving. These features may gray out when they are unavailable. Many infotainment features are also available through the instrument cluster and steering wheel controls. Before driving: . Become familiar with the operation, center stack controls, steering wheel controls, and infotainment display. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System 149 . Set up the audio by presetting favorite stations, setting the tone, and adjusting the speakers. . Set up phone numbers in advance so they can be called easily by pressing a single control or by using a single voice command. See Distracted Driving 0 210. Active Noise Cancellation (ANC) If equipped, ANC reduces engine noise in the vehicle’s interior. ANC requires the factory-installed audio system, radio, speakers, amplifier (if equipped), induction system, and exhaust system to work properly. Deactivation is required by your dealer if related aftermarket equipment is installed. Overview Infotainment System The infotainment system is controlled by using the infotainment display, controls on the center stack, steering wheel controls, and voice recognition. Uplevel Radio 1. . Turn to decrease or increase the O (Power) . Press to turn the power on. . Press and hold to turn the power off. . Press to mute/unmute the system when on. . When the power is on and the system is not muted, a quick status pane will display when O is pressed. Pressing O will mute the system and trigger this pane to show a long press is required to actually power down the system. volume. 2. 7 . Radio: Press and release to go to the previous station or channel. Press and hold to fast seek the next strongest previous station or channel. See AM-FM Radio 0 154. . USB/Bluetooth: Press to seek to the beginning of the current or previous track. Press and hold to quickly reverse through a track. Release to return to playing speed. See USB Port 0 158 or Bluetooth Audio 0 161. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 150 3. Infotainment System { . Press to go to the Home Page. See “Home Page” later in this section. . Press to exit Android Auto or Apple CarPlay. To enter back into Android Auto or Apple CarPlay, press and hold. See Apple CarPlay and Android Auto 0 183. 4. 6 . Radio: Press and release to go to the next station or channel. Press and hold to fast seek the next strongest station or channel. . USB/Bluetooth: Press to seek the next track. Press and hold to fast forward through a track. Release to return to playing speed. See USB Port 0 158 or Bluetooth Audio 0 161. 5. o BACK . Press to return to the previous display in a menu. 6. V . Turn to highlight a feature, where applicable. Press to activate the highlighted feature. 1. . USB/Bluetooth: Press to seek to { (Home Page) . Press to go to the Home Page. See “Home Page” later in this section. . Press to exit Android Auto or Apple CarPlay. To enter back into Android Auto or Apple CarPlay, press and hold. See Apple CarPlay and Android Auto 0 183. 2. 7 . Radio: Press and release to go to the previous station or channel. Press and hold to fast seek the next strongest previous station or channel. See AM-FM Radio 0 154. 3. O . . . . the beginning of the current or previous track. Press and hold to quickly reverse through a track. Release to return to playing speed. See USB Port 0 158 or Bluetooth Audio 0 161. (Power) Press to turn the power on. Press and hold to turn the power off. Press to mute/unmute the system when on. When the power is on and the system is not muted, a quick status pane will display when O is Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System pressed. Pressing O will mute the system and trigger this pane to show a long press is required to actually power down the system. . Turn to decrease or increase the volume. 4. 6 . Radio: Press and release to go to the next station or channel. Press and hold to fast seek the next strongest station or channel. . USB/Bluetooth: Press to seek the next track. Press and hold to fast forward through a track. Release to return to playing speed. See USB Port 0 158 or Bluetooth Audio 0 161. 5. Managing Home Page Icons 1. Touch and hold any of the Home Page icons to enter edit mode. 2. Continue holding the icon and drag it to the desired position. 3. Release your finger to drop the icon in the desired position. 4. To move an application to another page, drag the icon to the edge of the display toward the desired page. 5. Continue dragging and dropping application icons as desired. 151 g : Press to answer an incoming call or start voice recognition. See Bluetooth (Overview) 0 178 or Bluetooth (Pairing and Using a Phone) 0 179. c : Press to decline an incoming call or end a current call. Press to mute or unmute the infotainment system when not on a call. Steering Wheel Controls v . Press and release to access the phone display or answer an incoming call. Home Page The Home Page is where vehicle application icons are accessed. Some applications are disabled when the vehicle is moving. Swipe left or right across the display to access the pages of icons. If equipped, some audio controls can be adjusted at the steering wheel. The favorites and volume switches are on the back of the steering wheel. 1. Favorite: When on a radio source, press to select the next or previous audio broadcast favorite. When listening to a media device, press to select the next or previous track. 2. Volume: Press to increase or decrease the volume. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 152 Infotainment System Using the System Settings Audio Touch the Settings icon to display the Settings menu. See Settings 0 184. Touch the Audio icon to display the active audio source page. Examples of available sources may include AM, FM, SXM (if equipped), USB, AUX, and Bluetooth. Phone Touch the Phone icon to display the Phone main page. See Bluetooth (Overview) 0 178 or Bluetooth (Pairing and Using a Phone) 0 179. Nav If equipped, touch the Nav icon to display the navigation map. See Using the Navigation System 0 162. Users If equipped, touch the Users icon to sign in or create a new user profile, and follow the on-screen instructions. Only four user profiles can be active at one time in the vehicle. It may be necessary to remove a profile from the menu before creating or signing into an existing profile. The removed profile can be logged into at a later time. Apple CarPlay Touch the Apple CarPlay icon to activate Apple CarPlay (if equipped) after a supported device is connected. See Apple CarPlay and Android Auto 0 183. Android Auto Touch the Android Auto icon to activate Android Auto (if equipped) after a supported device is connected. See Apple CarPlay and Android Auto 0 183. Apps If equipped, in-vehicle apps are available for download. Touch the Apps icon on the Home Page to begin. Downloading and using in-vehicle apps requires Internet connectivity which can be accessed with a data plan through the vehicle’s built-in 4G LTE Wi-Fi hotspot, if equipped, or a compatible mobile device hotspot. On most mobile devices, activation of the Wi-Fi hotspot is in the device’s Settings menu under Mobile Network Sharing, Personal Hotspot, Mobile Hotspot, or similar. Availability of apps and connectivity varies by vehicle, conditions, and location. Data plan rates apply. Features are subject to change. For more information, see www.my.chevrolet.com/learn. OnStar Services If equipped, touch the OnStar Services icon to display the OnStar Services and Account pages. See OnStar Overview 0 420. Camera If equipped, touch the Camera icon to access the camera application. See Assistance Systems for Parking or Backing 0 253. Shortcut Tray The shortcut tray is near the bottom of the display. It shows up to four applications. Infotainment Display Features Infotainment display features show on the display when available. When a feature is unavailable, it may gray out. When a feature is touched, it may highlight. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System Haptic Feedback Touch and Hold If equipped, haptic feedback is a pulse that occurs when an icon or option is touched on the display or when controls on the center stack are pressed. 153 done up, down, right, or left. This feature is only available when vehicle is parked and not in motion. Nudge Infotainment Gestures Use the following finger gestures to control the infotainment system. Touch/Tap Touch and hold can be used to start another gesture, or to move or delete an application. Drag Nudge is used to move items a short distance on a list or a map. To nudge, hold and move the selected item up or down to a new location. Fling or Swipe Touch/tap is used to select an icon or option, activate an application, or change the location inside a map. Drag is used to move applications on the Home Page, or to pan the map. To drag the item, it must be held and moved along the display to the new location. This can be Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 154 Infotainment System Fling or swipe is used to scroll through a list, pan the map, or change page views. Do this by placing a finger on the display then moving it rapidly up and down or right and left. Pinch Software Updates Over-the-Air Software Updates If equipped, see “Updates” under Settings 0 184 for details on software updates. Spread Radio AM-FM Radio Pinch is used to zoom out on a map, certain images, or a web page. Place finger and thumb apart on the display, then move them together. Spread is used to zoom in on a map, certain images, or a web page. Place finger and thumb together on the display, then move them apart. Cleaning High Gloss Surfaces and Vehicle Information and Radio Displays For vehicles with high gloss surfaces or vehicle displays, use a microfiber cloth to wipe surfaces. Before wiping the surface with the microfiber cloth, use a soft bristle brush to remove dirt that could scratch the surface. Then use the microfiber cloth by gently rubbing to clean. Never use window cleaners or solvents. Periodically hand wash the microfiber cloth separately, using mild soap. Do not use bleach or fabric softener. Rinse thoroughly and air dry before next use. Playing the Radio From the Home Page, touch the Audio icon to display the active audio source page. Choose from the three most recently used sources listed at the left side of the display or touch the More option to display a list of available sources. Examples of available sources may include AM, FM, SXM (if equipped), USB, AUX (if equipped), and Bluetooth. Infotainment System Sound Menu From any of the audio source main pages, touch Sound to display the following: Equalizer : Touch to adjust Bass, Midrange, Treble, and Surround (if equipped) using the options on the infotainment display. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System Fade/Balance : Touch to adjust by using the controls on the infotainment display or by tapping/dragging the crosshair. Direct Tune Finding a Station Seeking a Station From the AM, FM, or SXM (if equipped) option, press 6 or 7 on the center stack to search for the previous or next strong station or channel. Browsing Stations Touch the Browse option to list all available stations or channels. Navigate up and down through all stations by scrolling the list. Touch the station or channel you want to listen to. Touch H to save the station or channel as a favorite. If equipped, touch Update Station List to update the active stations in your area. Access Direct Tune by touching the Tune icon on the infotainment display to bring up the keypad. Navigate through all frequencies using the arrows on the right side of the Direct Tune display. Directly enter a station or channel using the keypad. When a new station or channel is entered, the information about that station or channel displays on the right side. This information will update with each new valid frequency. Touch H to save the station or channel as a favorite. The keypad will gray out entries that do not contribute to a valid frequency and will automatically place a decimal point within the frequency number. Touch (X) to delete one number at a time. Touch and hold (X) to delete all numbers. 155 A valid AM or FM station will automatically tune to the new frequency but not close the Direct Tune display. When listening to SXM (if equipped), touch Go after entering the channel. Touch the Back icon on the infotainment display or touch z to exit out of Direct Tune. The tune arrows on the right side of the Direct Tune display will tune through the complete station or channel list one station step at a time per touch. A touch and hold advances through stations or channels quickly. If equipped, HD Radio multicast stations cannot be tuned directly through the Direct Tune feature. Only the analog or HD1 station can use that feature. Use the display arrows to adjust to the multicast stations. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 156 Infotainment System AM, FM, and SXM Categories From the AM stations, if equipped with HD Radio, FM, or SXM (if equipped) display, touch Categories at the top of the Browse menu to access the categories list. The list contains names associated with the AM or FM stations, or SXM channels. Touch a category name to display a list of stations or channels for that category. Touching a station or channel from the list will tune the radio to that station or channel. Storing Radio Station Presets Favorites show in the area at the top of the display. AM, FM, SXM (if equipped), and HD Radio Stations (if equipped) : Press and hold a preset to store the current station or channel as a favorite. Touch a saved favorite to recall a favorite station or channel. Favorites can also be stored by touching H in a station or channel list. This will highlight indicating that it is now saved as a favorite. The number of favorites displayed is automatically adjusted by default, but can be manually adjusted in Settings in the System tab under Favorites and then Set Number of Audio Favorites. It can also be adjusted in Settings in the Apps tab under Audio and then Set Number of Audio Favorites. seconds. The radio will also display icons representing additional channels (HD2, ...HD8), that may be available. When the radio successfully tunes to a HD station, the HD logo will display and digital audio will play. 2. Touch the display arrows to tune to the previous or next HD Radio station. There may be a delay before the station starts playing. The HD Radio station number is indicated next to the HD logo. HD Radio Technology HD Radio stations can be saved as favorites. If equipped, HD Radio is a free service with features such as digital quality sound, more stations available on a single frequency such as HD2 and HD3, and display information such as artist and song title. For a list of all stations, see www.hdradio.com. From the Now Playing display, touch the HD Radio icon to turn HD on or off. Station Access To access HD Radio stations: 1. Tune the radio to the station. If HD Radio is turned on and the station is broadcasting in HD Radio, the radio will automatically tune to the HD version of the current channel (HD1) after several HD Radio Troubleshooting Digital Audio Delay : Wait for the signal to process. This can take several seconds. Volume Change, Audio Skip, Echo, Digital Audio Lost : Station signal strength may be weak, the station is out of range, or the station may be out of alignment. Verify proper reception on another station. If the HD Radio signal weakens while listening to HD1, the radio will automatically switch to the analog version of the radio station. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System If the HD Radio signal loses reception while listening to stations HD2 to HD8, the radio mutes until the signal can be recovered or until the station is changed. HD Radio can be disabled if driving in a weak signal area. Touch HD Radio On/Off to toggle HD Radio reception on and off. Radio Data System (RDS) If equipped, RDS features are available for use only on FM stations that broadcast RDS information. With RDS, the radio can: . Group stations by Category (i.e., Program Type) such as Rock, Jazz, Classical, etc. . Display messages from radio stations. This system relies on receiving specific information from these stations and only works when the information is available. It is possible that a radio station could broadcast incorrect information that causes the radio features to work improperly. If this happens, contact the radio station. When information is broadcast from a RDS station, the station name or call letters display on the audio screen. Radio text supporting the currently playing broadcast may also appear. Satellite Radio SiriusXM Radio Service If equipped, vehicles with a valid SiriusXM radio subscription can receive SiriusXM programming. SiriusXM radio has a wide variety of programming and commercial-free music, coast to coast, in digital-quality sound. In the U.S., see www.siriusxm.com or call 1-888-601-6296. In Canada, see www.siriusxm.ca or call 1-877-438-9677. When SiriusXM is active, the channel name, number, song title, and artist appear on the display. SiriusXM with 360L SiriusXM with 360L interface has enhanced in-vehicle listening experience for subscribers. The experience now offers more categories and system learned recommendations toward discovering more personalized content. To use the full SiriusXM 360L program, including streaming content and listening recommendations, OnStar Connected Access is required. Connected vehicle services vary 157 by model and require a complete working electrical system, cell reception, and GPS signal. An active connected plan is required. Reference the SiriusXM user guide for use and subscription information. Radio Reception Unplug electronic devices from the accessory power outlets if there is interference or static in the radio. FM FM signals only reach about 16 to 65 km (10 to 40 mi). Although the radio has a built-in electronic circuit that automatically works to reduce interference, some static can occur, especially around tall buildings or hills, causing the sound to fade in and out. AM The range for most AM stations is greater than for FM, especially at night. The longer range can cause station frequencies to interfere with each other. Static can also occur when things like storms and power lines interfere with radio reception. When this happens, try reducing the treble on the radio. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 158 Infotainment System SiriusXM Satellite Radio Service Multi-Band Antenna If equipped, SiriusXM Satellite Radio Service provides digital radio reception. Tall buildings or hills can interfere with satellite radio signals, causing the sound to fade in and out. In addition, traveling or standing under heavy foliage, bridges, garages, or tunnels may cause loss of the SiriusXM signal for a period of time. Some cellular services may interfere with SXM reception causing loss of signal. The roof antenna is for SiriusXM Satellite Radio, OnStar, and GPS (Global Positioning System), depending on the equipped options. Keep clear of obstructions for clear reception. If the vehicle has a sunroof, and it is open, reception can also be affected. Mobile Device Usage Mobile device usage, such as making or receiving calls, charging, or just having the mobile device on may cause static interference in the radio. Unplug the mobile device or turn it off if this happens. When using media devices such as SD cards, USB devices, and mobile devices, consider the source. Untrusted media devices could contain files that affect system operation or performance. Avoid use if the content or origin cannot be trusted. Fixed Mast Antenna USB Port The fixed mast antenna will go through most car washes as long as it is securely attached. If the antenna becomes slightly bent, straighten it out by hand. If it is badly bent, replace it. This vehicle is equipped with two USB ports in the center console under the armrest and another two in the center stack. These ports are for data and charging. Occasionally check that the antenna is tight at the base. If tightening is required, protect the paint from damage. Audio Players Avoiding Untrusted Media Devices There may also be two USB ports for charging only at the rear of the center console. Caution To avoid vehicle damage, unplug all accessories and disconnect all accessory cables from the vehicle when not in use. Accessory cables left plugged into the vehicle, unconnected to a device, could be damaged or cause an electrical short if the unconnected end comes in contact with liquids or another power source such as the accessory power outlet. Playing from a USB A USB mass storage device can be connected to the USB port. Gracenote When plugging in a USB device, Gracenote service builds voice tags for music. Voice tags allow artists, albums with hard to pronounce names, and nicknames to be used to play music through voice recognition. While indexing, infotainment features are available. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System My Media Library d: MyMedia is only available when more than one indexed device is connected. It allows access to content from all indexed media sources. MyMedia will show as an available source in the Source page. . Press to seek to the next track. . Press and hold to advance quickly USB MP3 Player and USB Devices The USB MP3 players and USB devices connected must comply with the USB Mass Storage Class specification (USB MSC). to play a USB device: 1. Connect the USB. 2. Press MEDIA on the center stack until the connected device is shown. Use the following when playing an active USB source: r : Touch to play the current media source. j : Touch to pause playback of the current media source. g: . Press to seek to the beginning of the current or previous track. . Press and hold to reverse quickly through playback. Release to return to playing speed. Elapsed time displays. through playback. Release to return to playing speed. Elapsed time displays. Shuffle : Touch the shuffle icon to play music in random order. USB Menu Touch the Menu icon to display the USB menu. The following may be available: Shuffle : Touch to play the tracks randomly. Touch again to stop shuffle. Tone : Touch + or – to adjust the tone settings. See AM-FM Radio 0 154. Auto Volume (If Equipped) : This feature adjusts the volume based on the vehicle speed. See AM-FM Radio 0 154. Bose AudioPilot Noise Compensation Technology (If Equipped : This feature adjusts the volume based on the noise in the vehicle and speed. See AM-FM Radio 0 154. USB Browse Menu When a list of songs, albums, artists, or other types of media displays, the up and down arrows and A-Z appear on the left 159 side. Select A-Z to view a display that will show all letters of the alphabet and select the letter to go to. Touch anywhere between the top and bottom menus or touch the Browse option on the infotainment display to view the Browse menu and the following options are displayed near the bottom of the display: Playlists: 1. Touch to view the playlists stored on the USB. 2. Touch a playlist to view the list of all songs in that playlist. 3. Touch a song from the list to begin playback. Supported Playlist extensions are m3u, pls, and wpl. Artists: 1. Touch to view the list of artists stored on the USB. 2. Touch an artist name to view a list of all albums by the artist. 3. To select a song, touch All Songs or touch an album and then select a song from the list. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 160 Infotainment System Albums: 1. Touch to view the albums on the USB. 2. Touch the album to view a list of all songs on the album. 3. Touch a song from the list to begin playback. Songs: 1. Touch to display a list of all songs on the USB. 2. To begin playback, touch a song from the list. Genres: 1. Touch to view the genres on the USB. 2. Touch a genre to view a list of artists. 3. Touch an artist to view albums by that artist. 4. Touch an album to view songs on the album. 5. Touch a song to start playback. Podcasts, Composers, Audiobooks, and Folder View (if equipped) are shown when the More option is selected from near the bottom of the display. Podcasts: 1. Touch to view the podcasts on the USB. 2. Select a podcast. 3. Select an episode to start playback. Composers: 1. Touch to view the composers on the USB. 2. Touch Composers to view a list of albums by that composer. 3. Touch an album to view a list of songs. 4. Touch a song from the list to begin playback. Folder View: 1. Touch to view the directories on the USB. 2. Touch a folder to view a list of all files. 3. Touch a file from the list to begin playback. Audiobooks: 1. Touch to view the audiobooks stored on the USB. 2. Touch an audiobook to get a list of chapters. 3. Touch the chapter from the list to begin playback. When a list of songs, albums, artists, or other types of media display, a vertical keyboard appears on one side of the list and a scroll bar on the other side. When using the vertical keyboard, touch the beginning character of the desired name to display the zoom bubble of that character. Release the finger from the infotainment display and the zoom bubble disappears. Touch the scroll bar to move the list up and down. File System and Naming The songs, artists, albums, and genres are taken from the file’s song information and are only displayed if present. The radio displays the file name as the track name if the song information is not available. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System 161 Supported Apple Devices Auxiliary Jack AUX Menu To view supported devices in USA, see my.chevrolet.com\learned. If equipped, this vehicle may have an auxiliary input jack. This may be located in the center stack or center console under the armrest. Possible auxiliary audio sources include: . Laptop computer . Audio music player Press MENU on the center stack to display the AUX Input menu and the following may display: Loss of Audio If a phone currently paired over Bluetooth is plugged in with a USB cable, the system will automatically mute the phone audio. Playback can be resumed by changing the audio source from Bluetooth to USB cable. Source USB from the Media icon on the infotainment display to resume playback. Other phones such as Android phones may have a similar reaction. Bluetooth Streaming Audio and Voice Recognition See Bluetooth Audio 0 161 for information using voice recognition with Bluetooth streaming audio. Make sure all devices have the latest software downloaded. This jack is not an audio output. Do not plug headphones into the auxiliary input jack. Set up an auxiliary device while the vehicle is in P (Park). Connect a 3.5 mm (1/8 in) cable from the auxiliary device to the auxiliary input jack. When a device is connected, the system can play audio from the device over the vehicle speakers. If an auxiliary device has already been connected, but a different source is currently active, press MEDIA on the center stack or touch the Media icon on the infotainment display to scroll through audio source menus, until the AUX Input source appears. Playing from the AUX Port An auxiliary device is played through the audio system and controlled through the device itself. Tone Settings : Touch to adjust Bass, Midrange, Treble, Balance, Fade, and EQ (Equalizer). See AM-FM Radio 0 154. Auto Volume (If Equipped) : This feature adjusts the volume based on the vehicle speed. See AM-FM Radio 0 154. Bose AudioPilot Noise Compensation Technology (If Equipped) : This feature adjusts the volume based on the noise in the vehicle and speed. See “Bose AudioPilot” in AM-FM Radio 0 154. Bluetooth Audio Music may be played from a paired Bluetooth device. See Bluetooth (Overview) 0 178 or Bluetooth (Pairing and Using a Phone) 0 179 for help pairing a device. Volume and song selection may be controlled by using the infotainment controls or the mobile device. If Bluetooth is selected and no volume is present, check the volume setting on the infotainment system. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 162 Infotainment System Music can be launched by touching Bluetooth from the recent sources list on the left of the display or by touching the More option and then touching the Bluetooth device. All devices launch audio differently. When selecting Bluetooth as a source, the radio may show as paused on the display. Press play on the device or touch p on the display to begin playback. To play music via Bluetooth: 1. Power on the device, and pair to connect the device. 2. Once paired, touch Audio from the Home Page, then touch Bluetooth from the recent sources list on the left of the display. Browse functionality will be provided where supported by the Bluetooth device. This media content will not be part of the MyMedia source mode. Bluetooth Sound Menu See “Infotainment System Sound Menu” under AM-FM Radio 0 154. Manage Bluetooth Devices From the Home Page: 1. Touch Audio. 2. Touch More. 3. Touch Bluetooth. 4. Touch Devices to add or delete devices. When touching Bluetooth, the radio may not be able to launch the audio player on the connected device to start playing. When the vehicle is not moving, use the mobile device to begin playback. Some smartphones support sending Bluetooth music information to display on the radio. When the radio receives this information, it will check to see if any is available and display it. For more information about supported Bluetooth features, see my.chevrolet.com/learn. Navigation Using the Navigation System If equipped, launch the Nav application by touching the Nav icon on the Home Page or on the shortcut tray near the bottom of the infotainment display. When the Nav application is launched for the first time, a product walkthrough is available. Use of the feature requires the Terms and Conditions and the Privacy statement to be confirmed. If available and signed into a profile, it is also suggested to enable and confirm Predictive Navigation. Predictive Navigation (If Equipped) If Predictive Navigation is available and confirmed, this feature learns preferences by remembering where the vehicle has been. It uses the locations and navigation history to personalize routes and results. Predictive Navigation may learn elements such as: . Personalized routes based on preferred streets. . Search results that provide best matches at the top of the list. . Predictive traffic. . Local map content updating. Predictive Navigation can also be enabled or disabled at a later time by touching A (Options). While in Options, touch Settings, then Map and Navigation Settings, and then Predictive Navigation. See Settings 0 184. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System Navigation Map View After opening the Nav application for the first time, the application will always open in full map view displaying the vehicle’s current location. When the vehicle is stopped, the search bar will appear along the top of the navigation map view. Manually close the search bar by touching z. When the vehicle is moving, the } (Search) icon will replace the search bar to maximize the full map view. Destination Card Preferences From the Nav application, set up Home and Work addresses to enable one-touch navigation. To set up Home and Work addresses, touch A and select Settings, then Map and Navigation Settings, and then Destination Card Preferences. Show My Places on Map should be on by default. Select and enter Home and/or Work address and save. If the vehicle’s system is not signed into a customized profile, the current location icon uses a generic symbol. Once signed into a customized profile, the current location symbol will show a customized icon. See Navigation Symbols 0 165. Map and Navigation Settings Touch A while in the map view to display options. The following may display: . 3D Heading Up, 2D Heading Up, 2D North . Show on Map . Traffic Events (available with OnStar Connected Navigation) . Settings . Edit Destination (if a route has been set) 163 . Avoid on Route (if a route has been set) Touch Settings to view Map and Navigation Settings. The following may display: . Destination Card Preferences . Map Preferences . Route Preferences . Navigation Voice Control . Traffic Preferences . Alert Preferences . Fuel Grade Preferences . Manage History . Predictive Navigation: See “Predictive Navigation (If Equipped)” previously in this section. . About To exit a list, touch z in the top right corner to return to the main map view. Make sure to set up preferences before setting a destination and starting active guidance. Map Preferences Touch to choose between basic map feature configurations: Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 164 Infotainment System Map Colors . Auto – Touch to automatically change modes based on lighting conditions. . Day (Light) . Night (Dark) 3D Landmark (Default is On) : Touch On or Off. When turned on, the system will display all 3D Landmarks on the map depending on the zoom level. 3D Building (Default is Off) : Touch On or Off. When turned on, the system will display all of the possible 3D building shapes on the map depending on the zoom level. Show Terrain in 3D (Default is Off) : If equipped, touch On or Off. When turned on, the system will display terrain information on the map in 3D view. Auto-Zoom (Default is On) : Touch On or Off. When turned on, the system will automatically adjust the zoom level when the vehicle is approaching a turn. After the turn is completed, the system automatically brings the zoom back to the originally set level. If the vehicle is approaching a turn with the next turn occurring shortly after, the Auto-Zoom will remain on until both turns are completed. Route Preferences Touch to access the Route Preferences. The choices are: . Preferred Route – Choose from two different route options: Fastest or Eco-Friendly. ‐ Fastest would be the route with the shortest drive time. ‐ Eco-Friendly would be the most fuel-efficient route. . Avoid on Current Route – Choose any of the road features to avoid while on route: ‐ Highways ‐ Unpaved Roads ‐ Ferries ‐ Carpool Lanes ‐ Toll Roads ‐ Tunnels ‐ Country Borders Navigation Voice Control Touch to access the voice control setting display. . Navigation Volume – To adjust the volume level, touch the up and down arrows. If the voice guidance prompt is being heard, volume can also be adjusted using the knob on the center stack or the volume switch on the steering wheel. . Navigation Voice Prompt Level during a Call. Options available are: ‐ Full Prompt (Selected by default) ‐ Tone Only ‐ None Traffic Events (If Equipped) This feature provides a list of events that are on the route or nearby. Touch A and then select Traffic Events. An OnStar connected Navigation service plan is required. Traffic Preferences (If Equipped) While in Map View, touch A, then Settings and then Map and Navigation Settings to access Traffic Preferences. When Show Traffic on Map is turned on, the feature provides an overview of the traffic flow using different coded colors. The following options are available for rerouting: . Auto Reroute to Better Route – The system will automatically reroute if the system detects there is a traffic issue ahead. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System . Ask Before Rerouting (Default) – If the system detects there is a traffic issue ahead, it will display a pop-up with details about the issue. Choose to reroute or cancel the alert. . Never Search for Better Route – The system will not check for a better route until one of the above options is selected. Alert Preferences . Telenav Privacy Statement . Navigation Version Maps The Nav application requires a map database to run. It is stored on an SD card that is connected to the infotainment system. If the map database is not available, a missing SD card error message will be displayed. Set alerts on or off during both inactive and active guidance views. The following alerts may be available: . Road Safety Alerts – Touch to display upcoming School Zones. . Traffic Camera Alerts SD Card Error Messages Manage History Potential error scenarios and messages include: . The SD card has initialized for the first time: “Once initialized, this SD card can only be used for navigation in this vehicle.” Make sure the SD card switch is in an upward position. . The SD card is not working properly: “SD card is not functioning properly. (Error Code).” Touch Manage History to access the History options: . Clear Recent Destinations – Touch \ to clear the recent destinations. . Clear Search History – Touch \ to clear the search history. About Touch to display software information, such as: . Telenav Terms and Conditions The SD card only works for one unique vehicle. The SD card must pass authentication verification to be used for that specific vehicle. Do not remove SD card while the ignition is on. 165 . The SD card is not paired with the existing system: “This Nav SD card is not valid in this vehicle for navigation. See Owner’s Manual for more detail or visit your dealer. (Error Code).” . The SD card has been removed from the slot: “SD card has been removed. (Error Code).” Make sure the Nav SD card is in the slot. Touch Continue to resume after the initialization error message. For the other messages, touch OK to return to the Home Page. If any errors continue, see your dealer. Navigation Symbols Following are the most common symbols that may appear in the Nav application. This indicates the vehicle’s current location and direction on the map. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 166 Infotainment System Current Location When the vehicle is parked and not in a Navigation session, the user icon is centered on the map view, highlighting the current location. This is the vehicle’s current location icon during inactive guidance mode. Once a user profile is created, the current location icon can be customized. If equipped, smart Points of Interest (POIs) are places of interest for parking and gas stations. This icon indicates the vehicle’s current location and direction on the map. The destination pin marks the location of the final destination. Touch the pin to view the destination address or to add it or remove it from the Favorites list. Hide the information by touching the pin one more time. It will automatically time out if no action is taken. The progress bar provides an overview of the route progress and may show traffic and incidents along the way. As the route proceeds, the vehicle icon moves up the bar. Touch the icon to zoom out on the map and view the entire route. Touch it again to return to the previous view. View the drive time by touching the estimated time of arrival (ETA). Destination Receiving Destination Directions from Different Sources Destinations can be received or transferred from different sources to the Nav application for route guidance. If equipped, some of these sources may include: . Navigation from search results. . OnStar Advisor destination download. . An address from the Contacts list. . An application on the smartphone that can send destinations to the vehicle. . An application downloaded to the vehicle such as OnStar Services that can send destinations to the navigation system. Waypoints Add up to five waypoints, which are additional destinations, along the route. To add an additional stop or waypoint: 1. From active guidance, touch }. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System 2. Search for the destination using One-Box, Voice search, or the Quick Category icons. 3. Choose search results Along Route, Nearby, or Near Destination. 4. Choose the desired waypoint and touch Add to Trip or replace the current destination by touching New Destination. Route options are not available for waypoints. Arriving at a Waypoint When approaching a waypoint, the system will display a Destination Arrival view. To continue on to the next destination touch the Drive to message on the infotainment display. If the vehicle passes the waypoint or gets out of the current route, the system will automatically reroute back to this waypoint. At the same time, it will show a Drive to icon along with the next waypoint address so the current waypoint can be skipped and guidance can resume to the next waypoint or destination. Editing a Waypoint When waypoints are added during active guidance, the system allows a stop to be deleted or the order to be changed. To edit a waypoint: 1. Touch A. 2. Touch Edit Destinations. . Modify destination order by touching and holding the arrow until it is highlighted. Drag to move the waypoint up or down the list. . Delete a waypoint by touching Y. A pop-up will appear to confirm waypoint removal. Once the request is confirmed, the system will remove the address from the destinations list. Touch z on the top right corner so the system can recalculate the route. If there is only one address in the destinations list, the system will disable the move and delete functions. The system will not allow the final destination to be deleted. Map Information Road network attributes are contained in the map database for map information. Attributes include information such as street 167 names, street addresses, and turn restrictions. A detailed area includes all major highways, service roads, and residential roads. The detailed areas include Places of Interest (POIs) such as restaurants, airports, banks, hospitals, police stations, gas stations, tourist attractions, and historical monuments. If the vehicle does not have an applicable service plan, the map database may not include data for newly constructed areas or map database corrections that are completed after production. The navigation system provides full route guidance in the detailed map areas. Zoom Control The zoom control display is shown on the map view. A few ways to zoom in or out are: . Touch + or – to zoom in or out on the map. . Double tap with one finger to zoom in or single tap with two fingers to zoom out on the map. . Use the index finger and thumb to zoom out by pinching and then zoom in by spreading those two fingers on the map. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 168 Infotainment System Map Gestures and Map Scale Map Orientation Use the following gestures on the infotainment display to adjust the map scale and display options. . Pinch to zoom in or out. . Pan the map. . Use two fingers to tilt down and change from 2D to 3D. Tilt up to change back to 2D. . Rotate the map. Touch A on the map to access map orientation settings. Map orientation is 3D Heading Up by default. See Using the System 0 152. Mute When in active guidance, the audio prompts while using navigation can be muted. Touch the speaker icon on the right side of the upper bar. A slash will appear on the speaker to indicate voice guidance is muted. Available settings are: . 3D Heading Up (Default): 3D map with the vehicle pointing up. In this mode, the current location icon will always head up and the map will rotate around it. . 2D Heading Up: 2D map with the vehicle pointing up. In this mode, the current location icon will always head up and the map will rotate around it. . 2D North Up: 2D map with North pointing up. In this mode, the current location icon will shift as the vehicle turns left and right. Active Guidance View Touch the icon to change the map type. The icon and label will also update accordingly. When a destination is chosen and a navigation session is active, the navigation system enters into an Active Guidance View (AGV). Depending on the zoom level of the 2D Heading Up and 3D Heading Up maps, the system may automatically switch to the 2D North Up map. When in AGV, the entire route can be viewed in 2D North Up by touching the traffic bar. The map will zoom out and readjust to display the full route. When in 2D North Up Route View, the Recenter icon will appear in the middle of the display. Touch either the Recenter icon or the traffic bar again to return to the previous view, either 2D or 3D. Lane Guidance The map will display the lane information for the upcoming maneuver if it is available. Junction View When a vehicle is on the highway and approaching the exit, an image displays the lane that the vehicle must stay in to complete the next maneuver. Quick-Turn View Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System When the vehicle is approaching a turn with the next turn following in quick succession, a quick-turn list appears below the primary turn indicator. An audio prompt will announce the quick turn. Auto-Zoom When approaching a maneuver, the map will automatically zoom in to show both the vehicle icon and the upcoming maneuver to give a better view of the maneuver. Once the maneuver is complete, the system will zoom back to the previous zoom level. Touch A on the map to access Settings, then touch Map Preferences to access Auto-Zoom. This feature can be enabled or disabled. removed from the route by touching Y next to the segment. A pop-up appears to confirm segment removal. exit from the current vehicle position, and convenience stops that may be available, such as gas, coffee, food, and lodging. When the route segment has been removed, all segments are replaced by an activity indicator while the new route is recalculated. When the recalculation is complete, the activity indicator is replaced with the new route segments. Next Maneuver Menu Highway Exits List If the Navigation application is not open when a near maneuver prompt is given, it is shown as an alert. Touch the alert to go to the main navigation view or touch z to dismiss the alert. Touch the menu option next to the next turn street name to display Directions. Editing Directions Directions can be edited by choosing y, which expands the list to fill the display and enters the Edit Mode. While in Edit Mode, an unwanted route segment can be When in Active Guidance, the Next Maneuver Turn Arrow, Street Name, and Maneuver Distance are shown in the Next Maneuver at the top of the display overlaying the map. ETA, Distance to Destination, and Traffic Indicator are displayed in a panel pinned on the right of the display. Navigation Next Turn Maneuver Alert Directions Directions displays the turns and directions from the current location to the final destination. 169 Touch C to open the Exit list. This icon displays next to the current street name near the bottom of the display. The icon only appears when on a highway with defined exits. While traveling on roads with designated exits, an Exit list may be available. The Exit list displays the exit number, distance to the Repeat Voice Guidance Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 170 Infotainment System This symbol indicates the next guidance maneuver. Touch it to repeat the last spoken guidance instruction. Incident Alert (If Equipped) During active guidance, if the system determines that there is an incident ahead but there is not a better route, the system will play a tone and show a Quick Notice. This will only show once per incident. Incident Reports (If Equipped) Incident report icons, along with traffic flow data, display on the map during both active and inactive guidance. End Route Touch Cancel at the top right corner to end active guidance and return to inactive guidance. If active guidance is canceled before the destination has been reached, a pop-up option to Resume Trip will appear. Resume Trip The trip can be resumed if it was canceled by touching the Resume Trip pop-up option. If the system has determined that the destination has been reached, either because the arrival view displayed or the destination has been passed, the Resume Trip option will not appear. 3. Touch a saved Navigation favorite to access the edit icon. Touch the edit icon to rename the favorite. 4. Touch Save to store the renamed favorite. Favorites Recents The navigation favorites can have contacts, addresses, or POIs that have been saved through the favorite icon on the details view. Touch H to access a list of recent destinations. Accessing Favorites Touch the Recenter Position arrow in the middle of the map view to reset the map to the current location. In the Nav application, view the Favorites list by touching H in the search bar along the top of the Nav map view. If the search bar is closed, touch } and select H. Saving Favorites Favorites can be added from a number of the system’s applications. Touch the favorites icon to save content as a favorite. Renaming Navigation Favorites 1. Touch the Settings icon on the Home Page and touch the System tab. 2. Touch Favorites to access the Manage Favorites option. Recenter Position Icon Last Parked Location The Last Parked Location is the last location the vehicle engine was turned off. That location is displayed in the first row of the Recents list. Touching the last Parked Location shows the Address Details view to either save the address or drive to it. The Last Parked Location can be deleted by entering the Edit display. Once the Last Parked Location is deleted, it no longer appears in the Recents list, unless the vehicle is started at that location again. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System 171 Show POI Icons Smart Parking Icons Auto Complete To see the POI categories, touch Options, then touch Show on Map. Up to eight categories of icons can be selected. When reaching a densely populated destination and the system determines that parking may be limited, the system will attempt to display nearby parking destinations with pricing information, if available. Enter a partial location in the field entry box on the search display. Auto complete will attempt to complete the destination based on what is being entered. Touch the suggested item to search. Smart POI Icons on Map (If Equipped) Report an Issue Using POI Details (If Equipped) The smart POI icons such as fuel stations and parking may appear based on time, location, driver search behavior, driving conditions, and vehicle conditions. Touch a smart POI icon to open the corresponding details: . Left side: Name and address of the POI. . Right side: E + ETE (Estimated Time Enroute.) Smart Fuel Station Icons Fuel station prices are shown if available for nearby stations when the vehicle is low on fuel. In the POI details page, a POI issue can be reported if the data is not accurate or the address is incorrect. Touch Report an Issue near the bottom of the display to access the issue selection page. Touch one of the predefined issues on the selection page, then touch Send. The system will send the information for analysis. Search Touch Search on the infotainment display to open the search display. It has a search field entry box, quick category icon shortcuts, recents icon, favorites icon, and keyboard. Search While in Motion with No Front Seat Passenger Present The search display will not allow changes or text input with the keyboard when the vehicle is in motion. As a result, a display showing three rows of the most commonly used categories appears. Touching the search box will activate speech recognition. Search While in Motion with Front Seat Passenger Present If the system detects that the front seat passenger is present with both driver and passenger seat belts buckled, touching the search icon will display an alert message that allows the passenger to search for a destination as if the vehicle were stopped. Connected Navigation Connected Navigation is a subscription service that enables certain capabilities within the navigation system, such as Traffic, Smart Search/Routing, and Predictive Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 172 Infotainment System Navigation capabilities. The system will show an alert when the subscription is expiring and will ask to renew the plan. Global Positioning System (GPS) If equipped, the position of the vehicle is determined by using satellite signals, various vehicle signals, and map data. At times, other interference such as the satellite condition, road configuration, condition of the vehicle, and/or other circumstances can affect the navigation system's ability to determine the accurate position of the vehicle. The GPS shows the current position of the vehicle using signals sent by GPS satellites. When the vehicle is not receiving signals from the satellites, a symbol appears in the status bar. This system might not be available or interference can occur if any of the following are true: . Signals are obstructed by tall buildings, trees, large trucks, or a tunnel. . Satellites are being repaired or improved. For more information if the GPS is not functioning properly, see Problems with Route Guidance 0 172 and If the System Needs Service 0 173. Vehicle Positioning At times, the position of the vehicle on the map could be inaccurate due to one or more of the following reasons: . The road system has changed. . The vehicle is driving on slippery road surfaces such as sand, gravel, or snow. . The vehicle is traveling on winding roads or long, straight roads. . The vehicle is approaching a tall building or a large vehicle. . The surface streets run parallel to a freeway. . The vehicle has been transferred by a vehicle carrier or a ferry. . The current position calibration is set incorrectly. . The vehicle is traveling at high speed. . The vehicle changes directions more than once, or the vehicle is turning on a turn table in a parking lot. . The vehicle is entering and/or exiting a parking lot, garage, or a lot with a roof. . . . . . . The GPS signal is not received. A roof carrier is installed on the vehicle. Tire chains are installed on the vehicle. The tires are replaced or worn. The tire pressure for the tires is incorrect. This is the first navigation use after the map data is updated. . The 12-volt battery has been disconnected for several days. . The vehicle is driving in heavy traffic where driving is at low speeds, and the vehicle is stopped and started repeatedly. Problems with Route Guidance Inappropriate route guidance can occur under one or more of the following conditions: . The turn was not made on the road indicated. . Route guidance might not be available when using automatic rerouting for the next right or left turn. . The route might not be changed when using automatic rerouting. . There is no route guidance when turning at an intersection. . Plural names of places might be announced occasionally. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System . It could take a long time to operate . . . . automatic rerouting during high-speed driving. Automatic rerouting might display a route returning to the set waypoint if heading for a destination without passing through a set waypoint. The route prohibits the entry of a vehicle due to a regulation by time or season or any other regulation which may be given. Some routes might not be searched. The route to the destination might not be shown if there are new roads, if roads have recently changed, or if certain roads are not listed in the map data. See Maps 0 165. To recalibrate the vehicle's position on the map, park with the vehicle running for two to five minutes, until the vehicle position updates. Make sure the vehicle is parked in a location that is safe and has a clear view of the sky and away from large obstructions. If the System Needs Service If the navigation system needs service, see your dealer. Map Data Updates The map data in the vehicle is the most up-to-date information available when the vehicle was produced. The map data is updated periodically, provided that the map information has changed and the vehicle has a relevant service plan. See www.gmnavdisc.com for details on ordering, purchasing, and installing a new or replacement SD card. Features are subject to change. For more information on this feature, see my.chevrolet.com/learn. If the vehicle is equipped with Connected Navigation, which is a subscription service that enables certain features of the navigation system, such as Traffic, Smart Search/Routing, and Predictive Navigation, then the system will download the latest map data from the cloud. Database Coverage Explanations Coverage areas vary with respect to the level of map detail available for any given area. Some areas feature greater levels of detail than others. If this happens, it does not mean there is a problem with the system. As the map data is updated, more 173 detail can become available for areas that previously had limited detail. See Map Data Updates 0 173. Voice Recognition If equipped, voice recognition allows for hands-free operation within the navigation, audio, phone, and weather applications. This feature can be started by pressing g on the steering wheel or touching g on the infotainment display. However, not all features within these areas are supported by voice commands. Generally, only complex tasks that require multiple manual interactions to complete are supported by voice commands. For example, tasks that take more than one or two touches, such as a song or artist to play from a media device, would be supported by voice commands. Other tasks, like adjusting the volume or seeking up or down, are audio features that are easily performed by touching one or two options, and are not supported by voice commands. In general there are flexible ways to speak commands for completing the tasks. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 174 Infotainment System If your language supports it, try stating a one-shot command, such as “Directions to address .” Do not include the ZIP code while stating the address during the command. Another example of a one-shot Destination Entry command is, “Directions to Place of Interest at .” If these commands do not work, try saying, “Take me to Place of Interest” or “Find address” and the system will walk you through by asking additional questions. Hybrid Speech Recognition If equipped, this feature helps distinguish words by using Internet-based information along with the system’s voice recognition database. This allows you to speak more naturally when using voice recognition. Using Voice Recognition Voice recognition becomes available once the system has been initialized. This begins when the ignition is turned on. Initialization may take a few moments. 1. Press g on the steering wheel controls to activate voice recognition. 2. The audio system mutes and the system plays a prompt. 3. Clearly speak one of the commands described in this section. A voice recognition system prompt can be interrupted while it is playing by pressing g again. Once voice recognition is started, both the infotainment display and instrument cluster show the selections and visual dialog content. These displays can be turned on or off in the Tutorial Mode under Settings 0 184. There are three voice prompt modes supported: . Informative verbal prompts: This type of prompt will provide more information regarding the supported actions. . Short prompts: This type of prompt will provide simple instructions about what can be stated. . Auto informative prompts: This type of prompt plays during the first few speech sessions, then automatically switches to the short prompt after some experience has been gained through using the system. If a command is not spoken, the voice recognition system says a help prompt. Prompts and Infotainment Displays While a voice recognition session is active, there may be corresponding options showing on the displays. A selection can be made by manually touching the option, or by speaking the number for the option to select. Manual interaction in the voice recognition session is permitted. Interaction during a voice session may be completed entirely using voice commands while some manual commands may expedite a task. If a selection is made using a manual control, the voice recognition dialog will progress in the same way as if the selection were made using a voice command. Once the system completes the task, or the session is terminated, the voice recognition dialog stops. An example of this type of manual intervention is touching an entry of a displayed number list instead of speaking the number associated with the entry desired. Canceling Voice Recognition . Touch or say “Cancel” or “Exit” to terminate the voice recognition session and show the display where voice recognition was initiated. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System i on the steering wheel controls to terminate the voice recognition session and show the display where voice recognition was initiated. . Press Natural Language Commands Most languages do not support natural language commands in sentence form. For those languages, use direct commands like the examples shown on the display. Helpful Hints for Speaking Commands Voice recognition can understand commands that are naturally stated in sentence form or direct commands that state the application and the task. For best results: . Listen for the prompt before saying a command or reply. . Speak the command naturally, not too fast, not too slow. . Use direct commands without a lot of extra words. For example, “Call at work,” “Play” followed by the artist or song name, or “Tune” followed by the radio station number. . Navigation destinations can be made in a single command using keywords. A few examples are: “I want directions to an address,” “I need to find a place of interest or (POI),” or “Find contact.” The system responds by requesting more details. For other POIs, say the name of a category like “Restaurants,” “Shopping Malls,” or “Hospitals.” . Navigating to a destination outside of the current country takes more than one command. The first command is to tell the system where the navigation will take place, such as an Address, Intersection, POI, or Contact. If Address or Intersection is selected, the second command is to say, “Change Country.” Once the system responds, say the country before saying the rest of the address and/or intersection. If POI is asked for, say “Change Location,” then “Change Country.” Direct commands might be more clearly understood by the system. An example of a direct command would be “Call .” Examples of these direct commands are displayed on most of the screens while a voice session is active. If “Phone” or “Phone Commands,” is spoken, the system 175 understands that a phone call is requested and will respond with questions until enough details are gathered to make a call. If a cell phone number has been saved with a name and a place, the direct command should include both, for example “Call at work.” Using Voice Recognition for List Options When a list is displayed, a voice prompt will ask to confirm or select an option from that list. When a display contains a list, there may be options that are available but not displayed. The list on a voice recognition screen functions the same as a list on other displays. Scrolling or flinging can be used to help display other entries from the list. Manually scrolling or paging the list on a display during a voice recognition session suspends the current voice recognition event and plays the prompt “Please select manually or touch the Back icon on the infotainment display to try again.” Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 176 Infotainment System If manual selection takes more than 15 seconds, the session terminates and prompts that it has timed out. The display returns to the display where voice recognition was initiated. “Switch to SXM” : Switch bands to SiriusXM and tune to the last SiriusXM channel. The Back Command “Tune to FM” : Tune to the radio station whose frequency is identified in the command (like “one oh one point one”). Say “Back” or touch the Back icon on the infotainment display to go to the previous menu. If in voice recognition, and “Back” is spoken all the way back to the starting display, and then “Back” is spoken one more time, the voice recognition session will cancel. Help Say “Help” on any voice recognition display and the help prompt for the display is played. “Tune to AM” : Tune to the radio station whose frequency is identified in the command (like “nine fifty”). “Tune to AM HD” : Tune to the HD Radio station (if equipped) whose frequency is identified in the command. “Tune to FM HD” : Tune to the HD Radio station (if equipped) whose frequency is identified in the command. Voice Recognition for the Radio “Tune to FM HD ” : Tune to the HD Radio station (if equipped) whose frequency and HD channel are identified in the command. If browsing the audio sources when voice is touched, the voice recognition commands for AM, FM, and SiriusXM (if equipped) are available. “Tune to SXM ” : Tune to the SiriusXM radio station whose channel number is identified in the command. “Switch to AM” : Switch bands to AM and tune to the last AM radio station. “Tune to SXM ” : Tune to the SiriusXM radio station whose channel name is identified in the command. “Switch to FM” : Switch bands to FM and tune to the last FM radio station. Voice Recognition for Audio MyMedia The available voice recognition commands for [browsing] MyMedia are: “Play Artist” : Begin a dialog to enter a specific artist name. “Play Artist ” : Begin playback of a specific artist. “Play Album” : Begin a dialog to enter a specific album name. “Play Album ” : Begin playback of a specific album. “Play Song” : Begin a dialog to enter a specific song name. “Play Song ” : Begin playback of a specific song, if available. “Play Genre” : Begin a dialog to enter a specific genre. “Play Genre ” : Begin playback of a specific genre. “Play Playlist” : Begin a dialog to enter a specific playlist name. “Play Playlist ” : Begin playback of a specific playlist. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System “Play ” : Play music from a specific device identified by name. The device name is the name displayed on the display when the device is first selected as an audio source. “Play Chapter” : Begin a dialog to enter a specific name. “Play Chapter ” : Begin playback of a specific chapter. “Play Audiobook” : Begin a dialog to enter a specific audiobook. “Play Audiobook ” : Begin playback of a specific audiobook. “Play Episode” : Begin a dialog to enter a specific name. “Play Episode ” : Begin playback of a specific episode. “Play Podcast” : Begin a dialog to enter a specific podcast. “Play Podcast ” : Begin playback of a specific podcast. “My Media” : Begin a dialog to enter the desired media content. Handling Large Amounts of Media Content It is expected that large amounts of media content will be brought into the vehicle. It may be necessary to handle large amounts of media content in a different way than smaller amounts of media. The system may limit the options of voice recognition by not allowing selection of files by voice at the highest level if the number of files exceeds the maximum limit. Changes to voice commands due to media content limits are: . Files including other individual files of all media types such as songs, audiobook chapters, podcast episodes, and videos. . Album type folders including types such as albums and audiobooks. There are no restrictions if the number of files and albums is fewer than 12,000. When the number of files connected to the system is between 12,000 and 24,000, the content cannot be accessed directly with one command like “Play .” The restriction is that the command “Play Song” must be spoken first; the system will then ask for the song name. The reply command would be to say the name of the song to play. 177 Similar limits exist for album content. If there are more than 12,000 albums, but fewer than 24,000, the content cannot be accessed directly with one command like, “Play .” The command “Play Album” must first be spoken; the system will then ask for the album name. The reply would be to say the name of the album to play. Once the number of files has exceeded approximately 24,000, there is no support for accessing the songs directly through voice commands. There will still be access to the media content by using commands for playlists, artists, and genres. The access commands for playlists, artists, and genres are prohibited after the number of this type of media exceeds 12,000. The system will provide feedback the first time voice recognition is initiated if it has become apparent that any of these limits are reached during a device initializing process. Voice recognition performance will degrade to some extent based on many factors when adding large amounts of data to recognize. If this is the case, perhaps accessing songs through playlists or artist name would work better. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 178 Infotainment System Voice Recognition for Navigation (If Equipped) “Navigation” : Begin a dialog to enter specific destination information. “Navigation Commands” : Begin a dialog to enter specific destination information. “Address” : Begin a dialog to enter a specific destination address, which includes the entire address consisting of the house number, street name, city, state/province, and country. Do not include the ZIP code. “Place of Interest” : Begin a dialog to enter a destination Place of Interest category or major brand name. The name must be precisely spoken. Nicknames or short names for the businesses will not likely be found. Lesser known businesses might have to be located by category, such as fast food, hotels, or banks. “Navigate to Contact” : Begin a dialog to enter a specific destination contact name. “Cancel Route” : End route guidance. “Take Me Home” : Create a route to a stored home location. Voice Recognition for the Phone “Call ” : Initiate a call to a stored contact. The command may include location if the contact has location numbers stored. “Call At Home,” “At Work,” “On Mobile,” or “On Other” : Initiate a call to a stored contact and location at home, at work, on mobile device, or on another phone. “Call ” : Initiate a call to a cell phone number of seven digits, 10 digits, or three digit emergency numbers. and allow them to be re-entered. Once the entire number has been entered, the command “Call” will start dialing the number. Phone Assistant Voice Recognition Press and hold g on the steering wheel controls to pass through and launch Google phone assistant or Siri. For the low radio, whether connected by Bluetooth or phone projection, the only available voice recognition is either Siri (iPhone) or the Google Assistant (Android). “Pair Phone” : Begin the Bluetooth pairing process. Follow the instructions on the infotainment display. Phone “Redial” : Initiate a call to the last dialed number. The Bluetooth-capable system can interact with many mobile devices, allowing: . Placement and receipt of calls in a hands-free mode. . Sharing of the device’s address book or contact list with the vehicle. “Switch Phone” : Select a different connected cell phone for outgoing calls. “Voice Keypad” : Begin a dialog to enter special numbers like international numbers. The numbers can be entered in groups of digits with each group of digits being repeated back by the system. If the group of digits is not correct, the command “Delete” will remove the last group of digits Bluetooth (Overview) To minimize driver distraction, before driving, and with the vehicle parked: . Become familiar with the features of the mobile device. Organize the phone book and contact lists clearly and delete Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System duplicate or rarely used entries. If possible, program speed dial or other shortcuts. . Review the controls and operation of the infotainment system. . Pair mobile device(s) to the vehicle. The system may not work with all mobile devices. See “Pairing” later in this section. Vehicles with a Bluetooth system can use a Bluetooth-capable mobile device with a Hands-Free Profile to make and receive phone calls. The infotainment system and voice recognition are used to control the system. The system can be used while the ignition is on or in ACC/ACCESSORY. The range of the Bluetooth system can be up to 9.1 m (30 ft). Not all mobile devices support all functions and not all mobile devices work with the Bluetooth system. See my.chevrolet.com for more information about compatible mobile devices. Controls Use the controls on the center stack and the steering wheel to operate the Bluetooth system. g : Press to answer incoming calls and start Bluetooth (Pairing and Using a Phone) voice recognition on your connected Bluetooth mobile device. Pairing Steering Wheel Controls i : Press to end a call, decline a call, or cancel an operation. Press to mute or unmute the infotainment system when not on a call. Infotainment System Controls For information about how to navigate the menu system using the infotainment controls, see Using the System 0 152. Audio System When using the Bluetooth mobile device system, sound comes through the vehicle's front audio system speakers and overrides the audio system. The volume level while on a mobile device call can be adjusted by pressing the steering wheel controls or the volume control on the center stack. The adjusted volume level remains in memory for later calls. The volume cannot be lowered beyond a certain level. 179 A Bluetooth-enabled mobile device must be paired to the Bluetooth system and then connected to the vehicle before it can be used. See the mobile device manufacturer's user guide for Bluetooth functions before pairing the device. Pairing Information . If no mobile device has been connected, the Phone main page on the infotainment display will show the Connect Phone option. Touch this option to connect. Another way to connect is to touch the Phones tab at the top right of the display and then touch Add Phone. . A Bluetooth smartphone with music capability can be paired to the vehicle as a smartphone and a music player at the same time. . Up to 10 devices can be paired to the Bluetooth system. . The pairing process is disabled when the vehicle is moving. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 180 Infotainment System . Pairing only needs to be completed once, unless the pairing information on the cell phone changes or the cell phone is deleted from the system. . If multiple paired cell phones are within range of the system, the system connects to the paired cell phone that is set to First to Connect. If there is no cell phone set to First to Connect, it will link to the cell phone which was used last. To link to a different paired cell phone, see “Linking to a Different Phone” later in this section. Pairing a Phone 1. Make sure Bluetooth has been enabled on the cell phone before the pairing process is started. 2. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page or the phone icon on the shortcut tray near the bottom of the display. 3. Touch Phones at the top of the infotainment display. There is also a Connect Phones option in the middle of the Phone display which will shortcut to the Phone List menu. 4. Touch Add Phone. 5. Select the vehicle name shown on the infotainment display from your cell phone’s Bluetooth Settings list. 6. Follow the instructions on the cell phone to confirm the six-digit code showing on the infotainment display and touch Pair. The code on the cell phone and infotainment display will need to be acknowledged for a successful pair. 7. Start the pairing process on the cell phone to be paired to the vehicle. See the cell phone manufacturer's user guide for information on this process. Once the cell phone is paired, it will show under Connected. 8. If the vehicle name does not appear on your cell phone, there are a few ways to start the pairing process over: . Turn the cell phone off and then back on. . Go back to the beginning of the Phone menus on the infotainment display and restart the pairing process. . Reset the cell phone, but this step should be done as a last effort. 9. If the cell phone prompts to accept connection or allow phone book download, touch Always Accept and Allow. The phone book may not be available if not accepted. 10. Repeat Steps 1−8 to pair additional cell phones. First to Connect Paired Phones If multiple paired cell phones are within range of the system, the system connects to the paired cell phone that is set as First to Connect. To enable a paired cell phone as the First to Connect phone: 1. Make sure the cell phone is turned on. 2. Touch Settings, then touch System. 3. Touch Phones to access all paired and all connected cell phones and mobile devices. 4. Touch the information icon to the right of the cell phone to open the cell phone’s settings menu. 5. Touch the First to Connect option, to enable the setting for that device. Cell phones and mobile devices can be added, removed, connected, and disconnected. A sub-menu will display whenever a request is made to add or manage cell phones and mobile devices. Secondary Phone A cell phone can be enabled as a Secondary Phone by touching the information icon to the right of the paired cell phone name to Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System open the phone settings menu. If a cell phone is enabled as a Secondary Phone, it can connect simultaneously alongside another Bluetooth mobile device. In doing so, the Secondary Phone will be labeled as Incoming Calls. This means the mobile device can only receive calls. The Address Book of a Secondary Phone will not be available and hands-free outgoing calls cannot be placed using this cell phone. If needed, touch the Secondary Phone while in the Phones list to swap it into the Outgoing and Incoming role. This role makes it possible to place outgoing calls from the Contacts and Recents list. Listing All Paired and Connected Phones 1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page or the phone icon on the shortcut tray near the bottom of the display. 2. Touch Phones. Disconnecting a Connected Phone 1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page. 2. Touch Phones. 3. Touch the information icon next to the connected cell phone or mobile device to show the cell phone’s or mobile device’s information display. 4. Touch Disconnect. Deleting a Paired Phone 1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page or the phone icon on the shortcut tray near the bottom of the display. 2. Touch Phones. 3. Touch the information icon next to the connected cell phone to display the cell phone’s or mobile device’s information display. 4. Touch Forget Device. Linking to a Different Phone To link to a different cell phone, the new cell phone must be in the vehicle and paired to the Bluetooth system. 1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page or the phone icon on the shortcut tray near the bottom of the display. 2. Touch Phones. 3. Touch the new cell phone to link to from the not connected phone list. See “First to Connect Paired Phones” and “Secondary Phone” previously in this section. 181 Switching to Handset or Handsfree Mode To switch between handset or handsfree mode: . While the active call is hands-free, touch the Handset option to switch to the handset mode. The mute icon will not be available or functional while Handset mode is active. . While the active call is on the handset, touch the Handset option to switch to the hands-free mode. Making a Call Using Contacts and Recent Calls Calls can be made through the Bluetooth system using personal cell phone contact information for all cell phones that support the Phone Book feature. Become familiar with the cell phone settings and operation. Verify the cell phone supports this feature. The Contacts menu accesses the phone book stored in the cell phone. The Recents menu accesses the recents call list from your cell phone. To make a call using the Contacts menu: 1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 182 Infotainment System 2. Touch Contacts. 3. The Contacts list can be searched by using the first character. Touch A-Z on the infotainment display to scroll through the list of names. Touch the name to call. 4. Touch the desired contact number to call. To 1. 2. 3. make a call using the Recents menu: Touch Phone on the Home Page. Touch Recents. Touch the name or number to call. Results will show on the right side of the display. Touch one to place a call. Accepting or Declining a Call When an incoming call is received, the infotainment system mutes and a ring tone is heard in the vehicle. Accepting a Call There are two ways to accept a call: . Press g on the steering wheel controls. . Touch Answer on the infotainment display. Making a Call Using the Keypad Declining a Call To make a call by dialing the numbers: 1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page. 2. Touch Keypad and enter a phone number. . Press i on the steering wheel controls. . Touch Ignore on the infotainment display. 3. Touch # on the infotainment display to start dialing the number. Searching Contacts Using the Keypad To search for contacts using the keypad: 1. Touch the Phone icon on the Home Page. 2. Touch Keypad and enter partial phone numbers or contact names using the digits on the keypad to search. There are two ways to decline a call: Call Waiting Call waiting must be supported on the Bluetooth cell phone and enabled by the wireless service carrier to work. Accepting a Call Press g to answer, then touch Switch on the infotainment display. Declining a Call Press i to decline, then touch Ignore on the infotainment display Switching Between Calls (Call Waiting Calls Only) To switch between calls, touch Phone on the Home Page to display Call View. While in Call View, touch the call information of the call on hold to change calls. Three-Way Calling Three-way calling must be supported on the Bluetooth cell phone and enabled by the wireless service carrier to work. To start a three-way call while in a current call: 1. In the Call View, touch Add Call to add another call. 2. Initiate the second call by selecting from Recents, Contacts, or Keypad. 3. When the second call is active, touch the merge icon to conference the three-way call together. Ending a Call . Press i on the steering wheel controls. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System # on the infotainment display, next to a call, to end only that call. . Touch Dual Tone Multi-Frequency (DTMF) Tones The in-vehicle Bluetooth system can send numbers during a call. This is used when calling a menu-driven phone system. Use the Keypad to enter the number. Apple CarPlay and Android Auto If equipped, Android Auto and/or Apple CarPlay capability may be available through a compatible smartphone. If available, the Android Auto and Apple CarPlay icons will change from gray to color on the Home Page of the infotainment display. To use Android Auto and/or Apple CarPlay: For Wired Phone Projection 1. Download the Android Auto app to your smartphone from the Google Play store. There is no app required for Apple CarPlay. 2. Connect your Android phone or Apple iPhone by using the factory-provided phone USB cable and plugging into a USB data port. For best performance, it is highly recommended to use the device’s factory-provided USB cable, which should be replaced after significant wear to maintain connection quality. Aftermarket or third-party cables may not work. 3. When the phone is first connected to activate Apple CarPlay or Android Auto, accept the terms and conditions on both the infotainment system and the phone. 4. Follow the instructions on the phone. The Android Auto and Apple CarPlay icons on the Home Page will illuminate depending on the smartphone. Android Auto and/or Apple CarPlay may automatically launch upon USB connection. If not, touch the Android Auto or Apple CarPlay icon on the Home Page to launch. Press { on the center stack to return to the Home Page. For Wireless Phone Projection Verify your phone is wireless compatible by visiting the Google Android Auto or Apple CarPlay support page. 1. Download the Android Auto app to your smartphone from the Google Play store. There is no app required for Apple CarPlay. 183 2. For first time connection, there are two ways to set up wireless projection: . Connect your Android phone or Apple iPhone by using the factory-provided phone USB cable and plugging into a USB data port. For best performance, it is highly recommended to use the device’s factory-provided USB cable, which should be replaced after significant wear to maintain connection quality. Aftermarket or third-party cables may not work. . Connecting the phone over Bluetooth. See Bluetooth (Overview) 0 178 or Bluetooth (Pairing and Using a Phone) 0 179. 3. Make sure wireless is turned on the phone for wireless projection to work. 4. When the phone is first connected to activate Apple CarPlay or Android Auto, agree to the terms and conditions on both the infotainment system and the phone. 5. Follow the instructions on the phone. The Android Auto and Apple CarPlay icons on the Home Page will illuminate depending on the smartphone. Android Auto and/or Apple CarPlay may automatically launch Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 184 Infotainment System upon wireless connection. If not, touch the Android Auto or Apple CarPlay icon on the Home Page to launch. Wireless Carplay and/or Wireless Android Auto may experience occasional service disruption due to outside Wi-Fi interference. To disconnect the phones wireless projection: 1. Select Settings from the Home Page. 2. Select Phones 3. Touch 4 next to the phone to be disconnected. 4. Turn off Apple CarPlay or Android Auto. Press { on the center stack to return to the Home Page. Features are subject to change. For further information on how to set up Android Auto and Apple CarPlay in the vehicle, see my.chevrolet.com. Android Auto is provided by Google and is subject to Google’s terms and privacy policy. Apple CarPlay is provided by Apple and is subject to Apple’s terms and privacy policy. Data plan rates apply. For Android Auto support and to see if your phone is compatible, see https://support.google.com/ androidauto. For Apple CarPlay support and to see if your phone is compatible, see www.apple.com/ios/carplay/. Apple or Google may change or suspend availability at any time. Android Auto, Android, Google, Google Play, and other marks are trademarks of Google Inc.; Apple CarPlay is a trademark of Apple Inc. instructions, in the U.S. see my.chevrolet.com or in Canada see mychevrolet.ca or monchevrolet.ca. Press { on the center stack to exit Android Auto or Apple CarPlay. To enter back into Android Auto or Apple CarPlay, press and hold { on the center stack. The settings menu may be organized into four categories. Select the desired category by touching System, Apps, Vehicle, or Personal. Apple CarPlay and Android Auto can be disabled from the infotainment system. To do this, touch Home, Settings, and then touch the Apps tab along the top of the display. Use the On/Off toggled to turn off Apple CarPlay or Android Auto. To access the personalization menus: 1. Touch Settings on the Home Page on the infotainment display. 2. Touch the desired category to display a list of available options. 3. Touch to select the desired feature setting. 4. Touch the options on the infotainment display to disable or enable a feature. Settings Certain settings can be managed in the Owner Center sites when an account is established, and may be modified if other users have accessed the vehicle or created accounts. This may result in changes to the security or functionality of the infotainment system. Some settings may also be transferred to a new vehicle, if equipped. For Refer to the User Terms and Privacy Statement for important details. To view, touch the Settings icon on the Home Page of the infotainment display. 5. Touch z to go to the top level of the Settings menu. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System System Language The menu may contain the following: This will set the display language used on the infotainment display. It may also use the selected language for voice recognition and audio feedback. Touch Language and touch the appropriate language. Time / Date Use the following features to set the clock: . Automatic Time and Date: Touch Off or On to enable or disable automatic update of the time and date. When this feature is on, the time and date cannot be manually set. . Set Time: Touch to manually set the time using the controls on the infotainment display. . Set Date: Touch to manually set the date using the controls on the infotainment display. . Automatic Time Zone (If Equipped): Touch Off or On to disable or enable automatic update of the time zone based on vehicle location. When this feature is on, the time zone cannot be manually set. . Select Time Zone: Touch to manually set the time zone. Touch a time zone from the list. . Use 24-hour Format: Touch to specify the clock format shown. Touch Off or On to disable or enable. Phones Touch to connect to a different cell phone or mobile device source, disconnect a cell phone or media device, or delete a cell phone or media device. Wi-Fi Networks This will show connected and available Wi-Fi networks. If a 4G LTE data package is not active on the vehicle, the infotainment system can be connected to an external protected Wi-Fi network, such as a mobile device or home hotspot, to utilize connected services. Wi-Fi Hotspot Touch and the following may display: . Wi-Fi Services: This allows devices to use the vehicle hotspot. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable. 185 . Wi-Fi Name: Touch to change the vehicle Wi-Fi name. . Wi-Fi Password: Touch to change the vehicle Wi-Fi password. . Connected Devices: Touch to show connected devices. . Share Hotspot Data: Touch On to allow devices to use the vehicle hotspot and its data, or touch Off to allow devices to only use the vehicle hotspot but not its data. Privacy Touch and the following may display: . Location Services: This setting enables or disables sharing of vehicle location outside the vehicle. Emergency services will not be affected when Off is selected. . Data Services: If equipped, this setting determines if data sharing can be used by features including Wi-Fi, Hotspot, and applications. Touch Off to disable data services. Emergency services and phone calls, such as calls with OnStar Advisors or others, will not be affected when Off is selected. . Voice Recognition Sharing: This setting determines if voice commands can be shared with a cloud-based voice Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 186 Infotainment System recognition system. Touch Off to prevent the sharing and possible recording of your voice commands with this system. This may limit the system’s ability to understand your voice commands and may disable some features. . Types: This setting lists all Android-defined as dangerous permissions currently used by the infotainment system, the number of applications that have requested this permission, and the number of applications that are allowed to use this permission. . Used By Applications: This setting lists all applications that are requested or are using Android-defined as dangerous permissions. Only requested and active permissions are shown. Display Touch and the following may display: . Mode: This adjusts the appearance of the navigation map view and any downloaded apps optimized for day or night time conditions. Set to Auto for the display to automatically adjust based on bright/dark conditions. Touch Auto, Day, or Night to adjust the display. . Calibrate Touchscreen: Touch to calibrate the infotainment display and follow the prompts. . Turn Display Off: Touch to turn the display off. Touch anywhere on the infotainment display or press any infotainment control on the center stack again to turn the display on. Sounds Touch and the following may display: . Maximum Startup Volume: This feature adjusts the maximum volume of the infotainment system when you start your vehicle. To set the maximum startup volume, touch the controls on the infotainment display to increase or decrease. . Audio Cues: This feature determines if sounds play when the infotainment system starts up and shuts down. This feature can be turned off or on. . Set Audio Cue Volume: This setting controls the volume of Audio Cues played on startup and shut down. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to increase or decrease. . Audible Touch Feedback: This setting determines if a sound plays when touching the infotainment display or radio controls. This feature can be turned off or on. Voice Touch and the following may display: . Confirm More/Less: This setting specifies how often the voice recognition system confirms commands. Touch Confirm More to have the system check with you more often before acting on your commands. . Prompt Length: This setting specifies the amount of detail the voice recognition system provides when giving you feedback. Touch Auto to have the system automatically adjust to your speech habits. Touch Informative, Short, or Auto. . Audio Feedback Speed: Touch Slow, Medium, or Fast to adjust how quickly the voice recognition system speaks. . Friendly Prompts: This setting adjusts the formality of voice prompts. Touch Off for shorter prompts. Touch On to hear prompts with more personality. Touch Auto to have the prompt match your command style. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System . Tutorial Mode: Touch Off or On to provide tutorial feedback on the display. . Allow Prompt Interruptions: This setting controls whether voice commands can be spoken before voice prompts finish. Turn this on to speak commands without hearing the full prompt. Speaking while the prompt is still playing will immediately stop playing the current prompt and recognize your command. Background noise may cause accidental interruptions. Touch Off or On. Favorites Touch and the following may display: . Manage Favorites: Touch to display a list of Audio, Phone, and Navigation favorites. Favorites can be moved, renamed, or deleted. To move, touch and hold the favorite, and then drag up or down to rearrange the position. . Set Number of Audio Favorites: Touch to select how many favorites pages can be viewed from the audio application. The Auto setting will automatically adjust this number based on the number of favorites you have saved. Touch Auto, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, or 40. Updates If equipped, the vehicle can download and install select software updates over a wireless connection. The system will prompt for certain updates to be downloaded and installed. There is also an option to check for updates manually. To manually check for updates, touch Settings on the Home Page and select the System tab. Go to the Vehicle Software section and touch Updates. Follow the on-screen prompts. The steps to check for, download, and install updates may vary by vehicle. The vehicle can be used normally during the software download. Once the download is complete, there may be a prompt to accept the installation of the update upon the next ignition cycle or the next time the vehicle is shifted into P (Park). For most updates, the vehicle will be disabled and cannot be driven during the installation. The system will deliver messages indicating success or error during and after the download and installation processes. Downloading Over-the-Air vehicle software updates requires Internet connectivity, which can be accessed through the vehicle’s built-in 4G LTE connection, if equipped and 187 active. If required, data plans are provided by a third party. Optionally, a secure Wi-Fi hotspot such as a compatible mobile device hotspot, home hotspot, or public hotspot can be used. Applicable data rates may apply. To connect the infotainment system to a secured mobile device hotspot, home hotspot, or public hotspot, touch Settings on the Home Page, select the System tab, followed by Wi-Fi Networks. Select the appropriate Wi-Fi network, and follow the on-screen prompts. Download speeds may vary. On most compatible mobile devices, activation of the Wi-Fi hotspot is in the Settings menu under Mobile Network Sharing, Personal Hotspot, Mobile Hotspot, or similar. Availability of Over-the-Air software updates varies by vehicle and country. Features are subject to change. For more information on this feature, see my.chevrolet.com/learn. Preferences Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable the download of new updates in the background. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 188 Infotainment System About Apps Audio Touch to view the infotainment system software information. The menu may contain the following: Depending on the current audio source, different options will be available. Running Applications Touch to see a complete list of applications that are currently running on the infotainment system. Return to Factory Settings Touch and the following may display: . Reset Vehicle Settings: Resets all vehicle settings for the current user. Touch Reset or Cancel. . Erase Settings and Personal Data: Erases app data settings, user profiles, and personal data including navigation and mobile device data. Touch Erase or Cancel. . Clear Default Applications: Resets preferred applications that have been set to open when selecting a function. No application data will be lost. Touch Clear or Cancel. Android Auto This feature allows you to interact directly with your mobile device on the infotainment display. See Apple CarPlay and Android Auto 0 183. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable. Apple CarPlay This feature allows you to interact directly with your mobile device on the infotainment display. See Apple CarPlay and Android Auto 0 183. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable. Apps Touch and the following may display: . Update Apps Automatically: This allows downloaded applications to be updated automatically. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable. . About Apps: Touch to view the versions of the shop software. Touch and the following may display: . Tone Settings: Touch to adjust Equalizer, Fade/Balance, or Sound Mode. See “Infotainment System Sound Menu” in AM-FM Radio 0 154. . Auto Volume: This feature adjusts the volume based on the vehicle speed. Touch Off, Low, Medium-Low, Medium, Medium-High, or High. . Bose AudioPilot Noise Compensation Technology (If Equipped): This feature adjusts the volume based on the noise in the vehicle and the speed. Touch Off or On. . Manage Favorites: Touch to display a list of Audio, Mobile Devices, and Navigation favorites. Favorites can be moved, renamed, or deleted. To move, touch and hold the favorite, and then drag up or down to rearrange the position. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System . Set Number of Audio Favorites: Touch to . . . . . select how many favorites pages can be viewed from the audio application. The Auto setting will automatically adjust this number based on the number of favorites you have saved. Touch Auto, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, or 40. RDS: This allows the Radio Data System (RDS) to be turned on or off. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable. HD Radio: This allows HD Radio reception to be turned on or off. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable. Explicit Content Filter: This setting allows access to explicit content SiriusXM channels. Touch Off or On. Manage Phones: Select to connect to a different phone source, disconnect a phone, or delete a phone. Reset Music Index: This allows the music index to be reset if you are having difficulty accessing all of the media content on your device. Touch Yes or No. Climate Touch and the following may display: . Auto Fan Speed: This setting specifies the amount of airflow when the climate control fan setting is Auto Fan. Touch Low, Medium, or High. . Air Quality Sensor: This setting switches the system into Recirculation Mode based on the quality of the outside air. Touch Off, Low Sensitivity, or High Sensitivity. . Auto Cooled Seats: This setting automatically turns on and regulates the ventilated seats when the cabin temperature is warm. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable. . Auto Heated Seats: This setting automatically turns on and regulates the heated seats when the cabin temperature is cool. The auto heated seats can be turned off by using the heated seat controls on the center stack. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable. . Auto Defog: This setting automatically turns the front defogger on when the vehicle engine is started. 189 Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable. . Auto Rear Defog: This setting automatically turns the rear window defogger on when the vehicle engine is started. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable. Navigation Touch and the following may display: Destination Card Preferences Map Preferences Route Preferences Navigation Voice Control Traffic Preferences Alert Preferences Fuel Grade Preferences Manage History Predictive Navigation (if equipped) About . . . . . . . . . . See Using the Navigation System 0 162. Phone Touch and the following may display: . My Number: Displays the cell phone number of the Bluetooth connected device. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 190 Infotainment System . Active Call View: Shows active call display . . . . . when answering a call. Touch the controls on the infotainment display to disable or enable. Privacy: Only show call alerts in the instrument cluster. Touch Off or On. Sort Contacts: Touch to sort by first or last name. Re-sync Device Contacts: This allows the device contacts to re-sync if you are having difficulty accessing all of the contacts on your cell phone. Delete All Vehicle Contacts: Touch to delete all vehicle stored contacts. OnStar Phone TTY Mode: This enables OnStar cell phone TTY mode. Touch Disable or Enable. Vehicle This menu allows adjustment of different vehicle features. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Personal Touch Vehicle Key 1 and/or Vehicle Key 2. If equipped, this menu allows adjustment of different user profile settings. See “Users” in Using the System 0 152 for information on setting up user profiles. If the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter is lost or stolen, see your dealer. Security The menu may contain the following: Touch to have your profile secured with a PIN. Name Touch No or Yes. Touch to edit your user name that will be displayed in the vehicle. Vehicle Name Vehicle Account Information Touch to view the vehicle account information and to change the account password. An “unverified user account” pop-up will display until the account information verification process has been completed on the Internet. Check your registered e-mail account for an activation e-mail to complete the verification process. Touch to edit your vehicle name. Vehicle Account Touch to view the vehicle account information and to change the account password. Delete Profile Touch to remove the profile from the vehicle. Touch Remove or Cancel. Profile Picture Teen Driver Touch to choose or change your profile picture. If equipped, this allows multiple keys to be registered for beginner drivers to encourage safe driving habits. When the vehicle is started with a Teen Driver key, it will automatically activate certain safety systems, allow setting of some features, and Profile Identifiers Touch to have the vehicle recognize the identifier you choose. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System limit the use of others. The Report Card will record vehicle data about driving behavior that can be viewed later. When the vehicle is started with a registered key, the Driver Information Center (DIC) displays a message that Teen Driver is active. To access: 1. Touch Settings on the Home Page, then touch Vehicle, and then Teen Driver. 2. Create a Personal Identification Number (PIN) by choosing a four-digit PIN. Re-enter the PIN to confirm. To change the PIN, touch Change PIN. The PIN is required to: . Register or unregister keys. . Change Teen Driver settings. . Change or clear the Teen Driver PIN. . Access or delete Report Card data. Register keys to activate Teen Driver and assign restrictions to the key: Any vehicle key can be registered, up to a maximum of eight keys. Label the key to tell it apart from the other keys. For a pushbutton start system: 1. Start the engine. 2. For automatic transmissions, the vehicle must be in P (Park). For manual transmissions, the vehicle must be stopped with the parking brake set. 3. From the Settings menu, touch Vehicle and then Teen Driver. 4. Enter the PIN. 5. Place the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter key you wish to register in the transmitter pocket. The key does not need to be the one that started the vehicle. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) 0 10 or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) 0 13 for transmitter pocket location. 6. From the Teen Driver menu, touch Setup Keys. . If the transmitter key has not previously been registered, the option to add the key displays. Touch Add and a confirmation message displays. Teen Driver restrictions will be applied whenever this key is used to operate the vehicle. . If the transmitter key has already been registered, the option to remove the key displays. If Remove is touched, the transmitter key is no 191 longer registered. A confirmation message displays, and Teen Driver restrictions will not be applied if this transmitter key is used to operate the vehicle. In vehicles with a pushbutton start system, if a Teen Driver and a non-Teen Driver key are both present at start up, the vehicle will recognize the non-Teen Driver key to start the vehicle. The Teen Driver settings will not be active. For a keyed ignition system: 1. Start the engine. 2. For automatic transmissions, the vehicle must be in P (Park). For manual transmissions, the vehicle must be stopped with the parking brake set. 3. From the Settings menu, touch Vehicle and then Teen Driver. 4. Enter the PIN. 5. Touch Setup Keys. The system displays instructions for registering or unregistering a key. A confirmation message displays. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 192 Infotainment System Manage Settings Audio Volume Limit : Allows the audio volume limit to be turned on or off. Touch Set Audio Volume Limit to choose the maximum allowable audio volume level. Set Audio Volume Limit : Allows a maximum radio volume to be set. Use the arrows to choose the maximum allowable level for the audio volume. Teen Driver Speed Limiter : Limits the maximum speed of the vehicle. When the speed limiter is turned on and the vehicle is started with a Teen Driver key, the DIC displays a message that the top speed is limited. On certain vehicles, when the Speed Limiter is turned ON, the vehicle’s maximum acceleration will be limited. The DIC will display a message that the acceleration is limited. Teen Driver Speed Warning : Allows the speed warning to be turned on or off. Touch Set Teen Driver Speed Warning to set the warning speed. Set Teen Driver Speed Warning : Displays a warning in the DIC when exceeding a selectable speed. Choose the desired speed warning level. The speed warning does not limit the speed of the vehicle. SiriusXM Explicit Content Filter (if equipped) : Allows the SiriusXM Explicit Content Filter to be turned ON or OFF. When ON, the teen driver will not be able to listen to SiriusXM stations that contain explicit content, and the Explicit Content Filter selection in the Audio Settings will be unavailable for change. When Teen Driver is Active: . If equipped with Buckle to Drive, shifting out of P (Park) will be prevented if the driver seat belt, and in some vehicles the front passenger seat belt, is not buckled. . The radio will mute when the driver seat belt, and in some vehicles the front passenger seat belt, is not buckled. The audio from any device paired to the vehicle will also be muted. . An object placed on the front passenger seat, such as a briefcase, handbag, grocery bag, laptop, or other electronic device, could cause the passenger sensing system to falsely sense an unbuckled front passenger and mute the radio. . . . . . . If this happens, remove the object from the seat. See Passenger Sensing System 0 67. Some safety systems, such as Forward Collision Alert, if equipped, cannot be turned off. The gap setting for the Forward Collision Alert and Adaptive Cruise Control, if equipped, cannot be changed. When trying to change a safety feature that is not configurable in Teen Driver, the DIC displays a message indicating that Teen Driver is active and the action is not available. Super Cruise, if equipped, is not available. Enhanced Low Fuel Warning (if equipped) – When the vehicle is low on fuel, the low fuel light on the instrument cluster flashes and the DIC low fuel warning cannot be dismissed. Do not tow a trailer. Report Card The vehicle owner must secure the driver’s consent to record certain vehicle data when the vehicle is driven with a registered Teen Driver key. There is one Report Card per Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System vehicle. Data is only recorded when a registered Teen Driver key is used to operate the vehicle. The Report Card data is collected from the time Teen Driver is activated or the last time the Report Card was reset. The following items may be recorded: . Distance Driven – the total distance driven. . Maximum Speed – the maximum vehicle speed detected. . Overspeed Warnings – the number of times the speed warning setting was exceeded. . Wide Open Throttle – the number of times the accelerator pedal was pressed nearly all the way down. . Forward Collision Alerts – the number of times the driver was notified when approaching a vehicle ahead too quickly and at potential risk for a crash. . Forward Automatic Braking, also called Automatic Emergency Braking (if equipped) – the number of times the vehicle detected that a forward collision was imminent and applied the brakes. . Reverse Automatic Braking (if equipped) – . . . . the number of times the vehicle detected that a rearward collision was imminent and applied the brakes. Traction Control – the number of times the Traction Control System activated to reduce wheel spin or loss of traction. Stability Control – the number of events which required the use of electronic stability control. Antilock Braking System Active – The number of Antilock Brake System activations. Tailgating Alerts – the number of times the driver was alerted for following a vehicle ahead too closely. 193 . From the Report Card display, touch Reset. . Touch Clear All Teen Keys and PIN from the Teen Driver menu. This will also unregister any Teen Driver keys and delete the PIN. Forgotten PIN See your dealer to reset the PIN. Trademarks and License Agreements FCC Information See Radio Frequency Statement 0 417. Report Card Data Cumulative Data is saved for all trips until the Report Card is reset or until the maximum count is exceeded. If the maximum count is exceeded for a Report Card line item, that item will no longer be updated in the Report Card until it is reset. Each item will report a maximum of 1,000 counts. The distance driven will report a maximum of 64 374 km (40,000 mi). To delete Report Card data, do one of the following: "Made for iPod," and "Made for iPhone," mean that an electronic accessory has been designed to connect specifically to iPod or iPhone, respectively, and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple performance standards. Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 194 Infotainment System or its compliance with safety and regulatory standards. Please note that the use of this accessory with iPod or iPhone may affect wireless performance. iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod nano, iPod shuffle, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. If you decide to continue service after your trial, your selected subscription plan will automatically renew thereafter. You will be charged at then-current rates. Fees and taxes apply. Please see the SiriusXM Customer Agreement at siriusxm.com for complete terms and how to cancel, which includes calling SiriusXM at 1-866-635-2349. All fees and programming are subject to change. Fees and Taxes: Subscription fee, taxes, one time activation fee, and other fees may apply. Subscription fee is consumer only. All fees and programming subject to change. Subscriptions subject to Customer Agreement available at www.siriusxm.com. SiriusXM service is only available in the 48 contiguous United States and Canada. rights including patent rights, copyrights, and trade secrets of Digital Voice Systems, Inc. In Canada: Some deterioration of service may occur in extreme northern latitudes. This is beyond the control of SiriusXM Satellite Radio. General Requirements: 1. A License Agreement from SiriusXM is required for any product that incorporates SiriusXM Technology and/or for use of any of the SiriusXM marks to be manufactured, distributed, or marketed in the SiriusXM Service Area. 2. For products to be distributed, marketed, and/or sold in Canada, a separate agreement is required with Canadian Satellite Radio Inc. (operating as SiriusXM Canada). Explicit Language Notice: Channels with frequent explicit language are indicated with an “XL” preceding the channel name. Channel blocking is available for SiriusXM Satellite Radio receivers by notifying SiriusXM: . USA Customers — See www.siriusxm.com or call 1-888-601–6296. . Canada Customers — See www.siriusxm.ca or call 1-877-438-9677. It is prohibited to copy, decompile, disassemble, reverse engineer, hack, manipulate, or otherwise make available any technology or software incorporated in receivers compatible with the SiriusXM Satellite Radio System or that support the SiriusXM website, the Online Service or any of its content. Furthermore, the AMBER voice compression software included in this product is protected by intellectual property TouchSense Technology and TouchSense System 1000 Series Licensed from Immersion Corporation. TouchSense System 1000 protected under one or more of the Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System U.S. Patents at the following address www.immersion.com/patent-marking.html and other patents pending. Bose Bose AudioPilot and Bose Centerpoint surround are registered trademarks of Bose Corporation in the U.S. and other countries. Java Java is a registered trademark of Oracle and/or its affiliates. Schedule I: Gracenote EULA HD Radio Technology HD Radio Technology manufactured under license from iBiquity Digital Corporation. U.S. and Foreign patents. HD Radio and the HD, HD Radio, and “Arc” logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp. Bluetooth The Bluetooth word mark and logos are owned by the Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by General Motors is under license. Other trademarks and trade names are those of their respective owners. Music recognition technology and related data are provided by Gracenote. Gracenote is the industry standard in music recognition technology and related content delivery. For more information see www.gracenote.com. Music-related data from Gracenote, Inc., copyright © 2000 to present Gracenote. Gracenote Software, copyright © 2000 to present Gracenote. One or more patents owned by Gracenote may apply to this product and service. See the Gracenote website for a non-exhaustive list of applicable Gracenote patents. Gracenote, CDDB, MusicID, MediaVOCS, the Gracenote logo and logotype, and the "Powered by 195 Gracenote" logo are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Gracenote in the United States and/or other countries. Gracenote Terms of Use This application or device contains software from Gracenote, Inc. of Emeryville, California ("Gracenote"). The software from Gracenote (the "Gracenote Software") enables this application to do disc or file identification and obtain music-related information, including name, artist, track, and title information ("Gracenote Data") from online servers or embedded databases (collectively, "Gracenote Servers") and to perform other functions. You may use Gracenote Data only by means of the intended End-User functions of this application or device. This application or device may contain content belonging to Gracenote’s providers. If so, all of the restrictions set forth herein with respect to Gracenote Data shall also apply to such content and such content providers shall be entitled to all of the benefits and protections set forth herein that are available to Gracenote. You agree that you will use Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote Servers for your own personal non-commercial use only. You agree not to Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 196 Infotainment System assign, copy, transfer or transmit the Gracenote Software or any Gracenote Data to any third party. YOU AGREE NOT TO USE OR EXPLOIT GRACENOTE DATA, THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE, OR GRACENOTE SERVERS, EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY PERMITTED HEREIN. You agree that your non-exclusive license to use the Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote Servers will terminate if you violate these restrictions. If your license terminates, you agree to cease any and all use of the Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote Servers. Gracenote reserves all rights in Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and the Gracenote Servers, including all ownership rights. Under no circumstances will Gracenote become liable for any payment to you for any information that you provide. You agree that Gracenote may enforce its rights under this Agreement against you directly in its own name. The Gracenote service uses a unique identifier to track queries for statistical purposes. The purpose of a randomly assigned numeric identifier is to allow the Gracenote service to count queries without knowing anything about who you are. For more information, see the web page for the Gracenote Privacy Policy for the Gracenote service. The Gracenote Software and each item of Gracenote Data are licensed to you "AS IS." Gracenote makes no representations or warranties, express or implied, regarding the accuracy of any Gracenote Data. Gracenote reserves the right to delete data from the Gracenote Servers or to change data categories for any cause that Gracenote deems sufficient. No warranty is made that the Gracenote Software or Gracenote Servers are error-free or that functioning of Gracenote Software or Gracenote Servers will be uninterrupted. Gracenote is not obligated to provide you with new enhanced or additional data types or categories that Gracenote may provide in the future and is free to discontinue its services at any time. GRACENOTE DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE, AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. GRACENOTE DOES NOT WARRANT THE RESULTS THAT WILL BE OBTAINED BY YOUR USE OF THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE OR ANY GRACENOTE SERVER. IN NO CASE WILL GRACENOTE BE LIABLE FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES OR FOR ANY LOST PROFITS OR LOST REVENUES. © 2014. Gracenote, Inc. All Rights Reserved. MPEG4–AVC (H.264) THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE AVC PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR THE PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL USE OF A CONSUMER TO (i) ENCODE VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE AVC STANDARD (“AVC VIDEO”) AND/OR (ii) DECODE AVC VIDEO THAT WAS ENCODED BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN A PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL ACTIVITY AND/OR WAS OBTAINED FROM A VIDEO PROVIDER LICENSED TO PROVIDE AVC VIDEO. NO LICENSE IS GRANTED OR SHALL BE IMPLIED FOR ANY OTHER USE. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION MAY BE OBTAINED FROM MPEG LA, LLC. SEE HTTP://WWW.MPEGLA.COM. VC-1 THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE VC-1 PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR THE PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL USE OF A CONSUMER TO (i) ENCODE VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE VC-1 STANDARD Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System (“VC-1 VIDEO”) AND/OR (ii) DECODE VC-1 VIDEO THAT WAS ENCODED BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN A PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL ACTIVITY AND/OR WAS OBTAINED FROM A VIDEO PROVIDER LICENSED TO PROVIDE VC-1 VIDEO. NO LICENSE IS GRANTED OR SHALL BE IMPLIED FOR ANY OTHER USE. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION MAY BE OBTAINED FROM MPEG LA, LLC. SEE HTTP://WWW.MPEGLA.COM. MPEG4–Visual USE OF THIS PRODUCT IN ANY MANNER THAT COMPLIES WITH THE MPEG-4 VISUAL STANDARD IS PROHIBITED, EXCEPT FOR USE BY A CONSUMER ENGAGING IN PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL ACTIVITIES. MP3 MPEG Layer-3 audio coding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson. WMV/WMA This product includes technology owned by Microsoft Corporation and under a license from Microsoft Licensing, GP. Use or distribution of such technology outside of this product is prohibited without a license from Microsoft Corporation and/or Microsoft Licensing, GP as applicable. 197 Map End User License Agreement TERMS AND CONDITIONS END USER TERMS Personal Use Only: You agree to use this Data for the solely personal, noncommercial purposes for which you were licensed, and not for service bureau, timesharing or other similar purposes. Except as otherwise set forth herein, you agree not to otherwise reproduce, copy, modify, decompile, disassemble or reverse engineer any portion of this Data, and may not transfer or distribute it in any form, for any purpose, except to the extent permitted by mandatory laws. You may transfer the Data and all accompanying materials on a permanent basis if you retain no copies and the recipient agrees to the terms of this End User License Agreement. Multi-disc sets may only be transferred or sold as a complete set as provided to you and not as a subset thereof. The Map Data SD card (“Data”) is provided for your personal, internal use only and not for resale. It is protected by copyright, and is subject to the following terms (this “End User License Agreement”) and conditions which are agreed to by you, on the one hand, and HERE North America, LLC (“HERE”) and its licensors (including their licensors and suppliers) on the other hand. The Data for areas of Canada includes information taken with permission from Canadian authorities, including: © Her Majesty the Queen in Right of Canada, © Queen's Printer for Ontario, © Canada Post Corporation, GeoBase®. HERE holds a nonexclusive license from the United States Postal Service® to publish and sell ZIP+4® information. © United States Postal Service 2013. Prices are not established, controlled, or approved by the United States Postal Service. The following trademarks and registrations are owned by the USPS: United States Postal Service, USPS, and ZIP+4. Restrictions Except where you have been specifically licensed to do so by HERE and without limiting the preceding paragraph, you may not (a) use this Data with any products, systems, or applications installed or otherwise connected to or in communication with vehicles capable of vehicle navigation, positioning, dispatch, real time route Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 198 Infotainment System guidance, fleet management or similar applications; or (b) with, or in communication with, including without limitation, cellular phones, palmtop and handheld computers, pagers, and personal digital assistants or PDAs. Warning This Data may contain inaccurate or incomplete information due to the passage of time, changing circumstances, sources used, and the nature of collecting comprehensive geographic data, any of which may lead to incorrect results. No Warranty This Data is provided to you “as is,” and you agree to use it at your own risk. HERE and its licensors (and their licensors and suppliers) make no guarantees, representations, or warranties of any kind, express or implied, arising by law or otherwise, including but not limited to, content, quality, accuracy, completeness, effectiveness, reliability, fitness for a particular purpose, usefulness, use or results to be obtained from this Data, or that the Data or server will be uninterrupted or error free. Disclaimer of Warranty THE DATABASE IS PROVIDED ON AN “AS IS” AND “WITH ALL FAULTS BASIS” AND HARMAN (AND THEIR LICENSORS AND SUPPLIERS) EXPRESSLY DISCLAIM ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF NON-INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABILITY, SATISFACTORY QUALITY, ACCURACY, TITLE AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. NO ORAL OR WRITTEN ADVICE OR INFORMATION PROVIDED BY HARMAN (OR ANY OF THEIR LICENSORS, AGENTS, EMPLOYEES, OR THIRD PARTY PROVIDERS) SHALL CREATE A WARRANTY, AND YOU ARE NOT ENTITLED TO RELY ON ANY SUCH ADVICE OR INFORMATION. THIS DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTIES IS AN ESSENTIAL CONDITION OF THIS AGREEMENT. Disclaimer of Liability HERE AND ITS LICENSORS (INCLUDING THEIR LICENSORS AND SUPPLIERS) SHALL NOT BE LIABLE TO YOU IN RESPECT OF ANY CLAIM, DEMAND OR ACTION, IRRESPECTIVE OF THE NATURE OF THE CAUSE OF THE CLAIM, DEMAND OR ACTION ALLEGING ANY LOSS, INJURY OR DAMAGES, DIRECT OR INDIRECT, WHICH MAY RESULT FROM THE USE OR POSSESSION OF THIS DATA; OR FOR ANY LOSS OF PROFIT, REVENUE, CONTRACTS OR SAVINGS, OR ANY OTHER DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF YOUR USE OF OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DATA, ANY DEFECT IN THIS DATA, OR THE BREACH OF THESE TERMS OR CONDITIONS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION IN CONTRACT OR TORT OR BASED ON A WARRANTY, EVEN IF HERE OR ITS LICENSORS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Some States, Territories, and Countries do not allow certain liability exclusions or damages limitations, so to that extent the above may not apply to you. Export Control You agree not to export from anywhere any part of the Data provided to you or any direct product thereof except in compliance with, and with all licenses and approvals required under, applicable export laws, rules and regulations. Entire Agreement: These terms and conditions constitute the entire agreement between HERE (and its licensors, including their licensors and suppliers) and you pertaining to the subject matter hereof, and supersedes in their entirety any and all Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System the Contracting Officer, federal government agency, or any federal official must notify HERE prior to seeking additional or alternative rights in the Data. written or oral agreements previously existing between us with respect to such subject matter. Governing Law The above terms and conditions shall be governed by the laws of the State of Illinois, without giving effect to (i) its conflict of laws provisions, or (ii) the United Nations Convention for Contracts for the International Sale of Goods, which is explicitly excluded. You agree to submit to the jurisdiction of the State of Illinois for any and all disputes, claims, and actions arising from or in connection with the Data provided to you hereunder. 199 Unicode NOTICE OF USE CONTRACTOR (MANUFACTURER/ SUPPLIER) Copyright © 1991-2010 Unicode, Inc. All rights reserved. Distributed under the Terms of Use in http://www.unicode.org/ copyright.html. Free Type Project CONTRACTOR (MANUFACTURER/SUPPLIER) Portions of this software are copyright © 2010 The FreeType Project (http://www.freetype.org). All rights reserved. Government End Users ADDRESS: Open Source SW If the Data is being acquired by or on behalf of the United States government or any other entity seeking or applying rights similar to those customarily claimed by the United States government, this Data is a “commercial item” as that term is defined at 48 C.F.R. (“FAR”) 2.101, is licensed in accordance with this End User License Agreement, and each copy of Data delivered or otherwise furnished shall be marked and embedded as appropriate with the following “Notice of Use,” and be treated in accordance with such Notice: 425 West Randolph Street, Chicago, IL 60606. Further information concerning the OSS licenses is shown in the infotainment display. NAME: HERE North America, LLC This Data is a commercial item as defined in FAR 2.101 and is subject to the End User License Agreement under which this Data was provided. © 2014 HERE North America, LLC. All rights reserved. If the Contracting Officer, federal government agency, or any federal official refuses to use the legend provided herein, QNX Portions of this software are copyright © 2008-2011, QNX Software Systems. All rights reserved. Part C – EULA Copyright © 2011, Software Systems GmbH & Co. KG. All Rights Reserved. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 200 Infotainment System The product you have purchased ("Product") contains Software (Runtime Configuration No. 505962; "Software") which is distributed by or on behalf of the Product manufacturer "Manufacturer") under license from Software Systems Co. ("QSSC"). You may only use the Software in the Product and in compliance with the license terms below. Subject to the terms and conditions of this License, QSSC hereby grants you a limited, non-exclusive, non-transferable license to use the Software in the Product for the purpose intended by the Manufacturer. If permitted by the Manufacturer, or by applicable law, you may make one backup copy of the Software as part of the Product software. QSSC and its licensors reserve all license+C31 rights not expressly granted herein, and retain all right, title and interest in and to all copies of the Software, including all intellectual property rights therein. Unless required by applicable law you may not reproduce, distribute or transfer, or de-compile, disassemble or otherwise attempt to unbundle, reverse engineer, modify or create derivative works of, the Software. You agree: (1) not to remove, cover or alter any proprietary notices, labels or marks in or on the Software, and to ensure that all copies bear any notice contained on the original; and (2) not to export the Product or the Software in contravention of applicable export control laws. EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT OTHERWISE REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW, QSSC AND ITS LICENSORS PROVIDE THE SOFTWARE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS, WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, ANY WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF TITLE, NON-INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. ANY WARRANTIES OR OTHER PROVISIONS OFFERED BY THE MANUFACTURER OR ITS DISTRIBUTOR(S) THAT DIFFER FROM THIS LICENSE ARE OFFERED BY THE MANUFACTURER OR ITS DISTRIBUTOR(S) ALONE AND NOT BY QSSC, ITS AFFILIATES OR THEIR LICENSORS. YOU ASSUME ANY RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH YOUR USE OF THE SOFTWARE UNDER THIS LICENSE. EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT OTHERWISE REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW (SUCH AS IN THE CASE OF DELIBERATE OR GROSSLY NEGLIGENT ACTS), IN NO EVENT SHALL QSSC, ITS AFFILIATES OR THEIR LICENSORS BE LIABLE TO YOU UNDER ANY LEGAL THEORY, WHETHER IN TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), CONTRACT OR OTHERWISE, FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY CHARACTER ARISING AS A RESULT OF THIS LICENSE OR OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PRODUCT (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF GOODWILL, WORK STOPPAGE, PRODUCT FAILURE OR MALFUNCTION, OR ANY AND ALL OTHER COMMERCIAL DAMAGES OR LOSSES), EVEN IF QSSC, ITS AFFILIATES OR THEIR LICENSORS HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. WMA This product is protected by certain intellectual property rights of Microsoft. Use or distribution of such technology outside of this product is prohibited without a license from Microsoft. For more information on the Software, including any open source software license terms (and available source code) as well as copyright attributions applicable to the Runtime Configuration indicated above, please contact the Manufacturer or contact QSSC at 175 Terence Matthews Crescent, Kanata, Ontario, Canada K2M 1W8 ([email protected]). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Infotainment System Linotype Helvetica is a trademark of Linotype Corp. registered in the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office and may be registered in certain other jurisdictions in the name of Linotype Corp. or its licensee Linotype GmbH. Usage in text form of each of the Licensed Trademarks is: The trademark attribution requirements for the Licensed Trademarks may be viewed at http://www.linotype.com/2061-19414/ trademarks.html. END USER NOTICE The marks of companies displayed by this product to indicate business locations are the marks of their respective owners. The use of such marks in this product does not imply any sponsorship, approval, or endorsement by such companies of this product. 201 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 202 Climate Controls Climate Controls Climate Control Systems Climate Control Systems The heating, cooling, and ventilation in the vehicle can be controlled with this system. Climate Control Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 Dual Automatic Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Air Vents Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 Maintenance Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . 207 Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Fan Control MAX Defrost Air Delivery Mode Controls A/C (Air Conditioning) TEMP (Temperature Control) Recirculation Rear Window Defogger (If Equipped) or Heated Mirrors (If Equipped) 9 : Turn clockwise or counterclockwise to increase or decrease the fan speed. Turn the knob all the way counterclockwise to turn the fan off. TEMP : Turn clockwise or counterclockwise to increase or decrease the temperature inside the vehicle. Air Delivery Mode Controls : Press z, Y, or [ to change the direction of the airflow. Any combination of the three controls can be selected. An indicator light comes on in the selected mode button. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Climate Controls To change the current mode, select one or more of the following. An indicator light will illuminate: z : Air is directed to the windshield, outboard a/c outlets, and side window outlets. Y : Air is directed to the a/c outlets. [ : Air is directed to the floor outlets, with some air directed to the windshield, outboard a/c outlets, and side window outlets. 0 MAX : Air is directed to the windshield and the fan runs at a higher speed if not already above a medium fan speed. This mode overrides the previous mode selected and clears fog or frost from the windshield more quickly. When the control is pressed again, the system returns to the previous mode setting and fan speed. For best results, clear all snow and ice from the windshield before defrosting. @ : Press to turn on recirculation. An indicator light comes on. Air is recirculated to quickly cool the inside of the vehicle. It can also be used to help reduce outside air and odors that enter the vehicle. Avoid using recirculation for long periods of time in cold or damp conditions. Using recirculation in cold or damp conditions can result in window fogging. A/C : Press to turn the air conditioning on or off. An indicator light comes on to show that the air conditioning is enabled. If the fan is turned off, the air conditioner will not run. The A/C light will stay on even if the outside temperatures are below freezing. Rear Window Defogger 1 REAR : If equipped, press to turn the rear window defogger on or off. An indicator light on the button comes on to show that the rear window defogger is on. 203 The rear window defogger only works when the engine is running. The defogger turns off if the ignition is turned off or to ACC/ ACCESSORY. If equipped with heated outside mirrors, press f to turn them on or off. See Heated Mirrors 0 37. Caution Using a razor blade or sharp object to clear the inside rear window can damage the rear window defogger. Repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not clear the inside rear window with sharp objects. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 204 Climate Controls Dual Automatic Climate Control System Climate Control Display The heating, cooling, and ventilation in the vehicle can be controlled with this system. 1. Driver and Passenger Temperature Controls 2. MAX Defrost 3. Air Delivery Mode Controls 4. A/C (Air Conditioning) 5. SYNC (Synchronized Temperature) 6. 7. 8. 9. Recirculation Power Button Fan Control Rear Window Defogger (If Equipped) or Heated Mirrors (If Equipped) 10. AUTO (Automatic Operation) 1. Driver and Passenger Temperature Settings 2. Fan Control 3. Driver and Passenger Temperature Controls 4. Sync (Synchronized Temperature) 5. Recirculation 6. Air Delivery Mode Controls 7. Auto (Automatic Operation) 8. A/C (Air Conditioning) 9. On/Off (Power) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Climate Controls The fan, air delivery mode, air conditioning, driver and passenger temperatures, and Sync settings can be controlled by touching CLIMATE on the infotainment Home Page or the climate button in the climate control display application tray. A selection can then be made on the front climate control page displayed. Climate Control Status Display The climate control status display appears briefly when the center stack climate controls are adjusted. Automatic Operation The system automatically controls the fan speed, air delivery, air conditioning, and recirculation in order to heat or cool the vehicle to the desired temperature. When AUTO is lit, all four functions operate automatically. Each function can also be manually set and the selected setting is displayed. Functions not manually set will continue to be automatically controlled, even if the AUTO indicator is not lit. 205 selected, a small amount of air may still come out of the outlets depending on vehicle speed. If any buttons are pressed or knobs are turned, the climate control system will turn on and operate at the current setting. Press AUTO to return to automatic operation. Driver and Passenger Temperature Control : The temperature can be adjusted separately for the driver and passenger. For automatic operation: 1. Press AUTO. 2. Set the temperature. Allow the system time to stabilize. Adjust the temperature as needed for best comfort. Turn the knob clockwise or counterclockwise to increase or decrease the driver or passenger temperature setting. The driver side or passenger side temperature display shows the temperature setting increasing or decreasing. To improve fuel efficiency and to cool the vehicle faster, recirculation may be automatically selected in warm weather. SYNC : Press to link the passenger temperature setting to the driver setting. The SYNC indicator light will turn on. When the passenger setting is adjusted, the SYNC indicator light will turn off. The recirculation light will not come on when automatically controlled. See @ under “Manual Operation” for more details. Manual Operation 9 : Turn clockwise or counterclockwise to increase or decrease the fan speed. Press the knob to turn the fan off. When off is Air Delivery Mode Control : Press z, Y, or [ to change the direction of the airflow. Any combination of the three controls can be selected. An indicator light comes on in the selected mode button. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 206 Climate Controls Changing the mode cancels the automatic operation and the system goes into manual mode. Press AUTO to return to automatic operation. To change the current mode, select one or more of the following: z : Air is directed to the windshield, outboard a/c outlets, and side window outlets. Y : Air is directed to the a/c outlets. [ : Air is directed to the floor outlets, with some air directed to the windshield, outboard a/c outlets, and side window outlets. 0 MAX : Air is directed to the windshield and the fan runs at a higher speed if not already above a medium fan speed. This mode overrides the previous mode selected and clears fog or frost from the windshield more quickly. When the control is pressed again, the system returns to the previous mode setting and fan speed. For best results, clear all snow and ice from the windshield before defrosting. @ : Press to turn on recirculation. An indicator light comes on. Air is recirculated to quickly cool the inside of the vehicle. It can also be used to help reduce outside air and odors that enter the vehicle. Avoid using recirculation for long periods of time in cold or damp conditions. Using recirculation in cold or damp conditions can result in window fogging. A/C : Press to turn the air conditioning on or off. An indicator light comes on to show that the air conditioning is enabled. If the fan is turned off, the air conditioner will not run. The A/C light will stay on even if the outside temperatures are below freezing. Rear Window Defogger 1 REAR : If equipped, press to turn the rear window defogger on or off. An indicator light on the button comes on to show that the rear window defogger is on. The rear window defogger only works when the engine is running. The defogger turns off if the ignition is turned off or to ACC/ ACCESSORY. If equipped with heated outside mirrors, press f to turn them on or off. See Heated Mirrors 0 37. Caution Using a razor blade or sharp object to clear the inside rear window can damage the rear window defogger. Repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not clear the inside rear window with sharp objects. Remote Start Climate Control Operation : If equipped with remote start, the climate control system may run when the vehicle is started remotely. If equipped with heated or ventilated seats or a heated steering wheel, these features may come on during a remote start. See Remote Vehicle Start 0 20, Heated and Ventilated Front Seats 0 53, and Heated Steering Wheel 0 101. Sensors Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Climate Controls The solar sensor, on top of the instrument panel near the windshield, monitors the solar heat. The climate control system uses the sensor information to adjust the temperature, fan speed, recirculation, and air delivery mode for best comfort. Do not cover the sensor; otherwise the automatic climate control system may not work properly. Afterblow Feature If equipped, under certain conditions, the fan may stay on or may turn on and off several times after you turn off and lock the vehicle. This is normal. Air Vents Use the sliding knobs on the center and side air vents to change the direction of the airflow. Air vents blow warm air on the side windows in cold weather. If Floor, Defog, or Defrost modes are selected, a small amount of air will come from the vents close to the window. To close the front a/c vents, move the sliding knobs to the full down position. To close the rear a/c vents, move the sliding knobs to the full inboard position. Operation Tips . Clear away any ice, snow, or leaves from air inlets at the base of the windshield that could block the flow of air into the vehicle. . Clear snow off the hood to improve visibility and help decrease moisture drawn into the vehicle. . Keep the path under the front seats clear of objects to help circulate the air inside of the vehicle more effectively. . Use of non-GM approved hood deflectors can adversely affect the performance of the system. Check with your dealer before adding equipment to the outside of the vehicle. . Do not attach any devices to the air vent slats. This will restrict airflow and may cause damage to the air vents. Maintenance Passenger Compartment Air Filter The filter reduces the dust, pollen, and other airborne irritants from outside air that is pulled into the vehicle. 207 The filter should be replaced as part of routine scheduled maintenance. See Maintenance Schedule 0 392. To find out what type of filter to use, see Maintenance Replacement Parts 0 402. 1. Open the lower glove box door completely. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 208 Climate Controls 3. Press the sides of the glove box door inward and rotate the door downward to remove. 2. Push the dampener arm to the left until it releases the glovebox. 4. Pull lever on left side of the filter door and slide left, then remove the door. Remove the old filter. 5. Install the new air filter. 6. Reinstall the filter door. 7. Reverse the steps to reinstall the glove box. See your dealer if additional assistance is needed. Service All vehicles have a label underhood that identifies the refrigerant used in the vehicle. The refrigerant system should only be serviced by trained and certified technicians. The air conditioning evaporator should never be repaired or replaced by one from a salvage vehicle. It should only be replaced by a new evaporator to ensure proper and safe operation. During service, all refrigerants should be reclaimed with proper equipment. Venting refrigerants directly to the atmosphere is harmful to the environment and may also create unsafe conditions based on inhalation, combustion, frostbite, or other health-based concerns. The air conditioning system requires periodic maintenance. See Maintenance Schedule 0 392. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Driving and Operating Driving Information Driving for Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . 210 Distracted Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Impaired Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Off-Road Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 Driving on Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 If the Vehicle Is Stuck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Vehicle Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Truck-Camper Loading Information . . . . . 225 Starting and Operating New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Ignition Positions (Key Access) . . . . . . . . . 227 Ignition Positions (Keyless Access) . . . . . 229 Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 Engine Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Retained Accessory Power (RAP) . . . . . . . 232 Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Shifting out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Parking over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . 234 Extended Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Engine Exhaust Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . 235 Automatic Transmission Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Tow/Haul Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Drive Systems Four-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Brakes Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . 244 Electric Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 Brake Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Ride Control Systems Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Hill Descent Control (HDC) . . . . . . . . . . . . 248 Driver Mode Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Locking Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 Cruise Control Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 Driver Assistance Systems Driver Assistance Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 209 Assistance Systems for Parking or Backing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 Rear Vision Camera (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 Surround Vision System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 Assistance Systems for Driving . . . . . . . . 263 Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 Automatic Emergency Braking (AEB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) . . . . . . . . . . 266 Lane Change Alert (LCA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Lane Departure Warning (LDW) . . . . . . . 268 Fuel Top Tier Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Recommended Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Prohibited Fuels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Fuel Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 E85 or FlexFuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Filling the Tank (Pickup Models) . . . . . . . 271 Filling the Tank (Chassis Cab and Box Delete Models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . 273 Trailer Towing General Towing Information . . . . . . . . . . . 273 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 210 Driving and Operating Driving Characteristics and Towing Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Towing Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Trailer Sway Control (TSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 Trailering App . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 Conversions and Add-Ons Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . 303 Adding a Snow Plow or Similar Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 Pickup Conversion to Chassis Cab . . . . . 305 Driving Information Distracted Driving Driving for Better Fuel Economy Distraction comes in many forms and can take your focus from the task of driving. Exercise good judgment and do not let other activities divert your attention away from the road. Many local governments have enacted laws regarding driver distraction. Become familiar with the local laws in your area. Driving habits can affect fuel mileage. Here are some driving tips to get the best fuel economy possible: . Set the climate controls to the desired temperature after the engine is started, or turn them off when not required. . Avoid fast starts and accelerate smoothly. . Brake gradually and avoid abrupt stops. . Avoid idling the engine for long periods of time. . When road and weather conditions are appropriate, use cruise control. . Always follow posted speed limits or drive more slowly when conditions require. . Keep vehicle tires properly inflated. . Combine several trips into a single trip. . Replace the vehicle's tires with the same TPC Spec number molded into the tire's sidewall near the size. . Follow recommended scheduled maintenance. To avoid distracted driving, keep your eyes on the road, keep your hands on the steering wheel, and focus your attention on driving. . Do not use a phone in demanding driving situations. Use a hands-free method to place or receive necessary phone calls. . Watch the road. Do not read, take notes, or look up information on phones or other electronic devices. . Designate a front seat passenger to handle potential distractions. . Become familiar with vehicle features before driving, such as programming favorite radio stations and adjusting climate control and seat settings. Program all trip information into any navigation device prior to driving. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating . Wait until the vehicle is parked to . Assume that other road users retrieve items that have fallen to the floor. . Stop or park the vehicle to tend to children. . Keep pets in an appropriate carrier or restraint. . Avoid stressful conversations while driving, whether with a passenger or on a cell phone. (pedestrians, bicyclists, and other drivers) are going to be careless and make mistakes. Anticipate what they may do and be ready. . Allow enough following distance between you and the driver in front of you. . Focus on the task of driving. { Warning Taking your eyes off the road too long or too often could cause a crash resulting in injury or death. Focus your attention on driving. Refer to the infotainment section for more information on using that system and the navigation system, if equipped, including pairing and using a cell phone. Defensive Driving Defensive driving means “always expect the unexpected.” The first step in driving defensively is to wear the seat belt. See Seat Belts 0 55. Impaired Driving Death and injury associated with impaired driving is a global tragedy. { Warning Drinking alcohol or taking drugs and then driving is very dangerous. Your reflexes, perceptions, attentiveness, and judgment can be affected by even a small amount of alcohol or drugs. You can have a serious — or even fatal — collision if you drive after drinking or taking drugs. Do not drive while under the influence of alcohol or drugs, or ride with a driver who has been drinking or is impaired by drugs. Find alternate transportation home; or if you are with a group, designate a driver who will remain sober. 211 Control of a Vehicle Braking, steering, and accelerating are important factors in helping to control a vehicle while driving. Braking Braking action involves perception time and reaction time. Deciding to push the brake pedal is perception time. Actually doing it is reaction time. Average driver reaction time is about three-quarters of a second. In that time, a vehicle moving at 100 km/h (60 mph) travels 20 m (66 ft), which could be a lot of distance in an emergency. Helpful braking tips to keep in mind include: . Keep enough distance between you and the vehicle in front of you. . Avoid needless heavy braking. . Keep pace with traffic. If the engine ever stops or a brake fault occurs, the brakes may lose power assist. More effort will be required to stop the vehicle. It may take longer to stop. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 212 Driving and Operating Steering Caution To avoid damage to the steering system, do not drive over curbs, parking barriers, or similar objects at speeds greater than 3 km/h (1 mph). Use care when driving over other objects such as lane dividers and speed bumps. Damage caused by misuse of the vehicle is not covered by the vehicle warranty. Hydraulic Power Steering (2500/3500 Series) (2500/3500 Series – All Regular Cab, Double Cab/Crew Cab with Base Interior) The power steering system may require maintenance. See Power Steering Fluid 0 320. If power steering assist is lost because the engine stops or the system malfunctions, the vehicle can be steered but may require increased effort. See your dealer. (2500/3500 Series – Double Cab/Crew Cab with Uplevel Interior) The vehicle has a power steering system that varies the amount of effort required to steer the vehicle. Less steering effort is required at slower speeds. At faster speeds, the required steering effort increases. The system helps the steering wheel return to center at low speeds. Pressing the Tow/Haul mode button adjusts steering effort for driving conditions described in Tow/Haul Mode 0 240. The power steering system may require maintenance. See Power Steering Fluid 0 320. If power steering assist is lost because the engine stops or the system malfunctions, the vehicle can be steered but may require increased effort. See your dealer. { Warning Do not hold the brake pedal and press the accelerator pedal at the same time. Damage may occur to the power steering and power brake systems which could lead to reduced performance, up to and including loss of steering and brake assist. Caution Do not hold the steering wheel at full rotation for more than 15 seconds and/or at an elevated RPM. Damage may occur to the power steering system and there may be loss of power steering assist. Curve Tips . Take curves at a reasonable speed. . Reduce speed before entering a curve. . Maintain a reasonable steady speed through the curve. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating . Wait until the vehicle is out of the curve around a problem may be more effective than braking. . Holding both sides of the steering wheel allows you to turn 180 degrees without removing a hand. . Antilock Brake System (ABS) allows steering while braking. The vehicle's right wheels can drop off the edge of a road onto the shoulder while driving. Follow these tips: 1. Ease off the accelerator and then, if there is nothing in the way, steer the vehicle so that it straddles the edge of the pavement. 2. Turn the steering wheel about one-eighth of a turn, until the right front tire contacts the pavement edge. 3. Turn the steering wheel to go straight down the roadway. Off-Road Recovery Loss of Control before accelerating gently into the straightaway. Steering in Emergencies . There are some situations when steering Skidding There are three types of skids that correspond to the vehicle's three control systems: . Braking Skid — wheels are not rolling. . Steering or Cornering Skid — too much speed or steering in a curve causes tires to slip and lose cornering force. . Acceleration Skid — too much throttle causes the driving wheels to spin. 213 Defensive drivers avoid most skids by taking reasonable care suited to existing conditions, and by not overdriving those conditions. But skids are always possible. If the vehicle starts to slide, follow these suggestions: . Ease your foot off the accelerator pedal and steer the way you want the vehicle to go. The vehicle may straighten out. Be ready for a second skid if it occurs. . Slow down and adjust your driving according to weather conditions. Stopping distance can be longer and vehicle control can be affected when traction is reduced by water, snow, ice, gravel, or other material on the road. Learn to recognize warning clues — such as enough water, ice, or packed snow on the road to make a mirrored surface — and slow down when you have any doubt. . Try to avoid sudden steering, acceleration, or braking, including reducing vehicle speed by shifting to a lower gear. Any sudden changes could cause the tires to slide. Remember: Antilock brakes help avoid only the braking skid. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 214 Driving and Operating Off-Road Driving Four-wheel-drive vehicles can be used for off-road driving. Vehicles without four-wheel drive and vehicles not equipped with All Terrain (AT) or On-Off Road (OOR) tires must not be driven off-road except on a level, solid surface. For contact information about the original equipment tires, see the warranty manual. One of the best ways for successful off-road driving is to control the speed. { Warning When driving off-road, bouncing and quick changes in direction can easily throw you out of position. This could cause you to lose control and crash. You and your passengers should always wear seat belts. Before Driving Off-Road . Have all necessary maintenance and service work completed. . Fuel the vehicle, fill fluid levels, and check inflation pressure in all tires, including the spare, if equipped. . Read all the information about four-wheel-drive vehicles in this manual. . Remove any underbody air deflector, if equipped. Re-attach the air deflector after off-road driving. . Know the local laws that apply to off-road driving. To gain more ground clearance if needed, it may be necessary to remove the front fascia lower air dam, if equipped. However, driving without the air dam reduces fuel economy. Caution Warning (Continued) . Keep cargo in the cargo area as far forward and as low as possible. The heaviest things should be on the floor, forward of the rear axle. . Heavy loads on the roof raise the vehicle's center of gravity, making it more likely to roll over. You can be seriously or fatally injured if the vehicle rolls over. Put heavy loads inside the cargo area, not on the roof. Operating the vehicle for extended periods without the front fascia lower air dam installed can cause improper airflow to the engine. Reattach the front fascia air dam after off-road driving. For more information about loading the vehicle, see Vehicle Load Limits 0 220 and Tires 0 344. Loading the Vehicle for Off-Road Driving . Always use established trails, roads, and { Warning . Unsecured cargo on the load floor can be tossed about when driving over rough terrain. You or your passengers can be struck by flying objects. Secure the cargo properly. (Continued) Environmental Concerns areas that have been set aside for public off-road recreational driving and obey all posted regulations. . Do not damage shrubs, flowers, trees, or grasses or disturb wildlife. . Do not park over things that burn. See Parking over Things That Burn 0 234. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Driving on Hills Driving safely on hills requires good judgment and an understanding of what the vehicle can and cannot do. { Warning Many hills are simply too steep for any vehicle. Driving up hills can cause the vehicle to stall. Driving down hills can cause loss of control. Driving across hills can cause a rollover. You could be injured or killed. Do not drive on steep hills. Before driving on a hill, assess the steepness, traction, and obstructions. If the terrain ahead cannot be seen, get out of the vehicle and walk the hill before driving further. When driving on hills: . Use a low gear and keep a firm grip on the steering wheel. . Maintain a slow speed. . When possible, drive straight up or down the hill. . Slow down when approaching the top of the hill. . Use headlamps even during the day to make the vehicle more visible. { Warning Driving to the top of a hill at high speed can cause a crash. There could be a drop-off, embankment, cliff, or even another vehicle. You could be seriously injured or killed. As you near the top of a hill, slow down and stay alert. . Never go downhill forward or backward with either the transmission or transfer case in N (Neutral). The brakes could overheat and you could lose control. { Warning If the vehicle has the two-speed automatic transfer case, shifting the transfer case to N (Neutral) can cause your vehicle to roll even if the transmission is in P (Park). This is because the N (Neutral) position on the transfer case overrides the transmission. You or someone else could be injured. If leaving the vehicle, set the parking brake and shift the transmission to P (Park). Shift the transfer case to any position but N (Neutral). 215 . When driving down a hill, keep the vehicle headed straight down. Use a low gear because the engine will work with the brakes to slow the vehicle and help keep the vehicle under control. { Warning Heavy braking when going down a hill can cause your brakes to overheat and fade. This could cause loss of control and you or others could be injured or killed. Apply the brakes lightly when descending a hill and use a low gear to keep vehicle speed under control. If a brake fade condition is detected, a DIC warning message is displayed. Adjust brake pedal use and shift to a lower transmission gear to reduce braking. If the brakes continue to fade to a severe condition, additional DIC messages are displayed. The brake system warning light will illuminate, and the vehicle speed may be limited. See Brake System Warning Light 0 117. If the vehicle stalls on a hill: 1. Apply the brakes to stop the vehicle, and then apply the parking brake. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 216 Driving and Operating 2. Shift into P (Park) and then restart the engine. . If driving uphill when the vehicle stalls, shift to R (Reverse), release the parking brake, and back straight down. . Never try to turn the vehicle around. If the hill is steep enough to stall the vehicle, it is steep enough to cause it to roll over. . If you cannot make it up the hill, back straight down the hill. . Never back down a hill in N (Neutral) using only the brake. The vehicle can roll backward quickly and you could lose control. . If driving downhill when the vehicle stalls, shift to a lower gear, release the parking brake, and drive straight down the hill. 3. If the vehicle cannot be restarted after stalling, set the parking brake, shift into P (Park), and turn the vehicle off. 3.1. Leave the vehicle and seek help. 3.2. Stay clear of the path the vehicle would take if it rolled downhill. . Avoid turns that take the vehicle across the incline of the hill. A hill that can be driven straight up or down might be too steep to drive across. Driving across an incline puts more weight on the downhill wheels, which could cause a downhill slide or a rollover. . Surface conditions can be a problem. Loose gravel, muddy spots, or even wet grass can cause the tires to slip sideways, downhill. If the vehicle slips sideways, it can hit something that will trip it — a rock, a rut, etc. — and roll over. . Hidden obstacles can make the steepness of the incline more severe. If a rock is driven across with the uphill wheels, or if the downhill wheels drop into a rut or depression, the vehicle can tilt even more. . If an incline must be driven across, and the vehicle starts to slide, turn downhill. This should help straighten out the vehicle and prevent the side slipping. { Warning Getting out of the vehicle on the downhill side when stopped across an incline is dangerous. If the vehicle rolls over, you could be crushed or killed. (Continued) Warning (Continued) Always get out on the uphill side of the vehicle and stay well clear of the rollover path. Driving in Mud, Sand, Snow, or Ice Use a low gear when driving in mud — the deeper the mud, the lower the gear. Keep the vehicle moving to avoid getting stuck. Traction changes when driving on sand. On loose sand, such as on beaches or sand dunes, the tires tend to sink into the sand. This affects steering, accelerating, and braking. Drive at a reduced speed and avoid sharp turns or abrupt maneuvers. Traction is reduced on hard packed snow and ice and it is easy to lose control. Reduce vehicle speed when driving on hard packed snow and ice. { Warning Driving on frozen lakes, ponds, or rivers can be dangerous. Ice conditions vary greatly and the vehicle could fall through (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Warning (Continued) the ice; you and your passengers could drown. Drive your vehicle on safe surfaces only. Driving in Water under water. Do not turn off the ignition when driving through water. If the exhaust pipe is under water, the engine will not start. When going through water, the brakes get wet and it may take longer to stop. See “Driving on Wet Roads” later in this section. After Off-Road Driving { Warning Driving through rushing water can be dangerous. Deep water can sweep your vehicle downstream and you and your passengers could drown. If it is only shallow water, it can still wash away the ground from under your tires. Traction could be lost, and the vehicle could roll over. Do not drive through rushing water. Caution Do not drive through standing water if it is deep enough to cover the wheel hubs, axles, or exhaust pipe. Deep water can damage the axle and other vehicle parts. If the standing water is not too deep, drive through it slowly. At faster speeds, water can get into the engine and cause it to stall. Stalling can occur if the exhaust pipe is Remove any brush or debris that has collected on the underbody or chassis, or under the hood. These accumulations can be a fire hazard. Re-install underbody air deflector and air dam if removed. After operation in mud or sand, have the brake linings cleaned and checked. These substances can cause glazing and uneven braking. Check the body structure, driveline, steering, suspension, wheels, tires, and exhaust system for damage and check the fuel lines and cooling system for any leakage. More frequent maintenance service is required. See the Maintenance Schedule 0 392. Driving on Wet Roads Rain and wet roads can reduce vehicle traction and affect your ability to stop and accelerate. Always drive slower in these 217 types of driving conditions and avoid driving through large puddles and deep-standing or flowing water. { Warning Wet brakes can cause crashes. They might not work as well in a quick stop and could cause pulling to one side. You could lose control of the vehicle. After driving through a large puddle of water or a car/vehicle wash, lightly apply the brake pedal until the brakes work normally. Flowing or rushing water creates strong forces. Driving through flowing water could cause the vehicle to be carried away. If this happens, you and other vehicle occupants could drown. Do not ignore police warnings and be very cautious about trying to drive through flowing water. Hydroplaning Hydroplaning is dangerous. Water can build up under the vehicle's tires so they actually ride on the water. This can happen if the Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 218 Driving and Operating road is wet enough and you are going fast enough. When the vehicle is hydroplaning, it has little or no contact with the road. There is no hard and fast rule about hydroplaning. The best advice is to slow down when the road is wet. Other Rainy Weather Tips Besides slowing down, other wet weather driving tips include: . Allow extra following distance. . Pass with caution. . Keep windshield wiping equipment in good shape. . Keep the windshield washer fluid reservoir filled. . Have good tires with proper tread depth. See Tires 0 344. . Turn off cruise control. Hill and Mountain Roads Driving on steep hills or through mountains is different than driving on flat or rolling terrain. Tips include: . Keep the vehicle serviced and in good shape. . Check all fluid levels and brakes, tires, cooling system, and transmission. . Shift to a lower gear when going down steep or long hills. { Warning Using the brakes to slow the vehicle on a long downhill slope can cause brake overheating, can reduce brake performance, and could result in a loss of braking. Shift the transmission to a lower gear to let the engine assist the brakes on a steep downhill slope. { Warning Coasting downhill in N (Neutral) or with the ignition off is dangerous. This can cause overheating of the brakes and loss of steering assist. Always have the engine running and the vehicle in gear. . Drive at speeds that keep the vehicle in its own lane. Do not swing wide or cross the center line. . Be alert on top of hills; something could be in your lane (e.g., stalled car, crash). . Pay attention to special road signs (e.g., falling rocks area, winding roads, long grades, passing or no-passing zones) and take appropriate action. Winter Driving Driving on Snow or Ice Caution To avoid damage to the wheels and brake components, always clear snow and ice from inside the wheels and underneath the vehicle before driving. Snow or ice between the tires and the road creates less traction or grip, so drive carefully. Wet ice can occur at about 0 °C (32 °F) when freezing rain begins to fall. Avoid driving on wet ice or in freezing rain until roads can be treated. For Slippery Road Driving: . Accelerate gently. Accelerating too quickly causes the wheels to spin and makes the surface under the tires slick. . Turn on Traction Control. See Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control 0 247. . The Antilock Brake System (ABS) improves vehicle stability during hard stops, but the brakes should be applied sooner than when on dry pavement. See Antilock Brake System (ABS) 0 244. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating . Allow greater following distance and watch for slippery spots. Icy patches can occur on otherwise clear roads in shaded areas. The surface of a curve or an overpass can remain icy when the surrounding roads are clear. Avoid sudden steering maneuvers and braking while on ice. . Turn off cruise control. Blizzard Conditions Stop the vehicle in a safe place and signal for help. Stay with the vehicle unless there is help nearby. If possible, use Roadside Assistance. See Roadside Assistance Program 0 412. To get help and keep everyone in the vehicle safe: . Turn on the hazard warning flashers. . Tie a red cloth to an outside mirror. { Warning Snow can trap engine exhaust under the vehicle. This may cause exhaust gases to get inside. Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide (CO), which cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause unconsciousness and even death. (Continued) 219 If the vehicle is stuck in snow: charged to restart the vehicle and to signal for help with the headlamps. Do this as little as possible, to save fuel. . Clear snow from the base of the If the Vehicle Is Stuck Warning (Continued) vehicle, especially any blocking the exhaust pipe. . Open a window about 5 cm (2 in) on the vehicle side that is away from the wind, to bring in fresh air. . Fully open the air outlets on or under the instrument panel. . Adjust the climate control system to circulate the air inside the vehicle and set the fan speed to the highest setting. See “Climate Control Systems.” For more information about CO, see Engine Exhaust 0 235. To save fuel, run the engine for short periods to warm the vehicle and then shut the engine off and partially close the window. Moving about to keep warm also helps. If it takes time for help to arrive, when running the engine, push the accelerator pedal slightly so the engine runs faster than the idle speed. This keeps the battery Slowly and cautiously spin the wheels to free the vehicle when stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow. See “Rocking the Vehicle to Get It Out” later in this section. The Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control can often help to free a stuck vehicle. See Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control 0 247. If TC/ESC cannot free the vehicle, see “Rocking the Vehicle to Get it Out” following. { Warning If the vehicle's tires spin at high speed, they can explode, and you or others could be injured. The vehicle can overheat, causing an engine compartment fire or other damage. Spin the wheels as little as possible and avoid going above 56 km/h (35 mph). For information about using tire chains on the vehicle, see Tire Chains 0 362. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 220 Driving and Operating Rocking the Vehicle to Get It Out Caution Do not hold the steering wheel at full rotation for more than 15 seconds and/or at an elevated RPM. Damage may occur to the power steering system and there may be loss of power steering assist. Turn the steering wheel left and right to clear the area around the front wheels. Then make sure the wheels are pointed straight ahead. For four-wheel-drive vehicles, shift into Four-Wheel Drive High. Turn the TCS off. Shift back and forth between R (Reverse) and a forward gear, spinning the wheels as little as possible. To prevent transmission wear, wait until the wheels stop spinning before shifting gears. Slowly spinning the wheels in the forward and reverse directions causes a rocking motion that could free the vehicle. If that does not get the vehicle out after a few tries, it might need to be towed out. See Towing the Vehicle 0 377. Recovery hooks can be used, if the vehicle has them. Recovery Hooks { Warning Never pull on recovery hooks from the side. The hooks could break and you and others could be injured. When using recovery hooks, always pull the vehicle from the front. Caution Never use recovery hooks to tow the vehicle. The vehicle could be damaged, and the repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. If equipped, there are recovery hooks at the front of the vehicle. Use them if the vehicle is stuck off-road and needs to be pulled some place to continue driving. Vehicle Load Limits It is very important to know how much weight the vehicle can carry. This weight is called the vehicle capacity weight and includes the weight of all occupants, cargo, and all nonfactory-installed options. Two labels on the vehicle may show how much weight it was designed to carry: the Tire and Loading Information label and the Certification/Tire label. { Warning Do not load the vehicle any heavier than the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR), or either the maximum front or rear Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). This can cause systems to break and change the way the vehicle handles. This could cause loss of control and a crash. (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Warning (Continued) Overloading can also reduce stopping performance, damage the tires, and shorten the life of the vehicle. Tire and Loading Information Label Label Example A vehicle-specific Tire and Loading Information label is attached to the center pillar (B-pillar). The Tire and Loading Information label shows the number of occupant seating positions (1), and the maximum vehicle capacity weight (2) in kilograms and pounds. The Tire and Loading Information label also shows the size of the original equipment tires (3) and the recommended cold tire inflation pressures (4). For more information on tires and inflation see Tires 0 344 and Tire Pressure 0 349. There is also important loading information on the vehicle Certification/ Tire label. It may show the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) and the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for the front and rear axles. See “Certification/Tire Label” later in this section. “Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit– 1. Locate the statement "The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs." on your vehicle’s placard. 2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle. 221 3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs. 4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the "XXX" amount equals 1400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1400-750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.) 5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4. 6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.” Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 222 Driving and Operating See Trailer Towing 0 278 for important information on towing a trailer, towing safety rules, and trailering tips. Example 1 1. Vehicle Capacity Weight for Example 1 = (453 kg) (1,000 lb) 2. Subtract Occupant Weight @ 68 kg (150 lb) × 2 = 136 kg (300 lb) 3. Available Occupant and Cargo Weight = 317 kg (700 lb) Example 2 Example 3 1. Vehicle Capacity Weight for Example 2 = 453 kg (1,000 lb) 2. Subtract Occupant Weight @ 68 kg (150 lb) × 5 = 340 kg (750 lb) 3. Available Cargo Weight = 113 kg (250 lb) 1. Vehicle Capacity Weight for Example 3 = 453 kg (1,000 lb) 2. Subtract Occupant Weight @ 91 kg (200 lb) × 5 = 453 kg (1,000 lb) 3. Available Cargo Weight = 0 kg (0 lb) Refer to the Tire and Loading Information label for specific information about the vehicle's capacity weight and seating positions. The combined weight of the driver, passengers, and cargo should never exceed the vehicle's capacity weight. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Certification/Tire Label the actual loads on the front and rear axles, weigh the vehicle at a weigh station. Your dealer can help with this. Be sure to spread the load equally on both sides of the centerline. The Certification/Tire label also contains important information about the Front Axle Reserve Capacity. See Adding a Snow Plow or Similar Equipment 0 303. { Warning A vehicle-specific Certification/Tire label is attached to the center pillar (B-pillar). The label may show the size of the vehicle's original tires and the inflation pressures needed to obtain the gross weight capacity of the vehicle. This is called Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR). The GVWR includes the weight of the vehicle, all occupants, fuel, and cargo. The Certification/Tire label also may show the maximum weights for the front and rear axles, called Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). To determine In the case of a sudden stop or collision, things carried in the bed of your truck could shift forward and come into the passenger area, injuring you and others. If you put things in the bed of your truck, you should make sure they are properly secured. Caution Overloading the vehicle may cause damage. Repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not overload the vehicle. 223 Using heavier suspension components to get added durability might not change the weight ratings. Ask your dealer to help load the vehicle the right way. { Warning Things you put inside the vehicle can strike and injure people in a sudden stop or turn, or in a crash. . Put things in the cargo area of the vehicle. Try to spread the weight evenly. . Never stack heavier things, like suitcases, inside the vehicle so that some of them are above the tops of the seats. . Do not leave an unsecured child restraint in the vehicle. . When you carry something inside the vehicle, secure it whenever you can. . Do not leave a seat folded down unless you need to. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 224 Driving and Operating There is also important loading information for off-road driving in this manual. See “Loading the Vehicle for Off-Road Driving“ under Off-Road Driving 0 214. Two-Tiered Loading Depending on the model of the pickup, an upper load platform can be created by positioning three or four 5 cm (2 in) by 15 cm (6 in) wooden planks across the width of the pickup box. The planks must be inserted in the pickup box depressions. When using this upper load platform, be sure the load is securely tied down to prevent it from shifting. The load's center of gravity should be positioned in a zone over the rear axle. The zone is located in the area between the front of each wheel well and the rear of each wheel well. The center of gravity height must not extend above the top of the pickup box flareboard. Any load that extends beyond the vehicle's taillamp area must be properly marked according to local laws and regulations. * Equipment Maximum Weight Ladder Rack and Cargo 340 kg (750 lb) Remember not to exceed the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) of the front or rear axle. Cross Toolbox and 181 kg (400 lb) Cargo Add-On Equipment When carrying removable items, a limit on how many people carried inside the vehicle may be necessary. Be sure to weigh the vehicle before buying and installing the new equipment. Side Boxes and Cargo 113 kg per side (250 lb per side) * The combined weight for all rail-mounted equipment should not exceed 454 kg (1,000 lb). Loading Points Caution Overloading the vehicle may cause damage. Repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not overload the vehicle. Remember not to exceed the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) of the front or rear axle. 1. Primary Load Points Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating 2. Secondary Load Areas 3. GM Approved Accessory Mounting Points Structural members (1) and (2) are included in the pickup box design. Additional accessories should use these load points. Depending on the accessory design, use a spacer under the accessory at the load points to remove gap. The holes for GM approved accessories (3) are not intended for aftermarket equipment. See www.gmupfitter.com for additional pickup box load bearing structural information. Truck-Camper Loading Information A vehicle-specific Truck-Camper Loading Information label is attached to the inside of the vehicle's glove box. This label indicates if a slide-in camper can be carried, how much of a load the vehicle can carry, and how to correctly spread out the load. It will help to match the right slide-in camper to the vehicle. Your dealer can help make a good vehicle-camper match and help determine the Cargo Weight Rating (CWR). 225 Refer to the Truck-Camper Loading Information label in the glove box for dimensions A and B as shown in the following illustration. When installing and loading a slide-in camper, check the manufacturer's instructions. When carrying a slide-in camper, the total cargo load of the vehicle is the weight of the camper plus: . Everything added to the camper after it left the factory. . Everything in the camper. . All the people inside. The CWR is the maximum weight of the load the vehicle can carry. It does not include the weight of the people inside. But, use about 68 kg (150 lb) for each seat. The total cargo load must not be more than the vehicle's CWR. Use the rear edge of the load floor for measurement purposes. The recommended location for the cargo center of gravity is in zone C for the CWR. It is the point where the mass of a body is concentrated and, if suspended at that point, would balance the front and rear. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 226 Driving and Operating Here is an example of proper truck and camper match: cargo load should not exceed the truck's cargo weight rating, and the camper's center of gravity (1) should fall within the truck's recommended center of gravity zone (2) when installed. Any accessories or other equipment that are added to the vehicle must be weighed. Then, subtract this extra weight from the CWR. This extra weight may shorten the center of gravity zone of the vehicle. 1. Camper Center of Gravity 2. Recommended Center of Gravity Location Zone When the truck is used to carry a slide-in camper, the total cargo load of the truck consists of the manufacturer's camper weight figure, the weight of installed additional camper equipment not included in the manufacturer's camper weight figure, the weight of camper cargo, and the weight of passengers in the camper. The total If the slide-in camper and its load weighs less than the CWR, the center of gravity zone for the vehicle may be larger. Secure loose items to prevent weight shifts that could affect the balance of the vehicle. When the truck-camper is loaded, drive to a scale and weigh on the front and on the rear wheels separately to determine axle loads. Individual axle loads should not exceed either of the gross axle weight ratings (GAWR). The total axle loads should not exceed the vehicle's gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR). These ratings are given on the Certification/Tire label attached to the B-pillar. See “Certification/Tire Label” under Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. If weight ratings are exceeded, move or remove items to bring all weights below the ratings. See your dealer for more information on curb weights, cargo weights, Cargo Weight Rating, and the correct center of gravity zone. Starting and Operating New Vehicle Break-In Caution The vehicle does not need an elaborate break-in. But it will perform better in the long run if you follow these guidelines: . Do not drive at any one constant speed, fast or slow, for the first 800 km (500 mi). Do not make full-throttle starts. Avoid downshifting to brake or slow the vehicle. (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Caution (Continued) . Avoid making hard stops for the first 300 km (200 mi) or so. During this time the new brake linings are not yet broken in. Hard stops with new linings can mean premature wear and earlier replacement. Follow this breaking-in guideline every time you get new brake linings. . Do not tow a trailer during break-in. See Trailer Towing 0 278 for the trailer towing capabilities of the vehicle and more information. Normal driving charges the vehicle’s battery to achieve the best operation of the vehicle, including fuel economy. Ignition Positions (Key Access) 227 0 (Stopping the Engine/LOCK/OFF) : This position turns off the vehicle. It also locks the ignition, the transmission, and the steering column, if equipped with a locking steering column. Following break-in, engine speed and load can be gradually increased. On new vehicles, the various mechanical and electrical systems experience a “break-in” period during the first 6,400 km (4,000 miles) of routine driving. As the vehicle is driven, the mechanical systems adjust to provide optimal fuel economy and transmission shift performance. Electrical systems will adapt and calibrate during the break-in period. A one-time occurrence of clicks and similar vehicle noises is normal during this process. 0. Stopping the Engine/LOCK/OFF 1. ACC/ACCESSORY 2. ON/RUN 3. START The ignition switch has four positions. To shift out of P (Park), the ignition must be ON/RUN and the brake pedal must be applied. To 1. 2. 3. turn off the vehicle: Make sure that the vehicle is stopped. Shift to P (Park). Continue to hold the brake pedal, then set the parking brake. See Electric Parking Brake 0 245. 4. Push the key all the way in toward the steering column, then turn the key to LOCK/OFF. 5. Remove the key. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 228 Driving and Operating 6. Release the brake pedal. See your dealer if the key can be removed in any other position. Retained Accessory Power (RAP) will remain active. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP) 0 232. A warning chime will sound when the driver door is opened and the key is in the ignition. If equipped with a locking steering column, the steering can bind with the front wheels turned off center, which may prevent key rotation out of LOCK/OFF. If this happens, move the steering wheel from right to left while turning the key to ACC/ACCESSORY. If this does not work, then the vehicle needs service. { Warning Turning off the vehicle while moving may cause loss of power assist in the brake and steering systems and disable the airbags. While driving, turn off the vehicle only in an emergency. In an emergency, if the vehicle cannot be pulled over and must be turned off while driving: 1. Push the key all the way in toward the steering column, then turn the key to ACC/ACCESSORY. 2. Brake using firm and steady pressure. Do not pump the brakes repeatedly. This may deplete power assist, requiring increased brake pedal force. 3. Shift the vehicle to N (Neutral). This can be done while the vehicle is moving. Continue braking and steer the vehicle to a safe location. 4. Come to a complete stop. 5. Shift to P (Park). 6. Push the key all the way in toward the steering column (1), then turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF (2). 7. Set the parking brake. See Electric Parking Brake 0 245. 8. Remove the key. 9. Release the brake pedal. Caution Use the correct key, make sure it is all the way in — or pushed all the way in toward the steering column when turning off the vehicle — and turn it only with your hand. 1 (ACC/ACCESSORY) : This position allows features such as the infotainment system to operate while the vehicle is off. It also unlocks the steering column, if equipped with a locking steering column. Use this position if the vehicle must be pushed or towed. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP) 0 232. From ON/RUN, push the key all the way in toward the steering column, then turn the key to ACC/ACCESSORY. If the key is left in ACC/ACCESSORY with the engine off, the battery could drain and the vehicle may not start. A warning chime will sound when the driver door is opened and the key is in the ignition. 2 (ON/RUN) : This position can be used to operate the electrical accessories and to display some instrument cluster warning and indicator lights. This position can also be used for service and diagnostics, and to verify the proper operation of the malfunction indicator lamp as may be required for emission inspection purposes. The switch stays in this position when the engine is running. The transmission is also unlocked in this position. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating If the key is left in ON/RUN with the engine off, the battery could drain and the vehicle may not start. 3 (START) : This is the position that starts the engine. When the engine starts, release the key. The ignition returns to ON/RUN for driving. Ignition Positions (Keyless Access) the Keyless Access system. See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Key Access) 0 10 or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation (Keyless Access) 0 13. To shift out of P (Park), the ignition must be on or in Service Mode, and the brake pedal must be applied. { Warning Turning off the vehicle while moving may cause loss of power assist in the brake and steering systems and disable the airbags. While driving, only shut the vehicle off in an emergency. Stopping the Engine/LOCK/OFF (No Indicator Lights) : When the vehicle is stopped, press ENGINE START/STOP once to turn the engine off. Vehicles equipped with Keyless Access have pushbutton starting. The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter must be in the vehicle for the system to operate. If the pushbutton start is not working, the vehicle may be near a strong radio antenna signal causing interference to If the vehicle is in P (Park), the ignition will turn off, and Retained Accessory Power (RAP) will remain active. See Retained Accessory Power (RAP) 0 232. If the vehicle is not in P (Park), the ignition will return to ACC/ACCESSORY and display the message SHIFT TO PARK in the Driver 229 Information Center (DIC). When the vehicle is shifted into P (Park), the ignition system will turn off. The vehicle may have an electric steering column lock. The lock is activated when the ignition is turned off and driver door is opened. A sound may be heard as the lock actuates or releases. The steering column lock may not release with the wheels turned off center. If this happens, the vehicle may not start. Move the steering wheel from left to right while attempting to start the vehicle. If this does not work, the vehicle needs service. Unless an emergency exists, do not turn the engine off when the vehicle is moving. This will cause a loss of power assist in the brake and steering systems and disable the airbags. If the vehicle must be shut off in an emergency: 1. If the vehicle cannot be pulled over, and must be shut off while driving, press and hold ENGINE START/STOP button for longer than two seconds, or press twice in five seconds. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 230 Driving and Operating 2. Brake using a firm and steady pressure. Do not pump the brakes repeatedly. This may deplete power assist, requiring increased brake pedal force. 3. Shift the vehicle to N (Neutral). This can be done while the vehicle is moving. After shifting to N (Neutral), firmly apply the brakes and steer the vehicle to a safe location. 4. Come to a complete stop, shift to P (Park), and make sure engine is off. The shift lever must be in P (Park) to turn the ignition off. 5. Set the parking brake. See Electric Parking Brake 0 245. { Warning Turning off the vehicle while moving may cause loss of power assist in the brake and steering systems and disable the airbags. While driving, only shut the vehicle off in an emergency. ACC/ACCESSORY (Amber Indicator Light) : This mode allows some electrical accessories to be used when the engine is off. With the ignition off, pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button one time without the brake pedal applied will place the ignition system in ACC/ACCESSORY. The ignition will switch from ACC/ ACCESSORY to off after five minutes to prevent battery rundown. ON/RUN/START (Green Indicator Light) : This mode is for driving and starting. With the ignition off, and the brake pedal applied, pressing ENGINE START/STOP button once will turn the ignition on. Once engine cranking begins, release the button. Engine cranking will continue until the engine starts. See Starting the Engine 0 230. Service Mode This power mode is available for service and diagnostics, and to verify the proper operation of the malfunction indicator lamp as may be required for emission inspection purposes. With the vehicle off, and the brake pedal not applied, pressing and holding the ENGINE START/STOP button for more than five seconds will place the vehicle in Service Mode. The instruments and audio systems will operate as they do when the ignition is on, but the vehicle will not be able to be driven. The engine will not start in Service Mode. Press the ENGINE START/ STOP button again to turn the ignition off. Starting the Engine If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. Caution If you add electrical parts or accessories, you could change the way the engine operates. Any resulting damage would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. See Add-On Electrical Equipment 0 303. Move the shift lever to P (Park) or N (Neutral). To restart the engine when the vehicle is already moving, use N (Neutral) only. Caution Do not try to shift to P (Park) if the vehicle is moving. If you do, you could damage the transmission. Shift to P (Park) only when the vehicle is stopped. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Starting Procedure 1. For Key Access vehicles, turn the ignition key to Start. When the engine starts, let go of the key. For Keyless Access vehicles, the RKE transmitter must be in the vehicle. Press ENGINE START/STOP with the brake pedal applied. When the engine begins cranking, let go of the button. The driver may observe a minor, and temporary, brake pedal kickback when starting the vehicle. This is normal. The idle speed will go down as the engine gets warm. Do not race the engine immediately after starting it. Operate the engine and transmission gently to allow the oil to warm up and lubricate all moving parts. When the low fuel warning light is on and the FUEL LEVEL LOW message is displayed in the Driver Information Center (DIC), hold the ignition switch in the START position to continue engine cranking. Caution Cranking the engine for long periods of time, by returning the ignition to the START position immediately after cranking has ended, can overheat and damage the cranking motor, and drain the battery. Wait at least 15 seconds between each try, to let the cranking motor cool down. 2. If the engine does not start after five to 10 seconds, especially in very cold weather (below −18 °C or 0 °F), it could be flooded with too much gasoline. Try pushing the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor and holding it there while holding the key in START or ENGINE START/STOP for up to a maximum of 15 seconds. Wait at least 15 seconds between each try, to allow the cranking motor to cool down. When the engine starts, let go of the key or button and accelerator. If the vehicle starts briefly but then stops again, do the same thing. This clears the extra gasoline from the engine. Do not race the engine immediately after starting it. Operate 231 the engine and transmission gently until the oil warms up and lubricates all moving parts. Engine Heater If equipped, the engine heater can provide easier starting and better fuel economy during engine warm-up in cold weather conditions at or below −18 °C (0 °F). Vehicles with an engine heater should be plugged in at least four hours before starting. An internal thermostat in the plug-end of the cord may exist, which will prevent engine heater operation at temperatures above −18 °C (0 °F). { Warning Do not plug in the engine block heater while the vehicle is parked in a garage or under a carport. Property damage or personal injury may result. Always park the vehicle in a clear open area away from buildings or structures. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 232 Driving and Operating { Warning Improper use of the heater cord or an extension cord can damage the cord and may result in overheating and fire. . Plug the cord into a three-prong To Use the Engine Heater 1. Turn off the engine. 2. Check the heater cord for damage. If it is damaged, do not use it. See your dealer for a replacement. Inspect the cord for damage yearly. 3. Plug the heater cord into the connector on the vehicle. 4. Plug the cord into a grounded 110-volt AC outlet that is protected by a ground fault detection function. electrical utility receptacle that is protected by a ground fault detection function. An ungrounded outlet could cause an electric shock. . Use a weatherproof, heavy-duty, 15 amp-rated extension cord if needed. Failure to use the recommended extension cord in good operating condition, or using a damaged heater or extension cord, could make it overheat and cause a fire, property damage, electric shock, and injury. . Do not operate the vehicle with the heater cord permanently attached to the vehicle. Possible heater cord and thermostat damage could occur. . While in use, do not let the heater cord touch vehicle parts or sharp edges. Never close the hood on the heater cord. (Continued) Warning (Continued) . Before starting the vehicle, unplug the cord, reattach the cover to the plug, and securely fasten the cord. Keep the cord away from any moving parts. 5. Before starting the engine, be sure to unplug and store the cord. The length of time the heater should remain plugged in depends on several factors. Ask a dealer in the area where you will be parking the vehicle for the best advice on this. Retained Accessory Power (RAP) When the ignition is turned from on to off, the following features (if equipped) will continue to function for up to 10 minutes, or until the driver door is opened. These features will also work when the ignition is in RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY: . Infotainment System . Power Windows (during RAP this functionality will be lost when any door is opened) . Sunroof (during RAP this functionality will be lost when any door is opened) . Auxiliary Power Outlet Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating . Audio System . OnStar System Shifting Into Park { Warning It can be dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking brake firmly set. The vehicle can roll. If you have left the engine running, the vehicle can move suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be sure the vehicle will not move, even when you are on fairly level ground, use the steps that follow. With four-wheel drive, if the transfer case is in N (Neutral), the vehicle will be free to roll, even if the shift lever is in P (Park). Be sure the transfer case is in a drive gear. If towing a trailer, see Driving Characteristics and Towing Tips 0 274. 1. Hold the brake pedal down, then set the parking brake. See Electric Parking Brake 0 245. 2. Move the shift lever into P (Park) by pulling the shift lever toward you and moving it up as far as it will go. 3. Be sure the transfer case, if equipped, is in a drive gear, not in N (Neutral). 4. Turn the ignition off. For Key Access, push the ignition key in, toward the steering column, and then turn the ignition off. 5. For Key Access, remove the key and take it with you. If you can leave the vehicle with the ignition key in your hand, the vehicle is in P (Park). For Keyless Access, take the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter with you. Leaving the Vehicle with the Engine Running { Warning It can be dangerous to leave the vehicle with the engine running. The vehicle could move suddenly if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking brake firmly set. (Continued) 233 Warning (Continued) If you have four-wheel drive and the transfer case is in N (Neutral), the vehicle will be free to roll, even if the shift lever is in P (Park). So be sure the transfer case is in a drive gear – not in N (Neutral). And, if you leave the vehicle with the engine running, it could overheat and even catch fire. You or others could be injured. Do not leave the vehicle with the engine running unless you have to. If you have to leave the vehicle with the engine running, be sure the vehicle is in P (Park) and the parking brake is firmly set before you leave it. After moving the shift lever into P (Park), hold the regular brake pedal down. Then, see if you can move the shift lever away from P (Park) without first pulling it toward you. If you can, it means that the shift lever was not fully locked into P (Park). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 234 Driving and Operating Torque Lock If you are parking on a hill and you do not shift the transmission into P (Park) properly, the weight of the vehicle may put too much force on the parking pawl in the transmission. You may find it difficult to pull the shift lever out of P (Park). This is called torque lock. To prevent torque lock, set the parking brake and then shift into P (Park) properly before you leave the driver seat. When you are ready to drive, move the shift lever out of P (Park) before you release the parking brake. If torque lock does occur, you may need to have another vehicle push yours a little uphill to take some of the pressure from the parking pawl in the transmission. You will then be able to pull the shift lever out of P (Park). Shifting out of Park This vehicle is equipped with an electronic shift lock release system. The system is designed to prevent movement of the shift lever out of P (Park), unless the brake pedal is applied and the ignition is on or in Service Mode. The shift lock release is always functional except in the case of an uncharged or low voltage – less than 9 volt – battery. If the vehicle has an uncharged or low voltage battery, try charging or jump starting the battery. See Jump Starting North America 0 374. To shift out of P (Park): 1. Apply the brake pedal. 2. Release the parking brake if it is applied. See Electric Parking Brake 0 245. 3. Pull the shift lever toward you, then move it to the desired position, and release. If the vehicle still cannot be shifted out of P (Park): 1. Ease the pressure on, or release the shift lever. 2. While holding the brake pedal, push the shift lever all the way into P (Park). 3. Pull the shift lever toward you, then move it to the desired position, and release. If there is still a problem shifting, have the vehicle serviced soon. Parking over Things That Burn { Warning Things that can burn could touch hot exhaust parts under the vehicle and ignite. Do not park over papers, leaves, dry grass, or other things that can burn. Extended Parking It is best not to park with the vehicle running. If the vehicle is left running, be sure it will not move and there is adequate ventilation. See Shifting Into Park 0 233 and Engine Exhaust 0 235. If the vehicle is left parked and running with the RKE transmitter outside the vehicle, it will continue to run for up to 15 minutes. If the vehicle is left parked and running with the RKE transmitter inside the vehicle, it will continue to run for up to 30 minutes. The vehicle could turn off sooner if it is parked on a hill, due to lack of available fuel. The timer will reset if the vehicle is taken out of P (Park) while it is running. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating When the vehicle was produced, it came with the auto-shutdown feature enabled. If you are not the primary owner of your vehicle, please note that this feature may have been disabled by a previous owner. The vehicle owners can have this feature re-enabled at owner cost at any GM service center. Engine Exhaust { Warning Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide (CO), which cannot be seen or smelled. Exposure to CO can cause unconsciousness and even death. Exhaust may enter the vehicle if: . The vehicle idles in areas with poor ventilation (parking garages, tunnels, deep snow that may block underbody airflow or tail pipes). . The exhaust smells or sounds strange or different. . The exhaust system leaks due to corrosion or damage. (Continued) Warning (Continued) . The vehicle exhaust system has been modified, damaged, or improperly repaired. . There are holes or openings in the vehicle body from damage or aftermarket modifications that are not completely sealed. If unusual fumes are detected or if it is suspected that exhaust is coming into the vehicle: . Drive it only with the windows completely down. . Have the vehicle repaired immediately. Never park the vehicle with the engine running in an enclosed area such as a garage or a building that has no fresh air ventilation. 235 If the vehicle is left with the engine running, follow the proper steps to be sure the vehicle will not move. See Shifting Into Park 0 233 and Engine Exhaust 0 235. If parking on a hill and pulling a trailer, see Driving Characteristics and Towing Tips 0 274. Automatic Transmission If equipped, there is an electronic shift lever position indicator within the instrument cluster. This display comes on when the ignition is in ACC/ACCESSORY, on or service mode. There are several different positions for the shift lever. Running the Vehicle While Parked It is better not to park with the engine running. See Driver Mode Control 0 249 and “Range Selection Mode” under Manual Mode 0 238. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 236 Driving and Operating P : This position locks the rear wheels. Use P (Park) when starting the engine because the vehicle cannot move easily. When parked on a hill, especially when the vehicle has a heavy load, you might notice an increase in the effort to shift out of P (Park). See “Torque Lock” under Shifting Into Park 0 233. { Warning It is dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking brake firmly set. The vehicle can roll. Do not leave the vehicle when the engine is running. If you have left the engine running, the vehicle can move suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be sure the vehicle will not move, even when you are on fairly level ground, always set the parking brake and move the shift lever to P (Park). See Shifting Into Park 0 233 and Driving Characteristics and Towing Tips 0 274. { Warning If equipped with four-wheel drive, the vehicle will be free to roll if the transfer case is in N (Neutral), even when the shift lever is in P (Park). You or someone else could be seriously injured. Be sure the transfer case is in a drive gear — 2 m, 4 m, or 4 n — or set the parking brake before placing the transfer case in N (Neutral). See Four-Wheel Drive 0 240. R : Use this gear to back up. Caution Shifting to R (Reverse) while the vehicle is moving forward could damage the transmission. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Shift to R (Reverse) only after the vehicle is stopped. To rock the vehicle back and forth to get out of snow, ice, or sand without damaging the transmission, see If the Vehicle Is Stuck 0 219. N : In this position, the engine does not connect with the wheels. To restart the engine when the vehicle is already moving, use N (Neutral) only. Also, use N (Neutral) when the vehicle is being towed. { Warning Shifting into a drive gear while the engine is running at high speed is dangerous. Unless your foot is firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle could move very rapidly. You could lose control and hit people or objects. Do not shift into a drive gear while the engine is running at high speed. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Caution Shifting out of P (Park) or N (Neutral) with the engine running at high speed may damage the transmission. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Be sure the engine is not running at high speed when shifting the vehicle. Caution A transmission hot message may display if the automatic transmission fluid is too hot. Driving under this condition can damage the vehicle. Stop and idle the engine to cool the automatic transmission fluid. This message clears when the transmission fluid has cooled sufficiently. D : This position is for normal driving. It provides the best fuel economy. If more power is needed for passing, press the accelerator pedal down. . When going less than about 55 km/h (35 mph), push the accelerator pedal about halfway down. . When going about 55 km/h (35 mph) or more, push the accelerator all the way down. By doing this, the vehicle shifts down to the next gear and has more power. Use D (Drive) and Tow/Haul Mode when towing a trailer, carrying a heavy load, driving on steep hills, or driving off-road. Shift the transmission to a lower gear if the transmission shifts too often. Downshifting the transmission in slippery road conditions could result in skidding. See “Skidding” under Loss of Control 0 213. 237 The vehicle has a shift stabilization feature that adjusts the transmission shifting to the current driving conditions in order to reduce rapid upshifts and downshifts. This shift stabilization feature is designed to determine, before making an upshift, if the engine is able to maintain vehicle speed by analyzing things such as vehicle speed, throttle position, and vehicle load. If the shift stabilization feature determines that a current vehicle speed cannot be maintained, the transmission does not upshift and instead holds the current gear. In some cases, this could appear to be a delayed shift, however the transmission is operating normally. The transmission uses adaptive shift controls. The adaptive shift control process continually compares key shift parameters to pre-programmed ideal shifts stored in the transmission’s computer. The transmission constantly makes adjustments to improve vehicle performance according to how the vehicle is being used, such as with a heavy load or when the temperature changes. During this adaptive shift control process, shifting might feel different as the transmission determines the best settings. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 238 Driving and Operating When temperatures are very cold, the transmission's gear shifting could be delayed providing more stable shifts until the engine warms up. Shifts could be more noticeable with a cold transmission. This difference in shifting is normal. L : This position allows selection of a range of gears appropriate for current driving conditions. If equipped, see “Range Selection Mode” under Manual Mode 0 238. Caution Spinning the tires or holding the vehicle in one place on a hill using only the accelerator pedal may damage the transmission. The repair will not be covered by the vehicle warranty. If the vehicle is stuck, do not spin the tires. When stopping on a hill, use the brakes to hold the vehicle in place. Manual Mode Range Selection Mode Range Selection Mode helps control the vehicle transmission and vehicle speed while driving downhill or towing a trailer. It permits the manual selection of a desired gear range. To use this feature: 1. Move the shift lever to L (Manual Mode). 2. Press the plus/minus buttons on the shift lever to select the desired gear range for current driving conditions. When the shift lever is moved from D (Drive) to L (Manual Mode), a number displays next to the L, indicating the current transmission range. This number is the highest gear that the transmission will allow while operating in L (Manual Mode). All gears below that number are available. As driving conditions change, the transmission can automatically shift to lower gears. For example, when L5 is selected, 1 (First) through 5 (Fifth) gears are automatically shifted by the transmission, but 6 (Sixth) cannot be used until the plus/ minus button on the shift lever is used to change to the range. In vehicles with gasoline engines, when the shift lever is moved from D (Drive) to L (Manual Mode), a downshift may occur. The gear that the transmission is operating in when the shift lever is moved from D (Drive) to L (Manual Mode) determines if a downshift occurs. See the following charts. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating 6-Speed Automatic Transmission Gear before shifting from D (Drive) to L (Manual Mode) 6th 5th 4th 3rd 2nd 1st Range after shifting from D (Drive) to L (Manual Mode) L4 L4 L3 L2 L2 L1 8-Speed Automatic Transmission Gear before shifting from D (Drive) to L (Manual Mode) 8th 7th 6th 5th 4th 3rd 2nd 1st Range after shifting from D (Drive) to L (Manual Mode) – Tow/Haul not engaged L6 L6 L5 L4 L3 L3 L2 L1 Range after shifting from D (Drive) to L (Manual Mode) – Tow/Haul engaged L6 L5 L4 L3 L3 L3 L2 L1 239 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 240 Driving and Operating 10-Speed Automatic Transmission Gear before shifting from D (Drive) to L (Manual Mode) 10th 9th 8th 7th 6th 5th 4th 3rd 2nd 1st Range after shifting from D (Drive) to L (Manual Mode) – Tow/Haul not engaged L7 L7 L7 L6 L5 L4 L3 L3 L2 L1 Range after shifting from D (Drive) to L (Manual Mode) – Tow/Haul engaged L7 L7 L6 L5 L4 L3 L3 L3 L2 L1 Tow/Haul Mode Tow/Haul Mode Grade Braking The Tow/Haul Mode adjusts the transmission shift pattern to reduce shift cycling. This provides increased performance, vehicle control, and enhanced transmission and engine cooling when driving down steep hills or mountain grades, when towing, or when hauling heavy loads. See Driver Mode Control 0 249 to activate Tow/ Haul Mode. Tow/Haul Mode Grade Braking is only enabled while the Tow/Haul Mode is selected and the vehicle is not in the Range Selection Mode. See Manual Mode 0 238. Tow/Haul Mode Grade Braking assists in maintaining desired vehicle speeds when driving on downhill grades by using the engine and transmission to slow the vehicle. See Towing Equipment 0 281. For vehicles without Driver Mode Control, press the Tow/Haul button on the center stack. If equipped with Active Hydraulic Assist, the vehicle will provide a stiffer steering response when Tow/Haul mode is engaged to provide enhanced steering functionality. Drive Systems Four-Wheel Drive If equipped, four-wheel drive engages the front axle for extra traction. Read the appropriate section for transfer case operation before using. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Caution Do not drive on clean, dry pavement in 4 m and 4 n (if equipped) for an extended period of time. These conditions may cause premature wear on the vehicle’s powertrain. Driving on clean, dry pavement in 4 m or 4 n may: . Cause a vibration to be felt in the steering system. . Cause tires to wear faster. { Warning If equipped with four-wheel drive, the vehicle will be free to roll if the transfer case is in N (Neutral), even when the shift lever is in P (Park). You or someone else could be seriously injured. Be sure the transfer case is in a drive gear — 2 m, 4 m, or 4 n — or set the parking brake before placing the transfer case in N (Neutral). See Shifting Into Park 0 233. Caution Extended high-speed operation in 4 n may damage or shorten the life of the drivetrain. An engagement noise and bump is normal when shifting between 4 n and 4 m or N (Neutral), with the engine running. 241 If equipped, the transfer case controls are used to shift into and out of four-wheel drive. To shift the transfer case, press the desired button. The graphic in the instrument cluster will flash while a shift is in progress. The graphic displayed will change to indicate the setting requested. Shifting into 4 n will turn Traction Control and StabiliTrak/Electronic Stability Control (ESC) off. See Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control 0 247. When the shift is complete the graphic will stop flashing. The DIC message turns off once the shift is complete. If the transfer case cannot complete a shift request, it will go back to its last chosen setting. Automatic Transfer Case The settings are: Two-Speed Transfer Case N (Neutral) : Use only when the vehicle needs to be towed. See Recreational Vehicle Towing 0 378 or Towing the Vehicle 0 377. 2 m (Two-Wheel Drive High) : Use for driving on most streets and highways. The front axle is not engaged. This setting provides the best fuel economy. AUTO (Automatic Four-Wheel Drive) : Use when road surface conditions are variable. When driving in AUTO, the front axle is engaged, and the vehicle's power is sent to the front and rear wheels automatically Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 242 Driving and Operating based on driving conditions. This setting provides slightly lower fuel economy than 2 m. Once the 4x4 shift has completed, the DIC message disappears, the 4x4 graphic stops flashing, and the current setting is indicated. 4 m (Four-Wheel Drive High) : Use this setting when extra traction is needed, such as when driving on snowy or icy roads, when off-roading, or when plowing snow. When a shift to 2 m is completed successfully while in P (Park), the parking brake will engage. To resume driving, shift the transmission to the desired gear and manually release the parking brake or press the accelerator pedal to begin driving. See Electric Parking Brake 0 245. 4 n (Four-Wheel Drive Low) : This setting engages the front axle and delivers extra torque. Choose 4 n when driving off-road in deep sand, deep mud, or deep snow, and while climbing or descending steep hills. While driving in 4 n, keep vehicle speed below 72 km/h (45 mph). Shifting into 4 n will turn Traction Control and StabiliTrak/ESC off. See Traction Control/ Electronic Stability Control 0 247. Shifts between 2m, 4 m, and AUTO Any of these shifts can be made at normal driving speed. The actual 4x4 shift request is only made after the button is released. The 4x4 graphic will remain flashing until the shift request has completed. A DIC message displays to indicate that the 4x4 transfer case has been requested to shift to the new desired state. If equipped, use 4 n, AUTO, or 4 m to provide additional traction when parking on a steep grade with poor traction such as ice, snow, mud, or gravel. Shifting Into 4 n 1. The ignition must be on and the vehicle must be stopped or moving less than 5 km/h (3 mph) with the transmission in N (Neutral). It is best for the vehicle to be moving 1.6 to 3.2 km/h (1 to 2 mph). 2. Press 4 n. The actual 4x4 shift request is only made after the button is released. The 4x4 graphic will remain flashing until the shift request has completed. A DIC message displays to indicate that the 4x4 transfer case has been requested to shift to the new desired state. Once the 4x4 shift has completed, the DIC message disappears, the 4x4 graphic stops flashing and the current setting is indicated. If vehicle speed is higher when shift request occurs, a DIC message displays. Reduce vehicle speed. If the transmission is not in N (Neutral) when shift request occurs, a DIC message displays. The vehicle will allow 20 seconds for the shift to occur. After this time, a graphic in the instrument cluster will indicate that the transfer case is in 4 n. Caution Shifting the transmission into gear before the requested mode indicator light has stopped flashing could damage the transfer case. If the transmission is not shifted into N (Neutral) or the vehicle has not slowed to 5 km/h (3 mph) within 20 seconds, the transfer case will remain in its original state. This will be indicated in the instrument cluster. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating With the vehicle moving less than 5 km/h (3 mph) and the transmission in N (Neutral), attempt the shift again. Shifting Out of 4 n 1. The vehicle must be stopped or moving less than 5 km/h (3 mph) with the transmission in N (Neutral) and the ignition on. It is best for the vehicle to be moving 1.6 to 3.2 km/h (1 to 2 mph). 2. Press 4 m, AUTO, or 2 m. The actual 4x4 shift request is only made after the button is released. The 4x4 graphic will remain flashing until the shift request has completed. A DIC message displays to indicate the state of the request. Once the 4x4 shift has completed, the DIC message disappears, the 4x4 graphic stops flashing, and the current setting is indicated. If vehicle speed is higher when shift request occurs, a DIC message displays. Reduce vehicle speed. If the transmission is not in N (Neutral) when shift request occurs, DIC messages will display. The vehicle will allow 20 seconds for this shift to occur. After this time, a graphic in the instrument cluster will indicate that the transfer case is in 4 n. Caution Shifting the transmission into gear before the requested mode indicator light has stopped flashing could damage the transfer case. If the transmission is not shifted into N (Neutral) or the vehicle has not slowed to 5 km/h (3 mph) within 20 seconds, the transfer case will remain in its original state. This will be indicated in the instrument cluster. With the vehicle moving less than 5 km/h (3 mph), and the transmission in N (Neutral), attempt the shift again. Shifting Into N (Neutral) To shift into N (Neutral): 1. Start the vehicle. 2. Shift the transmission to N (Neutral). 3. Shift the transfer case to 2 m. 4. Apply the parking brake and/or brake pedal. 5. Press 2 m five times in 10 seconds until the N (Neutral) graphic starts flashing in the instrument cluster. When the shift is complete, the graphic stops flashing. 243 If the parking brake and/or brake pedal is not applied within 20 seconds, the transfer case will remain in the original state. 6. If the transmission is not shifted into N (Neutral) or the vehicle has not slowed to 5 km/h (3 mph) within 20 seconds, the transfer case will remain in its original state. This will be indicated in the instrument cluster. Shifting Out of N (Neutral) To shift out of N (Neutral): 1. Turn the ignition on with the engine off. See Ignition Positions (Keyless Access) 0 229 or Ignition Positions (Key Access) 0 227. 2. Set the parking brake. See Electric Parking Brake 0 245. 3. Shift the transmission to N (Neutral). 4. Shift the transfer case to 2 m. Transfer case shifts out of N (Neutral) can only be made into 2 m. When the shift to 2 m is complete, the graphic in the instrument cluster will stop flashing. If the transfer case cannot complete a shift, the graphic will return to the previously selected setting. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 244 Driving and Operating Single Speed Transfer Case If equipped, the transfer case controls are used to shift into and out of four-wheel drive. To shift the transfer case, press the desired button. The graphic in the instrument cluster will flash while a shift is in progress. The graphic displayed will change to indicate the setting requested. When the shift is complete the graphic will stop flashing. The DIC message turns off once the shift is complete. If the transfer case cannot complete a shift request, it will go back to its last chosen setting. The settings are: 2 m (Two-Wheel Drive High) : Use for driving on most streets and highways. The front axle is not engaged. This setting provides the best fuel economy. The actual 4x4 shift request is only made after the button is released. The 4x4 graphic will remain flashing until the shift request has completed. 4 m (Four-Wheel Drive High) : Use this setting when extra traction is needed, such as when driving on snowy or icy roads, when off-roading, or when plowing snow. A DIC message displays. Once the 4x4 shift has completed, the DIC message disappears, the 4x4 graphic stops flashing, and the current setting is indicated. AUTO (Automatic Four-Wheel Drive) Brakes Use when road surface conditions are variable. When driving in AUTO, the front axle is engaged, and the vehicle's power is sent to the front and rear wheels automatically based on driving conditions. This setting provides slightly lower fuel economy than 2 m. Shifts between 2 m, 4 m, and AUTO Any of these shifts can be made at normal driving speed. The actual 4x4 shift request is only made after the button is released. The 4x4 graphic will remain flashing until the shift request has completed. A DIC message displays. Once the 4x4 shift has completed, the DIC message disappears, the 4x4 graphic stops flashing, and the current setting is indicated. Antilock Brake System (ABS) The Antilock Brake System (ABS) helps prevent a braking skid and maintain steering while braking hard. ABS performs a system check when the vehicle is first driven. A momentary motor or clicking noise may be heard while this test is going on, and the brake pedal may move slightly. This is normal. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating If there is a problem with ABS, this warning light stays on. See Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light 0 118. Electric Parking Brake ABS does not change the time needed to get a foot on the brake pedal and does not always decrease stopping distance. If you get too close to the vehicle ahead, there will not be enough time to apply the brakes if that vehicle suddenly slows or stops. Always leave enough room ahead to stop, even with ABS. Braking in Emergencies ABS allows steering and braking at the same time. In many emergencies, steering can help even more than braking. Before leaving the vehicle, check the red parking brake status light to ensure that the parking brake is applied. EPB Apply To apply the EPB: 1. Be sure the vehicle is at a complete stop. 2. Press the EPB switch momentarily. Using ABS Do not pump the brakes. Just hold the brake pedal down firmly. Hearing or feeling ABS operate is normal. 245 The Electric Parking Brake (EPB) can always be applied, even if the vehicle is off. In case of insufficient electrical power, the EPB cannot be applied or released. To prevent draining the battery, avoid unnecessary repeated cycles of the EPB. The system has a red parking brake status light and an amber service parking brake warning light. See Electric Parking Brake Light 0 118 and Service Electric Parking Brake Light 0 118. There are also parking brake-related Driver Information Center (DIC) messages. The red parking brake status light will flash and then stay on once the EPB is fully applied. If the red parking brake status light flashes continuously, then the EPB is only partially applied or there is a problem with the EPB. A DIC message will display. Release the EPB and try to apply it again. If the light does not come on, or keeps flashing, have the vehicle serviced. Do not drive the vehicle if the red parking brake status light is flashing. See your dealer. If the amber service parking brake warning light is on, press the EPB switch. Continue to hold the switch until the red parking brake status light remains on. If the amber service parking brake warning light is on, see your dealer. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 246 Driving and Operating If the EPB is applied while the vehicle is moving, the vehicle will decelerate as long as the switch is pressed. If the switch is pressed until the vehicle comes to a stop, the EPB will remain applied. The vehicle may automatically apply the EPB in some situations when the vehicle is not moving. This is normal, and is done to periodically check the correct operation of the EPB system, or at the request of other safety functions that utilize the EPB. If the EPB fails to apply, block the rear wheels to prevent vehicle movement. EPB Release To release the EPB: 1. Turn the ignition on or to ACC/ ACCESSORY. 2. Apply and hold the brake pedal. 3. Press the EPB switch momentarily. The EPB is released when the red parking brake status light is off. If the amber service parking brake warning light is on, release the EPB by pressing and holding the EPB switch. Continue to hold the switch until the red parking brake status light is off. If either light stays on after release is attempted, see your dealer. Caution Driving with the parking brake on can overheat the brake system and cause premature wear or damage to brake system parts. Make sure that the parking brake is fully released and the brake warning light is off before driving. If you are towing a trailer and parking on a hill, see Driving Characteristics and Towing Tips 0 274. Automatic EPB Release The EPB will automatically release if the vehicle is running, placed into gear, and an attempt is made to drive away. Avoid rapid acceleration when the EPB is applied, to preserve parking brake lining life. Brake Assist Brake Assist detects rapid brake pedal applications due to emergency braking situations and provides additional braking to activate the Antilock Brake System (ABS) if the brake pedal is not pushed hard enough to activate ABS normally. Minor noise, brake pedal pulsation, and/or pedal movement during this time may occur. Continue to apply the brake pedal as the driving situation dictates. Brake Assist disengages when the brake pedal is released. Hill Start Assist (HSA) { Warning Do not rely on the HSA feature. HSA does not replace the need to pay attention and drive safely. You may not hear or feel alerts or warnings provided by this system. Failure to use proper care when driving may result in injury, death, or vehicle damage. See Defensive Driving 0 211. When the vehicle is stopped on a grade, Hill Start Assist (HSA) prevents the vehicle from rolling in an unintended direction during the transition from brake pedal release to accelerator pedal apply. The brakes release when the accelerator pedal is applied. If the accelerator pedal is not applied within a few minutes, the Electric Parking Brake will apply. The brakes may also release under other conditions. Do not rely on HSA to hold the vehicle. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating HSA is available when the vehicle is facing uphill in a forward gear, or when facing downhill in R (Reverse). The vehicle must come to a complete stop on a grade for HSA to activate. Ride Control Systems Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control System Operation The vehicle has a Traction Control System (TCS) and StabiliTrak/Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system. These systems help limit wheel spin and assist the driver in maintaining control, especially on slippery road conditions. TCS activates if it senses any of the drive wheels are spinning or beginning to lose traction. When this happens, TCS applies the brakes to the spinning wheels and reduces engine power to limit wheel spin. StabiliTrak/ESC activates when the vehicle senses a difference between the intended path and the direction the vehicle is actually traveling. StabiliTrak/ESC selectively applies braking pressure to any one of the vehicle wheel brakes to assist the driver in keeping the vehicle on the intended path. Trailer Sway Control (TSC) is also on automatically when the vehicle is started. See Trailer Sway Control (TSC) 0 291. 247 Driver Information Center (DIC). Both traction control and StabiliTrak/ESC are automatically disabled in this condition. If cruise control is being used and traction control or StabiliTrak/ESC begins to limit wheel spin, cruise control will disengage. Cruise control may be turned back on when road conditions allow. Both systems come on automatically when the vehicle is started and begins to move. The systems may be heard or felt while they are operating or while performing diagnostic checks. This is normal and does not mean there is a problem with the vehicle. The indicator light for both systems is in the instrument cluster. This light will: . Flash when TCS is limiting wheel spin. . Flash when StabiliTrak/ESC is activated. . Turn on and stay on when either system is not working. It is recommended to leave both systems on for normal driving conditions, but it may be necessary to turn TCS off if the vehicle gets stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow. See If the Vehicle Is Stuck 0 219 and “Turning the Systems Off and On” later in this section. If either system fails to turn on or to activate, a message displays in the Driver Information Center (DIC), and d comes on and stays on to indicate that the system is inactive and is not assisting the driver in maintaining control. The vehicle is safe to drive, but driving should be adjusted accordingly. When the transfer case (if equipped) is in Four-Wheel Drive Low, the stability system is automatically disabled, g comes on, and the appropriate message will appear on the If d comes on and stays on: 1. Stop the vehicle. 2. Turn the engine off and wait 15 seconds. 3. Start the engine. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 248 Driving and Operating Drive the vehicle. If d comes on and stays on, the vehicle may need more time to diagnose the problem. If the condition persists, see your dealer. Turning the Systems Off and On The button for TCS and StabiliTrak/ESC is on the center stack. Caution Do not repeatedly brake or accelerate heavily when TCS is off. The vehicle driveline could be damaged. To turn off only TCS, press and release g. The traction off light i displays in the instrument cluster. The appropriate message will display in the DIC. To turn TCS on again, press and release g. The traction off light i displayed in the instrument cluster will turn off. If TCS is limiting wheel spin when g is pressed, the system will not turn off until the wheels stop spinning. To turn off both TCS and StabiliTrak/ESC, press and hold g until the traction off light i and the StabiliTrak/ESC OFF light g come on and stay on in the instrument cluster, then release. The appropriate message will display in the DIC. Hill Descent Control (HDC) If equipped, Hill Descent Control (HDC) sets and maintains vehicle speed while driving down steep grades in a forward or reverse gear. The HDC switch is on the center stack, below the climate controls. Press 5 to enable or disable HDC. Vehicle speed must be below 50 km/h (31 mph). To turn TCS and StabiliTrak/ESC on again, press and release g. The traction off light i and the StabiliTrak/ESC OFF light g in the instrument cluster turn off. StabiliTrak/ESC will automatically turn on if the vehicle exceeds 56 km/h (35 mph). Traction control will remain off. The vehicle has a Trailer Sway Control (TSC) feature and a Hill Start Assist (HSA) feature. See Trailer Sway Control (TSC) 0 291 or Hill Start Assist (HSA) 0 246. Adding accessories can affect the vehicle performance. See Accessories and Modifications 0 307. When enabled, the HDC light displays on the instrument cluster. A blinking HDC light indicates the system is actively applying the brakes to maintain vehicle speed. HDC can maintain vehicle speeds between 1 and 22 km/h (1 and 14 mph) on grades greater than or equal to 10%. If HDC is to be used for more than three minutes or on grades steeper than 25%, the transfer case should be put into Four-Wheel Drive Low (4 n) to reduce the possibility of brake overheating. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Noise from the Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) is normal when HDC is active. When HDC is activated, the initial HDC speed is set to the current driving speed. It can be increased or decreased by pressing +RES or SET- on the steering wheel, or by applying the accelerator or brake pedal. This adjusted speed becomes the new set speed. HDC will remain enabled between 30 and 60 km/h (19 and 37 mph); however, vehicle speed cannot be set or maintained in this range. HDC will automatically disable if the vehicle speed is above 80 km/h (50 mph) or above 60 km/h (37 mph) for at least 30 seconds. Driver Mode Control Modes: Driver Mode Control (DMC) allows the driver to adjust the overall driving experience to better suit preference by adjusting multiple systems to fit specific driving needs. Drive mode availability and affected vehicle subsystems are dependent upon vehicle trim level, region, and optional features. Normal Mode : Use for normal city and highway driving to provide a smooth ride. This setting provides balance between comfort and handling. This is the standard/ default mode. There is no persistent indicator in the instrument cluster for this mode. Mode Activation 6 Snow/Ice Mode : Snow/Ice Mode improves vehicle acceleration on snow and ice covered roads. When active, Snow/Ice Mode will adjust acceleration to optimize traction on slippery surfaces. This can compromise the acceleration on dry asphalt. This feature is not intended for use when the vehicle is stuck in sand, mud, ice, snow, or gravel. If the vehicle becomes stuck, see If the Vehicle Is Stuck 0 219. 5 must be pressed again to re-enable HDC. HDC may disable after an extended period of use. If this happens, HDC will require time to cool down. The length of time HDC remains active depends on road conditions, grade, set speed, vehicle loading, and outside temperature. When enabled, if the vehicle speed is above 30 km/h (19 mph) and below 60 km/h (37 mph), a DIC message will display. 249 To activate Tow/Haul Mode turn the knob counterclockwise. To activate other drive modes turn the knob clockwise. 7 Off-Road Mode : Use this mode for off-road recreational driving. Off-Road Mode should be used to improve driving at moderate speeds, on grass, gravel, dirt, unpaved roads, or snow-covered roads. The accelerator pedal is tuned for off-road use. This mode modifies pedal mapping, transmission shift pattern, Antilock Brake Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 250 Driving and Operating For more information on off-road driving see Off-Road Driving 0 214. While in the Electronic Range Select (ERS) Mode, grade breaking is deactivated, allowing the driver to select a range and limiting the highest gear available. See Manual Mode 0 238. _ Tow/Haul Mode : Use this mode For more information on trailer weight specifications, see Towing Equipment 0 281. System (ABS), StabiliTrak/Electronic Stability Control (ESC), and Traction Control System (TCS) performance. when hauling heavy loads to provide increased performance and vehicle control. Tow/Haul Mode adjusts the transmission shift pattern, trailer sway, and steering. If the vehicle is turned off with Tow/Haul Mode active and then restarted within four hours or less, Tow/Haul will remain active. Otherwise, the vehicle will start in Normal Mode. If the vehicle has a diesel engine, exhaust braking is automatically activated when Tow/Haul Mode is selected. It maintains vehicle speed by automatically implementing a shift pattern that uses the engine and the transmission to slow the vehicle. The system will command downshifts and use the turbocharger on the engine to reduce vehicle speed when the brake is applied. The normal tow/haul shift pattern will return once the vehicle is on a low grade or when the accelerator pedal is pressed. Locking Rear Axle Vehicles with a locking rear axle can give more traction on snow, mud, ice, sand, or gravel. It works like a standard axle most of the time, but when traction is low, this feature will allow the rear wheel with the most traction to move the vehicle. Cruise Control { Warning Cruise control can be dangerous where you cannot drive safely at a steady speed. Do not use cruise control on winding roads or in heavy traffic. Cruise control can be dangerous on slippery roads. On such roads, fast changes in tire traction can cause (Continued) Warning (Continued) excessive wheel slip, and you could lose control. Do not use cruise control on slippery roads. If equipped with cruise control, a speed of about 40 km/h (25 mph) or more can be maintained without keeping your foot on the accelerator. Cruise control does not work at speeds below about 40 km/h (25 mph). If the cruise control is being used and the Traction Control System (TCS) or StabiliTrak/ Electronic Stability Control (ESC) begins to limit wheel spin, the cruise control will automatically disengage. See Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control 0 247. If a collision alert occurs when cruise control is activated, cruise control is disengaged. See Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System 0 263. When road conditions allow you to safely use it again, cruise control can be turned back on. Turning off the TCS or StabiliTrak/ESC system will disengage the cruise control. If the brakes are applied, cruise control disengages. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Setting Cruise Control If 5 is on when not in use, SET− or +RES could get pressed and go into cruise when not desired. Keep 5 off when cruise is not being used. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5 : Press to turn cruise control on or off. A white indicator comes on or off in the instrument cluster. +RES : If there is a set speed in memory, press the control up briefly to resume to that speed or press and hold to accelerate. If cruise control is already engaged, use to increase vehicle speed. SET− : Press the control down briefly to set the speed and activate cruise control. If cruise control is already engaged, use to decrease vehicle speed. * : Press to disengage cruise control without erasing the set speed from memory. Press 5 to turn the cruise system on. Get up to the desired speed. Press and release SET−. Remove your foot from the accelerator. The cruise control indicator on the instrument cluster turns green after cruise control has been set to the desired speed. See Instrument Cluster 0 107. Resuming a Set Speed If the cruise control is set at a desired speed and then the brakes are applied or * is pressed, the cruise control is disengaged without erasing the set speed from memory. Once the vehicle reaches about 40 km/h (25 mph) or more, press RES+ up briefly. The vehicle returns to the previously set speed. Increasing Speed While Using Cruise Control Do one of the following: . Press and hold +RES up until the desired speed is reached, then release it. 251 . To increase vehicle speed in small increments, press +RES up briefly. For each press, the vehicle goes about 1 km/h (1 mph) faster. The speedometer reading can be displayed in either English or metric units. See Instrument Cluster 0 107. The increment value used depends on the units displayed. Reducing Speed While Using Cruise Control Do one of the following: . Press and hold SET– down until the desired lower speed is reached, then release it. . To slow down in small increments, press SET– down briefly. For each press, the vehicle goes about 1 km/h (1 mph) slower. The speedometer reading can be displayed in either English or metric units. See Instrument Cluster 0 107. The increment value used depends on the units displayed. Passing Another Vehicle While Using Cruise Control Use the accelerator pedal to increase the vehicle speed. When you take your foot off the pedal, the vehicle will slow down to the previously set cruise speed. While pressing the accelerator pedal or shortly following Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 252 Driving and Operating the release to override cruise control, briefly pressing SET– will result in cruise control set to the current vehicle speed. Using Cruise Control on Hills How well the cruise control works on hills depends on the vehicle speed, the load, and the steepness of the hills. When going up steep hills, pressing the accelerator pedal may be necessary to maintain vehicle speed. While going downhill, cruise braking helps maintain driver selected speed. Cruise Grade Braking is enabled when the vehicle is started and cruise control is active. It is not enabled in Range Selection Mode. It assists in maintaining driver selected speed when driving on downhill grades by using the engine and transmission to slow the vehicle. For other forms of descent control, see Hill Descent Control (HDC) 0 248, Automatic Transmission 0 235, and Tow/Haul Mode 0 240. Ending Cruise Control There are four ways to end cruise control: . Step lightly on the brake pedal. . Press *. . Shift the transmission to N (Neutral). . To turn off cruise control, press 5. Erasing Speed Memory Warning (Continued) . Detect children, pedestrians, bicyclists, The cruise control set speed is erased from memory if 5 is pressed or the ignition is turned off. . Driver Assistance Systems . This vehicle may have features that work together to help avoid crashes or reduce crash damage while driving, backing, and parking. Read this entire section before using these systems. . { Warning Do not rely on the Driver Assistance Systems. These systems do not replace the need for paying attention and driving safely. You may not hear or feel alerts or warnings provided by these systems. Failure to use proper care when driving may result in injury, death, or vehicle damage. See Defensive Driving 0 211. Under many conditions, these systems will not: (Continued) . . . . or animals. Detect vehicles or objects outside the area monitored by the system. Work at all driving speeds. Warn you or provide you with enough time to avoid a crash. Work under poor visibility or bad weather conditions. Work if the detection sensor is not cleaned or is covered by ice, snow, mud, or dirt. Work if the detection sensor is covered up, such as with a sticker, magnet, or metal plate. Work if the area surrounding the detection sensor is damaged or not properly repaired. Complete attention is always required while driving, and you should be ready to take action and apply the brakes and/or steer the vehicle to avoid crashes. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating 253 . Front side and rear side panels . Outside of the windshield in front of the Audible or Safety Alert Seat Some driver assistance features alert the driver of obstacles by beeping. To change the volume of the warning chime, see “Comfort and Convenience” under Vehicle Personalization 0 131. rearview mirror . Side camera lens on the bottom of the outside mirrors . Rear side corner bumpers . Rear Vision Camera in the tailgate handle . Rear Camera Mirror and Cargo View If equipped with the Safety Alert Seat, the driver seat cushion may provide a vibrating pulse alert instead of beeping. To change this, see “Collision/Detection Systems” under Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Camera in the Center High-Mounted Stoplamp Radio Frequency Cleaning This vehicle may be equipped with driver assistance systems that operate using radio frequency. See Radio Frequency Statement 0 417. Depending on vehicle options, keep these areas of the vehicle clean to ensure the best driver assistance feature performance. Driver Information Center (DIC) messages may display when the systems are unavailable or blocked. Assistance Systems for Parking or Backing . Front and rear bumpers and the area below the bumpers . Front grille and headlamps . Front camera lens in the front grille or near the front emblem If equipped, the Rear Vision Camera (RVC), Surround Vision, Rear Park Assist (RPA), Front Park Assist (FPA), and Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA) may help the driver park or avoid objects. Always check around the vehicle when parking or backing. The RVC, RPA, and Surround Vision will not work properly if the tailgate is down. If the tailgate is down, do not use these systems. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 254 Driving and Operating Rear Vision Camera (RVC) When the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse), the RVC displays an image of the area behind the vehicle in the infotainment display. The previous screen displays when the vehicle is shifted out of R (Reverse) after a short delay. To return to the previous screen sooner, press any button on the infotainment system, shift into P (Park), or, while in D (Drive), reach a vehicle speed of approximately 12 km/h (8 mph). The rear vision camera is in the tailgate handle. { Warning 1. View Displayed by the Rear Vision Camera 2. Corners of the Rear Bumper Displayed images may be farther or closer than they appear. The area displayed is limited and objects that are close to either corner of the bumper or under the bumper do not display. A warning triangle may display to show that Rear Park Assist (RPA) has detected an object. This triangle changes from amber to red and increases in size the closer the object. If equipped with Hitch View, see Surround Vision System 0 254. 1. View Displayed by the Rear Vision Camera The camera(s) do not display children, pedestrians, bicyclists, crossing traffic, animals, or any other object outside of the cameras’ field of view, below the bumper, or under the vehicle. Shown distances may be different from actual distances. Do not drive or park the vehicle using only these camera(s). Always check behind and around the vehicle before driving. Failure to use proper care may result in injury, death, or vehicle damage. Surround Vision System If equipped the Surround Vision system can display various views surrounding the vehicle in the infotainment display. See below for camera view descriptions and more information. { Warning The Surround Vision cameras have blind spots and will not display all objects near the corners of the vehicle. Folding outside mirrors that are out of position may not (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Warning (Continued) display surround view correctly. Always check around the vehicle when parking or backing. 1. Views Displayed by the Surround Vision Cameras 2. Area Not Shown 1. Views Displayed by the Surround Vision Cameras 2. Area Not Shown 255 Camera Views { Warning The camera(s) do not display children, pedestrians, bicyclists, crossing traffic, animals, or any other object outside of the cameras’ field of view, below the bumper, or under the vehicle. Shown distances may be different from actual distances. Do not drive or park the vehicle using only these camera(s). Always check behind and around the vehicle before driving. Failure to use proper care may result in injury, death, or vehicle damage. Touch the camera view buttons along the bottom of the infotainment display to access each view (if equipped): 1. Front/Rear Standard View Displays an image of the area in front or behind the vehicle. To select, touch Front/Rear Standard View on the infotainment display when a camera view is active. When the hitch guidance is selected, Rear Standard View will remain visible across gear changes, otherwise the view will toggle between Front and Rear Standard View based on gear position. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 256 Driving and Operating If equipped, the front view camera also displays when the Park Assist system detects an object within 30 cm (12 in). To access this view when in a forward gear above 12 km/h (8 mph), select CAMERA on the infotainment display and select Rear Standard View. The view will close after 8 seconds and can be closed early by selecting X, Home or Back. 2. Front/Rear Top-Down View Displays a front or rear overhead view of the vehicle. To view, select Front/ Rear Top-Down View on the infotainment display when the camera app is active. 3. Front/Rear side View Displays a view that shows objects next to the front or rear sides of the vehicle. To select, touch Front/Rear Side View on the infotainment display when a camera view is active. Touch the button to toggle between front and rear camera views. Park Assist and RCTA overlays are not available when Front/Rear Side View is active. 4. Hitch View Displays a zoomed-in view of the hitch area to assist with aligning the vehicle’s hitch ball with the trailer coupler and monitoring the trailer connection. To view, select Hitch View on the infotainment display when the Camera App is active. To access this view when in a forward gear above 12 km/h (8 mph), select CAMERA on the infotainment display and select Hitch View. The view will close after eight seconds and can be closed early by selecting X, Home or Back. Shifting into P (Park) while in this view will automatically engage the Electric Parking Brake (EPB). 5. Surround View Displays an image of the area surrounding the vehicle. Surround View is displayed alongside the currently selected view when below 12 kph (8 mph). Surround View is disabled when above 12 kph (8 mph). 6. Camera App Guidance Lines The Camera App supports three possible guidance modes: No Guidance, Vehicle Guidance and Trailering Guidance. To change guidance mode, select the appropriate guidance icon. Depending on the guidance mode and view selected, different guidance lines may appear. A grayed-out icon indicates that guidance lines are not available. Certain views do not support Guidance lines. . Standard Guidance Lines are available in Front/Rear Standard Views, Front/Rear Top-Down Views and Surround View when the vehicle guidance mode is selected. Standard Guidance Lines show current and intended vehicle path. . Hitch Guidance Line is available in Rear Standard View or Cargo Bed View when the Trailering Guidance mode is selected. Hitch Guidance displays a single centered guidance line on the infotainment display to assist with aligning the vehicle’s hitch with a trailer coupler. Align the Hitch Guidance Line with the trailer coupler by continuously steering the vehicle to keep the guidance line centered on the coupler when backing. Park Assist overlays will not display when the Hitch Guidance Line is active. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating . Rear Trailer Guidance Lines are available in the Rear Trailer View when the Trailering Guidance mode is selected and the rear trailer camera calibration has been successfully completed. Rear Trailer Guidance Lines show the intended path (yellow) and the current path (blue) of the trailer. The current path guidance lines will converge with the intended path guidance lines. 7. Camera App Guidance Lines Duplicate of item 6. 8. Interior Trailer View Displays a view of the interior of the trailer. The feature is available when a trailer is connected. The feature requires user installation of an accessory trailer camera on the interior of the trailer per the accessory trailer camera installation instructions (see your dealer for accessory trailer camera(s) and information). To view, select Interior Trailer View on the infotainment display when the Camera App is active. To access this view when in a forward gear above 12 km/h (8 mph), select CAMERA on the infotainment display and select Interior Trailer View. The view will close after 8 seconds and can be closed early by selecting X, Home or Back. 9. Cargo Bed View/Bed Hitch View Use the plus and minus icons on the infotainment display to zoom in or out. . Cargo Bed View Displays a view of the truck bed and the area behind the vehicle to assist in cargo or hitch monitoring or hitching to a fifth wheel or gooseneck trailer. To view, select Cargo Bed View on the infotainment display when the Camera App is active. To access this view when in a forward gear above 12 km/h (8 mph), select CAMERA on the infotainment display and select Cargo Bed View. The view will close after 8 seconds and can be closed early by selecting X, Home or Back. When the Cargo Bed View is selected when not in Drive the cargo bed lighting is turned on automatically. 257 The feature can be enabled or disabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. . Bed Hitch View Displays a zoomed-in view of the bed hitch area to assist with aligning the vehicle’s hitch with the trailer coupler and monitoring the trailer connection. To view, select Bed Hitch View on the infotainment display when the Camera App is active. To access this view when in a forward gear above 12 km/h (8 mph), select CAMERA on the infotainment display and select Bed Hitch View. The view will close after 8 seconds and can be closed early by selecting X, Home or Back. When the Bed Hitch View is selected when not in Drive the cargo bed lighting is turned on automatically. The feature can be enabled or disabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. 10. Transparent Trailer View Displays a view that allows the driver to virtually “see through” the trailer. The feature is available when a Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 258 Driving and Operating compatible trailer is connected, a valid profile is selected and the vehicle is not in Reverse. The feature requires user installation of an accessory trailer camera on the rear exterior surface of the trailer per the accessory trailer camera installation instructions (see your dealer for accessory trailer camera(s) and information). To view, select Transparent Trailer View on the infotainment display when the Camera App is active. To access this view when in a forward gear above 12 km/h (8 mph), select CAMERA on the infotainment display and select Transparent Trailer View. The view can be closed by selecting X, Home or Back. When the system is calibrated and trailer position is known one of three views will be shown; Transparent Trailer View, Left Transparent Trailer View or Right Transparent Trailer View. The Transparent Trailer View is shown when the position of the trailer is relatively straight behind the vehicle. The Left or Right Transparent Trailer view is shown when the position of the trailer is too far to the left or right. When the system is not calibrated or trailer position is not known the Transparent Trailer Picture-in-Picture View will be shown. 11. Rear Trailer Views . Rear Trailer View Displays a view of the area behind the trailer when a trailer is connected. The feature requires user installation of an accessory trailer camera on the rear exterior surface of the trailer per the accessory trailer camera installation instructions (see your dealer for accessory trailer camera(s) and information). To view, select Rear Trailer View on the infotainment display when the Camera App is active. To access this view when in a forward gear above 12 km/h (8 mph), select CAMERA on the infotainment display and select Rear Trailer View. The view can be closed by selecting X, Home or Back. . Rear Side View with Available Articulation Functionality Displays a rearward split view of the left and right sides of the vehicle and trailer, when a trailer is connected. The view will automatically pan to show more of the left or right side based on the position of the trailer when a compatible profile is configured and selected via the Trailering App. To view, select Rear Side View with Available Articulation Functionality on the infotainment display when the Camera App is active. To access this view when in a forward gear above 12 km/h (8 mph), select CAMERA on the infotainment display and select Rear Side View with Available Articulation Functionality. The view can be closed by selecting X, Home or Back. . Picture-in-Picture Side View Displays a rearward split view of the left and right sides of the vehicle and trailer with an overlay view of the area behind the trailer when a trailer is connected. The feature requires user installation of an accessory trailer camera on the rear exterior surface of the trailer per the accessory trailer camera installation instructions (see your dealer for accessory trailer Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating camera(s) and information). To view, select Picture-in-Picture Side View on the infotainment display when the Camera App is active. To access this view when in a forward gear above 12 km/h (8 mph), select CAMERA on the infotainment display and select Picture-in-Picture Side View. The view can be closed by selecting X, Home or Back. Additional Views and Alerts . Turn Signal Activated Views Displays a rearward view of the left or right side of the vehicle and trailer when a trailer is connected. Views are provided based on turn signal activation with the right-side view being shown when the right turn signal is active and the left side view being shown when the left turn signal is active. The feature can be enabled or disabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. The view can be closed early by selecting X, Home or Back. A Trailer Length Indicator Overlay is available in the Turn Signal Activated Views when the trailer is relatively straight behind the vehicle and a compatible profile is configured and selected via the Trailering App. The overlay will not be visible when the position of the trailer is too far to the left or right. The overlay can be enabled or disabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. . Jack-Knife Detection and Alert The vehicle may be equipped with Jack-Knife Detection. The system will track the position of the trailer relative to the vehicle. As the front of the trailer approaches the rear of the vehicle, a warning or an alert will be displayed. A warning indicates to the driver to proceed with caution, an alert indicates that a collision is imminent. Based on vehicle equipment and user settings, the visual warning or alert may be accompanied by audible or safety alert seat notifications. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. . Trailer Angle Indicator The vehicle may be equipped with a Trailer Angle Indicator. The Trailer Angle Indicator gives the driver a visual representation of the trailer’s position relative to the vehicle. (Available only in Reverse, Guidelines On, Rear Trailering Views). 259 { Warning Use Hitch Guidance only to help back the vehicle to a trailer hitch or, when traveling above 12 km/h (8 mph), to briefly check the status of your trailer. Do not use for any other purpose, such as making lane change decisions. Before making a lane change, always check the mirrors and glance over your shoulder. Improper use could result in serious injury to you or others. HD Surround Vision with Trailer Camera Provisions If equipped, this feature provides additional views to aid in trailering/towing. The system shows multiple views in the infotainment display using five cameras mounted around the vehicle and up to two additional accessory cameras that can be mounted on or in a trailer. The front camera is in the grille under the front emblem, the side cameras are on the bottom of the outside mirrors, the rear camera is in the tailgate handle and the bed camera is mounted on the rear of the cab. Additionally, up to two accessory cameras can be mounted to the rear and/or interior Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 260 Driving and Operating of the trailer. See your dealer for accessory trailer cameras. To access, touch CAMERA on the infotainment display or shift to R (Reverse). To return to the previous screen when not in reverse, touch the Home or Back buttons on the infotainment display. Certain trailer views require a compatible trailer profile be configured and selected. A compatible trailer is a box type trailer (cargo, camper, etc.) with a conventional hitch. Available camera views: . Front/Rear Standard View . Front/Rear Top-Down View . Rear Bowl View . Front/Rear Side View . Hitch View . Bed View . Rear trailer View . Rear Side view with a available articulation functionality . Picture-in-Picture Side View . Interior Trailer View . Transparent trailer View . Surround View . Guidance Lines . Hitch Guidance Surround Vision (360 Degrees) Surround Vision If equipped, the Surround Vision system can display various views surrounding the vehicle in the infotainment display using four cameras mounted around the vehicle. The front camera is in the grille under the front emblem, the side cameras are on the bottom of the outside mirrors, and the rear camera is in the tailgate handle. If equipped, this feature provides, additional views to aid in trailering/towing. The Front Vision Camera and Surround Vision cameras are not supported. The system can show various views in the infotainment display using cameras mounted in and around the vehicle and trailer. The rear camera is in the tailgate handle and the cargo bed camera is mounted on the rear of the cab. Up to two accessory cameras can be mounted to the rear and/or interior of the trailer. See your dealer for these accessory cameras. The Surround Vision system can be accessed by selecting CAMERA in the infotainment display or when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse). To return to the previous screen sooner, when not in R (Reverse), press the Home or Back button on the infotainment system, shift into P (Park), or, while in D (Drive), reach a vehicle speed of approximately 12 km/h (8 mph). Available camera views: . Front/Rear Standard View . Front/Rear Top-Down View . Rear Bowl View . Front/Rear Side View . Hitch View . Surround View . Guidance Lines . Hitch Guidance The system can be accessed by selecting CAMERA in the infotainment display or when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse). To return to the previous screen sooner, when not in R (Reverse), press the Home or Back button on the infotainment system or shift into P (Park). Available camera views: . Rear Standard View . Hitch View . Bed View . Rear Trailer View . Interior Trailer View . Guidance Lines . Hitch Guidance Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Troubleshooting The Transparent Trailer calibration may take longer than expected or not calibrate if: . The vehicle is driven too fast during calibration. Speed should be maintained below 50 km/h (31 mph). . The vehicle is not driven straight during calibration. Steering should be maintained as straight as possible, excessive steering during calibration may extend calibration time. . The calibration is attempted in low light. Calibration should be attempted when there is enough light. . The calibration is attempted during adverse weather conditions. Calibration during conditions such as snow or heavy rain should be avoided. . The road surface is not ideal for calibration. Calibration should be attempted on an alternate road surface. . The accessory trailer cameras are swapped at the hitch connector. Ensure that the camera mounted to the rear of the trailer is connected to the rear trailer camera input. . The accessory trailer camera is mounted, angled or rotated outside of the defined mounting location (see camera installation instructions). Distortion may be observed in the calibrated Transparent Trailer View if: . The accessory trailer camera is mounted, angled or rotated outside of the defined mounting location (see camera installation instructions). The Transparent Trailer icon may appear grayed out if: . A compatible trailer profile is not configured or a non-compatible trailer profile is selected. . The vehicle is in R (Reverse). . The trailer is not connected. . The accessory rear trailer camera is not connected or connected to the incorrect input. The preview may not be provided or the wrong preview may be provided if: . The accessory cameras are not recognized. Ensure that the accessory camera(s) are connected and power cycle the vehicle. 261 . The accessory trailer cameras are swapped at the hitch connector. Ensure that the accessory camera(s) are connected to the correct input. . The accessory trailer camera(s) are connected to the correct camera input. . The accessory trailer camera(s) are not installed according to the installation instructions. A feature may be unavailable or not activating as expected if: . The customization is disabled. Check the customization settings where applicable. . The accessory trailer cameras are swapped at the hitch connector. Ensure that the accessory camera(s) are connected to the correct camera input. A view may switch automatically if: . The vehicle is shifted to another gear. Park Assist If the vehicle has Rear Park Assist (RPA) or Front and Rear Park Assist (FRPA), as the vehicle moves at speeds of less than 8 km/h (5 mph) the sensors on the bumpers may detect objects up to 1.2 m (4 ft) in front and 2.5 m (8 ft) behind the vehicle within a zone 25 cm (10 in) high off the ground and below Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 262 Driving and Operating bumper level. These detection distances may be shorter during warmer or humid weather. Blocked sensors will not detect objects and can also cause false detections. Keep the sensors clean of mud, dirt, snow, ice, and slush; and clean sensors after a car wash in freezing temperatures. The instrument cluster may have a Park Assist display with bars that show “distance to object” and object location information for the Front and Rear Park Assist system. As the object gets closer, more bars light up and the bars change color from yellow to amber to red. { Warning When an object is first detected in the rear, one beep will be heard from the rear, or both sides of the Safety Alert Seat will pulse two times. When an object is very close — <0.4 m (1.5 ft) in the vehicle rear or <0.3 m (1 ft) in the vehicle front — five beeps will sound from the rear or front depending on object location, or both sides of the Safety Alert Seat will pulse five times. Beeps for FPA are higher pitched than for RPA. The Park Assist system does not detect children, pedestrians, bicyclists, animals, or objects located below the bumper or that are too close or too far from the vehicle. It is not available at speeds greater than 8 km/h (5 mph). To prevent injury, death, or vehicle damage, even with Park Assist, always check the area around the vehicle and check all mirrors before moving forward or backing. Turning the Features On or Off Press X on the center stack to turn on or off the Front and Rear Park Assist. The indicator light next to the button comes on when the features are on and turns off when the features have been disabled. Front and Rear Park Assist can be turned Off, On, or On with Towbar. See “Park Assist” under Vehicle Personalization 0 131. If Park Assist is turned off through vehicle personalization, the Park Assist button will be disabled. To turn Park Assist on again, select On in vehicle personalization. The On with Towbar setting allows Park Assist to work properly with a trailer hitch. Some larger trailer hitches may not be compatible. Turn off Park Assist when towing a trailer. To turn the RPA symbols on or off, see “Rear Camera Park Assist Symbols” under Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA) System If equipped, when the vehicle is shifted into R (Reverse), RCTA shows a red warning triangle with a left or right pointing arrow on the infotainment display to warn of traffic coming from the left or right. This system detects objects coming from up to Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating 20 m (65 ft) from the left or right side of the vehicle. When an object is detected, either three beeps sound from the left or right or three Safety Alert Seat pulses occur on the left or right side, depending on the direction of the detected vehicle. Use caution while backing up when towing a trailer, as the RCTA detection zones that extend out from the back of the vehicle do not move further back when a trailer is towed. RCTA is disabled when the trailer connection status is displayed. RCTA can be turned off. See “Collision/ Detection Systems” under Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Assistance Systems for Driving If equipped, when driving the vehicle in a forward gear, Forward Collision Alert (FCA), Lane Departure Warning (LDW), Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA), Lane Change Alert (LCA), and/or the Automatic Emergency Braking (AEB) can help to avoid a crash or reduce crash damage. Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System If equipped, the FCA system may help to avoid or reduce the harm caused by front-end crashes. When approaching a vehicle ahead too quickly, FCA provides a red flashing alert on the windshield and rapidly beeps. FCA also lights an amber visual alert if following another vehicle much too closely. FCA detects vehicles within a distance of approximately 60 m (197 ft) and operates at speeds above 8 km/h (5 mph). 263 Warning (Continued) objects. Be ready to take action and apply the brakes. See Defensive Driving 0 211. FCA can be disabled through vehicle personalization. See “Collision/Detection Systems” under Vehicle Personalization 0 131. Detecting the Vehicle Ahead { Warning FCA is a warning system and does not apply the brakes. When approaching a slower-moving or stopped vehicle ahead too rapidly, or when following a vehicle too closely, FCA may not provide a warning with enough time to help avoid a crash. It also may not provide any warning at all. FCA does not warn of pedestrians, animals, signs, guardrails, bridges, construction barrels, or other (Continued) FCA warnings will not occur unless the FCA system detects a vehicle ahead. When a vehicle is detected, the vehicle ahead indicator will display green. Vehicles may not be detected on curves, highway exit ramps, or hills, due to poor visibility; or if a vehicle ahead is partially blocked by pedestrians or other objects. FCA will not detect another vehicle ahead until it is completely in the driving lane. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 264 Driving and Operating The vehicle ahead indicator will display amber when you are following a vehicle ahead much too closely. { Warning FCA does not provide a warning to help avoid a crash, unless it detects a vehicle. FCA may not detect a vehicle ahead if the FCA sensor is blocked by dirt, snow, or ice, or if the windshield is damaged. It may also not detect a vehicle on winding or hilly roads, or in conditions that can limit visibility such as fog, rain, or snow, or if the headlamps or windshield are not cleaned or in proper condition. Keep the windshield, headlamps, and FCA sensors clean and in good repair. Collision Alert Selecting the Alert Timing Without Head-Up Display When your vehicle approaches another detected vehicle too rapidly, the red FCA display will flash on the windshield. Also, eight rapid high-pitched beeps will sound from the front, or both sides of the Safety Alert Seat will pulse five times. When this Collision Alert occurs, the brake system may prepare for driver braking to occur more rapidly which can cause a brief, mild deceleration. Continue to apply the brake pedal as needed. Cruise control may be disengaged when the Collision Alert occurs. Tailgating Alert The Collision Alert control is on the steering wheel. Press [ to set the FCA timing to Far, Medium, or Near. The first button press shows the current setting on the DIC. Additional button presses will change this setting. The chosen setting will remain until it is changed and will affect the timing of both the Collision Alert and the Tailgating Alert features. The timing of both alerts will vary based on vehicle speed. The faster the vehicle speed, the farther away the alert will occur. Consider traffic and weather conditions when selecting the alert timing. The range of selectable alert timings may not be appropriate for all drivers and driving conditions. Unnecessary Alerts With Head-Up Display FCA may provide unnecessary alerts for turning vehicles, vehicles in other lanes, objects that are not vehicles, or shadows. These alerts are normal operation and the vehicle does not need service. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Cleaning the System If the FCA system does not seem to operate properly, this may correct the issue: . Clean the outside of the windshield in front of the rearview mirror. . Clean the entire front of the vehicle. . Clean the headlamps. Automatic Emergency Braking (AEB) If equipped, the AEB system may help avoid or reduce the harm caused by front-end crashes. AEB also includes Intelligent Brake Assist (IBA). When the system detects a vehicle ahead in your path that is traveling in the same direction that you may be about to crash into, it can provide a boost to braking or automatically brake the vehicle. This can help avoid or lessen the severity of crashes when driving in a forward gear. Depending on the situation, the vehicle may automatically brake moderately or hard. This automatic emergency braking can only occur if a vehicle is detected. This is shown by the FCA vehicle ahead indicator being lit. See Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System 0 263. The system works when driving in a forward gear between 8 km/h (5 mph) and 80 km/h (50 mph). It can detect vehicles up to approximately 60 m (197 ft). { Warning AEB is an emergency crash preparation feature and is not designed to avoid crashes. Do not rely on AEB to brake the vehicle. AEB will not brake outside of its operating speed range and only responds to detected vehicles. AEB may not: . Detect a vehicle ahead on winding or hilly roads. . Detect all vehicles, especially vehicles with a trailer, tractors, muddy vehicles, etc. . Detect a vehicle when weather limits visibility, such as in fog, rain, or snow. . Detect a vehicle ahead if it is partially blocked by pedestrians or other objects. (Continued) 265 Warning (Continued) Complete attention is always required while driving, and you should be ready to take action and apply the brakes and/or steer the vehicle to avoid crashes. AEB may slow the vehicle to a complete stop to try to avoid a potential crash. If this happens, AEB may engage the Electric Parking Brake (EPB) to hold the vehicle at a stop. Release the EPB or firmly press the accelerator pedal. { Warning AEB may automatically brake the vehicle suddenly in situations where it is unexpected and undesired. It could respond to a turning vehicle ahead, guardrails, signs, and other non-moving objects. To override AEB, firmly press the accelerator pedal, if it is safe to do so. Intelligent Brake Assist (IBA) IBA may activate when the brake pedal is applied quickly by providing a boost to braking based on the speed of approach and distance to a vehicle ahead. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 266 Driving and Operating Minor brake pedal pulsations or pedal movement during this time is normal and the brake pedal should continue to be applied as needed. IBA will automatically disengage only when the brake pedal is released. { Warning IBA may increase vehicle braking in situations when it may not be necessary. You could block the flow of traffic. If this occurs, take your foot off the brake pedal and then apply the brakes as needed. AEB and IBA can be disabled. See “Collision/ Detection Systems” under Vehicle Personalization 0 131. { Warning Using AEB or IBA while towing a trailer could cause you to lose control of the vehicle and crash. Turn the system to Alert or Off when towing a trailer. A system unavailable message may display if: . The front of the vehicle or windshield is not clean. . Heavy rain or snow is interfering with object detection. . There is a problem with the StabiliTrak/ Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system. The AEB system does not need service. Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) If equipped, the SBZA system is a lane-changing aid that assists drivers with avoiding crashes that occur with moving vehicles in the side blind zone, or blind spot areas. When the vehicle is in a forward gear, the left or right side mirror display will light up if a moving vehicle is detected in that blind zone. If the turn signal is activated and a vehicle is also detected on the same side, the display will flash as an extra warning not to change lanes. Since this system is part of the Lane Change Alert (LCA) system, read the entire LCA section before using this feature. LCA warning display will light up in the corresponding outside side mirror and will flash if the turn signal is on. { Warning LCA does not alert the driver to vehicles outside of the system detection zones, pedestrians, bicyclists, or animals. It may not provide alerts when changing lanes under all driving conditions. Failure to use proper care when changing lanes may result in injury, death, or vehicle damage. Before making a lane change, always check mirrors, glance over your shoulder, and use the turn signals. LCA Detection Zones Lane Change Alert (LCA) If equipped, the LCA system is a lane-changing aid that assists drivers with avoiding lane change crashes that occur with moving vehicles in the side blind zone (or spot) areas or with vehicles rapidly approaching these areas from behind. The 1. SBZA Detection Zone 2. LCA Detection Zone Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating The LCA sensor covers a zone of approximately one lane over from both sides of the vehicle, or 3.5 m (11 ft). The height of the zone is approximately between 0.5 m (1.5 ft) and 2 m (6 ft) off the ground. The Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) warning area starts at approximately the middle of the vehicle and goes back 5 m (16 ft). Drivers are also warned of vehicles rapidly approaching from up to 70 m (230 ft) behind the vehicle. When the vehicle is started, both outside mirror LCA displays will briefly come on to indicate the system is operating. When the vehicle is in a forward gear, the left or right side mirror display will light up if a moving vehicle is detected in the next lane over in that blind zone or rapidly approaching that zone. If the turn signal is activated in the same direction as a detected vehicle, this display will flash as an extra warning not to change lanes. How the System Works LCA can be disabled through vehicle personalization. When you disable LCA, SBZA is also disabled. See Vehicle Personalization 0 131. If LCA is disabled by the driver, the LCA mirror displays will not light up. The LCA symbol lights up in the side mirrors when the system detects a moving vehicle in the next lane over that is in the side blind zone or rapidly approaching that zone from behind. A lit LCA symbol indicates it may be unsafe to change lanes. Before making a lane change, check the LCA display, check mirrors, glance over your shoulder, and use the turn signals. Left Side Mirror Display Right Side Mirror Display When the System Does Not Seem to Work Properly The LCA system requires some driving for the system to calibrate to maximum performance. This calibration may occur more quickly if the vehicle is driving on a straight highway road with traffic and roadside objects (e.g., guardrails, barriers). LCA displays may not come on when passing a vehicle quickly, for a stopped vehicle, or when towing a trailer. The LCA detection zones that extend back from the 267 side of the vehicle do not move further back when a trailer is towed. Use caution while changing lanes when towing a trailer. LCA may alert to objects attached to the vehicle, such as a trailer, bicycle, or object extending out to either side of the vehicle. Attached objects may also interfere with the detection of vehicles. This is normal system operation; the vehicle does not need service. LCA may not always alert the driver to vehicles in the next lane over, especially in wet conditions or when driving on sharp curves. The system does not need to be serviced. The system may light up due to guardrails, signs, trees, shrubs, and other non-moving objects. This is normal system operation; the vehicle does not need service. LCA may not operate when the LCA sensors in the left or right corners of the rear bumper are covered with mud, dirt, snow, ice, or slush, or in heavy rainstorms. For cleaning instructions, see "Washing the Vehicle" under Exterior Care 0 381. If the DIC still displays the system unavailable message after cleaning both sides of the vehicle toward the rear corners of the vehicle, see your dealer. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 268 Driving and Operating If the LCA displays do not light up when moving vehicles are in the side blind zone or are rapidly approaching this zone and the system is clean, the system may need service. Take the vehicle to your dealer. { Warning The LDW system does not steer the vehicle. The LDW system may not: . Provide enough time to avoid a crash. Radio Frequency Information . Detect lane markings under poor See Radio Frequency Statement 0 417. weather or visibility conditions. This can occur if the windshield or headlamps are blocked by dirt, snow, or ice; if they are not in proper condition; or if the sun shines directly into the camera. . Detect road edges. . Detect lanes on winding or hilly roads. Lane Departure Warning (LDW) If equipped, LDW may help avoid crashes due to unintentional lane departures. LDW uses a camera sensor to detect the lane markings at speeds of 56 km/h (35 mph) or greater. It may provide an alert if the vehicle is crossing a lane without using a turn signal in that direction. LDW light will not alert if the turn signal is active in the direction of lane departure, or if LDW detects that you are accelerating, braking or actively steering. If LDW only detects lane markings on one side of the road, it will only warn you when departing the lane on the side where it has detected a lane marking. Always keep your attention on the road and maintain proper vehicle position within the lane, or vehicle damage, injury, or death could occur. Always keep the windshield, headlamps, and camera sensors clean and in good repair. Do not use LDW in bad weather conditions. How the System Works LDW utilizes a camera sensor installed on the windshield ahead of the rearview mirror to detect lane markings. To turn LDW on and off, press @ on the center stack. The control indicator will light when LDW is on. When LDW is on, @ is green if LDW is available to warn of a lane departure. If the vehicle crosses a detected lane marking without using the turn signal in that direction, @ changes to amber and flashes. Additionally, there will be three beeps, on the right or left, depending on the lane departure direction. LDW will not alert if the turn signal is active in the direction of lane departure or if LDA detects that you are accelerating, braking or actively steering. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Prohibited Fuels Fuel Caution Top Tier Fuel GM recommends the use of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline to keep the engine clean, reduce engine deposits, and maintain optimal vehicle performance. Look for the TOP TIER Logo or see www.toptiergas.com for a list of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline marketers and applicable countries. If the vehicle has a yellow sticker on the fuel door, E85 or FlexFuel can be used. If the vehicle does not have a yellow sticker, do not use gasoline with ethanol levels greater than 15% by volume. See E85 or FlexFuel 0 270. Regular unleaded gasoline meeting ASTM specification D4814 with a posted octane rating (R+M)/2 of 87 or greater is recommended. Do not use gasoline with a posted octane rating of less than 87, as this will result in reduced performance and driveability. If heavy knocking is heard when using gasoline rated at 87 or greater, the engine needs service. Recommended Fuel For diesel engine vehicles, see “Fuel for Diesel Engines” in the Duramax diesel supplement. 269 Do not use fuels with any of the following conditions; doing so may damage the vehicle and void its warranty: . For vehicles that are not FlexFuel, fuel labeled greater than 15% ethanol by volume, such as mid-level ethanol blends (16–50% ethanol), E85, or FlexFuel. . Fuel with any amount of methanol, methylal, ferrocene, and aniline. These fuels can corrode metal fuel system parts or damage plastic and rubber parts. . Fuel containing metals such as methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl (MMT), which can damage the emissions control system and spark plugs. . Fuel with a posted octane rating of less than the recommended fuel. Using this fuel will lower fuel economy and performance, and may decrease the life of the emissions catalyst. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 270 Driving and Operating Fuels in Foreign Countries The U.S., Canada, and Mexico post fuel octane ratings in anti-knock index (AKI). For fuel not to use in a foreign country, see Prohibited Fuels 0 269. Fuel Additives TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is highly recommended for use with your vehicle. If your country does not have TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline, add ACDelco Fuel System Treatment Plus−Gasoline to the vehicle’s gasoline fuel tank at every oil change or 15 000 km (9,000 mi), whichever occurs first. TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline and ACDelco Fuel System Treatment Plus −Gasoline will help keep your vehicle’s engine fuel deposit free and performing optimally. E85 or FlexFuel Vehicles with a yellow fuel sticker on the fuel door can use either unleaded gasoline or fuel containing up to 85% ethanol (E85). All other vehicles should use only the unleaded gasoline as described in Recommended Fuel 0 269. The use of E85 or FlexFuel is encouraged when the vehicle is designed to use it. E85 or FlexFuel is made from renewable sources. To help locate fuel stations that carry E85 or FlexFuel, the U.S. Department of Energy has an alternative fuel website. See www.afdc.energy.gov/afdc/locator/stations. E85 or FlexFuel should meet ASTM Specification D 5798 or CAN/CGSB–3.512 in Canada. Do not use the fuel if the ethanol content is greater than 85%. Fuel mixtures that do not meet ASTM or CGSB specifications can affect driveability and could cause the malfunction indicator lamp to come on. The starting characteristics of E85 or FlexFuel make it unsuitable for use when temperatures fall below −18 °C (0 °F). Use gasoline or add gasoline to the E85 or FlexFuel. Because E85 or FlexFuel has less energy per liter (gallon) than gasoline, the vehicle will need to be refilled more often. See Filling the Tank (Chassis Cab and Box Delete Models) 0 272 or Filling the Tank (Pickup Models) 0 271. The only GM approved aftermarket additive is ACDelco Fuel System Treatment Plus-FlexFuel. Follow the instructions on the bottle for proper use. This product is available at your GM dealer. Caution Some additives are not compatible with E85 or FlexFuel and can harm the vehicle's fuel system. Use only additives approved by GM for E85 or FlexFuel vehicles. Damage caused by unapproved additives would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Caution Do not use fuel containing methanol. It can corrode metal parts in the fuel system and also damage plastic and rubber parts. That damage would not be covered under the vehicle warranty. To help keep the engine running efficiently, fill the tank with gasoline, up to E15, after filling the tank with E85 one or two times. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Filling the Tank (Pickup Models) If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. An arrow on the fuel gauge indicates which side of the vehicle the fuel door is on. See Fuel Gauge 0 111. { Warning Fuel vapors and fuel fires burn violently and can cause injury or death. Follow these guidelines to help avoid injuries to you and others: . Read and follow all the instructions on . . . . . the fuel pump island. Turn off the engine when refueling. Keep sparks, flames, and smoking materials away from fuel. Do not leave the fuel pump unattended. Avoid using electronic devices while refueling. Do not re-enter the vehicle while pumping fuel. (Continued) Warning (Continued) . Keep children away from the fuel pump and never let children pump fuel. . Before touching the fill nozzle, touch a metallic object to discharge static electricity from your body. . Fuel can spray out if the fill nozzle is inserted too quickly. This spray can happen if the tank is nearly full, and is more likely in hot weather. Insert the fill nozzle slowly and wait for any hiss noise to stop before beginning to flow fuel. 271 The capless refueling system does not have a fuel cap. Fully insert and latch the fill nozzle, begin fueling. { Warning Overfilling the fuel tank by more than three clicks of a standard fill nozzle may cause: . Vehicle performance issues, including engine stalling and damage to the fuel system. . Fuel spills. . Under certain conditions, fuel fires. Be careful not to spill fuel. Wait five seconds after you have finished pumping before removing the fill nozzle. Clean fuel from painted surfaces as soon as possible. See Exterior Care 0 381. Push the fuel door closed. { Warning If a fire starts while you are refueling, do not remove the fill nozzle. Shut off the flow of fuel by shutting off the pump or by notifying the station attendant. Leave the area immediately. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 272 Driving and Operating Filling the Tank with a Portable Fuel Container If the vehicle runs out of fuel and must be filled from a portable fuel container: Filling the Tank (Chassis Cab and Box Delete Models) If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. An arrow on the fuel gauge indicates which side of the vehicle the fuel fill is on. See Fuel Gauge 0 111. { Warning 1. Locate the capless funnel adapter. 2. Insert and latch the funnel into the capless fuel system. { Warning Attempting to refuel from a portable fuel container without using the funnel adapter may cause fuel spillage and damage the capless fuel system. This could cause a fire. You or others could be badly burned and the vehicle could be damaged. 3. Remove and clean the funnel adapter and return it to the storage location. Fuel vapors and fuel fires burn violently and can cause injury or death. Follow these guidelines to help avoid injuries to you and others: . Read and follow all the instructions on . . . . . the fuel pump island. Turn off the engine when refueling. Keep sparks, flames, and smoking materials away from fuel. Do not leave the fuel pump unattended. Avoid using electronic devices while refueling. Do not re-enter the vehicle while pumping fuel. (Continued) Warning (Continued) . Keep children away from the fuel pump and never let children pump fuel. . Before touching the fill nozzle, touch a metallic object to discharge static electricity from your body. . Fuel can spray out if the fuel cap is opened too quickly. This spray can happen if the tank is nearly full, and is more likely in hot weather. Open the fuel cap slowly and wait for any hiss noise to stop, then unscrew the cap all the way. Turn the fuel cap counterclockwise to remove. Fully insert and latch the fill nozzle, begin fueling. For models with dual fuel tanks, the fuel gauge shows an average of both tanks. When refueling, refuel the primary front tank first, then add fuel to the auxiliary rear tank. { Warning Overfilling the fuel tank by more than three clicks of a standard fill nozzle may cause: (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Warning (Continued) . Vehicle performance issues, including engine stalling and damage to the fuel system. . Fuel spills. . Under certain conditions, fuel fires. Be careful not to spill fuel. Wait five seconds after you have finished pumping before removing the fill nozzle. Clean fuel from painted surfaces as soon as possible. See Exterior Care 0 381. Reinstall the cap by turning it clockwise until it clicks. { Warning If a fire starts while you are refueling, do not remove the fill nozzle. Shut off the flow of fuel by shutting off the pump or by notifying the station attendant. Leave the area immediately. Caution If a new fuel cap is needed, get the right type of cap from your dealer. The wrong type of fuel cap may not fit properly, (Continued) Caution (Continued) may turn on the malfunction indicator lamp, and could damage the fuel system and emissions system. See Malfunction Indicator Lamp (Check Engine Light) 0 116. Filling a Portable Fuel Container { Warning Never fill a portable fuel container while it is in the vehicle. Static electricity discharge from the container can ignite the fuel vapor. You or others could be badly burned and the vehicle could be damaged. To help avoid injury to you and others: . Dispense fuel only into approved containers. . Do not fill a container while it is inside a vehicle, in a vehicle's trunk, in a pickup bed, or on any surface other than the ground. . Bring the fill nozzle in contact with the inside of the fill opening before operating the nozzle. Maintain contact until filling is complete. (Continued) 273 Warning (Continued) . Keep sparks, flames, and smoking materials away from fuel. . Avoid using electronic devices while pumping fuel. . When transporting a fuel container or other material that can catch fire in the truck bed, secure the container to prevent spills. Trailer Towing General Towing Information Only use towing equipment that has been designed for the vehicle. Contact your dealer or trailering dealer for assistance with preparing the vehicle to tow a trailer. Read the entire section before towing a trailer. To tow a disabled vehicle, see Towing the Vehicle 0 377. To tow the vehicle behind another vehicle such as a motor home, see Recreational Vehicle Towing 0 378. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 274 Driving and Operating Driving Characteristics and Towing Tips { Warning You can lose control when towing a trailer if the correct equipment is not used or the vehicle is not driven properly. For example, if the trailer is too heavy or the trailer brakes are inadequate for the load, the vehicle may not stop as expected. You and others could be seriously injured. The vehicle may also be damaged, and the repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Pull a trailer only if all the steps in this section have been followed. Ask your dealer for advice and information about towing a trailer with the vehicle. Driving with a Trailer Trailering is different than just driving the vehicle by itself. Trailering means changes in handling, acceleration, braking, durability, and fuel economy. Successful, safe trailering takes correct equipment, and it has to be used properly. The following information has many time-tested, important trailering tips and safety rules. Many of these are important for your safety and that of your passengers. Read this section carefully before pulling a trailer. When towing a trailer: . Become familiar with and follow all state and local laws that apply to trailer towing. These requirements vary from state to state. . State laws may require the use of extended side view mirrors. Even if not required, you should install extended side view mirrors if your visibility is limited or restricted while towing. . Do not tow a trailer during the first 800 km (500 mi) of vehicle use to prevent damage to the engine, axle, or other parts. . It is recommended to perform the first oil change before heavy towing. . During the first 800 km (500 mi) of trailer towing, do not drive over 80 km/h (50 mph) and do not make starts at full throttle. . Vehicles can tow in D (Drive). Tow/Haul Mode is recommended for heavier trailers. See Tow/Haul Mode 0 240. If the transmission downshifts too often, a lower gear may be selected using Manual Mode. See Manual Mode 0 238. If equipped, the following driver assistance features should be turned off when towing a trailer: . Park Assist . Automatic Parking Assist (APA) . Reverse Automatic Braking (RAB) If equipped, the following driver assistance features should be turned to alert or off when towing a trailer, unless equipped with Super Cruise: . Automatic Emergency Braking (AEB) . Front Pedestrian Braking (FPB) If equipped with Lane Change Alert (LCA), the LCA detection zones that extend back from the side of the vehicle do not move further back when a trailer is towed. Use caution while changing lanes when towing a trailer. If equipped with Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA), use caution while backing up when towing a trailer, as the RCTA detection zones that extend out from the back of the vehicle do not move further back when a trailer is towed. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating { Warning To prevent serious injury or death from carbon monoxide (CO), when towing a trailer: . Do not drive with the liftgate, trunk/ hatch, or rear-most window open. . Fully open the air outlets on or under the instrument panel. . Adjust the climate control system to a setting that brings in only outside air. See “Climate Control Systems” in the Index. For more information about carbon monoxide, see Engine Exhaust 0 235. and attachments, safety chains, electrical connectors, lamps, tires, and mirrors. See Towing Equipment 0 281. If the trailer has electric brakes, start the combination moving and then manually apply the trailer brake controller to check that the trailer brakes work. During the trip, occasionally check that the cargo and trailer are secure and that the lamps and any trailer brakes are working. Towing with a Stability Control System When towing, the stability control system might be heard. The system reacts to vehicle movement caused by the trailer, which mainly occurs during cornering. This is normal when towing heavier trailers. Towing a trailer requires experience. The combination of the vehicle and trailer is longer and not as responsive as the vehicle itself. Get used to the handling and braking of the combination by driving on a level road surface before driving on public roads. Following Distance The trailer structure, the tires, and the brakes must all be rated to carry the intended cargo. Inadequate trailer equipment can cause the combination to operate in an unexpected or unsafe manner. Before driving, inspect all trailer hitch parts Passing Stay at least twice as far behind the vehicle ahead as you would when driving without a trailer. This can help to avoid heavy braking and sudden turns. More passing distance is needed when towing a trailer. The combination of the vehicle and trailer will not accelerate as quickly and is much longer than the vehicle alone. It is necessary to go much farther 275 beyond the passed vehicle before returning to the lane. Pass on level roadways. Avoid passing on hills if possible. Backing Up Hold the bottom of the steering wheel with one hand. To move the trailer to the left, move that hand to the left. To move the trailer to the right, move that hand to the right. Always back up slowly and, if possible, have someone guide you. Making Turns Caution Turn more slowly and make wider arcs when towing a trailer to prevent damage to your vehicle. Making very sharp turns could cause the trailer to contact the vehicle. Make wider turns than normal when towing, so the trailer will not go over soft shoulders, over curbs, or strike road signs, trees, or other objects. Always signal turns well in advance. Do not steer or brake suddenly. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 276 Driving and Operating Driving on Grades Reduce speed and shift to a lower gear before starting down a long or steep downhill grade. If the transmission is not shifted down, the brakes may overheat and result in reduced braking efficiency. The vehicle can tow in D (Drive). Shift the transmission to a lower gear if the transmission shifts too often under heavy loads and/or hilly conditions. Parking on Hills { Warning To prevent serious injury or death, always park your vehicle and trailer on a level surface when possible. When towing at higher altitudes, engine coolant will boil at a lower temperature than at lower altitudes. If the engine is turned off immediately after towing at high altitude on steep uphill grades, the vehicle could show signs similar to engine overheating. To avoid this, let the engine run, preferably on level ground, with the transmission in P (Park) for a few minutes before turning the engine off. If the overheat warning comes on, see Engine Overheating 0 318. When parking your vehicle and your trailer on a hill: 1. Press the brake pedal, but do not shift into P (Park) yet. Turn the wheels into the curb if facing downhill or into traffic if facing uphill. 2. Have someone place chocks under the trailer wheels. 3. Gradually release the brake pedal to allow the chocks to absorb the load of the trailer. 4. Reapply the brake pedal. Then apply the parking brake and shift into P (Park). 5. Release the brake pedal. Viewing Systems Leaving After Parking on a Hill If equipped, the viewing systems on the vehicle can improve visibility while hitching, backing, and driving with a trailer. See Driver Assistance Systems 0 252. 1. Apply and hold the brake pedal. . Start the engine. . Shift into a gear. . Release the parking brake. 2. Let up on the brake pedal. 3. Drive slowly until the trailer is clear of the chocks. 4. Stop and have someone pick up and store the chocks. Launching and Retrieving a Boat Backing the Trailer into the Water { Warning . Have all passengers get out of the vehicle before backing onto the sloped part of the ramp. Lower the driver and passenger side windows before backing onto the ramp. This will provide a means of escape in the unlikely event the vehicle slides into the water. . If the boat launch surface is slippery, have the driver remain in the vehicle with the brake pedal applied while the boat is being launched. The boat launch can be especially slippery at low tide when part of the ramp was previously submerged at high tide. Do not back onto the ramp to launch the boat if you are not sure the vehicle can maintain traction. (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Warning (Continued) . Do not move the vehicle if someone is in the path of the trailer. Some parts of the trailer might be underwater and not visible to people who are assisting in launching the boat. 5. Gradually release the brake pedal to allow the chocks to absorb the load of the trailer. 6. Reapply the brake pedal. Then apply the parking brake and shift into P (Park). 7. Release the brake pedal. Pulling the Trailer from the Water Disconnect the wiring to the trailer before backing the trailer into the water to prevent damage to the electrical circuits on the trailer. Reconnect the wiring to the trailer after removing the trailer from the water. If the trailer has electric brakes that can function when the trailer is submerged, it might help to leave the electrical trailer connector attached to maintain trailer brake functionality while on the boat ramp. To back the trailer into the water: 1. If equipped, place the vehicle in four-wheel-drive high. 2. Slowly back down the boat ramp until the boat is floating, but no further than necessary. 3. Press and hold the brake pedal, but do not shift into P (Park) yet. 4. Have someone place chocks under the front wheels of the vehicle. To 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. pull the trailer out of the water: Press and hold the brake pedal. Start the engine and shift into gear. Release the parking brake. Let up on the brake pedal. Drive slowly until the tires are clear of the chocks. 6. Stop and have someone pick up and store the chocks. 7. Slowly pull the trailer from the water. 8. Once the vehicle and trailer have been driven from the sloped part of the boat ramp, the vehicle can be shifted from four-wheel-drive high. Shift into the drive mode that is appropriate for the road conditions. 277 Caution If the vehicle tires begin to spin and the vehicle begins to slide toward the water, remove your foot from the accelerator pedal and apply the brake pedal. Seek help to have the vehicle towed up the ramp. Maintenance when Trailer Towing The vehicle needs service more often when used to tow trailers. See Maintenance Schedule 0 392. It is especially important to check the engine oil, axle lubricant, belts, cooling system, and brake system before and during each trip. Check periodically to see that all nuts and bolts on the trailer hitch are tight. Engine Cooling When Trailer Towing The cooling system may temporarily overheat during severe operating conditions. See Engine Overheating 0 318. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 278 Driving and Operating Trailer Towing If equipped with a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. Caution Towing a trailer improperly can damage the vehicle and result in costly repairs not covered by the vehicle warranty. To tow a trailer correctly, follow the directions in this section and see your dealer for important information about towing a trailer with the vehicle. Trailering is different than just driving the vehicle by itself. Trailering means changes in handling, acceleration, braking, durability, and fuel economy. Successful, safe trailering takes correct equipment, and it has to be used properly. The following information has many time-tested, important trailering tips and safety rules. Many of these are important for your safety and that of your passengers. Read this section carefully before pulling a trailer. Trailer Weight { Warning Never exceed the towing capacity for your vehicle. Safe trailering requires monitoring the weight, speed, altitude, road grades, outside temperature, and how frequently the vehicle is used to tow a trailer. Trailer Weight Ratings When towing a trailer, the combined weight of the vehicle, vehicle contents, trailer, and trailer contents must be below all of the maximum weight ratings for the vehicle, including: . GCWR: Gross Combined Weight Rating . GVWR: Gross Vehicle Weight Rating . Maximum Trailer Weight Rating . GAWR-RR: Gross Axle Weight Rating-Rear . Maximum Trailer Tongue Weight Rating See “Weight-Distributing Hitch and Adjustment” under Towing Equipment 0 281 to determine if equalizer bars are required to obtain the maximum trailer weight rating. See “Trailer Brakes” under Towing Equipment 0 281 to determine if brakes are required based on your trailer's weight. The only way to be sure the weight is not exceeding any of these ratings is to weigh the tow vehicle and trailer combination, fully loaded for the trip, getting individual weights for each of these items. A trailering information label on the B-pillar shows tow rating information for the vehicle. { Warning You and others could be seriously injured or killed if the trailer is too heavy or the trailer brakes are inadequate for the load. The vehicle may be damaged, and the repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Only tow a trailer if all the steps in this section have been followed. Ask your dealer for advice and information about towing a trailer. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR) GCWR is the total allowable weight of the completely loaded vehicle and trailer including any fuel, passengers, cargo, equipment, and accessories. Do not exceed the GCWR for your vehicle. The GCWR for the vehicle is on the Trailering Information Label. To check that the weight of the vehicle and trailer are within the GCWR for the vehicle, follow these steps: 1. Start with the "curb weight" from the Trailering Information Label. 2. Add the weight of the trailer loaded with cargo and ready for the trip. 3. Add the weight of all passengers. 4. Add the weight of all cargo in the vehicle. 5. Add the weight of hitch hardware such as a draw bar, ball, load equalizer bars, or sway bars. 6. Add the weight of any accessories or aftermarket equipment added to the vehicle. The resulting weight cannot exceed the GCWR value on the Trailering Information Label. The gross combined weight can also be confirmed by weighing the truck and trailer on a public scale. The truck and trailer should be loaded for the trip with passengers and cargo. 279 Maximum Trailer Weight The maximum trailer weight rating is calculated assuming the tow vehicle has a driver, a front seat passenger, and all required trailering equipment. This value represents the heaviest trailer the vehicle can tow, but it may be necessary to reduce the trailer weight to stay within the GCWR, GVWR, maximum trailer tongue load, or GAWR-RR for the vehicle. Use the Tow Rating Guide (my.chevrolet.com/learn) to determine how much the trailer can weigh, based on the vehicle model and options. Weights listed apply for conventional trailers and gooseneck/fifth-wheel trailers unless otherwise noted. Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) For information about the vehicle's maximum load capacity, see Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. When calculating the GVWR with a trailer attached, the trailer tongue weight must be included as part of the weight the vehicle is carrying. A step bumper trailer hitch can only support a total trailer weight up to 2 271 kg (5,000 lb). If a trailer hitch ball is added to the step bumper, check the hitch ball rating to be sure it is higher than the total trailer weight. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 280 Driving and Operating Maximum Trailer Tongue Weight Rating The Maximum Trailer Tongue Weight Rating is the allowable trailer tongue weight that the vehicle can support using a conventional trailer hitch. It may be necessary to reduce the overall trailer weight to stay within the maximum trailer tongue weight rating while still maintaining the correct trailer load balance. A fifth-wheel or gooseneck hitch may support a higher tongue weight. Do not exceed a maximum trailer tongue weight of 567 kg (1,250 lb) for a conventional trailer hitch. The trailer tongue weight contributes to the Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW). GVW includes the curb weight of your vehicle, any passengers, cargo, equipment and the trailer tongue weight. Vehicle options, passengers, cargo, and equipment reduce the maximum allowable tongue weight the vehicle can carry, which also reduces the maximum allowable trailer weight. Trailer Load Balance The correct trailer load balance must be maintained to ensure trailer stability. Incorrect load balance is a leading cause of trailer sway. The Maximum Trailer Tongue Weight Rating for a conventional trailer hitch or a fifth wheel/gooseneck hitch is shown on the Trailering Information Label. The trailer tongue weight (1) should be 10– 15% and fifth-wheel or gooseneck tongue weight should be 15–25% of the total loaded trailer weight (2). Some specific trailer types, such as boat trailers, fall outside of this range. Always refer to the trailer owner’s manual for the recommended trailer tongue weight for each trailer. Never exceed the maximum loads for the vehicle, hitch, and trailer. The trailer load balance percentage is calculated as: weight (1) divided by weight (2) times 100. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating After loading the trailer, separately weigh the trailer and then the trailer tongue and calculate the trailer load balance percentage to see if the weights and distribution are appropriate for your vehicle. If the trailer weight is too high, it may be possible to transfer some of the cargo into your vehicle. If the trailer tongue weight is too high or too low, it may be possible to rearrange some of the cargo inside of the trailer. Do not exceed the maximum allowable tongue weight for your vehicle. Use the shortest hitch extension available to position the hitch ball closer to your vehicle. This will help reduce the effect of the trailer tongue weight on the trailer hitch and the rear axle. Rear Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR-RR) The GAWR-RR is the total weight that can be supported by the rear axle of the vehicle. Do not exceed the GAWR-RR for the vehicle, with the tow vehicle and trailer fully loaded for the trip including the weight of the trailer tongue. If using a weight-distributing hitch, do not exceed the GAWR-RR before applying the weight distribution spring bars. 281 Towing Equipment Hitches { Warning In order to avoid serious injury or property damage, always follow the hitch manufacturer's instructions when securing your draw bar/coupling device to the vehicle's hitch receiver. Ensure that the draw bar/coupling device is secured with a locking retainer pin or other means such that rotation of the pin or locking mechanism will not cause the pin to back out or loosen during use. Failure to correctly secure the draw bar/ coupling device to the receiver can result in separation of the hitch/receiver while towing. If a cargo carrier is used in the trailer hitch receiver, choose a carrier that positions the load as close to the vehicle as possible. Make sure the total weight, including the carrier, is no more than half of the maximum allowable tongue weight for the vehicle or 227 kg (500 lb), whichever is less. The GAWR-RR for the vehicle is on the Trailering Information Label. Ask your dealer for trailering information or assistance. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 282 Driving and Operating Conventional Hitch A conventional hitch is bolted to the frame or cross member of the tow vehicle, and is generally rated Class 2, 3, or 4. Gooseneck Hitch A gooseneck hitch is designed to be coupled to a special hitch leveraging a hitch ball, and is mounted over the rear axle in the truck bed. Fifth-Wheel Hitch A fifth-wheel hitch is mounted over the rear axle in the truck bed, and leverages a hinged plate — the same type of hitch leveraged by semi trucks. Generally, fifth-wheel hitches accommodate large trailers with as many as one, two, or three axles. Always use the correct hitch equipment for your vehicle. Crosswinds, large trucks going by, and rough roads can affect the trailer and the hitch. Avoid sharp turns when using a step-bumper hitch to prevent damage. Make wider turns to prevent contact between your trailer and your bumper. Proper hitch equipment for your vehicle helps maintain control of the vehicle-trailer combination. Many trailers can be towed using a weight-carrying hitch which has a coupler latched to the hitch ball, or a tow eye latched to a pintle hook. Other trailers may require a weight-distributing hitch that uses spring bars to distribute the trailer tongue weight between your vehicle and trailer axles. Fifth-wheel and gooseneck hitches may also be used. See “Maximum Trailer Tongue Weight” under Trailer Towing 0 278 for weight limits with various hitch types. Consider using mechanical sway controls with any trailer. Ask a trailering professional about sway controls or refer to the trailer manufacturer's recommendations and instructions. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating 283 Weight-Distributing Hitch and Adjustment A weight-distributing hitch may be useful with some trailers. Use the following guidelines to determine if a weight-distributing hitch should be used. Vehicle 2500/3500 Maximum Trailer Weight GCWR* Maximum Tongue Weight Up to 9 080 kg (20,000 lb) See (1) below 25% (1) Weight distributing hitch required on vehicles equipped with On/Off Road (OOR) and Mud Terrain (MT) tires with trailers over 10,000 lbs. Weight distributing hitch optional for other vehicles. 1. Front of Vehicle 2. H1/H2 Body to Ground Distance Towing with Model 2500/3500 Trucks 1. Position the truck so that the trailer is ready to connect. Keep the trailer detached. 2. Measure the height of the top of the front wheel opening at the fender to the ground (H1). 3. Attach the vehicle to the trailer. Do not attach weight distribution bars at this time. 4. Measure the height of the top of the front wheel opening on the fender to the ground (H2). 5. Install and adjust the tension in the weight-distributing bars per the manufacturers’ recommendations so that the height of the front fender is approximately H2−[(H2−H1)/4] (1/4 the difference between the two measured ride heights, below the secondary ride height {H2}). 6. Visually inspect the trailer and weight-distributing hitch to ensure that the manufacturers’ recommendations have been met. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 284 Driving and Operating Measurement Height Example 2500/3500 (mm) H1 1 040 H2 1 080 H2−H1 40 (H2−H1)/4 10 H2−[(H2−H1)/4] 1 070 Tires . Do not tow a trailer while using a compact spare tire on the vehicle. . Tires must be properly inflated to support loads while towing a trailer. See Tires 0 344 for instructions on proper tire inflation. Fifth-Wheel and Gooseneck Trailering Fifth-wheel and gooseneck trailers can be used with many pickup models. These trailers place a larger percentage of the weight (kingpin weight) on the tow vehicle than conventional trailers. Make sure this weight does not cause the vehicle to exceed GAWR or GVWR. Fifth-wheel or gooseneck kingpin weight should be 15–25% of the trailer weight up to the maximum amount specified in the trailering chart for the vehicle. See “Trailer Weight" under Trailer Towing 0 278. Two Inch Adapter Sleeve and Retainer Pin The hitch should be in the pickup bed so that its centerline is over or slightly in front of the rear axle. Take care that it is not so far forward that it will contact the back of the cab in sharp turns. This is especially important for short box pickups. Trailer pin box extensions and sliding fifth-wheel hitch assemblies may be used. There should be at least 15 cm (6 in) of clearance between the top of the pickup box and the bottom of the trailer shelf that extends over the box. Safety Chains Make sure the hitch is attached to the tow vehicle frame rails. Do not use the pickup box for support. The 2500/3500 series vehicles are equipped with a 2-1/2” square receiver. An adapter is provided to allow the use of a 2” draw bar, along with a hitch retainer pin, and retainer clip. Always attach safety chains between the vehicle and the trailer. Instructions about safety chains may be provided by the hitch manufacturer or by the trailer manufacturer. If the trailer being towed weighs up to 2 271 kg (5,000 lb) with a factory-installed step bumper, safety chains may be attached Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating 285 to the attaching points on the bumper; otherwise, safety chains should be attached to holes on the trailer hitch. brake system. If you do, both the vehicle antilock brakes and the trailer brakes may not function, which could result in a crash. frame. The harness requires the installation of a trailer connector, which is available through your dealer. Cross the safety chains under the tongue of the trailer to help prevent the tongue from contacting the road if it becomes separated from the hitch. Always leave enough slack in the safety chains to allow the combination to turn. Never allow safety chains to drag on the ground. Auxiliary Battery Use only a round, seven-wire connector with flat blade terminals meeting SAE J2863 specifications for proper electrical connectivity. Trailer Brakes Loaded trailers over 900 kg (2,000 lb) must be equipped with brake systems and with brakes for each axle. Trailer braking equipment conforming to Canadian Standards Association (CSA) requirement CAN3-D313, or its equivalent, is recommended. State or local regulations may require trailers to have their own braking system if the loaded weight of the trailer exceeds certain minimums that can vary from state to state. Read and follow the instructions for the trailer brakes so they are installed, adjusted, and maintained properly. Never attempt to tap into your vehicle's hydraulic If equipped, the vehicle's auxiliary battery can be used to supply electrical power to additional equipment that may be added, such as a slide-in camper. Locate the auxiliary battery connector under the hood on the driver side of the vehicle, next to the engine compartment fuse block. Follow the proper installation instructions included with any electrical equipment that is installed. Caution To prevent draining the auxiliary battery, always turn off electrical equipment when not in use and do not use any equipment that may exceed the maximum amperage rating of 30 amps. Trailer Wiring Harness Basic Trailer Wiring If the vehicle is not equipped with a trailer connector on the rear bumper, a 7-wire trailering harness is tied to the vehicles The seven-wire harness contains the following trailer circuits: Stop/Turn Yellow/Blue Signal Left Stop/Turn Signal Right Green/Violet Tail/Parking Lamps Gray/Brown Reverse Lamps White/Green Battery Feed Red/Green Ground White Electric Trailer Brake Blue Heavy-Duty Trailer Wiring Harness Package If equipped, the trailer wiring harness, with a 7-pin connector and a 4-pin connector, is mounted on the vehicle's rear bumper. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 286 Driving and Operating 3. Left Turn/Brake 4. Right Turn/Brake on the top left hand side (A) and the rear trailer auxiliary camera (B) should be installed on the top right hand side. The trailer connectors contain the following circuits. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 1. Ground 2. Tail Lamps Left Turn/Brake Tail Lamps Reverse Lamps Battery Feed Right Turn/Brake Electric Brakes Ground If equipped, trailering camera connectors are available in the bumper trailer receptacle in place of the four pin connector. The inside trailer auxiliary camera should be installed If equipped with the fifth wheel/ gooseneck trailer package, the harness connector is mounted on the inside of the pickup bed behind the rear wheel. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Reverse Lamps White/Green Battery Feed Red/Green Ground White Electric Trailer Brake Blue Camper/Fifth-Wheel Trailer Wiring Package For vehicles without the fifth wheel/ gooseneck trailer package, the seven-wire camper harness is under the rear bumper, attached to the frame near the rear crossmember. A connector must be added to the wiring harness that connects to the camper. The harness contains the following camper/ trailer circuits: Stop/Turn Yellow/Blue Signal Left Stop/Turn Signal Right Green/Violet Tail/Parking Lamps Gray/Brown If equipped with the heavy-duty trailering option, see “Heavy-Duty Trailer Wiring Harness Package” earlier in this section. When the camper-wiring harness is ordered without the heavy-duty trailering package, a seven-wire harness with a seven-pin connector is at the rear of the vehicle and is tied to the vehicle's frame. Trailer Lamps Always check that all trailer lamps are working at the beginning of each trip, and periodically on longer trips. If equipped, the Trailering App will monitor the RH turn/brake lamp circuit, LH turn/ brake lamp circuit, running lamp circuit, and reverse lamp circuits on the trailer. DIC messages and Trailering App alerts may be displayed if lighting circuit issues are detected on the trailer. 287 Pressing START LIGHT TEST in the Trailering App automatically activates the trailer lamps. The Trailering App is not a substitute for manually inspecting your trailer lamps. See Trailering App 0 292. Turn Signals When Towing a Trailer When properly connected, the trailer turn signals will illuminate to indicate the vehicle is turning, changing lanes, or stopping. When towing a trailer, the arrows on the instrument cluster will illuminate even if the trailer is not properly connected or the bulbs are burned out. Tow/Haul Mode For instructions on how to enter Tow/Haul Mode, see Driver Mode Control 0 249. Tow/Haul assists when pulling a heavy trailer or a large or heavy load. See Tow/ Haul Mode 0 240. Tow/Haul Mode is designed to be most effective when the vehicle and trailer combined weight is at least 75% of the vehicle's Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR). See “Trailer Weight” under Trailer Towing 0 278. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 288 Driving and Operating Tow/Haul Mode is most useful when towing a heavy trailer or carrying a large or heavy load: . Through rolling terrain. . In stop-and-go traffic. . In busy parking lots. This symbol is on the Trailer Brake Control Panel on vehicles with an ITBC system. The power output to the trailer brakes is proportional to the amount of vehicle braking. This available power output to the trailer brakes can be adjusted to a wide range of trailering situations. Operating the vehicle in Tow/Haul Mode when lightly loaded or not towing will not cause damage; however, it is not recommended and may result in unpleasant engine and transmission driving characteristics, heavy or light steering efforts, and reduced fuel economy. The ITBC system is integrated with the vehicle’s brake, antilock brake, and StabiliTrak/Electronic Stability Control (ESC) systems. In trailering conditions that cause the vehicle’s antilock brake or StabiliTrak/ ESC systems to activate, power sent to the trailer's brakes will be automatically adjusted to minimize trailer wheel lock-up. This does not imply that the trailer has StabiliTrak/ESC. Integrated Trailer Brake Control System The vehicle may have an Integrated Trailer Brake Control (ITBC) system for use with electric trailer brakes or most electric over hydraulic trailer brake systems. These instructions apply to both types of electric trailer brakes. { Warning Connecting a trailer that has an air brake system may result in reduced or complete loss of trailer braking, including increased stopping distance or trailer instability which could result in serious injury, death, or property damage. Only use the ITBC system with electric or electric over hydraulic trailer brake systems. Trailer Brake Control Panel If the vehicle’s brake, antilock brake, or StabiliTrak/ESC systems are not functioning properly, the ITBC system may not function fully or at all. Make sure all of these systems are fully operational to allow the ITBC system to function properly. The ITBC system is powered through the vehicle's electrical system. Turning the ignition off will also turn off the ITBC system. The ITBC system is fully functional only when the ignition is in on. 1. Manual Trailer Brake Apply Lever 2. Trailer Symbol 3. Trailer Gain Adjustment Buttons Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating The trailer symbol on the control panel will light amber when a trailer with electric brakes is connected. The ITBC control panel is on the center stack. See Instrument Panel Overview 0 4. The control panel allows adjustment to the amount of output, referred to as Trailer Gain, available to the trailer brakes and allows manual application of the trailer brakes. Use the ITBC control panel and the DIC trailer brake display page to adjust and display power output to the trailer brakes. Trailer Brake DIC Display Page The ITBC display page indicates: . Trailer Gain setting . Output to the trailer brakes . Trailer connection . System operational status To display: . Scroll through the DIC menu pages . Press a Trailer Gain (+) or (−) button . Activate the Manual Trailer Brake Apply Lever TRAILER GAIN: Press a Trailer Gain button to recall the current Trailer Gain setting. Each press and release of the gain buttons will then change the Trailer Gain setting. Press the Trailer Gain (+) or (-) to adjust. Press and hold to continuously adjust the Trailer Gain. To turn the output to the trailer off, adjust the Trailer Gain setting to 0.0. This setting can be adjusted from 0.0 to 10.0 with a trailer connected or disconnected. TRAILER OUTPUT: This displays anytime a trailer with electric brakes is connected. Output to the trailer brakes is based on the amount of vehicle braking present and relative to the Trailer Gain setting. Output is displayed from 0 to 100% for each gain setting. The Trailer Output will indicate “- - - - - -” on the Trailer Brake Display Page whenever the following occur: . No trailer is connected. . A trailer without electric brakes is connected. No DIC message displays. . A trailer with electric brakes has become disconnected. A CHECK TRAILER WIRING message displays on the DIC. . There is a fault present in the wiring to the trailer brakes. A CHECK TRAILER WIRING message displays on the DIC. . The ITBC system is not working due to a fault. A SERVICE TRAILER BRAKE SYSTEM message displays in the DIC. 289 Manual Trailer Brake Apply Lever Slide this lever right to apply the trailer’s electric brakes independent of the vehicle’s brakes. Use this lever to adjust the Trailer Gain to achieve proper power output to the trailer brakes. Under certain circumstances, this lever can also be used to apply additional trailer braking. The trailer and vehicle brake lamps will come on when either the vehicle brakes or trailer brakes are applied and properly connected. Trailer Gain Adjustment Procedure Trailer Gain should be set for a specific trailering condition and it must be readjusted anytime vehicle loading, trailer loading, or road surface conditions change. { Warning Trailer brakes that are over-gained or under-gained may not stop the vehicle and the trailer as intended and can result in a crash. Always follow the instructions to set the Trailer Gain for the proper trailer stopping performance. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 290 Driving and Operating To adjust Trailer Gain for each towing condition: 1. Drive the vehicle with the trailer attached on a level road surface representative of the towing condition and free of traffic at about 32–40 km/h (20–25 mph) and fully apply the Manual Trailer Brake Apply Lever. Adjusting Trailer Gain at speeds lower than 32–40 km/h (20–25 mph) may result in an incorrect gain setting. 2. Adjust the Trailer Gain, using the Trailer Gain (+) or (−) adjustment buttons, to just below the point of trailer wheel lock-up, indicated by trailer wheel squeal or tire smoke when a trailer wheel locks. Trailer wheel lock-up may not occur if towing a heavily loaded trailer. Adjust the Trailer Gain to the highest allowable setting for the towing condition. 3. Readjust Trailer Gain anytime vehicle loading, trailer loading, or road surface conditions change or if trailer wheel lock-up is noticed at any time while towing. Other ITBC-Related DIC Messages TRAILER CONNECTED: This message will briefly display when a trailer with electric brakes is first connected to the vehicle. This message will automatically turn off in about 10 seconds. This message can be acknowledged before it automatically turns off. CHECK TRAILER WIRING: This message will display if: . The ITBC system first determines connection to a trailer with electric brakes and then the trailer harness becomes disconnected from the vehicle. If the disconnect occurs while the vehicle is stationary, this message will automatically turn off in about 30 seconds. This message will also turn off if it is acknowledged or if the trailer harness is reconnected. If the disconnect occurs while the vehicle is moving, this message will continue until the ignition is turned off. This message will also turn off if it is acknowledged or if the trailer harness is reconnected. . There is an electrical fault in the wiring to the trailer brakes. This message will continue as long as there is an electrical fault in the trailer wiring. This message will also turn off if it is acknowledged. To determine whether the electrical fault is on the vehicle side or trailer side of the trailer wiring harness connection: 1. Disconnect the trailer wiring harness from the vehicle. 2. Turn the ignition off. 3. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition back to RUN. 4. If the CHECK TRAILER WIRING message reappears, the electrical fault is on the vehicle side. If the CHECK TRAILER WIRING message only reappears when connecting the trailer wiring harness to the vehicle, the electrical fault is on the trailer side. SERVICE TRAILER BRAKE SYSTEM: This message will display when there is a problem with the ITBC system. If this message continues over multiple ignition cycles, have the vehicle serviced. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating If either the CHECK TRAILER WIRING or SERVICE TRAILER BRAKE SYSTEM message displays while driving, the ITBC system may not be fully functional or may not function at all. When traffic conditions allow, carefully pull the vehicle over to the side of the road and turn the ignition off. Check the wiring connection to the trailer and turn the ignition back on. If either of these messages continues, either the vehicle or trailer needs service. A GM dealer may be able to diagnose and repair problems with the trailer. However, any diagnosis and repair of the trailer is not covered under the vehicle warranty. Contact your trailer dealer for assistance with trailer repairs and trailer warranty information. Trailer Sway Control (TSC) Vehicles with StabiliTrak/Electronic Stability Control (ESC) have a Trailer Sway Control (TSC) feature. Trailer sway is unintended side-to-side motion of a trailer while towing. If the vehicle is towing a trailer and the TSC detects that sway is increasing, the vehicle brakes are selectively applied at each wheel, to help reduce excessive trailer sway. If equipped with the Integrated Trailer Brake Control (ITBC) system, and the trailer has an electric brake system, StabiliTrak/ESC may also apply the trailer brakes. If TSC is enabled, the Traction Control System (TCS)/StabiliTrak/ESC warning light will flash on the instrument cluster. Reduce vehicle speed by gradually removing your foot from the accelerator. If trailer sway continues, StabiliTrak/ESC can reduce engine torque to help slow the vehicle. TSC will not function if StabiliTrak/ESC is turned off. See Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control 0 247. 291 { Warning Trailer sway can result in a crash and in serious injury or death, even if the vehicle is equipped with TSC. If the trailer begins to sway, reduce vehicle speed by gradually removing your foot from the accelerator. Then pull over to check the trailer and vehicle to help correct possible causes, including an improperly or overloaded trailer, unrestrained cargo, improper trailer hitch configuration, or improperly inflated or incorrect vehicle or trailer tires. See Towing Equipment 0 281 for trailer ratings and hitch setup recommendations. Aftermarket Electronic Trailer Sway Control Devices Some trailers may come equipped with an electronic device designed to reduce or control trailer sway. Aftermarket equipment manufacturers also offer similar devices that connect to the wiring between the trailer and the vehicle. These devices may interfere with the vehicle’s trailer brake or other systems, including integrated anti-sway systems, if equipped. Messages related to Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 292 Driving and Operating trailer connections or trailer brakes could appear on the DIC. The effects of these aftermarket devices may have on vehicle handling or trailer brake performance is not known. { Warning Use of aftermarket electronic trailer sway control devices could result in reduced trailer brake performance, loss of trailer brakes, or other malfunctions, and result in a crash. You or others could be seriously injured or killed. Before using one of these devices: . Ask the device or trailer manufacturer if the device has been thoroughly tested for compatibility with the make, model, and year of your vehicle and any optional equipment installed on your vehicle. . Before driving, check the trailer brakes are working properly, if equipped. Drive the vehicle with the trailer attached on a level road surface that is free of traffic at about 32-40 km/h (20-25 mph) and fully apply the (Continued) Warning (Continued) manual trailer brake apply lever. Also, check the trailer brake lamps and other lamps are functioning correctly. . If the trailer brakes are not operating properly at any time, or if a DIC message indicates problems with the trailer connections or trailer brakes, carefully pull the vehicle over to the side of the road when traffic conditions allow. If the vehicle is equipped with a trailer tire pressure monitoring system, see the trailer tire pressure monitoring system description and the trailering app. Trailer tires deteriorate over time. The trailer tire sidewall will show the week and year the tire was manufactured. Many trailer tire manufacturers recommend replacing tires more than six years old. Trailer Tires Overloading is another leading cause of trailer tire blow-outs. Never load your trailer with more weight than the tires are designed to support. The load rating is located on the trailer tire sidewall. Special Trailer (ST) tires differ from vehicle tires. Trailer tires are designed with stiff sidewalls to help prevent sway and to support heavy loads. These features can make it difficult to determine if the trailer tire pressures are low only based on a visual inspection. Always know the maximum speed rating for the trailer tires before driving. This may be significantly lower than the vehicle tire speed rating. The speed rating may be on the trailer tire sidewall. If the speed rating is not shown, the default trailer tire speed rating is 105 km/h (65 mph). Always check all trailer tire pressures before each trip when the tires are cool. Low trailer tire pressure is a leading cause of trailer tire blow-outs. Trailering App Trailer Lights App If equipped, the Trailer Lights App is on the Home Page of the infotainment display. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating Touch Start to cycle the trailer lamps on and off to determine if they are working. The test follows this sequence: 1. The running lights turn on first and remain on throughout the sequence. 2. The brake lights turn on for about two seconds. 3. The left turn signal light flashes three times. 4. The right turn signal light flashes three times. 5. The reverse lights turn on for about two seconds. 6. Steps 2–5 repeat for approximately one minute and 45 seconds, or until the test deactivates. Touch Stop to stop the test. The test will automatically end after one minute and 45 seconds. The sequence also deactivates when any of the following occur: . The ignition is turned off. . The transmission is shifted out of P (Park). . The brake pedal is pressed. . The turn signal is activated. . The hazard warning lights are activated. Trailering App If equipped, the Trailering App is on the Home Page of the infotainment display. If equipped this feature allows profiles for connected trailers to be created to view status, to store and track trailer usage information, and to set up towing assistance features. The Trailering App Preview will appear when the Trailering App is opened for the first time from the Home Page. Touch GET STARTED in the Trailering App to go into the app. When a trailer is electrically connected and a trailer profile has not been created, there will be an option to create a profile, use a guest profile, or select Accessory/No trailer. After the pop-up is displayed three times, Don’t Remind Me will display and touching that will turn off the trailer detection pop-up. To turn the Trailer Detection Alert on, select ON in the Settings tab. When a trailer is electrically connected and after a Trailer Profile has been created, the trailer detection pop-up will appear with a list of all of the custom Trailer Profiles made on the vehicle. To load an existing Trailer Profile, select one of the Trailer Profiles 293 listed, or load the Guest Trailer Profile by selecting GUEST TRAILER. Touching Accessory/No trailer will select Accessory/No trailer as the active Trailer Profile and will dismiss the pop- up. Shifting the vehicle from P (Park) will select Guest Trailer as the active Trailer Profile and will dismiss the pop-up. Create a Trailer Profile 1. Touch Create Profile on the trailer detection pop-up or touch + Add Trailer Profile in the Trailering App. 2. Create a name for the trailer. 3. Select the hitch type. A checklist profile will be created based on the type selected. 4. Select Save Profile. A pop-up will indicate the setup is complete. Touch DONE to complete the process or touch TRAILER FEATURE SETUP to set up the Tow/Haul Mode reminder, Trailer Tire Pressure Monitoring System, if equipped, maintenance reminders, or towing assistance, if equipped. Import a Trailer Profile A trailer profile saved to an OnStar account can be imported to the vehicle. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 294 Driving and Operating 1. Touch + Add Trailer Profile in the Trailering App 2. Touch Import Profile on the pop-up. 3. Select a trailer profile from the list. 4. Touch IMPORT. A pop-up will indicate the import was successful. Touch OK to return to the trailer list and select the trailer profile. The Tow/ Haul Mode reminder, Brake Gain Setting and Trailer Tire Pressure sensor learning, if equipped, do not import. Trailer Feature Setup Tow/Haul Mode Reminder To turn the Tow/Haul Mode Reminder setting on, touch Yes. To turn it off, touch No. Trailer Tire Pressure Setup If the Trailer Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TTPMS) is detected, touch the Tire Pressure Monitoring icon to set up tire pressure monitoring. Touch Yes to set up the sensors or touch No to return to the previous screen. The trailer tire pressure sensors can transmit up to 7 m (23 feet) from the hitch receiver of the vehicle. A trailer must be electrically connected to the vehicle before starting the sensor-to-vehicle learn process. trailer tires are rotated or replaced. See “Editing a Trailer Profile” later in this section for tire pressure sensor relearn information. After selecting Start from the Learn Sensors screen, use the Tool Method or the Manual Method (described below) to learn each tire sensor, during which the current tire number will be highlighted. Tool Method: A TTPMS activation tool can be purchased separately to learn the sensor locations. Each sensor has a minimum of two minutes to learn, shown by a timer. After a sensor is learned, a checkmark appears next to the tire, the vehicle horn will sound, the vehicle’s brake lamps will flash, and all working trailer lamps will flash. It then moves to the next sensor. To cancel the process touch Stop. The recommended tire pressure must be entered for the trailer tires. This allows the vehicle to alert when the tire pressure is high or low. TTPMS must learn the location of the installed tire sensors to show correct air pressure and temperature for each tire. To set up, use one of the following options or see a tire or trailer dealer for service. The learning process must be repeated when the Manual Method: Without the tool, the air pressure can be increased or decreased in each tire for 10 seconds. Do not exceed the maximum inflation pressure found on the tire sidewalls. Make sure to re-adjust tire pressure to the recommended level when the process is complete. Sensor Learning Steps To complete the sensor-to-vehicle learn process: 1. Touch Start on the Learn Sensors screen. The horn chirps twice and the Learning Active screen appears on the infotainment display. 2. Start with the driver side front trailer tire. 3. Activate the tool near the valve stem or adjust the air pressure of this tire until the horn chirps and all working vehicle and trailer lights flash. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating The process stops without saving the sensor locations if this step takes more than two minutes. 4. Move to the next tire and repeat Step 3 for each sensor. The horn chirps twice when all sensors are completed. 5. Return to the vehicle to complete the setup. Maintenance Reminders To set up maintenance reminders, touch the Trailer Maintenance icon. Select Yes to set up the maintenance reminders for the Trailer Profile. Follow the on-screen prompts. The maximum number of reminders is 50. Select No to return to the previous screen. Towing Assistance To set up towing assistance features, if equipped, touch the Towing Assistance icon. Touch Yes to begin set up or touch No to return to the previous screen. 1. Select the number of axles on the trailer. 2. Enter trailer dimensions as prompted. 3. Follow the on-screen instructions to complete setup for available features. Transparent Trailer Setup (if equipped) To complete setup for transparent trailer: . Trailer Length: 300 cm (118.1 in) – 970 cm (381.8 in). Measure from center of coupler to furthest rear point on the trailer. . Trailer Width: 120 cm (47.2 in) – 260 cm (102.3 in). Measure from left edge to right edge. . Trailer Height: 1 cm (0.39 in) – 450 cm (177.1 in). Measure from ground to tallest point. . Hitching Point Length: 180 cm (70.8 in) – 970 cm (381.8 in). Measure from center of coupler to middle of tires. . Trailer Tongue Length: 50 cm (19.6 in) – 220 cm (86.6 in). Measure from center of coupler to trailer front wall. . Vehicle Hitch Height: 10 cm (3.9 in) – 100 cm (39.3 in). Measure from ground to top of coupler. . Vehicle Hitch Length: 10 cm (3.9 in) – 100 cm (39.3 in). Measure from hitch receiver to center of ball. 1. If trailer dimensions are out of range, this feature will be unavailable. 2. Ensure rear trailer camera is connected. 295 3. Follow instructions to drive forward to complete calibration. Rear Trailer Guidance Setup (if equipped) A rear trailer camera must be mounted on the trailer and electrically connected to the vehicle before transparent trailer feature can be used. See Assistance Systems for Parking or Backing 0 253. Trailer dimensions must be in range to enable this feature. . Trailer Length: 300 cm (118.1 in) – 970 cm (381.8 in). Measure from center of coupler to furthest rear point on the trailer. 1. If trailer dimensions are out of range, this feature will be unavailable. 2. Ensure rear trailer camera is connected. 3. Follow instructions to drive forward to complete calibration. Jack-Knife Alert Setup (if equipped) Follow instructions to drive forward to complete calibration. Trailer Length Indicator Setup (if equipped) Follow instructions to drive forward to complete calibration. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 296 Driving and Operating Trailer Side Blind Zone Alert Setup (if equipped) Vehicle Connections Trailer dimensions must be in range to enable this feature. . Trailer Length: 300 cm (118.1 in) – 1200 cm (472.4 in). Measure from center of coupler to furthest rear point on the trailer. If trailer dimensions are out of range, this feature will be unavailable. Status View The Status view shows: . Vehicle . Connections . Tires . Maintenance . Cameras Upon entry, the most recent items will be shown. Select MORE to view all options. 1. Transmission Fluid Temperature 2. Average Fuel Economy with Trailer Profile Transmission Temperature View the temperature of the transmission fluid by looking at the graphic. The graphic will indicate a dangerous level if the temperature is at 130 °C–150 °C (270 °F– 300 °F). Average Fuel Economy Touch to view the average fuel economy of the vehicle while the Trailer Profile is active. 1. Light Test Start Button 2. Trailer Electrical Diagnostics Connections: OK If a trailer connection is detected, the view will display OK. Trailer Connections Status When a trailer is connected, the Trailering App System detects the trailer connection using the Park and Stop/Turn Signal lighting circuits and alerts the driver by requesting a trailer profile setup through the Trailering App System on the infotainment screen. The Trailer Detection Alert setting must be enabled for the alert to display when a Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating trailer is connected. When a trailer is connected and the ignition is off, the Trailering App System will periodically pulse the lighting circuits of the trailer to verify it is still connected. The trailer lights may periodically flash as a result of this trailer connection detection. These flashes may be more visible in dark ambient light environments. The flashing or flickering lights are a normal condition and the Trailering App System has built-in protections to prevent the battery from draining. When Theft Alert is also enabled the frequency and pattern of this flashing will change. Connection Problem If any of the trailer connections are lost, a message about the connection issue will appear on the Driver Information Center (DIC). The infotainment display will also show the connection issue in the Connection Status view. If a trailer connection is not detected, the Trailering App will not display the Connection Status screen. 297 Connection Trailer Lighting Faults Detected Light Test The Trailering App System monitors for electrical faults on the trailer lights. A message about the lighting issue will appear on the DIC. The infotainment display will also show the lighting issue in the Connection Status view. Repair your trailer lights if needed. A trailer lighting issue is not covered by your GM warranty. Touch Start Light Test to cycle the trailer lights on and off to determine if they are working. The test follows this sequence: 1. The running lights turn on first and remain on throughout the sequence. 2. The brake lights turn on for about two seconds. 3. The left turn signal light flashes three times. 4. The right turn signal light flashes three times. 5. The reverse lights turn on for about two seconds. 6. Steps 2–5 repeat for approximately one minute and 45 seconds, or until the test deactivates. Diagnose View Touch Diagnose to see more information about the connection problem. This view will display the names of the trailer connector pins, a graphic of the trailer connector, and a graphic of the back of the trailer. Any connector pin that failed will be amber color, and the location of the corresponding connection will be highlighted on the graphic of the back of the trailer. The Running Lights connection may not detect partial outages. Activate the light test to check all trailer lamps. See “Light Test” following. Touch Stop to stop the test. The test will automatically end after one minute and 45 seconds. The sequence also deactivates when any of the following occur: . The ignition is turned off. . The transmission is shifted out of P (Park). . The brake pedal is pressed. . The turn signal is activated. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 298 Driving and Operating . The hazard warning lights are activated. Maintenance Tires . Touch Remind Me Later to delay the reminder. . Touch X next to Upcoming Alerts (90%) to dismiss the alert. It will not appear again. . Touch X next to Maintenance Due (100%) to delay the alert to the next ignition cycle. Always follow all of the maintenance instructions that came with your trailer. Cameras 1. Trailer Tire Pressure/Temperature Tire Pressure and Temperature If the TTPMS sensor-to-vehicle learn process was completed, the status view will display the current tire pressure and temperature of the trailer tires related to the active Trailer Profile. If a tire’s pressure is low or high, the color of the pressure value will be amber. If a sensor malfunctions, the values are dashed lines. If the screen displays “Service Tire Pressure Monitoring System”, the vehicle needs to be taken to a dealer for service. 1. List of Maintenance Reminders 2. Add a New Maintenance Reminder The Maintenance Status view displays reminders. Touch a reminder to edit. Touch + New Maintenance Reminder to go to the Select New Reminder view. The progress bar turns yellow when the maintenance item reaches 90% complete. The progress bar turns red when the maintenance item reaches 100% complete. Maintenance Notifications . Touch Service Complete to reset the maintenance reminder. Guest Trailer Status View Touch the Guest Trailer Profile for the status views. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating The Guest Trailer Profile Status view shows: . Vehicle . Connections . Cameras, if equipped The Trailer Status view displays mileage information. Touch to edit, and follow the on-screen prompts. Mileage and fuel economy will reset after the trailer disconnects. Accessory/No Trailer Status View If the Accessory/No Trailer profile is active, trailer status information is not available. Checklist View This view shows the recommended steps to take before towing a trailer. Touch the box next to each item if that step has been completed. Touch p to access a detailed view of each step. Within each detailed view, touch Next and Previous to navigate between steps. Touch Clear All to clear the completed statuses from all items in the current checklist. 299 The checklist is unique to the Trailer Profile based on hitch type; for example, the steps involve different details between conventional, gooseneck, and fifth-wheel hitch types. The Custom Trailer Profiles and Guest Trailer are in order of the most frequently used. The Accessory/No Trailer profile is shown below the Custom Trailer Profiles and Guest Trailer Profile. Custom Checklist Items All personalization features are based on the settings for each driver in vehicle personalization. The list of Trailer Profiles is based on vehicle personalization settings. For each of the Trailer Profile checklists, there is an option to create custom items to view in the checklist. The custom item will appear at the bottom of the checklist. Guest Trailer Touch the Trailers tab to view, activate, create, edit, or delete Trailer Profiles. If the Guest Trailer Profile is the active Trailer Profile, trailer detection, connections status, theft, and the Tow/Haul reminder alerts can be sent. The system will not track total mileage or fuel economy, but the system will track trip mileage and fuel economy if the Guest Trailer Profile is active. The Trailer Tire Pressure Monitoring System or maintenance reminders cannot be set up for a Guest Trailer Profile. The Guest Trailer Profile cannot be edited. If a trailer is connected, touch the Trailer Profile name to activate a Trailer Profile. Touch p to learn more about the Guest Trailer option. There can be up to five Custom Trailer Profiles on the vehicle. Accessory/No Trailer Guest Trailer and No Trailer Connected If Guest Trailer Profile is active or if no trailer is connected, the checklist will show all of the checklists associated with Custom Trailer Profiles in addition to default checklists. Trailers View If the Accessory/No Trailer Profile is active, alerts will not be sent and the system will not track mileage or fuel economy. The Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 300 Driving and Operating Trailer Tire Pressure Monitoring System or maintenance reminders cannot be set up for the Accessory/No Trailer Profile. The Accessory/No Trailer profile cannot be edited. No Trailer Connected When there is no trailer connected, Trailer Profiles cannot be activated but most options can be edited. Trailer Brake Gain Memory The system can memorize the brake gain setting of a Trailer Profile or a Guest Trailer Profile. When a Trailer Profile or Guest Trailer Profile is selected, and a brake gain setting is set for that Trailer Profile, a quick notice will appear to indicate that the system has recalled that profile’s brake gain setting. If a Trailer Profile is already active and the brake gain setting had been set for that Trailer Profile, the quick notice will trigger whenever the ignition is turned on. If there was an error in setting the brake gain for a Trailer Profile, there will be a notification. This pop-up will not appear if the Guest Trailer Profile is active or if there is no trailer connected. Trailer brake gain should be set for a specific trailering condition and must be adjusted anytime vehicle loading, trailer loading, or road surface conditions change. Touch to set up towing assistance features for the Trailer Profile. See "Towing Assistance" for details on the setup. Editing a Trailer Profile Touch to set up the Trailer Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TTPMS) for the Trailer Profile. See “Trailer Tire Pressure Setup” previously in this section for details on the setup. Also, touch Tire Pressure Setup if the trailer tires were rotated or if the tire pressure sensors in the tires were replaced for this Trailer Profile. The vehicle will need to relearn the tire sensors and their locations. Trailer Profile View Touch to edit any of the following options in the Trailer Profile view: . Trailer Name . Towing Assistance Setup, if equipped . Tire Pressure Setup, if equipped . Trailer Maintenance . Edit Mileage . Reset Average Fuel Economy Touch Save to save the new value to the Trailer Profile. Touching Back will still save the previously entered information. Trailer Name Touch to edit the Trailer Profile’s name. Use at least one character and no spaces. Touch Save. Towing Assistance Setup A trailer should be connected to complete this portion of profile setup. Tire Pressure Setup If TTPMS had been set up previously, the Select Number of Sensors screen will appear after touching Tire Pressure Setup. If the number of sensors has changed, select the number and touch Next. If a new number of sensors is selected, the Relearn Sensors pop-up will appear. Touch Cancel to go back or touch Relearn to overwrite the current sensors and begin the relearning process. See “Trailer Tire Pressure Setup” previously in this section. If number of sensors has not changed, touch Next and the Learn sensors screen will appear. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating 301 On the Learn Sensors screen. Touch Relearn to overwrite the current sensors and begin the relearning process. See “Trailer Tire Pressure Setup” previously in this section. Edit Reminder Effect on Maintenance Reminders Touch to edit the mileage or time settings for the reminder. Touch Save to save the new settings to the Trailer Profile. On the Learn Sensors screen, touch Next to go to the Edit Recommended Tire Pressure screen. Delete Reminder If the mileage is reset or changed, and mileage has already accumulated, any maintenance reminders that have been set up will be adjusted accordingly. On the Edit Recommended Tire Pressure screen, touch a number on the keypad to change the Recommended Tire Pressure for the trailer’s tires. This will change the number at which the vehicle displays alerts related to trailer tire pressure. Touch Done to return to the Trailer Profile view. Trailer Maintenance Touch to view a list of maintenance reminders for the Trailer Profile. Touch a reminder to view, reset, delete, or edit it. Reset Reminder Touch Maintenance Complete in the reminder view to reset the reminder. On the pop-up, touch Reset to reset the time and mileage values for the reminder. Touch Cancel to return to the previous view and nothing will change. Touch to delete the maintenance reminder. On the pop-up, touch Delete to delete the reminder or touch Cancel to return to the previous view and nothing will change. New Maintenance Reminder Reset Average Fuel Economy Touch to reset the average fuel economy for the Trailer Profile. Touch Reset to change, or touch Cancel to go back to the previous view. Touch + New Maintenance Reminder to set up a new reminder. Suggested reminders that were previously set will have checkmarks next to them. Suggested reminders that have not been set will have empty boxes next to them. The maximum number of reminders is 50. Delete/Remove Trailer Edit Mileage Remove will be displayed if there is a connected OnStar plan active with the vehicle. Removing a trailer profile will remove the profile from the vehicle but the profile will still be associated with the user account. However, if there is not a connected OnStar plan then the remove button will read DELETE and the profile will be deleted permanently. Touch to edit the Trailer Profile’s mileage. Touch Reset to reset trailer mileage to zero, or enter a new value and touch Save. Touching back will return to the Trailer Profile view. Touch to remove the Trailer Profile and all of its settings. On the pop-up, touch Remove to remove the Trailer Profile from the vehicle. Touch Cancel to dismiss the pop-up and return to the previous view. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 302 Driving and Operating Settings View Within the Trailering App, touch the Settings tab to modify the following settings: . Trailer Detection Alert . Maintenance Alerts . Theft Alert . Tow/Haul Mode Reminder . Trailer Length Indicator turned on or off. Touch a profile to view more information or adjust the setting for that profile. The setting will be on by default for each profile. All Maintenance Alerts for that active Trailer Profile will be received. if the setting is on for the active Trailer Profile, the vehicle has an OnStar or connected service plan and the smartphone number has been added to the account for this notification. Turn a setting off to not receive any of the Maintenance Alerts when that Trailer Profile is active. If the setting is turned off for a given Trailer Profile, the smartphone will not receive this security notification even if the Trailer Profile is active. Trailer Detection Alert Theft Alert Tow/Haul Mode Reminder The Trailer Detection Alert setting will be on by default. Turn it off to disable the Trailer Detection pop-up from displaying when a trailer is connected. The Guest Trailer Profile will become the active Trailer Profile, unless another Trailer Profile is selected manually through the Trailering App. If this setting is disabled while a Custom Trailer Profile is active, that Trailer Profile will remain the active profile until the trailer is disconnected. A theft alert can be set if a trailer is connected and the alert is enabled. When the trailer is disconnected and the vehicle is off, an alarm will sound. This is a reminder to turn on the Tow/Haul Mode when towing a trailer. See Tow/Haul Mode 0 240. Maintenance Alerts Touch Maintenance Alerts to view the Maintenance Alerts settings page. These alerts are based on the Trailer Profile, so the settings for each Trailer Profile must be Touch Theft Alert in Settings to view the Theft Alert settings page. These alerts are based on the Trailer Profile, so the settings for each Trailer Profile must be turned on or off. Touch a profile to view more information or adjust the setting for that profile. This setting will be off by default for each Trailer Profile, including the Guest Trailer Profile. A smartphone will receive a notification that the trailer related to the selected Trailer Profile is disconnected from the vehicle, Touch Tow/Haul Mode Reminder in Settings to view the Tow/Haul Mode Reminder settings page. These alerts are based on the Trailer Profile, so the settings for each Trailer Profile must be turned on or off. Touch a profile to view more information or to adjust the setting for that profile. This setting will default to OFF for each Trailer Profile, including the Guest Trailer Profile. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating If Tow/Haul Mode is off and this setting is on for a Trailer Profile, each time the ignition is turned on a reminder will appear to turn on Tow/Haul Mode when the Trailer Profile is active. If Tow/Haul Mode is on and this setting is on for a Trailer Profile, the reminder will not appear when the Trailer Profile is active. Trailer Length Indicator Touch Trailer Length Indicator to view the Trailer Length Indicator settings page. If this setting is ON a guideline is displayed in the side mirror camera view to indicate the rear of the attached trailer. If this setting is OFF the guideline will not be displayed. This setting will default to OFF if the trailer length indicator feature is not set up. See "Towing Assistance" for details on the setup. Conversions and Add-Ons Add-On Electrical Equipment { Warning The Data Link Connector (DLC) is used for vehicle service and Emission Inspection/ Maintenance testing. See Malfunction Indicator Lamp (Check Engine Light) 0 116. A device connected to the DLC — such as an aftermarket fleet or driver-behavior tracking device — may interfere with vehicle systems. This could affect vehicle operation and cause a crash. Such devices may also access information stored in the vehicle’s systems. Caution Some electrical equipment can damage the vehicle or cause components to not work and would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Always check with your dealer before adding electrical equipment. Add-on equipment can drain the vehicle's 12-volt battery, even if the vehicle is not operating. 303 The vehicle has an airbag system. Before attempting to add anything electrical to the vehicle, see Servicing the Airbag-Equipped Vehicle 0 71 and Adding Equipment to the Airbag-Equipped Vehicle 0 71. For information on wiring auxiliary switches, see www.gmupfitter.com or contact your dealer. Adding a Snow Plow or Similar Equipment Caution Do not exceed 72 km/h (45 mph) with a snow plow mounted to the vehicle. The vehicle could overheat and be damaged. Before installing a snow plow on the vehicle, follow these guidelines: Caution If the vehicle does not have the snow plow prep package, RPO VYU, adding a plow can damage the vehicle, and the repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Unless the vehicle was built to carry a snow plow, do not add (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 304 Driving and Operating Caution (Continued) one to the vehicle. If the vehicle has RPO VYU, then the payload the vehicle can carry will be reduced when a snow plow is installed. The vehicle can be damaged if either the front or rear axle ratings or the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) are exceeded. The plow the vehicle can carry depends on many things, such as: . The options the vehicle came with, and the weight of those options. . The weight and number of passengers to be carried. . The weight of items added to the vehicle, like a tool box or truck cap. . The total weight of any additional cargo to be carried. To safely carry a snow plow on the vehicle: . With a snow plow attached, the engine coolant temperature gauge may show a higher temperature than while driving without one. The snow plow could block the airflow to the radiator. This could be more noticeable as vehicle speed increases. At speeds above 72 km/h (45 mph), this may cause the engine . . . . . coolant to overheat. Move or angle the snow plow blade to allow increased airflow to the radiator. To increase the airflow, move the snow plow blade position. If driving more than 24 km/h (15 mi), angle the plow blade position. Make sure the weight on the front and rear axles does not exceed the axle rating for each. Follow the snowplow manufacturer’s recommendations for any rear ballast that may be required. Rear ballast may be required to ensure a proper front and rear weight distribution ratio even though the actual weight at the front axle may be less than the front axel rating. The snowplow manufacturer or installer can assist in determining the amount of rear ballast required to ensure that the vehicle with the attached snowplow does not exceed the GVW rating, the front and rear axle ratings, or the front and rear weight distribution ratio. Front axle reserve capacity is the difference between the Front Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) and the front axle weight of the vehicle with full fuel, passengers, and any other cargo. This is the amount of weight that can be added to the front axle before reaching the Front GAWR. To calculate the amount of weight any front accessory, such as a snow plow, is adding to the front axle, use this formula: (W x (A + W.B.)) /W.B.= Weight the accessory is adding to the front axle. Where: IW = Weight of added accessory IA = Distance that the accessory is in front of the front axle IW.B. = Vehicle Wheelbase Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Driving and Operating For example, adding a 318 kg (700 lb) snow plow actually adds more than 318 kg (700 lb) to the front axle. Using the formula, if the snow plow is 122 cm (4 ft) in front of the front axle and the wheelbase is 305 cm (10 ft), then: IW = 318 kg (700 lb) IA = 122 cm (4 ft) IW.B. = 305 cm (10 ft) (W x (A + W.B.)/W.B. = (318 x (122 + 305))/305 = 445 kg (980 lb) This means if the front axle reserve capacity is more than 445 kg (980 lb), the snow plow could be added without exceeding the front GAWR. Heavier equipment can be added on the front of the vehicle if less cargo or fewer passengers are carried, or by positioning cargo toward the rear. This reduces the load on the front. However, the front GAWR, rear GAWR, and Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) must never be exceeded. { Warning On some vehicles that have certain front mounted equipment, such as a snow plow, it may be possible to load the front axle to the front Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) but not have enough weight on the rear axle to have proper braking performance. If the brakes cannot work properly, the vehice could crash. Always follow the snow plow manufacturer or installer's recommendation for rear ballast to ensure a proper front and rear weight distribution ratio. Maintaining a proper front and rear weight distribution ratio is necessary to provide proper braking performance. See your dealer for additional advice and information about using a snow plow on the vehicle. Also, see Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. 305 Pickup Conversion to Chassis Cab We are aware that some vehicle owners might consider having the pickup box removed and a commercial or recreational body installed. Owners should be aware that, as manufactured, there are differences between a chassis cab and a pickup with the box removed which could affect vehicle safety. The components necessary to adapt a pickup to permit its safe use with a specialized body should be installed by the body builder. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 306 Vehicle Care Vehicle Care General Information General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 California Perchlorate Materials Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . 307 Vehicle Checks Doing Your Own Service Work . . . . . . . . 308 Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 Engine Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . 310 Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311 Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313 Automatic Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . 314 Engine Air Filter Life System . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Engine Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315 Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Engine Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Power Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321 Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 Brake Pad Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 Brake Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323 Battery - North America . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324 Four-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 Front Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 Noise Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 Starter Switch Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327 Automatic Transmission Shift Lock Control Function Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Ignition Transmission Lock Check . . . . . . 328 Park Brake and P (Park) Mechanism Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Glass Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 Windshield Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 Gas Strut(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 Headlamp Aiming Front Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Bulb Replacement Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331 LED Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331 Headlamps, Front Turn Signal, Sidemarker, and Parking Lamps . . . . . . 331 Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps, and Back-Up Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332 Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) and Cargo Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . 333 License Plate Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334 Electrical System Electrical System Overload . . . . . . . . . . . . 334 Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336 Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . 336 Instrument Panel Fuse Block (Left) . . . . 339 Instrument Panel Fuse Block (Right) . . . 341 Wheels and Tires Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 All-Season Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 Winter Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 All-Terrain Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 Tire Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 Tire Designations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346 Tire Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . 347 Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349 Tire Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . 350 Tire Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . 351 Tire Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355 Tire Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356 When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . 358 Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359 Different Size Tires and Wheels . . . . . . . 360 Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . 360 Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . 361 Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 Tire Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362 If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 Tire Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 Full-Size Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 Jump Starting Jump Starting - North America . . . . . . . . 374 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Towing the Vehicle Towing the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . 378 Appearance Care Exterior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 Interior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 Floor Mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389 General Information For service and parts needs, visit your dealer. You will receive genuine GM parts and GM-trained and supported service people. Genuine GM parts have one of these marks: 307 special handling may apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/ perchlorate. Accessories and Modifications Adding non-dealer accessories or making modifications to the vehicle can affect vehicle performance and safety, including such things as airbags, braking, stability, ride and handling, emissions systems, aerodynamics, durability, and electronic systems like antilock brakes, traction control, and stability control. These accessories or modifications could even cause malfunction or damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. Damage to suspension components caused by modifying vehicle height outside of factory settings will not be covered by the vehicle warranty. California Perchlorate Materials Requirements Certain types of automotive applications, such as airbag initiators, seat belt pretensioners, and lithium batteries contained in electronic keys, may contain perchlorate materials. Perchlorate Material – Damage to vehicle components resulting from modifications or the installation or use of non-GM certified parts, including control module or software modifications, is not covered under the terms of the vehicle warranty and may affect remaining warranty coverage for affected parts. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 308 Vehicle Care GM Accessories are designed to complement and function with other systems on the vehicle. See your dealer to accessorize the vehicle using genuine GM Accessories installed by a dealer technician. Also, see Adding Equipment to the Airbag-Equipped Vehicle 0 71. Vehicle Checks Doing Your Own Service Work { Warning It can be dangerous to work on your vehicle if you do not have the proper knowledge, service manual, tools, or parts. Always follow owner’s manual procedures and consult the service manual for your vehicle before doing any service work. If doing some of your own service work, use the proper service manual. It tells you much more about how to service the vehicle than this manual can. To order the proper service manual, see Publication Ordering Information 0 416. This vehicle has an airbag system. Before attempting to do your own service work, see Servicing the Airbag-Equipped Vehicle 0 71. If equipped with remote vehicle start, open the hood before performing any service work to prevent remote starting the vehicle accidentally. See Remote Vehicle Start 0 20. Keep a record with all parts receipts and list the mileage and the date of any service work performed. See Maintenance Records 0 404. Caution Even small amounts of contamination can cause damage to vehicle systems. Do not allow contaminants to contact the fluids, reservoir caps, or dipsticks. Hood { Warning Turn the vehicle off before opening the hood. If the engine is running with the hood open, you or others could be injured. { Warning Components under the hood can get hot from running the engine. To help avoid the risk of burning unprotected skin, never touch these components until they have cooled, and always use a glove or towel to avoid direct skin contact. Clear any snow from the hood before opening. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care To open the hood: 1. Pull the hood release lever with the i symbol. It is on the lower left side of the instrument panel. 3. After you have partially lifted the hood, the gas strut system will automatically lift the hood and hold it in the fully open position. To close the hood: 1. Before closing the hood, be sure all filler caps are on properly, and all tools are removed. 2. Pull the hood down until the strut system is no longer holding up the hood. 3. Allow the hood to fall. Check to make sure the hood is latched completely. Repeat this process with additional force if necessary. 2. Go to the front of the vehicle and locate the secondary release lever under the front center of the hood. Push the secondary hood release lever to the right to release. 309 { Warning Do not drive the vehicle if the hood is not latched completely. The hood could open fully, block your vision, and cause a crash. You or others could be injured. Always close the hood completely before driving. The Driver Information Center (DIC) will display a message if the hood is not fully closed, and the vehicle is moving. Stop and turn off the vehicle, check the hood for obstructions, and close the hood again. Check to see if the message still appears on the DIC. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 310 Vehicle Care Engine Compartment Overview Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care 1. Remote Negative (–) Location. See Jump Starting - North America 0 374. 2. Positive (+) Terminal (Under Cover). See Jump Starting - North America 0 374. 3. Battery - North America 0 324. 4. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter 0 315. 5. Engine Oil Dipstick. See “Checking Engine Oil” under Engine Oil 0 311. 6. Engine Cooling Fan (Out of View). See Cooling System 0 316. 7. Power Steering Fluid Reservoir. See Power Steering Fluid 0 320. 8. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See “When to Add Engine Oil” under Engine Oil 0 311. 9. Auxiliary Battery. Battery - North America 0 324. 10. Brake Fluid Reservoir. See Brake Fluid 0 323. 11. Engine Compartment Fuse Block 0 336. 12. Coolant Surge Tank and Pressure Cap. See Cooling System 0 316. 13. Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir. See “Adding Washer Fluid” under Washer Fluid 0 321. If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. Engine Oil For diesel engine vehicles, see “Engine Oil” in the Duramax diesel supplement. To ensure proper engine performance and long life, careful attention must be paid to engine oil. Following these simple, but important steps will help protect your investment: . Use engine oil approved to the proper specification and of the proper viscosity grade. See “Selecting the Right Engine Oil” in this section. . Check the engine oil level regularly and maintain the proper oil level. See “Checking Engine Oil” and “When to Add Engine Oil” in this section. . Change the engine oil at the appropriate time. See Engine Oil Life System 0 313. . Always dispose of engine oil properly. See “What to Do with Used Oil” in this section. Checking Engine Oil Check the engine oil level regularly, every 650 km (400 mi), especially prior to a long trip. The engine oil dipstick handle is a loop. See Engine Compartment Overview 0 310 for the location. 311 { Warning The engine oil dipstick handle may be hot; it could burn you. Use a towel or glove to touch the dipstick handle. If a low oil Driver Information Center (DIC) message displays, check the oil level. Follow these guidelines: . To get an accurate reading, park the vehicle on level ground. Check the engine oil level after the engine has been off for at least two hours. Checking the engine oil level on steep grades or too soon after engine shutoff can result in incorrect readings. Accuracy improves when checking a cold engine prior to starting. Remove the dipstick and check the level. . If unable to wait two hours, the engine must be off for at least 15 minutes if the engine is warm, or at least 30 minutes if the engine is not warm. Pull out the dipstick, wipe it with a clean paper towel or cloth, then push it back in all the way. Remove it again, keeping the tip down, and check the level. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 312 Vehicle Care When to Add Engine Oil Caution (Continued) damaged. Drain the excess oil or limit driving of the vehicle, and seek a service professional to remove the excess oil. See Engine Compartment Overview 0 310 for the location of the engine oil fill cap. If the oil is below the cross-hatched area at the tip of the dipstick and the engine has been off for at least 15 minutes, add 1 L (1 qt) of the recommended oil and then recheck the level. See “Selecting the Right Engine Oil” later in this section for an explanation of what kind of oil to use. For engine oil crankcase capacity, see Capacities and Specifications 0 406. Add enough oil to put the level somewhere in the proper operating range. Push the dipstick all the way back in when through. Selecting the Right Engine Oil Selecting the right engine oil depends on both the proper oil specification and viscosity grade. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 401. Specification Caution Do not add too much oil. Oil levels above or below the acceptable operating range shown on the dipstick are harmful to the engine. If the oil level is above the operating range (i.e., the engine has so much oil that the oil level gets above the cross-hatched area that shows the proper operating range), the engine could be (Continued) Use full synthetic engine oils that meet the dexos1 specification. Engine oils that have been approved by GM as meeting the dexos1 specification are marked with the dexos1 approved logo. Caution Failure to use the recommended engine oil or equivalent can result in engine damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. Viscosity Grade Use SAE 5W-30 viscosity grade engine oil. Cold Temperature Operation: In an area of extreme cold, where the temperature falls below −29 °C (−20 °F), use SAE 0W-30 oil. An oil of this viscosity grade will provide easier cold starting for the engine at extremely low temperatures. When selecting an oil of the appropriate viscosity grade, it is recommended to select an oil of the correct specification. See “Specification” earlier in this section. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Engine Oil Additives/Engine Oil Flushes Engine Oil Life System Do not add anything to the oil. The recommended oils meeting the dexos1 specification are all that is needed for good performance and engine protection. When to Change Engine Oil Engine oil system flushes are not recommended and could cause engine damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. What to Do with Used Oil Used engine oil contains certain elements that can be unhealthy for your skin and could even cause cancer. Do not let used oil stay on your skin for very long. Clean your skin and nails with soap and water, or a good hand cleaner. Wash or properly dispose of clothing or rags containing used engine oil. See the manufacturer's warnings about the use and disposal of oil products. Used oil can be a threat to the environment. If you change your own oil, be sure to drain all the oil from the filter before disposal. Never dispose of oil by putting it in the trash or pouring it on the ground, into sewers, or into streams or bodies of water. Recycle it by taking it to a place that collects used oil. This vehicle has a computer system that indicates when to change the engine oil and filter. This is based on a combination of factors which include engine revolutions, engine temperature, and miles driven. Based on driving conditions, the mileage at which an oil change is indicated can vary considerably. For the oil life system to work properly, the system must be reset every time the oil is changed. On some vehicles, when the system has calculated that oil life has been diminished, a CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message comes on to indicate that an oil change is necessary. Change the oil as soon as possible within the next 1 000 km (600 mi). It is possible that, if driving under the best conditions, the oil life system might indicate that an oil change is not necessary for up to a year. The engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a year and, at this time, the system must be reset. For vehicles without the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message, an oil change is needed when the REMAINING OIL LIFE percentage is near 0%. Your dealer has trained service people who 313 will perform this work and reset the system. It is also important to check the oil regularly over the course of an oil drain interval and keep it at the proper level. If the system is ever reset accidentally, the oil must be changed at 5 000 km (3,000 mi) since the last oil change. Remember to reset the oil life system whenever the oil is changed. How to Reset the Engine Oil Life System Reset the system whenever the engine oil is changed so that the system can calculate the next engine oil change. Always reset the engine oil life to 100% after every oil change. It will not reset itself. To reset the engine oil life system: 1. Display the oil life percentage on the DIC. See Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125. 2. Press the thumbwheel on the steering wheel, or the trip odometer reset stem if the vehicle does not have DIC controls, for several seconds. When the confirmation message displays, select YES. The oil life will change to 100%. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 314 Vehicle Care The oil life system can also be reset as follows: 1. Display the oil life percentage on the DIC. See Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125. 2. Fully press the accelerator pedal slowly three times within five seconds. 3. If the display changes to 100%, the system is reset. If the vehicle has a CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message and it comes back on when the vehicle is started and/or the oil life percentage is near 0%, the engine oil life system has not been reset. Repeat the procedure. Automatic Transmission Fluid When to Check and Change Automatic Transmission Fluid It is usually not necessary to check the transmission fluid level. The only reason for fluid loss is a transmission leak or overheated transmission. This vehicle is not equipped with a transmission fluid level dipstick. There is a special procedure for checking and changing the transmission fluid in these vehicles. Because this procedure is difficult, this should be done at the dealer. Contact the dealer for additional information or the procedure can be found in the service manual. See Publication Ordering Information 0 416. Caution Use of the incorrect automatic transmission fluid may damage the vehicle, and the damage may not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Always use the correct automatic transmission fluid. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 401. Change the fluid and filter at the scheduled maintenance intervals listed in Maintenance Schedule 0 392. Be sure to use the transmission fluid listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 401. Engine Air Filter Life System If equipped, this feature provides the engine air filter’s remaining life and best timing for a change. The timing to change an engine air filter depends on driving and environmental conditions. When to Change the Engine Air Filter When the Driver Information Center (DIC) displays a message to replace the engine air filter at the next oil change, follow this timing. When the DIC displays a message to replace the engine air filter soon, replace the engine air filter at the earliest convenience. The system must be reset after the engine air filter is changed. If the DIC displays a message to check the engine air filter system, see your dealer. How to Reset the Engine Air Filter Life System To reset: 1. Place the vehicle in P (Park). 2. Display the Air Filter Life on the DIC. See Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125. 3. Press T on the steering wheel, or press the trip odometer reset stem if the vehicle does not have DIC controls, to move to the Reset/Disable display area. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Select Reset then press the thumbwheel or press the reset stem for several seconds. 4. Press the thumbwheel or the reset stem to confirm the reset. To inspect or replace the engine air cleaner/ filter: The engine air cleaner/filter is on the driver side of the engine compartment. See Engine Compartment Overview 0 310. When to Inspect the Engine Air Cleaner/ Filter How to Inspect/Replace the Engine Air Cleaner/Filter Do not start the engine or have the engine running with the engine air cleaner/filter housing open. Before removing the engine air cleaner/filter, make sure that the engine air cleaner/filter housing and nearby components are free of dirt and debris. Do not clean the engine air cleaner/filter or components with water or compressed air. { Warning If part replacement is necessary, the part must be replaced with one of the same part number or with an equivalent part. Use of a replacement part without the same fit, form, and function may result in personal injury or damage to the vehicle. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter If the vehicle is not equipped with the engine air filter life system, see Maintenance Schedule 0 392 for intervals on inspecting and replacing the engine air cleaner filter. 315 1. Locate the air cleaner/filter assembly. See Engine Compartment Overview 0 310. 2. Remove the eight screws on top of the cover of the housing, then lift the cover. 3. Remove the engine air cleaner/filter from the housing. Take care to dislodge as little dirt as possible. 4. Clean the engine air cleaner/filter sealing surfaces and the housing. 5. Inspect or replace the engine air cleaner/ filter. 6. Reverse Steps 2–4 to reinstall the filter cover housing. 7. If equipped, reset the engine air filter life system after replacing the engine air filter. see Engine Air Filter Life System 0 314. { Warning Operating the engine with the air cleaner/filter off can cause you or others to be burned. Use caution when working on the engine. Do not start the engine or drive the vehicle with the air cleaner/ filter off, as flames may be present if the engine backfires. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 316 Vehicle Care Engine Coolant Caution The cooling system in the vehicle is filled with DEX-COOL engine coolant. This coolant is designed to remain in the vehicle for 5 years or 240 000 km (150,000 mi), whichever occurs first. If the air cleaner/filter is off, dirt can easily get into the engine, which could damage it. Always have the air cleaner/ filter in place when driving. The following explains the cooling system and how to check and add coolant when it is low. If there is a problem with engine overheating, see Engine Overheating 0 318. Cooling System If the vehicle has the Duramax diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. The cooling system allows the engine to maintain the correct working temperature. { Warning An underhood electric fan can start up even when the engine is not running and can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools away from any underhood electric fan. What to Use 1. Engine Cooling Fan (Out of View) 2. Coolant Surge Tank and Pressure Cap { Warning Do not touch heater, radiator, a/c pipes or hoses, or other engine parts. They can be very hot and can burn you. Do not run the engine if there is a leak; all coolant could leak out. That could cause an engine fire and can burn you. Fix any leak before driving the vehicle. { Warning Plain water, or other liquids such as alcohol, can boil before the proper coolant mixture will. With plain water or the wrong mixture, the engine could get too hot but there would not be an overheat warning. The engine could catch fire and you or others could be burned. Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL coolant. This mixture: . Gives freezing protection down to −37 °C (−34 °F), outside temperature. . Gives boiling protection up to 129 °C (265 °F), engine temperature. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care . Protects against rust and corrosion. . Will not damage aluminum parts. . Helps keep the proper engine The vehicle must be on a level surface when checking the coolant level. Caution Do not use anything other than a mix of DEX-COOL coolant that meets GM Standard GMW3420 and clean, drinkable water. Anything else can cause damage to the engine cooling system and the vehicle, which would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Checking Coolant The coolant surge tank is in the engine compartment on the driver side of the vehicle. See Engine Compartment Overview 0 310. How to Add Coolant to the Coolant Surge Tank If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see “Cooling System” in the Duramax diesel supplement for the proper coolant fill procedure. temperature. Never dispose of engine coolant by putting it in the trash, or by pouring it on the ground, or into sewers, streams, or bodies of water. Have the coolant changed by an authorized service center, familiar with legal requirements regarding used coolant disposal. This will help protect the environment and your health. 317 { Warning Spilling coolant on hot engine parts can burn you. Coolant contains ethylene glycol and it will burn if the engine parts are hot enough. Check to see if coolant is visible in the coolant surge tank. If the coolant inside the coolant surge tank is boiling, wait until it cools down. The coolant level should be at or above the indicated mark. If it is not, there may be a leak in the cooling system. If coolant is visible but the coolant level is not at or above the indicated mark, see the following sections on how to add coolant to the coolant surge tank following. { Warning Plain water, or other liquids such as alcohol, can boil before the proper coolant mixture will. With plain water or the wrong mixture, the engine could get too hot but there would not be an overheat warning. The engine could catch fire and you or others could be burned. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 318 Vehicle Care { Warning Steam and scalding liquids from a hot cooling system are under pressure. Turning the pressure cap, even a little, can cause them to come out at high speed and you could be burned. Never turn the cap when the cooling system, including the pressure cap, is hot. Wait for the cooling system and pressure cap to cool. Caution Failure to follow the specific coolant fill procedure could cause the engine to overheat and could cause system damage. If coolant is not visible in the surge tank, contact your dealer. If no coolant is visible in the surge tank, add coolant. 1. Remove the coolant surge tank pressure cap when the cooling system, including the coolant surge tank pressure cap and upper radiator hose, is no longer hot. Turn the pressure cap slowly counterclockwise about one full turn. If a hiss is heard, wait for that to stop. A hiss means there is still some pressure left. 2. Keep turning the pressure cap slowly, and remove it. 3. Fill the coolant surge tank with the proper mixture to the full cold mark. 4. With the coolant surge tank pressure cap off, start the engine and let it run until the engine coolant temperature gauge indicates approximately 90 °C (195 °F). By this time, the coolant level inside the coolant surge tank may be lower. If the level is lower, add more of the proper mixture to the coolant surge tank until the level reaches the indicated mark. 5. Replace the pressure cap tightly. 6. Verify coolant level after the engine is shut off and the coolant is cold. If necessary, repeat coolant fill procedure Steps 1–6. Caution If the pressure cap is not tightly installed, coolant loss and engine damage may occur. Be sure the cap is properly and tightly secured. Engine Overheating If the vehicle has the Duramax diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. Caution Do not run the engine if there is a leak in the engine cooling system. This can cause a loss of all coolant and can damage the system and vehicle. Have any leaks fixed right away. The vehicle has several indicators to warn of engine overheating. There is a coolant temperature gauge in the vehicle's instrument cluster. See Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge 0 113. In addition, there are ENGINE OVERHEATED STOP ENGINE, ENGINE OVERHEATED IDLE ENGINE, and ENGINE POWER IS REDUCED messages in the Driver Information Center (DIC). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care If the decision is made not to lift the hood when this warning appears, get service help right away. See Roadside Assistance Program 0 412. If the decision is made to lift the hood, make sure the vehicle is parked on a level surface. Check to see if the engine cooling fans are running. If the engine is overheating, the fans should be running. If they are not, do not continue to run the engine and have the vehicle serviced. If the engine or transmission detects an impending hot fluid condition, then the transmission may force upshifts to limit temperatures. Downshifts may also be prevented in this instance. Normal operation may continue unless the display indicates there is a hot condition and engine should be idled. If Steam is Coming from the Engine Compartment { Warning Steam and scalding liquids from a hot cooling system are under pressure. Turning the pressure cap, even a little, can cause them to come out at high speed and you could be burned. Never turn the cap when the cooling system, including the pressure cap, is hot. Wait for the cooling system and pressure cap to cool. If No Steam is Coming from the Engine Compartment The ENGINE OVERHEATED STOP ENGINE or the ENGINE OVERHEATED IDLE ENGINE message, along with a low coolant condition, can indicate a serious problem. If there is an engine overheat warning, but no steam is seen or heard, the problem may not be too serious. Sometimes the engine can get a little too hot when the vehicle: . Climbs a long hill on a hot day. . Stops after high-speed driving. . Idles for long periods in traffic. 319 . Tows a trailer; see Trailer Towing 0 278. If the ENGINE OVERHEATED STOP ENGINE or the ENGINE OVERHEATED IDLE ENGINE message appears with no sign of steam, try this for a minute or so: 1. Turn the air conditioning off. 2. Turn the heater on to the highest temperature and to the highest fan speed. Open the windows as necessary. 3. When it is safe to do so, pull off the road, shift to P (Park) or N (Neutral) and let the engine idle. If the temperature overheat gauge is no longer in the overheat zone or an overheat warning no longer displays, the vehicle can be driven. Continue to drive the vehicle slowly for about 10 minutes. Keep a safe vehicle distance from the vehicle in front. If the warning does not come back on, continue to drive normally and have the cooling system checked for proper fill and function. If the warning continues, pull over, stop, and park the vehicle right away. If there is still no sign of steam and the vehicle is equipped with an engine driven cooling fan, push down the accelerator until the engine speed is about twice as fast as Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 320 Vehicle Care normal idle speed for at least five minutes while the vehicle is parked. If the warning is still there, turn off the engine and get everyone out of the vehicle until it cools down. may continue unless the display indicates there is a hot condition and engine should be idled. If there is no sign of steam, idle the engine for five minutes while parked. If the warning is still displayed, turn off the engine until it cools down. After driving in the overheated engine protection operating mode, the engine oil will be severely degraded. Any repairs performed before the engine is cool may cause engine damage. Allow the engine to cool before attempting any repair. Repair the cause of coolant loss, change the oil, and reset the oil life system. See Engine Oil 0 311. Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode If an overheated engine condition exists and the ENGINE POWER IS REDUCED message displays, an overheat protection mode which alternates firing groups of cylinders helps to prevent engine damage. In this mode, a loss in power and engine performance will be noticed. This operating mode allows the vehicle to be driven to a safe place in an emergency. Driving extended distances and/ or towing a trailer in the overheat protection mode should be avoided. If the engine or transmission detects an impending hot fluid condition, then the transmission may force upshifts to limit temperatures. Downshifts may also be prevented in this instance. Normal operation Caution so an increase in fan noise may be heard. This is normal and should not be mistaken as the transmission slipping or making extra shifts. It is merely the cooling system functioning properly. The fan will slow down when additional cooling is not required and the clutch partially disengages. This fan noise may be heard when starting the engine. It will go away as the fan clutch partially disengages. Power Steering Fluid Engine Fan If the vehicle has the Duramax diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. The vehicle has a clutched engine cooling fan. When the clutch is engaged, the fan spins faster to provide more air to cool the engine. In most everyday driving conditions, the fan is spinning slower and the clutch is not fully engaged. This improves fuel economy and reduces fan noise. Under heavy vehicle loading, trailer towing, and/or high outside temperatures, the fan speed increases as the clutch more fully engages, The power steering fluid reservoir is in the engine compartment on the driver side of the vehicle. See Engine Compartment Overview 0 310 for reservoir location. When to Check Power Steering Fluid It is not necessary to regularly check power steering fluid unless there is a leak suspected in the system or an unusual noise Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care is heard. A fluid loss in this system could indicate a problem. Have the system inspected and repaired. Wait for the power steering system to cool, with the engine off, before checking the fluid. How to Check Power Steering Fluid To check the power steering fluid: 1. Set the ignition off and let the engine compartment cool down. 2. Wipe the cap and the top of the reservoir clean. 3. Unscrew the cap and wipe the dipstick with a clean rag. 4. Replace the cap and completely tighten it. 5. Remove the cap again and look at the fluid level on the dipstick. The level should be between the ADD and FULL marks. If necessary, add only enough fluid to bring the level up to the hashed area between the ADD and FULL marks, do not overfill. To prevent contamination of brake fluid, never check or fill the power steering reservoir with the brake master cylinder cover off. What to Use Caution Use of the incorrect fluid may damage the vehicle and the damages may not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Always use the correct fluid listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 401. To determine what kind of fluid to use, see Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 401. Always use the proper fluid. Failure to use the proper fluid can cause leaks and damage hoses and seals. Washer Fluid What to Use When windshield washer fluid needs to be added, be sure to read the manufacturer's instructions before use. Use a fluid that has sufficient protection against freezing in an area where the temperature may fall below freezing. 321 Adding Washer Fluid The vehicle has a low washer fluid message on the DIC that comes on when the washer fluid is low. The message is displayed for 15 seconds at the start of each ignition cycle. When the WASHER FLUID LOW ADD FLUID message displays, washer fluid will need to be added to the windshield washer fluid reservoir. Open the cap with the washer symbol on it. Add washer fluid until the tank is full. See Engine Compartment Overview 0 310 for reservoir location. Caution . Do not use washer fluid that contains any type of water repellent coating. This can cause the wiper blades to chatter or skip. (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 322 Vehicle Care Caution (Continued) . Do not use engine coolant (antifreeze) in the windshield washer. It can damage the windshield washer system and paint. . Do not mix water with ready-to-use washer fluid. Water can cause the solution to freeze and damage the washer fluid tank and other parts of the washer system. . When using concentrated washer fluid, follow the manufacturer instructions for adding water. . Fill the washer fluid tank only three-quarters full when it is very cold. This allows for fluid expansion if freezing occurs, which could damage the tank if it is completely full. Brakes Disc brake linings have built-in wear indicators that make a high-pitched warning sound when the brake linings are worn and new linings are needed. The sound can come and go or can be heard all the time when the vehicle is moving, except when applying the brake pedal firmly. { Warning The brake wear warning sound means that soon the brakes will not work well. That could lead to a crash. When the brake wear warning sound is heard, have the vehicle serviced. Caution Continuing to drive with worn-out brake linings could result in costly brake repairs. Some driving conditions or climates can cause a brake squeal when the brakes are first applied, clearing up following several applications. This does not mean something is wrong with the brakes. Properly torqued wheel nuts are necessary to help prevent brake pulsation. When tires are rotated, inspect brake linings for wear and evenly tighten wheel nuts in the proper sequence to torque specifications. See Capacities and Specifications 0 406. Brake pads should be replaced as complete axle sets. Brake Pedal Travel See your dealer if the brake pedal does not return to normal height, or if there is a rapid increase in pedal travel. This could be a sign that brake service may be required. Replacing Brake System Parts Always replace brake system parts with new, approved replacement parts. If this is not done, the brakes may not work properly. The braking performance can change in many ways if the wrong brake parts are installed or if parts are improperly installed. Brake Pad Life System When to Change Brake Pads This vehicle has a system that estimates the remaining life of the front and rear brake pads. Brake pad life is displayed in the Driver Information Center (DIC), along with a percentage for each axle. The system must be reset every time the brake pads are changed. When the system has determined that the brake pads need to be replaced, a message will display, which may include mileage remaining. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Brake pads should always be replaced as complete axle sets. How to Reset the Brake Pad Life System The system will automatically detect when significantly worn brake pads are replaced. When the ignition is turned on after new pads and wear sensors are installed, a message will display. Follow the prompts to reset the system. The brake pad life system can also be manually reset: 1. Display Brake Pad Life on the DIC. See Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125. 2. Select the Brake Pad Life menu. 3. Select front or rear pads as appropriate. 4. Select YES on the confirmation message. Repeat for pads on the other axle if they were also replaced. How to Disable the Brake Pad Life System The brake pad life system can be turned off. This may be necessary if aftermarket brake pads without wear sensors are installed. When the system is turned off, the front and rear brake pad life percentages will not display. However, the built-in wear indicators that make a high-pitched warning sound when the brake pads are worn can still determine when the pads should be replaced. See Brakes 0 322. To turn off the brake pad life system: 1. Display Brake Pad Life on the DIC. See Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125. 2. Select the Brake Pad Life menu. 3. Select DISABLE. To turn the brake pad life system back on, follow the above steps but select ENABLE in Step 2. Brake Fluid 323 The brake master cylinder reservoir is filled with GM approved DOT 4 brake fluid as indicated on the reservoir cap. See Engine Compartment Overview 0 310 for the location of the reservoir. Checking Brake Fluid With the vehicle in P (Park) on a level surface, the brake fluid level should be between the minimum and maximum marks on the brake fluid reservoir. There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in the reservoir may go down: . Normal brake lining wear. When new linings are installed, the fluid level goes back up. . A fluid leak in the brake hydraulic system. Have the brake hydraulic system fixed. With a leak, the brakes will not work well. Always clean the brake fluid reservoir cap and the area around the cap before removing it. Do not top off the brake fluid. Adding fluid does not correct a leak. If fluid is added when the linings are worn, there will be too much fluid when new brake linings are Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 324 Vehicle Care installed. Add or remove fluid, as necessary, only when work is done on the brake hydraulic system. { Warning If too much brake fluid is added, it can spill on the engine and burn, if the engine is hot enough. You or others could be burned, and the vehicle could be damaged. Add brake fluid only when work is done on the brake hydraulic system. When the brake fluid falls to a low level, the brake warning light comes on. See Brake System Warning Light 0 117. Brake fluid absorbs water over time which degrades the effectiveness of the brake fluid. Replace brake fluid at the specified intervals to prevent increased stopping distance. See Maintenance Schedule 0 392. What to Add Use only GM approved DOT 4 brake fluid from a clean, sealed container. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 401. { Warning The wrong or contaminated brake fluid could result in damage to the brake system. This could result in the loss of braking leading to a possible injury. Always use the proper GM approved brake fluid. Caution If brake fluid is spilled on the vehicle's painted surfaces, the paint finish can be damaged. Immediately wash off any painted surface. Battery - North America The original equipment battery is maintenance free. Do not remove the cap and do not add fluid. Refer to the replacement number shown on the original battery label when a new battery is needed. See Engine Compartment Overview 0 310 for battery location. { Warning WARNING: Battery posts, terminals and related accessories can expose you to chemicals including lead and lead compounds, which are known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. Wash hands after handling. For more information go to www.P65Warnings.ca.gov. See the warning on the back cover. Vehicle Storage { Warning Batteries have acid that can burn you and gas that can explode. You can be badly hurt if you are not careful. See Jump Starting - North America 0 374 for tips on working around a battery without getting hurt. Infrequent Usage: Remove the black, negative (−) cable from the battery to keep the battery from running down. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Negative Battery Cable Reconnection Extended Storage: Remove the black, negative (−) cable from the battery or use a battery trickle charger. Caution When reconnecting the battery: Negative Battery Cable Disconnection . Use the original nut from the vehicle { Warning Before disconnecting the negative battery cable, turn off all features, turn the ignition off, and remove the key, if equipped, from the vehicle. If this is not done, you or others could be injured, and the vehicle could be damaged. Caution If the battery is disconnected with the ignition on or the vehicle in Retained Accessory Power (RAP), the OnStar back-up battery will be permanently discharged and will need to be replaced. 1. Make sure the lamps, features, and accessories are turned off. 2. Turn the ignition off and remove the key, if equipped. 325 1. Loosen the negative battery cable nut (1). 2. Remove the negative battery cable clamp (2) from the negative battery post. 3. Cover the negative battery cable clamp, and negative battery post with a non-conductive material to prevent any contact with the negative battery cable. to secure the negative battery cable. Do not use a different nut. If you need a replacement nut, see your dealer. . Tighten the nut with a hand tool. Do not use an impact wrench or power tools to tighten the nut. The vehicle could be damaged if these guidelines are not followed. Caution Do not use paints, lubricants, or corrosion inhibitors on the nut that secures the negative battery cable to the vehicle. This could damage the vehicle. 1. Install the negative battery cable clamp to the negative battery post. 2. Tighten the negative battery cable nut. 3. Turn the ignition on. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 326 Vehicle Care Four-Wheel Drive Rear Axle Transfer Case enough lubricant to raise the level to the bottom of the fill plug (1) hole. Use care not to overtighten the plug. When to Check Lubricant When to Change Lubricant Refer to Maintenance Schedule 0 392 to determine when to check the lubricant. Refer to Maintenance Schedule 0 392 to determine how often to change the lubricant. It is not necessary to regularly check the rear axle fluid unless a leak is suspected or an unusual noise is heard. A fluid loss could indicate a problem. Have it inspected and repaired. This service can be complex. See your dealer. What to Use Refer to Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 401 to determine what kind of lubricant to use. Front Axle When to Check Lubricant 1. Fill Plug 2. Drain Plug To get an accurate reading, the vehicle should be on a level surface. If the level is below the bottom of the fill plug (1) hole, located on the transfer case, some lubricant will need to be added. Add It is not necessary to regularly check the front axle fluid unless a leak is suspected or an unusual noise is heard. A fluid loss could indicate a problem. Have it inspected and repaired. This service can be complex. See your dealer. Do not directly power wash the transfer case and/or front/rear axle output seals. High pressure water can overcome the seals and contaminate the fluid. Contaminated fluid will decrease the life of the transfer case and/or drive axles and should be replaced. When to Check Lubricant Do not directly power wash the transfer case and/or front/rear axle output seals. High pressure water can overcome the seals and contaminate the fluid. Contaminated fluid will decrease the life of the transfer case and/or drive axles and should be replaced. Noise Control System NOISE EMISSIONS WARRANTY General Motors LLC, warrants to the first person who purchases this vehicle for purposes other than resale and to each subsequent purchaser that this vehicle as manufactured by General Motors LLC, was designed, built and equipped to conform at the time it left General Motors LLC’s control with all applicable U.S. EPA Noise Control Regulations. This warranty covers this vehicle as designed, built and equipped by Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care General Motors LLC, and is not limited to any particular part, component or system of the vehicle manufactured by General Motors LLC. Defects in design, assembly or in any part, component or system of the vehicle as manufactured by General Motors LLC, which, at the time it left General Motors LLC’s control, caused noise emissions to exceed Federal standards, are covered by this warranty for the life of the vehicle. TAMPERING WITH NOISE CONTROL SYSTEM PROHIBITED Federal law prohibits the following acts or the causing thereof: 1. The removal or rendering inoperative by any person, other than for purposes of maintenance, repair, or replacement, of any device or element of design incorporated into any new vehicle for the purpose of noise control prior to its sale or delivery to the ultimate purchaser or while it is in use; or 2. the use of the vehicle after such device or element of design has been removed or rendered inoperative by any person. Among those acts presumed to constitute tampering are the acts listed below. Insulation: Removal of the noise shields or any undercab insulation. Engine: Removal or rendering engine speed governor, if so equipped, inoperative so as to allow engine speed to exceed manufacturer specifications. Modification of the engine control system or calibration. Fan and Drive: . Removal of fan clutch or rendering clutch inoperative. . Removal of the fan shroud. Air Intake: . Removal of air cleaner silencer. . Reversing air cleaner cover. Exhaust: . Removal of muffler, catalytic converter, and/or resonator. . Removal of exhaust pipes and exhaust pipe clamps. 327 Starter Switch Check { Warning When you are doing this inspection, the vehicle could move suddenly. If the vehicle moves, you or others could be injured. 1. Before starting this check, be sure there is enough room around the vehicle. 2. Apply both the parking brake and the regular brake. Do not use the accelerator pedal, and be ready to turn off the engine immediately if it starts. 3. Try to start the engine in each gear. The vehicle should start only in P (Park) or N (Neutral). If the vehicle starts in any other position, contact your dealer for service. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 328 Vehicle Care Automatic Transmission Shift Lock Control Function Check { Warning When you are doing this inspection, the vehicle could move suddenly. If the vehicle moves, you or others could be injured. 1. Before starting this check, be sure there is enough room around the vehicle. It should be parked on a level surface. 2. Apply the parking brake. Be ready to apply the regular brake immediately if the vehicle begins to move. 3. With the engine off, turn the ignition on, but do not start the engine. Without applying the regular brake, try to move the shift lever out of P (Park) with normal effort. If the shift lever moves out of P (Park), contact your dealer for service. Ignition Transmission Lock Check If equipped with Key Access ignition, while parked, and with the parking brake set, try to turn the ignition off in each shift lever position. The ignition should turn to off only when the shift lever is in P (Park). The ignition key should come out only when the ignition is off. Contact your dealer if service is required. Park Brake and P (Park) Mechanism Check { Warning When you are doing this check, the vehicle could begin to move. You or others could be injured and property could be damaged. Make sure there is room in front of the vehicle in case it begins to roll. Be ready to apply the regular brake at once should the vehicle begin to move. Park on a fairly steep hill, with the vehicle facing downhill. Keeping your foot on the regular brake, set the parking brake. . To check the parking brake's holding ability: With the engine running and the transmission in N (Neutral), slowly remove foot pressure from the regular brake pedal. Do this until the vehicle is held by the parking brake only. . To check the P (Park) mechanism's holding ability: With the engine running, shift to P (Park). Then release the parking brake followed by the regular brake. Contact your dealer if service is required. Wiper Blade Replacement Windshield wiper blades should be replaced periodically. See Maintenance Schedule 0 392. Replacement blades come in different types and are removed in different ways. For proper type and length, see Maintenance Replacement Parts 0 402. Caution Allowing the wiper arm to touch the windshield when no wiper blade is installed could damage the windshield. Any damage that occurs would not be (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Caution (Continued) covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not allow the wiper arm to touch the windshield. Front Wiper Blade Replacement To replace the wiper blade: 1. Pull the wiper assembly away from the windshield. 3. With the latch open, pull the wiper blade down toward the windshield far enough to release it from the J-hooked end of the wiper arm. 4. Remove the wiper blade. 5. Reverse Steps 1–3 for wiper blade replacement. Glass Replacement If the windshield or front side glass must be replaced, see your dealer to determine the correct replacement glass. Windshield Replacement HUD System If equipped, the windshield is part of the HUD system. If the windshield must be replaced, get one that is designed for HUD or the HUD image may look out of focus. Driver Assistance Systems 2. Lift up on the latch in the middle of the wiper blade where the wiper arm attaches. If the windshield needs to be replaced and the vehicle is equipped with a front camera sensor for the Driver Assistance Systems, a GM replacement windshield is recommended. The replacement windshield must be installed according to GM specifications for proper alignment. If it is 329 not, these systems may not work properly, they may display messages, or they may not work at all. See your dealer for proper windshield replacement. Gas Strut(s) This vehicle is equipped with gas strut(s) to provide assistance in lifting and holding open the hood/trunk/liftgate system in full open position. { Warning If the gas struts that hold open the hood, trunk, and/or liftgate fail, you or others could be seriously injured. Take the vehicle to your dealer for service immediately. Visually inspect the gas struts for signs of wear, cracks, or other damage periodically. Check to make sure the hood/trunk/liftgate is held open with enough force. If struts are failing to hold the hood/trunk/liftgate, do not operate. Have the vehicle serviced. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 330 Vehicle Care Headlamp Aiming Caution Do not apply tape or hang any objects from gas struts. Also do not push down or pull on gas struts. This may cause damage to the vehicle. Front Headlamp Aiming Headlamp aim has been preset and should need no further adjustment. If the vehicle is damaged in a crash, the headlamp aim may be affected. If adjustment to the headlamps is necessary, see your dealer. See Maintenance Schedule 0 392. Trunk Bulb Replacement For the proper type of replacement bulbs, or any bulb changing procedure not listed in this section, contact your dealer. Caution Do not replace incandescent bulbs with aftermarket LED replacement bulbs. This can cause damage to the vehicle electrical system. Hood Liftgate Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Halogen Bulbs { Warning Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas inside and can burst if you drop or scratch the bulb. You or others could be injured. Be sure to read and follow the instructions on the bulb package. Headlamps, Front Turn Signal, Sidemarker, and Parking Lamps 331 Midlevel Headlamp Assembly Base Level Headlamp Assembly LED Lighting This vehicle has several LED lamps. For replacement of any LED lighting assembly, contact your dealer. 1. Turn Signal Lamps Headlamp Replacement 1. 2. 3. 4. Sidemarker lamp Low-Beam Headlamp High-Beam Headlamp Turn Signal/Park Lamps Base Level 1. Open the hood. 2. Remove the headlamp bulb cover. 3. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise to remove it from the headlamp assembly. 4. Unplug the electrical connector from the bulb by releasing the clip on the connector. 5. Replace the bulb and reverse Steps 1–4 to reinstall. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 332 Vehicle Care Midlevel and Uplevel See your dealer for headlamp replacement. Uplevel Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps, and Back-Up Lamps Uplevel Taillamp Assembly Base Level Taillamp Assembly See your dealer for turn signal replacement. Turn Signal Lamp Replacement 1. Open the hood. 2. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise to remove it from the headlamp assembly and pull it straight out. 3. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight out of the bulb socket. 4. Replace the bulb and reverse Steps 1–3 to reinstall. 1500 shown 2500/3500 similar 1. Back-Up Lamp 1. Stoplamp/Taillamp/Turn Signal Lamp 2. Back-Up Lamp 3. Side Marker Lamp It is recommended to replace the grommets when replacing a bulb. See your dealer. To replace one of these bulbs: 1. Open the tailgate. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care 333 Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) and Cargo Lamp This procedure is for the regular cab only. For crew cab and double cab see your dealer. 2. Remove the two rear lamp assembly screws. 3. Pull the rear lamp assembly outward and rearward away from the box side to remove it from the vehicle. 4. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise. 5. Pull the bulb straight out from the socket. 6. Replace the bulb and reverse Steps 1–5 to reinstall. 1. Cargo Lamp Bulbs 2. Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) Bulb Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 334 Vehicle Care Fuses and circuit breakers protect power devices in the vehicle. To replace one of these bulbs: If there is a problem on the road and a fuse needs to be replaced, the same amperage fuse can be borrowed. Choose some feature of the vehicle that is not needed to use and replace it as soon as possible. 1. Remove the two screws and lift off the lamp assembly. 2. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull it straight out. 3. Pull the bulb straight out from the socket. 3. Replace the bulb and reverse Step 2 to reinstall. Electrical System Electrical System Overload License Plate Lamp The vehicle has fuses and circuit breakers to protect against an electrical system overload. To replace the bulb: 1. Reach behind the rear bumper and locate the bulb. 2. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull the bulb straight out of the socket. When the current electrical load is too heavy, the circuit breaker opens and closes, protecting the circuit until the current load returns to normal or the problem is fixed. This greatly reduces the chance of circuit overload and fire caused by electrical problems. To check a fuse, look at the band inside the fuse. If the band is broken or melted, replace the fuse. Be sure to replace a bad fuse with a fuse of the identical size and rating. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care 335 4. If the fuse must be replaced immediately, spare fuses are also provided on the instrument panel end cap or borrow a replacement fuse with the same amperage from the fuse block. Choose a vehicle feature that is not needed to safely operate the vehicle. Repeat Steps 2-3. 5. Insert the replacement fuse into the empty slot of the blown fuse. At the next opportunity, see your dealer to replace the blown fuse. Replacing a Blown Fuse Headlamp Wiring 1. Turn off the vehicle. 2. Locate the fuse puller on the instrument panel end cap. See the Instrument Panel Fuse Block (Right) 0 341 or Instrument Panel Fuse Block (Left) 0 339. An electrical overload may cause the lamps to go on and off, or in some cases to remain off. Have the headlamp wiring checked right away if the lamps go on and off or remain off. Windshield Wipers If the wiper motor overheats due to heavy snow or ice, the windshield wipers will stop until the motor cools and will then restart. 3. Use the fuse puller to remove the fuse from the top or side, as shown above. Although the circuit is protected from electrical overload, overload due to heavy snow or ice may cause wiper linkage Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 336 Vehicle Care damage. Always clear ice and heavy snow from the windshield before using the windshield wipers. If the overload is caused by an electrical problem and not snow or ice, be sure to get it fixed. Fuses and Circuit Breakers The wiring circuits in the vehicle are protected from short circuits by a combination of fuses and circuit breakers. This greatly reduces the chance of damage caused by electrical problems. { Danger Fuses and circuit breakers are marked with their ampere rating. Do not exceed the specified amperage rating when replacing fuses and circuit breakers. Use of an oversized fuse or circuit breaker can result in a vehicle fire. You and others could be seriously injured or killed. { Warning Installation or use of fuses that do not meet GM’s original fuse specifications is dangerous. The fuses could fail, and result in a fire. You or others could be injured or killed, and the vehicle could be damaged. See Accessories and Modifications 0 307 and General Information 0 307. To check or replace a blown fuse, see Electrical System Overload 0 334. Engine Compartment Fuse Block If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. The engine compartment fuse block is in the engine compartment on the driver side of vehicle. Lift the cover to access the fuse block. Caution Spilling liquid on any electrical component on the vehicle may damage it. Always keep the covers on any electrical component. A fuse puller is available in the left instrument panel end cap. The vehicle may not be equipped with all of the fuses, relays, and features shown. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Fuses 6 Fuses 1 2 Usage High-beam left High-beam right Fuses 3 4 Usage – 7 – 8 Fog lamp 9 – 10 – 11 Police upfitter 12 – 13 Washer front 14 Washer rear 15 – 16 – 17 IECL 1 19 DC/AC inverter 20 IECR 2 (LD) / EBCM2 (HD) 21 – 22 IECL 2 24 EBCM 1 Headlamp left 25 – Headlamp right 26 – Usage 337 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 338 Vehicle Care Fuses Usage Fuses Usage Fuses Usage 27 Horn 48 – 65 49 Transmission control module Auxiliary underhood electrical center 66 Cooling fan motor left 67 Active fuel management 2 28 – 29 – 30 – 50 A/C clutch 31 – 51 32 Rear window defogger Transfer case control module 68 – 52 Front wiper 69 53 Center high-mounted stop lamp Starter Pinion (LD) / Starter Motor (HD Gas) 71 Cooling fan 33 Heated mirror 34 Parking lamp left 37 – 54 Trailer reverse lamp 72 Cooling fan right/lower 38 – 55 Trailer back-up lamp 73 Trailer stop/turn lamp left 39 – 56 SADS 40 Misc ignition 57 TTPM/SBZA 74 58 Starter motor (LD & HD DSL) Trailer Interface Module 1 75 DEFC 60 Active fuel management 1 76 Electric RNG BDS 78 Engine control module 61 VES 79 Auxiliary battery 62 Integrated chassis control module/CVS 80 Cabin cooling pump 81 Trailer stop/turn lamp right 41 Trailer parking lamp 42 Park lamp right 44 – 45 – 46 Engine control module ignition 47 Transmission control module ignition 63 Trailer battery Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Fuses Usage Relays Usage 82 Trailer Interface Module 2 5 Headlamp 18 DC/AC inverter 83 FTZM 23 Rear window defogger 84 Trailer brake 35 Parking lamp 85 ENG 36 Run/Crank 86 Engine control module 43 – 87 Injector B even 59 A/C clutch 88 O2 B sensor 64 Starter Motor (LD & HD DSL) 89 O2 A sensor 90 Injector A odd 70 91 Engine control module throttle control Starter Pinion (LD) / Starter Motor (HD Gas) 77 Powertrain 92 Cool fan clutch/ Aeroshutter 339 Instrument Panel Fuse Block (Left) The left instrument panel fuse block access door is on the driver side edge of the instrument panel. The vehicle may not be equipped with all of the fuses, relays, and features shown. Pull off the cover to access the fuse block. A fuse puller is available on the left instrument panel end cap. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 340 Vehicle Care Fuses The vehicle may not be equipped with all of the fuses, relays, and features shown. Usage Fuses Usage F1 Rear Heated Seats Left/ Right F16 AMP – Amplifier F17 – F3 – F18 – F4 – F20 Endgate F5 Spare/MFEG – Multifunction End Gate F22 Rear Sliding Window F6 Heated and Ventilated Seats Left/Right F23 – F24 – F8 – F25 – F9 Passive Entry Passive Start/ Spare F26 – F27 – F10 – F11 – F12 Passenger Power Seat F13 Export Power Take Off/ Special Equipment Option 1 F14 – F15 – Circuit Breakers CB1 Usage – Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Relays Usage K1 Rear Sliding Window Open K2 Rear sliding Window Close K3 MFEG Major 1 – Multifunction End Gate Major 1 K4 MFEG Minor 1 – Multifunction End Gate Minor 1 K5 MFEG Minor 2 – Multifunction End Gate Minor 2 K6 MFEG Major 2 – Multifunction End Gate Major 2 K7 – K8 – Instrument Panel Fuse Block (Right) The right instrument panel fuse block access door is on the passenger side edge of the instrument panel. Pull off the cover to access the front of the fuse block. To access the back of the fuse block: 341 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 342 Vehicle Care Fuses 1. Push the tab at the top of fuse block down. 2. Pull the top of the fuse block outward. 3. Reverse Steps 1–2 to reinstall. Back The vehicle may not be equipped with all of the fuses, relays, and features shown. Usage F1 Right Doors F2 Left Doors F3 Universal Garage Door Opener F4 – F5 – F6 Front Blower F8 Lumbar Switch F10 Body Control Module 6/ Body Control Module 7 F11 Seat/Column Lock Module F12 Body Control Module 3/ Body Control Module 5 F14 Mirrors/Windows Module F17 Steering Wheel Controls F18 Video Processing Module/ Obstacle Detection F19 DLIS – Discrete Logic Ignition Switch F20 Ventilated Seats F21 NOT R/C Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Fuses Usage F22 Heated Steering Wheel F23 MISC R/C F24 Power Take Off/Reflective Light Auxiliary Display/ Instrument Panel Cluster/ Central Gateway Module/ Inside Rear View Mirror/ Overhead Console Module Ignition F25 Heating, Ventilation, and Air Conditioning Ignition/ Heating, Ventilation, and Air Conditioning Auxiliary Fuses Usage Fuses F32 Special Equipment Option/ Data Link Connection F53 – F54 Sunroof F33 Body Control Module 8 F55 Driver Power Seat F34 Cargo Lamp F56 DC DC TRANS 1 F40 CGM – Central Gateway Module F57 DC DC TRANS 2 F41 Infotainment 1 F58 Infotainment 2 F42 TCP – Telematics Connectivity Platform 343 Usage Circuit Breakers Usage F43 – 1 Accessory Power Outlet 2 F44 – 2 USB Ports/Special Equipment Option Retained Accessory Power F45 Body Control Module 2 Accessory Power Outlet 1/ Cigarette Lighter F46 Heating, Ventilation, and Air Conditioning/Battery 1 3 – 4 – F27 Accessory Power Outlet/ Retained Accessory Power F47 Instrument Panel Cluster/ Battery Relays F28 Accessory Power Outlet/ Battery F48 F30 Sensing and Diagnostic Module/Parking Brake F49 Body Control Module 1 F31 Body Control Module 4 F50 F26 Transmission Control Module Usage K1 Run/Crank K2 Retained Accessory Power/ Accessory 1 – K4 – F51 Battery 1 K5 – F52 Battery 2 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 344 Vehicle Care Wheels and Tires Warning (Continued) Tires Every new GM vehicle has high-quality tires made by a leading tire manufacturer. See the warranty manual for information regarding the tire warranty and where to get service. For additional information refer to the tire manufacturer. . . { Warning Poorly maintained and improperly used tires are dangerous. . Overloading the tires can cause overheating as a result of too much flexing. There could be a blowout and a serious crash. See Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. . Underinflated tires pose the same danger as overloaded tires. The resulting crash could cause serious injury. Check all tires frequently to . (Continued) . . maintain the recommended pressure. Tire pressure should be checked when the tires are cold. Overinflated tires are more likely to be cut, punctured, or broken by a sudden impact — such as when hitting a pothole. Keep tires at the recommended pressure. Worn or old tires can cause a crash. If the tread is badly worn, replace them. Replace any tires that have been damaged by impacts with potholes, curbs, etc. Improperly repaired tires can cause a crash. Only your dealer or an authorized tire service center should repair, replace, dismount, and mount the tires. (Continued) . Warning (Continued) Do not spin the tires in excess of 56 km/h (35 mph) on slippery surfaces such as snow, mud, ice, etc. Excessive spinning may cause the tires to explode. All-Season Tires This vehicle may come with all-season tires. These tires are designed to provide good overall performance on most road surfaces and weather conditions. Original equipment tires designed to GM's specific tire performance criteria have a TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall. Original equipment all-season tires can be identified by the last two characters of this TPC code, which will be “MS.” Consider installing winter tires on the vehicle if frequent driving on snow or ice-covered roads is expected. All-season tires provide adequate performance for most winter driving conditions, but they may not offer the same level of traction or performance as winter tires on snow or ice-covered roads. See Winter Tires 0 345. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Winter Tires All-Terrain Tires This vehicle was not originally equipped with winter tires. Winter tires are designed for increased traction on snow and ice-covered roads. Consider installing winter tires on the vehicle if frequent driving on ice or snow covered roads is expected. See your dealer for details regarding winter tire availability and proper tire selection. Also, see Buying New Tires 0 359. This vehicle may have all-terrain or mud-terrain tires. These tires provide good performance on most road surfaces, weather conditions, and for off-road driving. See Off-Road Driving 0 214. With winter tires, there may be decreased dry road traction, increased road noise, and shorter tread life. After changing to winter tires, be alert for changes in vehicle handling and braking. If using winter tires: . Use tires of the same brand and tread type on all four wheel positions. . Use only radial ply tires of the same size, load range, and speed rating as the original equipment tires. Winter tires with the same speed rating as the original equipment tires may not be available for H, V, W, Y, and ZR speed rated tires. If winter tires with a lower speed rating are chosen, never exceed the tire's maximum speed capability. The tread pattern on these tires may wear more unevenly than other tires. Consider rotating the tires more frequently than at 12 000 km (7,500 mi) intervals if irregular wear is noted when the tires are inspected. See Tire Inspection 0 355. Tire Sidewall Labeling Useful information about a tire is molded into the sidewall. The example shows a typical light truck tire sidewall. 345 Light Truck (LT-Metric) Tire (1) Tire Size : The tire size code is a combination of letters and numbers used to define a particular tire's width, height, aspect ratio, construction type, and service description. See the “Tire Size” illustration later in this section for more detail. (2) TPC Spec (Tire Performance Criteria Specification) : Original equipment tires designed to GM's specific tire performance criteria have a TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall. GM's TPC specifications meet or exceed all federal safety guidelines. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 346 Vehicle Care (3) Dual Tire Maximum Load : Maximum load that can be carried and the maximum pressure needed to support that load when used in a dual configuration. For information on recommended tire pressure see Tire Pressure 0 349 and Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. (4) DOT (Department of Transportation) : The Department of Transportation (DOT) code indicates that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. DOT Tire Date of Manufacture : The last four digits of the TIN indicate the tire manufactured date. The first two digits represent the week (01-52) and the last two digits, the year. For example, the third week of the year 2020 would have a 4-digit DOT date of 0320. Week 01 is the first full week (Sunday through Saturday) of each year. (5) Tire Identification Number (TIN) : The letters and numbers following the DOT code are the Tire Identification Number (TIN). The TIN shows the manufacturer and plant code, tire size, and date the tire was manufactured. The TIN is molded onto both sides of the tire, although only one side may have the date of manufacture. (6) Tire Ply Material : The type of cord and number of plies in the sidewall and under the tread. (7) Single Tire Maximum Load : Maximum load that can be carried and the maximum pressure needed to support that load when used as a single. For information on recommended tire pressure see Tire Pressure 0 349 and Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. Tire Designations Tire Size The examples show a typical light truck tire size. Light Truck (LT-Metric) Tire (1) Light Truck (LT-Metric) Tire : The United States version of a metric tire sizing system. The letters LT as the first two characters in the tire size mean a light truck tire engineered to standards set by the U.S. Tire and Rim Association. (2) Tire Width : The 3-digit number indicates the tire section width in millimeters from sidewall to sidewall. (3) Aspect Ratio : A 2-digit number that indicates the tire height-to-width measurements. For example, if the tire size aspect ratio is 75, as shown in item 3 of the light truck (LT-Metric) tire illustration, it would mean that the tire's sidewall is 75 percent as high as it is wide. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care (4) Construction Code : A letter code is used to indicate the type of ply construction in the tire. The letter R means radial ply construction; the letter D means diagonal or bias ply construction. Accessory Weight : The combined weight of optional accessories. Some examples of optional accessories are automatic transmission, power windows, power seats, and air conditioning. (5) Rim Diameter : Diameter of the wheel in inches. Aspect Ratio : The relationship of a tire's height to its width. (6) Load Range : Load Range. Belt : A rubber coated layer of cords between the plies and the tread. Cords may be made from steel or other reinforcing materials. (7) Service Description : The service description indicates the load index and speed rating of a tire. If two numbers are given as in the example, 120/116, then this represents the load index for single versus dual wheel usage (single/ dual). The speed rating is the maximum speed a tire is certified to carry a load. Tire Terminology and Definitions Air Pressure : The amount of air inside the tire pressing outward on each square inch of the tire. Air pressure is expressed in kPa (kilopascal) or psi (pounds per square inch). Bead : The tire bead contains steel wires wrapped by steel cords that hold the tire onto the rim. Bias Ply Tire : A pneumatic tire in which the plies are laid at alternate angles less than 90 degrees to the centerline of the tread. Cold Tire Pressure : The amount of air pressure in a tire, measured in kPa (kilopascal) or psi (pounds per square inch) before a tire has built up heat from driving. See Tire Pressure 0 349. 347 Curb Weight : The weight of a motor vehicle with standard and optional equipment including the maximum capacity of fuel, oil, and coolant, but without passengers and cargo. DOT Markings : A code molded into the sidewall of a tire signifying that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation (DOT) Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. The DOT code includes the Tire Identification Number (TIN), an alphanumeric designator which can also identify the tire manufacturer, production plant, brand, and date of production. GVWR : Gross Vehicle Weight Rating. See Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. GAWR FRT : Gross Axle Weight Rating for the front axle. See Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. GAWR RR : Gross Axle Weight Rating for the rear axle. See Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 348 Vehicle Care Intended Outboard Sidewall : The side of an asymmetrical tire that must always face outward when mounted on a vehicle. Normal Occupant Weight : The number of occupants a vehicle is designed to seat multiplied by 68 kg (150 lb). See Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. Radial Ply Tire : A pneumatic tire in which the ply cords that extend to the beads are laid at 90 degrees to the centerline of the tread. Kilopascal (kPa) : The metric unit for air pressure. Occupant Distribution : Designated seating positions. Rim : A metal support for a tire and upon which the tire beads are seated. Light Truck (LT-Metric) Tire : A tire used on light duty trucks and some multipurpose passenger vehicles. Outward Facing Sidewall : The side of an asymmetrical tire that has a particular side that faces outward when mounted on a vehicle. The side of the tire that contains a whitewall, bears white lettering, or bears manufacturer, brand, and/or model name molding that is higher or deeper than the same moldings on the other sidewall of the tire. Sidewall : The portion of a tire between the tread and the bead. Load Index : An assigned number ranging from 1 to 279 that corresponds to the load carrying capacity of a tire. Maximum Inflation Pressure : The maximum air pressure to which a cold tire can be inflated. The maximum air pressure is molded onto the sidewall. Maximum Load Rating : The load rating for a tire at the maximum permissible inflation pressure for that tire. Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight : The sum of curb weight, accessory weight, vehicle capacity weight, and production options weight. Passenger (P-Metric) Tire : A tire used on passenger cars and some light duty trucks and multipurpose vehicles. Recommended Inflation Pressure : Vehicle manufacturer's recommended tire inflation pressure as shown on the tire placard. See Tire Pressure 0 349 and Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. Speed Rating : An alphanumeric code assigned to a tire indicating the maximum speed at which a tire can operate. Traction : The friction between the tire and the road surface. The amount of grip provided. Tread : The portion of a tire that comes into contact with the road. Treadwear Indicators : Narrow bands, sometimes called wear bars, that show across the tread of a tire when only 1.6 mm (1/16 in) of tread remains. See When It Is Time for New Tires 0 358. UTQGS (Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards) : A tire information system that provides consumers with ratings Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care for a tire's traction, temperature, and treadwear. Ratings are determined by tire manufacturers using government testing procedures. The ratings are molded into the sidewall of the tire. See Uniform Tire Quality Grading 0 360. Vehicle Capacity Weight : The number of designated seating positions multiplied by 68 kg (150 lb) plus the rated cargo load. See Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire : Load on an individual tire due to curb weight, accessory weight, occupant weight, and cargo weight. Vehicle Placard : A label permanently attached to a vehicle showing the vehicle capacity weight and the original equipment tire size and recommended inflation pressure. See “Tire and Loading Information Label” under Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. Tire Pressure Tires need the correct amount of air pressure to operate effectively. { Warning Neither tire underinflation nor overinflation is good. Underinflated tires, or tires that do not have enough air, can result in: . Tire overloading and overheating, which could lead to a blowout. . Premature or irregular wear. . Poor handling. . Reduced fuel economy. Overinflated tires, or tires that have too much air, can result in: . Unusual wear. . Poor handling. . Rough ride. . Needless damage from road hazards. 349 The Tire and Loading Information label on the vehicle indicates the original equipment tires and the correct cold tire inflation pressures. The recommended pressure is the minimum air pressure needed to support the vehicle's maximum load carrying capacity. For additional information regarding how much weight the vehicle can carry, and an example of the Tire and Loading Information label, see Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. How the vehicle is loaded affects vehicle handling and ride comfort. Never load the vehicle with more weight than it was designed to carry. When to Check Check the pressure of the tires once a month or more. Do not forget the spare tire, if the vehicle has one. See Full-Size Spare Tire 0 374 for additional information. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 350 Vehicle Care How to Check Use a good quality pocket-type gauge to check tire pressure. Proper tire inflation cannot be determined by looking at the tire. Check the tire inflation pressure when the tires are cold, meaning the vehicle has not been driven for at least three hours or no more than 1.6 km (1 mi). Remove the valve cap from the tire valve stem. Press the tire gauge firmly onto the valve to get a pressure measurement. If the cold tire inflation pressure matches the recommended pressure on the Tire and Loading Information label, no further adjustment is necessary. If the inflation pressure is low, add air until the recommended pressure is reached. If the inflation pressure is high, press on the metal stem in the center of the tire valve to release air. Re-check the tire pressure with the tire gauge. Put the valve caps back on the valve stems to keep out dirt and moisture. Use only valve caps designed for the vehicle by GM. TPMS sensors could be damaged and would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Tire Pressure Monitor System The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses radio and sensor technology to check tire pressure levels. The TPMS sensors monitor the air pressure in your tires and transmit tire pressure readings to a receiver located in the vehicle. Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.) As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale. Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly. See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation 0 351. See Radio Frequency Statement 0 417. Tire Pressure Monitor Operation This vehicle may have a Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS). The TPMS is designed to warn the driver when a low tire pressure condition exists. TPMS sensors are mounted onto each tire and wheel assembly, excluding the spare tire and wheel assembly. The TPMS sensors monitor the air pressure in the tires and transmit the tire pressure readings to a receiver located in the vehicle. When a low tire pressure condition is detected, the TPMS illuminates the low tire pressure warning light located on the instrument cluster. If the warning light comes on, stop as soon as possible and inflate the tires to the recommended pressure shown on the Tire and Loading Information label. See Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. A message to check the pressure in a specific tire displays in the Driver Information Center (DIC). The low tire pressure warning light and the DIC warning message come on at each ignition cycle until the tires are inflated to the correct inflation pressure. If the vehicle has DIC buttons, tire pressure levels can be viewed. For additional information and details about the DIC operation and displays, 351 see Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125. The low tire pressure warning light may come on in cool weather when the vehicle is first started, and then turn off as the vehicle is driven. This could be an early indicator that the air pressure is getting low and needs to be inflated to the proper pressure. A Tire and Loading Information label shows the size of the original equipment tires and the correct inflation pressure for the tires when they are cold. See Vehicle Load Limits 0 220, for an example of the Tire and Loading Information label and its location. Also see Tire Pressure 0 349. The TPMS can warn about a low tire pressure condition but it does not replace normal tire maintenance. See Tire Inspection 0 355, Tire Rotation 0 356 and Tires 0 344. Caution Tire sealant materials are not all the same. A non-approved tire sealant could damage the TPMS sensors. TPMS sensor (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 352 Vehicle Care Caution (Continued) damage caused by using an incorrect tire sealant is not covered by the vehicle warranty. Always use only the GM approved tire sealant available through your dealer or included in the vehicle. TPMS Malfunction Light and Message The TPMS will not function properly if one or more of the TPMS sensors are missing or inoperable. When the system detects a malfunction, the low tire pressure warning light flashes for about one minute and then stays on for the remainder of the ignition cycle. A DIC warning message also displays. The malfunction light and DIC warning message come on at each ignition cycle until the problem is corrected. Some of the conditions that can cause these to come on are: . One of the road tires has been replaced with the spare tire. The spare tire does not have a TPMS sensor. The malfunction light and the DIC message should go off after the road tire is replaced and the sensor matching process is performed successfully. See "TPMS Sensor Matching Process" later in this section. . The TPMS sensor matching process was not done or not completed successfully after rotating the tires. The malfunction light and the DIC message should go off after successfully completing the sensor matching process. See "TPMS Sensor Matching Process" later in this section. . One or more TPMS sensors are missing or damaged. The malfunction light and the DIC message should go off when the TPMS sensors are installed and the sensor matching process is performed successfully. See your dealer for service. . Replacement tires or wheels do not match the original equipment tires or wheels. Tires and wheels other than those recommended could prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. See Buying New Tires 0 359. . Operating electronic devices or being near facilities using radio wave frequencies similar to the TPMS could cause the TPMS sensors to malfunction. If the TPMS is not functioning properly, it cannot detect or signal a low tire pressure condition. See your dealer for service if the TPMS malfunction light and DIC message come on and stay on. Tire Fill Alert (If Equipped) This feature provides visual and audible alerts outside the vehicle to help when inflating an underinflated tire to the recommended cold tire pressure. When the low tire pressure warning light comes on: 1. Park the vehicle in a safe, level place. 2. Set the parking brake firmly. 3. Place the vehicle in P (Park). 4. Add air to the tire that is underinflated. The turn signal lamp will flash. When the recommended pressure is reached, the horn sounds once and the turn signal lamp will stop flashing and briefly turn solid. Repeat these steps for all underinflated tires that have illuminated the low tire pressure warning light. { Warning Overinflating a tire could cause the tire to rupture and you or others could be injured. Do not exceed the maximum (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Warning (Continued) pressure listed on the tire sidewall. See Tire Sidewall Labeling 0 345 and Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. If the tire is overinflated by more than 35 kPa (5 psi), the horn will sound multiple times and the turn signal lamp will continue to flash for several seconds after filling stops. To release and correct the pressure, while the turn signal lamp is still flashing, briefly press the center of the valve stem. When the recommended pressure is reached, the horn sounds once. If the turn signal lamp does not flash within 15 seconds after starting to inflate the tire, the tire fill alert has not been activated or is not working. If the hazard warning flashers are on, the tire fill alert visual feedback will not work properly. The TPMS will not activate the tire fill alert properly under the following conditions: . There is interference from an external device or transmitter. . The air pressure from the inflation device is not sufficient to inflate the tire. . There is a malfunction in the TPMS. . There is a malfunction in the horn or turn signal lamps. . The identification code of the TPMS sensor is not registered to the system. . The battery of the TPMS sensor is low. If the tire fill alert does not operate due to TPMS interference, move the vehicle about 1 m (3 ft) back or forward and try again. If the tire fill alert feature is not working, use a tire pressure gauge. TPMS Sensor Matching Process Each TPMS sensor has a unique identification code. The identification code needs to be matched to a new tire/wheel position after rotating the vehicle’s tires or replacing one or more of the TPMS sensors. Also, the TPMS sensor matching process should be performed after replacing a spare tire with a road tire containing the TPMS sensor. The malfunction light and the DIC message should go off at the next ignition cycle. The sensors are matched to the tire/ wheel positions, using a TPMS relearn tool, in the following order: driver side front tire, passenger side front tire, passenger side rear tire, and driver side rear. See your dealer for service or to purchase a relearn tool. 353 A TPMS relearn tool can also be purchased. See Tire Pressure Monitor Sensor Activation Tool at www.gmtoolsandequipment.com or call 1-800-GM TOOLS (1-800-468-6657). There are two minutes to match the first tire/wheel position, and five minutes overall to match all four tire/wheel positions. If it takes longer, the matching process stops and must be restarted. The TPMS sensor matching process is: 1. Set the parking brake. 2. Turn the ignition on without starting the vehicle. 3. Uplevel DIC Only: Make sure the Tire Pressure info page option is turned on. The info pages on the DIC can be turned on and off through the Options menu. See Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125. 4. If the vehicle has an uplevel DIC, use the DIC controls on the right side of the steering wheel to scroll to the Tire Pressure screen under the DIC info page. If the vehicle has a base level DIC, use the trip odometer reset stem to scroll to the Tire Pressure screen. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 354 Vehicle Care 5. If the vehicle has an uplevel DIC, press and hold the thumbwheel located in the center of the DIC controls on the right side of the steering wheel. If the vehicle has a base level DIC, press and hold the trip odometer reset stem for about five seconds. A message asking if the process should begin should appear. Select yes and press the trip odometer reset stem to confirm the selection. The horn sounds twice to signal the receiver is in relearn mode and the TIRE LEARNING ACTIVE message displays on the DIC screen. 6. Start with the driver side front tire. 7. Place the relearn tool against the tire sidewall, near the valve stem. Then press the button to activate the TPMS sensor. A horn chirp confirms that the sensor identification code has been matched to this tire and wheel position. 8. Proceed to the passenger side front tire, and repeat the procedure in Step 7. 9. Proceed to the passenger side rear tire, and repeat the procedure in Step 7. 10. Proceed to the driver side rear tire, and repeat the procedure in Step 7. The horn sounds two times to indicate the sensor identification code has been matched to the driver side rear tire, and the TPMS sensor matching process is no longer active. The TIRE LEARNING ACTIVE message on the DIC display screen goes off. 11. Turn the vehicle off. 12. Set all four tires to the recommended air pressure level as indicated on the Tire and Loading Information label. Trailer Tire Pressure Monitoring Operation If equipped, the Trailer Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TTPMS) is designed to monitor the pressure of the trailer tires and warn the driver when a low pressure condition exists. TTPMS sensors for four tires are provided. The system can accommodate a trailer with up to six tires if additional sensors are purchased from the dealer. Also, the system can be paired with up to five individual trailers. Prior to use, the vehicle must learn the sensors by following the learning process. See Trailering App 0 292. Contact your trailer service center or tire service center to have the pressure sensors installed inside the trailer tires. The technician should insert the sensor stem through the hole in the trailer wheel. When the sensor is correctly positioned, the nut on the sensor stem should be tightened to 8 Y (6 lb ft). When mounting the trailer tire onto the trailer wheel be careful not to damage the sensor. The Trailering App can be used to view the tire pressures after the recommended trailer tire pressures have been entered. Refer to the trailer tire placard on the trailer or the trailer tire sidewall for the recommended tire pressure. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care The system is compatible with trailer tires that have placard pressure values from 103 689 kpa (15 - 100 psi). The hole in the wheel for the tire stem must be 11.43 mm (0.453 in) or 15.88 mm (0.625 in) in diameter. Use of the pressure sensors on a wheel with a different stem hole size could result in loss of air from the tire. If a low trailer tire pressure condition is detected, the TTPMS displays a warning message on the DIC. If the warning message is displayed, stop as soon as possible and inflate the tires to the recommended pressure shown on the tire placard on the trailer. In addition, the TTPMS monitors the temperature of the trailer tires. If the system detects a high temperature on one or more of the trailer tires, a warning message will be displayed on the DIC. If this warning message is displayed, stop as soon as possible, and inspect the overheated trailer tire. Common causes for high trailer tire temperature are underinflation, overloading, or tire damage. TTPMS Malfunction Message The TTPMS will not function properly if one or more of the trailer tire sensors are missing or inoperable. If the system detects a malfunction, a DIC message indicates that the system requires service. Some of the conditions that can cause the service message to occur are: . One of the trailer tires has been replaced with the spare tire which does not have a learned TTPMS sensor. The DIC message should turn off after the pressure sensor is installed in the tire, and the learning process is performed successfully. See "TTPMS Sensor Learning Process" under Trailering App 0 292. . The TTPMS sensor learning process was not done or not completed successfully. The DIC message should go off after successfully completing the sensor learning process. See "TTPMS Sensor Learning Process" under Trailering App 0 292. . One or more TTPMS sensors are missing or damaged. The DIC message should go off when the TTPMS sensors are installed and the sensor learning process is 355 performed successfully. See "TTPMS Sensor Learning Process" under Trailering App 0 292. . Operating electronic devices or being near facilities using radio wave frequencies similar to the TTPMS could cause interference to the TTPMS which could cause loss of signal reception from the sensor. . If the system does not receive the signal from an individual sensor, an error message may not occur until the vehicle has been driver for a period of time. If the TTPMS is not functioning properly, it cannot detect or signal a low tire condition. See your dealer for service if the DIC message comes on and stays on when the trailer tire pressures have been checked and determined to be correct. Tire Inspection We recommend that the tires, including the spare tire, if the vehicle has one, be inspected for signs of wear or damage at least once a month. Replace the tire if: . The indicators at three or more places around the tire can be seen. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 356 Vehicle Care There is cord or fabric showing through the tire's rubber. . The tread or sidewall is cracked, cut, or snagged deep enough to show cord or fabric. . The tire has a bump, bulge, or split. . The tire has a puncture, cut, or other damage that cannot be repaired well because of the size or location of the damage. . See When It Is Time for New Tires 0 358 and Wheel Replacement 0 361. If the full-size spare tire is part of the tire rotation, make sure the tire rotated into the spare position is stored securely. Push, pull, and then try to rotate or turn the tire. If it moves, use the wheel wrench/hoist shaft to tighten the cable. See Tire Changing 0 364. Tire Rotation Tires should be rotated every 12 000 km (7,500 mi). See Maintenance Schedule 0 392. Tires are rotated to achieve a more uniform wear for all tires. The first rotation is the most important. Anytime unusual wear is noticed, rotate the tires as soon as possible, check for proper tire inflation pressure, and check for damaged tires or wheels. If the unusual wear continues after the rotation, check the wheel alignment. Use this rotation pattern when rotating the tires if the vehicle has single rear wheels. Dual Tire Rotation When the vehicle is new, or whenever a wheel, wheel bolt, or wheel nut is replaced or serviced, check the wheel nut torque after 160, 1 600, and 10 000 km (100, 1,000, and 6,000 mi) of driving. For proper torque and wheel nut tightening information, see “Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare Tire” under Tire Changing 0 364 and “Wheel Nut Torque” under Capacities and Specifications 0 406 and “Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare Tire” under Tire Changing 0 364. The outer tire on a dual wheel setup generally wears faster than the inner tire. Tires last longer and wear more evenly if they are rotated. See Tire Inspection 0 355 and Tire Rotation 0 356. Also see Maintenance Schedule 0 392. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care 357 Adjust the front and rear tires to the recommended inflation pressure on the Tire and Loading Information label after the tires have been rotated. See Tire Pressure 0 349 and Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. Reset the Tire Pressure Monitor System. See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation 0 351. Use this rotation pattern when rotating the tires if the vehicle has dual rear wheels (except polished forged aluminum wheels). Vehicles with polished forged aluminum dual wheels have three unique wheels; a front, a rear outer and a rear inner. These wheels cannot be rotated to another position, however, they can be rotated from left to right to the same position. Use this rotation pattern when rotating the tires if the vehicle has polished forged aluminum dual rear wheels. The spare wheel can be used in any position in the event of a flat tire, and can be rotated with the rear inner wheels. After the flat tire is repaired, if the spare is not on one of the inner rear positions, it must be replaced by the correct wheel in the front or rear outer positions. When installing dual wheels, check that the vent holes in the inner and outer wheels on each side are lined up. Check that all wheel nuts are properly tightened. See “Wheel Nut Torque” under Capacities and Specifications 0 406, and “Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare Tire” under Tire Changing 0 364. { Warning Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to which it is fastened, can cause wheel nuts to become loose over time. The wheel could come off and cause a crash. When changing a wheel, remove any rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches to the vehicle. In an emergency, a cloth (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 358 Vehicle Care four digits of the DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN) molded into one side of the tire sidewall. The last four digits of the TIN indicate the tire manufactured date. The first two digits represent the week and the last two digits, the year. For example, the third week of the year 2020 would have a 4-digit DOT date of 0320. Week 01 is the first full week (Sunday through Saturday) of each year. Warning (Continued) or paper towel can be used; however, use a scraper or wire brush later to remove all rust or dirt. Lightly coat the inner diameter of the wheel hub opening with wheel bearing grease after a wheel change or tire rotation to prevent corrosion or rust build-up. { Warning Do not apply grease to the wheel mounting surface, wheel conical seats, or the wheel nuts or bolts. Grease applied to these areas could cause a wheel to become loose or come off, resulting in a crash. When It Is Time for New Tires Factors, such as maintenance, temperatures, driving speeds, vehicle loading, and road conditions affect the wear rate of the tires. Vehicle Storage Treadwear indicators are one way to tell when it is time for new tires. Treadwear indicators appear when the tires have only 1.6 mm (1/16 in) or less of tread remaining. See Tire Inspection 0 355 and Tire Rotation 0 356 for additional information. The rubber in tires ages over time. This also applies to the spare tire, if the vehicle has one, even if it is never used. Multiple factors including temperatures, loading conditions, and inflation pressure maintenance affect how fast aging takes place. GM recommends that tires, including the spare if equipped, be replaced after six years, regardless of tread wear. To identify the age of a tire, use the tire manufacture date, which is the last Tires age when stored normally mounted on a parked vehicle. Park a vehicle that will be stored for at least a month in a cool, dry, clean area away from direct sunlight to slow aging. This area should be free of grease, gasoline, or other substances that can deteriorate rubber. Parking for an extended period can cause flat spots on the tires that may result in vibrations while driving. When storing a vehicle for at least a month, remove the tires or raise the vehicle to reduce the weight from the tires. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Buying New Tires GM has developed and matched specific tires for the vehicle. The original equipment tires installed were designed to meet General Motors Tire Performance Criteria Specification (TPC Spec) system rating. When replacement tires are needed, GM strongly recommends buying tires with the same TPC Spec rating. GM's exclusive TPC Spec system considers over a dozen critical specifications that impact the overall performance of the vehicle, including brake system performance, ride and handling, traction control, and tire pressure monitoring performance. GM's TPC Spec number is molded onto the tire's sidewall near the tire size. If the tires have an all-season tread design, the TPC Spec number will be followed by MS for mud and snow. See Tire Sidewall Labeling 0 345 for additional information. GM recommends replacing worn tires in complete sets of four (six for dual rear wheels). Uniform tread depth on all tires will help to maintain the performance of the vehicle. Braking and handling performance may be adversely affected if all the tires are not replaced at the same time. If proper rotation and maintenance have been done, all four tires (six for dual rear wheels) should wear out at about the same time. However, if it is necessary to replace only one axle set of worn tires, place the new tires on the rear axle (two for single rear wheels, four for dual rear wheels). See Tire Rotation 0 356. { Warning Tires could explode during improper service. Attempting to mount or dismount a tire could cause injury or death. Only your dealer or authorized tire service center should mount or dismount the tires. 359 { Warning Mixing tires of different sizes (other than those originally installed on the vehicle), brands, tread patterns, or types may cause loss of vehicle control, resulting in a crash or other vehicle damage. Use the correct size, brand, and type of tire on all wheels. { Warning Using bias-ply tires on the vehicle may cause the wheel rim flanges to develop cracks after many miles of driving. A tire and/or wheel could fail suddenly and cause a crash. Use only radial-ply tires with the wheels on the vehicle. Winter tires with the same speed rating as the original equipment tires may not be available for H, V, W, Y and ZR speed rated tires. Never exceed the winter tires’ maximum speed capability when using winter tires with a lower speed rating. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 360 Vehicle Care If the vehicle tires must be replaced with a tire that does not have a TPC Spec number, make sure they are the same size, load range, speed rating, and construction (radial) as the original tires. The Tire and Loading Information label indicates the original equipment tires on the vehicle. See Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. Different Size Tires and Wheels If wheels or tires are installed that are a different size than the original equipment wheels and tires, vehicle performance, including its braking, ride and handling characteristics, stability, and resistance to rollover may be affected. If the vehicle has electronic systems such as antilock brakes, rollover airbags, traction control, electronic stability control, or All-Wheel Drive, the performance of these systems can also be affected. { Warning If different sized wheels are used, there may not be an acceptable level of performance and safety if tires not recommended for those wheels are selected. This increases the chance of a crash and serious injury. Only use GM specific wheel and tire systems developed for the vehicle, and have them properly installed by a GM certified technician. See Buying New Tires 0 359 and Accessories and Modifications 0 307. Uniform Tire Quality Grading The following information relates to the system developed by the United States National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), which grades tires by treadwear, traction, and temperature performance. This applies only to vehicles sold in the United States. The grades are molded on the sidewalls of most passenger car tires. The Uniform Tire Quality Grading (UTQG) system does not apply to deep tread, winter tires, compact spare tires, tires with nominal rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches (25 to 30 cm), or to some limited-production tires. While the tires available on General Motors passenger cars and light trucks may vary with respect to these grades, they must also conform to federal safety requirements and additional General Motors Tire Performance Criteria (TPC) standards. Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example: Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A All Passenger Car Tires Must Conform to Federal Safety Requirements In Addition To These Grades. Treadwear The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1½) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate. Traction The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance. Warning: The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics. Temperature The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C, representing the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law. Warning: The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure. 361 Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance The tires and wheels were aligned and balanced at the factory to provide the longest tire life and best overall performance. Adjustments to wheel alignment and tire balancing are not necessary on a regular basis. Consider an alignment check if there is unusual tire wear or the vehicle is significantly pulling to one side or the other. Some slight pull to the left or right, depending on the crown of the road and/or other road surface variations such as troughs or ruts, is normal. If the vehicle is vibrating when driving on a smooth road, the tires and wheels may need to be rebalanced. See your dealer for proper diagnosis. Wheel Replacement Replace any wheel that is bent, cracked, or badly rusted or corroded. If wheel nuts keep coming loose, the wheel, wheel bolts, and wheel nuts should be replaced. If the wheel leaks air, replace it. Some aluminum wheels can be repaired. See your dealer if any of these conditions exist. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 362 Vehicle Care Your dealer will know the kind of wheel that is needed. Each new wheel should have the same load-carrying capacity, diameter, width, offset, and be mounted the same way as the one it replaces. Replace wheels, wheel bolts, wheel nuts, or Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) sensors with new GM original equipment parts. { Warning Using the wrong replacement wheels, wheel bolts, or wheel nuts can be dangerous. It could affect the braking and handling of the vehicle. Tires can lose air, and cause loss of control, causing a crash. Always use the correct wheel, wheel bolts, and wheel nuts for replacement. Caution The wrong wheel can also cause problems with bearing life, brake cooling, speedometer or odometer calibration, headlamp aim, bumper height, vehicle ground clearance, and tire or tire chain clearance to the body and chassis. Used Replacement Wheels { Warning Replacing a wheel with a used one is dangerous. How it has been used or how far it has been driven may be unknown. It could fail suddenly and cause a crash. When replacing wheels, use a new GM original equipment wheel. Tire Chains { Warning If the vehicle has LT275/65R20 size tires, do not use tire chains. There is not enough clearance. Tire chains used on a vehicle without the proper amount of clearance can cause damage to the brakes, suspension, or other vehicle parts. The area damaged by the tire chains could cause loss of control and a crash. Use another type of traction device only if its manufacturer recommends it for the vehicle's tire size combination and road conditions. Follow that manufacturer's instructions. To avoid vehicle damage, drive slow and readjust or remove the (Continued) Warning (Continued) traction device if it is contacting the vehicle. Do not spin the wheels. If traction devices are used, install them on the rear tires. Caution Use tire chains only where legal and only when necessary. Use chains that are the proper size for the tires. If the vehicle has LT235/80R17 size tires, install the chains on the tires of the rear axle only. If the vehicle has LT245/75R17, LT265/70R17, or LT275/70R18 size tires, install the chains on the tires of the front and rear axle. Tighten them as tightly as possible with the ends securely fastened. Drive slowly and follow the chain manufacturer's instructions. If the chains contact the vehicle, stop and retighten them. If the contact continues, slow down until it stops. Driving too fast or spinning the wheels with chains on will damage the vehicle. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care If a Tire Goes Flat It is unusual for a tire to blowout while driving, especially if the tires are maintained properly. If air goes out of a tire, it is much more likely to leak out slowly. But if there ever is a blowout, here are a few tips about what to expect and what to do: If a front tire fails, the flat tire creates a drag that pulls the vehicle toward that side. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal and grip the steering wheel firmly. Steer to maintain lane position, and then gently brake to a stop, well off the road, if possible. A rear blowout, particularly on a curve, acts much like a skid and may require the same correction as used in a skid. Stop pressing the accelerator pedal and steer to straighten the vehicle. It may be very bumpy and noisy. Gently brake to a stop, well off the road, if possible. { Warning Driving on a flat tire will cause permanent damage to the tire. Re-inflating a tire after it has been driven on while severely underinflated or flat (Continued) 363 Warning (Continued) { Warning may cause a blowout and a serious crash. Never attempt to re-inflate a tire that has been driven on while severely underinflated or flat. Have your dealer or an authorized tire service center repair or replace the flat tire as soon as possible. Changing a tire can be dangerous. The vehicle can slip off the jack and roll over or fall causing injury or death. Find a level place to change the tire. To help prevent the vehicle from moving: 1. Set the parking brake firmly. 2. Shift the vehicle to P (Park). { Warning Lifting a vehicle and getting under it to do maintenance or repairs is dangerous without the appropriate safety equipment and training. If a jack is provided with the vehicle, it is designed only for changing a flat tire. If it is used for anything else, you or others could be badly injured or killed if the vehicle slips off the jack. If a jack is provided with the vehicle, only use it for changing a flat tire. If a tire goes flat, avoid further tire and wheel damage by driving slowly to a level place, well off the road, if possible. Turn on the hazard warning flashers. See Hazard Warning Flashers 0 142. 3. For vehicles with four-wheel drive with an N (Neutral) transfer case position, be sure the transfer case is in a drive gear — not in N (Neutral). 4. Turn off the engine and do not restart while the vehicle is raised. 5. Do not allow passengers to remain in the vehicle. 6. Place wheel blocks, if equipped, on both sides of the tire at the opposite corner of the tire being changed. When the vehicle has a flat tire (2), use the following example as a guide to assist in the placement of the wheel blocks (1), if equipped. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 364 Vehicle Care Tire Changing Removing the Spare Tire and Tools 2. Turn the wing nut counterclockwise to remove the wheel blocks and the wheel block retainer. 3. Turn the wing nut used to retain the storage bag and tools counterclockwise to remove it. Use the jack handle extensions and the wheel wrench to remove the underbody-mounted spare tire. 1. Wheel Block (If Equipped) 2. Flat Tire The following information explains how to use the jack and change a tire. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Jack Jack Knob Tool Kit Wing Nut Retaining Tool Kit Wheel Blocks Wing Nut Retaining Wheel Blocks The equipment is under the second row seats, if equipped, or behind the front row seats on regular cab models. 1. Turn the knob on the jack counterclockwise to lower the jack head to release the jack from its holder. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Spare Tire (Valve Stem Pointed Down) Tire/Wheel Retainer Hoist Cable Hoist Assembly Hoist Shaft Jack Handle Extensions Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care 7. Wheel Wrench 8. Spare Tire Lock (If Equipped) 9. Hoist Shaft Access Hole 10. Hoist End of Extension Tool 1. Open the spare tire lock cover on the bumper and use the ignition key to remove the spare tire lock (8). To remove the spare tire lock, insert the ignition key, turn, and pull straight out. Spare Tire Cable (If Equipped) 3. If the vehicle is equipped with a spare tire cable disconnect the cable from the attachment on the frame by unclipping it from the frame attachment bracket. 365 4. Insert the hoist end (open end) (10) of the extension through the hole (9) in the rear bumper. Do not use the chiseled end of the wheel wrench. Be sure the hoist end of the extension (10) connects to the hoist shaft. The ribbed square end of the extension is used to lower the spare tire. 5. Turn the wheel wrench counterclockwise to lower the spare tire to the ground. Continue to turn the wheel wrench until the spare tire can be pulled out from under the vehicle. 6. Pull the spare tire out from under the vehicle. 2. Assemble the wheel wrench (7) and the two jack handle extensions (6), as shown. 7. Tilt the tire toward the vehicle with some slack in the cable to access the tire/wheel retainer. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 366 Vehicle Care 9. If equipped with a spare tire cable remove the cable from the spare tire by passing the clip through the looped end of the cable. Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare Tire The tools you will be using include the jack (1), the wheel blocks (2), the jack handle (3), the jack handle extensions (4), and the wheel wrench (5). 1. Do a safety check before proceeding. See If a Tire Goes Flat 0 363. Use the following pictures and instructions to remove the flat tire and raise the vehicle. Tilt the retainer and pull it through the center of the wheel along with the cable and spring. 8. Put the spare tire near the flat tire. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Jack Wheel Blocks Jack Handle Jack Handle Extensions Wheel Wrench 2. If the vehicle has wheel nut caps, loosen them by turning the wheel wrench counterclockwise. If the vehicle has a center cap with wheel nut caps, the wheel nut caps are designed to stay with the center cap after they are loosened. Remove the entire center cap. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care If the wheel has a smooth center cap, concealing access to the wheel nuts, place the chisel end of the wheel wrench in the slot on the wheel, and gently pry it out. If the wheel’s center cap does not conceal the wheel nuts, the center cap may remain during wheel removal. If the removed wheel is to be stowed in the hoist, the cap needs to be detached from the wheel. Access the wheel from the back side, and use a jack handle extension to push out the center cap. 3. Use the wheel wrench and turn it counterclockwise to loosen the wheel nuts. Do not remove the wheel nuts yet. { Warning To avoid personal injury and vehicle damage, disable the power assist steps before using a jack or placing an object under the vehicle. See Power Assist Steps 0 31. 367 Front Position 4. If the flat tire is on the front of the vehicle, position the jack under the bracket attached to the vehicle's frame, behind the flat tire, as shown. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 368 Vehicle Care { Warning Warning (Continued) Getting under a vehicle when it is lifted on a jack is dangerous. If the vehicle slips off the jack, you could be badly injured or killed. Never get under a vehicle when it is supported only by a jack. overextended position or not lower fully. Do not attempt to force the jack higher once the height limit is reached. { Warning Rear Position 5. If the flat tire is on the rear of the vehicle, position the jack under the rear axle between the spring anchor and the shock absorber bracket. If a snow plow has been added to the front of the vehicle, lower the snow plow fully before raising the vehicle. Make sure that the jack head is positioned so that the rear axle is resting securely between the grooves that are on the jack head. Raising the vehicle with the jack improperly positioned can damage the vehicle and even make the vehicle fall. To help avoid personal injury and vehicle damage, be sure to fit the jack lift head into the proper location before raising the vehicle. 6. Turn the wheel wrench clockwise to raise the vehicle. Raise the vehicle far enough off the ground so there is enough room for the spare tire to fit under the wheel well. { Warning The jack has a feature to limit its travel to prevent overextension. When the height limit is reached, an increase in resistance if felt when attempting to raise the jack farther. Raising the jack past the height limit can damage the jack pin and cause the jack to lock into an (Continued) 7. Remove all the wheel nuts and take off the flat tire. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care { Warning Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to which it is fastened, can cause wheel nuts to become loose over time. The wheel could come off and cause a crash. When changing a wheel, remove any rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches to the vehicle. In an emergency, a cloth or paper towel can be used; however, use a scraper or wire brush later to remove all rust or dirt. 8. Remove any rust or dirt from the wheel bolts, mounting surfaces, and spare wheel. 9. Install the spare tire. { Warning Never use oil or grease on bolts or nuts because the nuts might come loose. The vehicle's wheel could fall off, causing a crash. 10. Put the wheel nuts back on with the rounded end of the nuts toward the wheel. 11. Tighten each wheel nut by hand. Then use the wheel wrench to tighten the nuts until the wheel is held against the hub. 12. Turn the wheel wrench counterclockwise to lower the vehicle. Lower the jack completely. { Warning If wheel studs are damaged, they can break. If all the studs on a wheel broke, the wheel could come off and cause a crash. If any stud is damaged because of (Continued) 369 Warning (Continued) a loose-running wheel, it could be that all of the studs are damaged. To be sure, replace all studs on the wheel. If the stud holes in a wheel have become larger, the wheel could collapse in operation. Replace any wheel if its stud holes have become larger or distorted in any way. Inspect hubs and hub‐piloted wheels for damage. Because of loose running wheels, piloting pad damage may occur and require replacement of the entire hub, for proper centering of the wheels. When replacing studs, hubs, wheel nuts or wheels, be sure to use GM original equipment parts. { Warning Wheel nuts that are improperly or incorrectly tightened can cause the wheels to become loose or come off. The wheel nuts should be tightened with a torque wrench to the proper torque specification after replacing. Follow the torque specification supplied by the aftermarket manufacturer when using (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 370 Vehicle Care Warning (Continued) accessory locking wheel nuts. See Capacities and Specifications 0 406 for original equipment wheel nut torque specifications. Caution Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. To avoid expensive brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts in the proper sequence and to the proper torque specification. See Capacities and Specifications 0 406 for the wheel nut torque specification. 13. Tighten the nuts firmly in a crisscross sequence, as shown, by turning the wheel wrench clockwise. Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools { Warning For vehicles with dual wheels, have a technician check the wheel nut tightness of all wheels with a torque wrench after the first 160, 1 600 and 10 000 km (100, 1,000 and 6,000 mi). Repeat this service whenever you have a tire removed or serviced. See Capacities and Specifications 0 406. Storing a jack, a tire, or other equipment in the passenger compartment of the vehicle could cause injury. In a sudden stop or collision, loose equipment could strike someone. Store all these in the proper place. When reinstalling the regular wheel and tire, also reinstall either the center cap, or bolt-on hub cap, depending on what the vehicle is equipped with. For center caps, place the cap on the wheel and tap it into place until it seats flush with the wheel. The cap only goes on one way. Be sure to line up the tab on the center cap with the indentation on the wheel. For bolt-on hub caps, align the plastic nut caps with the wheel nuts and then tighten by hand. Then use the wheel wrench to tighten. Failure to follow these tire storage instructions carefully could result in personal injury or property damage if the hoist cable fails or if the tire comes loose. Make sure the tire is stored securely before driving. { Warning Caution Storing an aluminum wheel with a flat tire under your vehicle for an extended period of time or with the valve stem pointing up can damage the wheel. Always stow the wheel with the valve stem pointing down and have the wheel/ tire repaired as soon as possible. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care 371 Caution The tire hoist can be damaged if there is no tension on the cable when using it. To have the necessary tension, the spare or road tire and wheel assembly must be installed on the tire hoist to use it. { Warning An improperly stored spare tire could come loose and cause a crash. To avoid personal injury or property damage, always store the spare tire when the vehicle is parked on a level surface. Store the tire under the rear of the vehicle in the spare tire carrier. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. Spare Tire (Valve Stem Pointed Down) Tire/Wheel Retainer Hoist Cable Hoist Assembly Hoist Shaft Jack Handle Extensions Wheel Wrench Spare Tire Lock (If Equipped) Hoist Shaft Access Hole Hoist End of Extension Tool 11. Spare Tire Cable (If Equipped) 1. If equipped with a spare tire cable, reinstall the cable to the spare wheel by looping the cable around a wheel vent window then pass the clip end of the Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 372 Vehicle Care cable through the looped end. The excess cable wire should be on the valve stem side of the spare tire. 2. Put the tire on the ground at the rear of the vehicle with the valve stem pointed down, and to the rear. 3. Pull the cable and spring through the center of the wheel. Tilt the wheel retainer plate down and through the center wheel. Make sure the retainer is fully seated across the underside of the wheel. 4. Attach the wheel wrench (7) and extensions (6) together, as shown. Caution Use of an air wrench or other power tools with the hoist mechanism is not recommended and could damage the system. Use only the tools supplied with the hoist mechanism. 5. Insert the hoist end (10) through the hole (9) in the rear bumper and onto the hoist shaft. Do not use the chiseled end of the wheel wrench. 6. Raise the tire part way upward. Make sure the retainer is seated in the wheel opening. 7. If equipped with a spare tire cable, orient the cable by rotating the spare tire so that the cable is by the frame attachment location. 8. Raise the tire fully against the underside of the vehicle by turning the wheel wrench clockwise until you hear two clicks or feel it skip twice. You cannot overtighten the cable. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care 373 If equipped with a spare tire cable, reattach the clip to the frame attachment bracket. Note that there may be slack in the cable. Repeat this tightness check procedure when checking the spare tire pressure according to the scheduled maintenance information or any time the spare tire is handled due to service of other components. Incorrectly Stored 9. Make sure the tire is stored securely. Push, pull, and then try to turn the tire. If the tire moves, use the wheel wrench to tighten the cable. 10. Reinstall the spare tire lock, if the vehicle has one. Correctly Stored Return the jack and tools to their original location in the vehicle. See “Removing the Spare Tire and Tools.” Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 374 Vehicle Care Full-Size Spare Tire Caution If this vehicle came with a full-size spare tire, it was fully inflated when new, however, it can lose air over time. Check the inflation pressure regularly. See Tire Pressure 0 349 and Vehicle Load Limits 0 220 for information regarding proper tire inflation and loading the vehicle. For instructions on how to remove, install, or store a spare tire, see Tire Changing 0 364. If the vehicle has four-wheel drive and a different size spare tire is installed, do not drive in four-wheel drive until the flat tire is repaired and/or replaced. The vehicle could be damaged and the repairs would not be covered by the warranty. Never use four-wheel drive when a different size spare tire is installed on the vehicle. After installing the spare tire on the vehicle, stop as soon as possible and check that the spare is correctly inflated. The spare tire is made to perform well at speeds up to 112 km/h (70 MPH) at the recommended inflation pressure, so you can finish your trip. The vehicle may have a different size spare tire than the road tires originally installed on the vehicle. This spare tire was developed for use on this vehicle, so it is all right to drive on it. If the vehicle has four-wheel drive and a different size spare tire is installed, drive only in two-wheel drive. Have the damaged or flat road tire repaired or replaced and installed back onto the vehicle as soon as possible so the spare tire will be available in case it is needed again. Do not mix tires and wheels of difference sizes, because they will not fit. Keep the spare tire and its wheel together. If the vehicle has a spare tire that does not match the vehicle’s original road tires and wheels, in size and type, do not include the spare in the tire rotation. Jump Starting Jump Starting - North America For more information about the vehicle battery, see Battery - North America 0 324. If the vehicle's battery (or batteries) has run down, you may want to use another vehicle and some jumper cables to start your vehicle. Be sure to use the following steps to do it safely. { Warning WARNING: Battery posts, terminals and related accessories can expose you to chemicals including lead and lead compounds, which are known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. Wash hands after handling. For more information go to www.P65Warnings.ca.gov. See the warning on the back cover. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care 375 The discharged battery positive (+) terminal is under a cover. Open the cover to expose the terminal. 1. Check the other vehicle. It must have a 12-volt battery with a negative ground system. { Warning Batteries can hurt you. They can be dangerous because: . They contain acid that can burn you. . They contain gas that can explode or ignite. Caution . They contain enough electricity to burn you. If you do not follow these steps exactly, some or all of these things can hurt you. Caution Ignoring these steps could result in costly damage to the vehicle that would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Trying to start the vehicle by pushing or pulling it will not work, and it could damage the vehicle. 1. Good Battery Positive (+) Terminal 2. Good Battery Negative (–) Terminal 3. Discharged Battery Positive (+) Terminal 4. Discharged Battery Negative (–) Grounding Point The good battery positive (+) terminal and the good battery negative (–) terminal are on the battery of the vehicle providing the jump start. The discharged battery positive (+) terminal and the discharged battery negative (–) grounding point are on the passenger side of the vehicle. If the other vehicle does not have a 12-volt system with a negative ground, both vehicles can be damaged. Only use a vehicle that has a 12-volt system with a negative ground for jump starting. 2. If you have a vehicle with a diesel engine with two batteries, you should know before you begin that, especially in cold weather, you may not be able to get enough power from a single battery in another vehicle to start your diesel engine. If your vehicle has more than one battery, using the battery that is closer to the starter will reduce electrical resistance. This is located on the passenger side, in the rear of the engine compartment. 3. Get the vehicles close enough so the jumper cables can reach, but be sure the vehicles are not touching each other. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 376 Vehicle Care If they are, it could cause an unwanted ground connection. You would not be able to start your vehicle, and the bad grounding could damage the electrical systems. To avoid the possibility of the vehicles rolling, set the parking brake firmly on both vehicles involved in the jump start procedure. Put the automatic transmission in P (Park) before setting the parking brake. If you have a four-wheel-drive vehicle, be sure the transfer case is in a drive gear, not in N (Neutral). not needed. This will avoid sparks and help save both batteries. And it could save the radio! 5. Open the hood on the other vehicle and locate the positive (+) and negative (−) terminal locations on that vehicle. { Warning An electric fan can start up even when the engine is not running and can injure you. Keep hands, clothing, and tools away from any underhood electric fan. Caution { Warning If any accessories are left on or plugged in during the jump starting procedure, they could be damaged. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Whenever possible, turn off or unplug all accessories on either vehicle when jump starting. Using a match near a battery can cause battery gas to explode. People have been hurt doing this, and some have been blinded. Use a flashlight if you need more light. 4. Turn the ignition off on both vehicles. Unplug unnecessary accessories plugged into the accessory power outlets. Turn off the radio and all the lamps that are Battery fluid contains acid that can burn you. Do not get it on you. If you accidentally get it in your eyes or on your skin, flush the place with water and get medical help immediately. { Warning Fans or other moving engine parts can injure you badly. Keep your hands away from moving parts once the engine is running. 6. Check that the jumper cables do not have loose or missing insulation. If they do, you could get a shock. The vehicles could be damaged too. Before you connect the cables, here are some basic things you should know. Positive (+) will go to positive (+) or to a remote positive (+) terminal if the vehicle has one. Negative (–) will go to a heavy, unpainted metal engine part or to a remote negative (–) terminal if the vehicle has one. Do not connect positive (+) to negative (–) or you will get a short that would damage the battery and maybe other parts too. And do not connect the negative (–) cable to the negative (–) terminal on the dead battery because this can cause sparks. 7. Connect one end of the red positive (+) cable to the discharged battery positive (+) terminal. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care 8. Do not let the other end touch metal. Connect it to the good battery positive (+) terminal. Use a remote positive (+) terminal if the vehicle has one. 9. Connect one end of the black negative (–) cable to the good battery negative (–) terminal. Use a remote negative (–) terminal if the vehicle has one. Do not let the other end touch anything until the next step. 10. Connect the other end of the negative (–) cable to the discharged battery negative (–) grounding point. 11. Start the vehicle with the good battery and run the engine for a while. 12. Try to start the vehicle that had the dead battery. If it will not start after a few tries, it probably needs service. Caution If the jumper cables are connected or removed in the wrong order, electrical shorting may occur and damage the vehicle. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Always connect (Continued) 377 Caution (Continued) Caution and remove the jumper cables in the correct order, making sure that the cables do not touch each other or other metal. The vehicle may be equipped with an electric parking brake and/or a mechanical transmission range select shifter. In the event of a loss of 12-volt battery power, the electric parking brake cannot be released, and the vehicle cannot be shifted to N (Neutral). Tire skates or dollies must be used under the non-rolling tires to prevent damage while loading/unloading the vehicle. Dragging the vehicle will cause damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. Jumper Cable Removal Reverse the sequence exactly when removing the jumper cables. After starting the disabled vehicle and removing the jumper cables, allow it to idle for several minutes. Towing the Vehicle Caution Caution Incorrectly transporting a disabled vehicle may cause damage to the vehicle. Use proper tire straps to secure the vehicle to the flatbed tow truck. Do not strap or hook to any frame, underbody, or suspension component not specified below. Do not move vehicles with drive axle tires on the ground. Damage is not covered by the vehicle warranty. The vehicle may be equipped with a tow eye. Improper use of the tow eye may cause damage to the vehicle and is not covered by the vehicle warranty. If equipped, use the tow eye to load the vehicle onto a flatbed tow truck from a flat road surface, or to move the vehicle a very short distance at a walking pace. The tow eye is not designed for off-road (Continued) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 378 Vehicle Care Caution (Continued) recovery. The vehicle must be in N (Neutral) with the electric parking brake released when using the tow eye. . If unsuccessful, the vehicle will not move. Tire skates or dollies must be used under the non-rolling tires to prevent vehicle damage. Front Attachment Points Contact a professional towing service if the disabled vehicle must be transported. GM recommends a flatbed tow truck to transport a disabled vehicle. Use ramps to help reduce approach angles, if necessary. If equipped, a tow eye may be located near the spare tire or emergency jack. Do not use the tow eye to pull the vehicle from the snow, mud, sand, or ditch. Tow eye threads may have right or left-hand threads. Use caution when installing or removing the tow eye. The vehicle must be in N (Neutral) and the electric parking brake must be released when loading the vehicle onto a flatbed tow truck. . If the 12-volt battery is dead and/or electric parking brake is not released, the vehicle will not move. Try to jump start the vehicle with a known good 12-volt battery, shift the car into N (Neutral), and release the electric parking brake. Refer to Jump Starting - North America 0 374. The vehicle is equipped with specific attachment points to be used to pull the vehicle onto a flatbed car carrier from a flat road surface. Do not use these attachment points to pull the vehicle from snow, mud or sand. Recreational Vehicle Towing Recreational vehicle towing means towing the vehicle behind another vehicle, such as a motor home. The two most common types of recreational vehicle towing are dinghy and dolly towing. Dinghy towing is towing the vehicle with all four wheels on the ground. Dolly towing is towing the vehicle with two wheels on the ground and two wheels on a dolly. Here are some important things to consider before recreational vehicle towing: . Before towing the vehicle, become familiar with the local laws that apply to recreational vehicle towing. These laws may vary by region. . The towing capacity of the towing vehicle. Read the tow vehicle manufacturer's recommendations. . How far the vehicle can be towed. Some vehicles have restrictions on how far and how long the vehicle can be towed. . Whether the vehicle has the proper towing equipment. See your dealer or trailering professional for additional advice and equipment recommendations. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care . Whether the vehicle is ready to be towed. Just as preparing the vehicle for a long trip, make sure the vehicle is prepared to be towed. Dinghy Towing (Two-Wheel-Drive Vehicles and Vehicles with a Single-Speed Transfer Case) 379 Dinghy Towing (Vehicles with a Two-Speed Transfer Case) Follow the tow vehicle manufacturer’s instructions. See your dealer or trailering professional for additional advice and equipment recommendations. Caution Use of a shield mounted in front of the vehicle grille could restrict airflow and cause damage to the transmission. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. If using a shield, only use one that attaches to the towing vehicle. Caution If a vehicle with two-wheel drive or a single-speed transfer case is towed with all four wheels on the ground, the drivetrain components could be damaged. The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Two-wheel-drive vehicles and vehicles with a single-speed transfer case should not be towed with all four wheels on the ground. Only dinghy tow four-wheel-drive vehicles with a two-speed transfer case that have an N (Neutral) and a 4 n (Four-Wheel Drive Low) setting. { Warning Shifting a four-wheel-drive vehicle's transfer case into N (Neutral) can allow the vehicle to move even if the transmission is in P (Park). You or others could be injured. Set the parking brake and use wheel blocks before shifting the transfer case to N (Neutral). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 380 Vehicle Care To dinghy tow: 1. Position the vehicle being towed behind the tow vehicle, facing forward and on a level surface. 2. Securely attach the vehicle being towed to the tow vehicle. 3. Apply the parking brake and start the engine. 4. Shift the transfer case to N (Neutral). See “Shifting into N (Neutral)” under Four-Wheel Drive 0 240. 5. With the engine running, release the parking brake and verify that the transfer case is in N (Neutral) by shifting the transmission to D (Drive) and then to R (Reverse). There should be no movement while shifting the transmission. 6. Shift the transmission to D (Drive). 7. If equipped with an ignition key, turn the ignition to ACC/ACCESSORY. If equipped with Keyless Access, turn the engine off. Disregard the Shift to P (Park) DIC message. See Ignition Positions (Keyless Access) 0 229 or Ignition Positions (Key Access) 0 227. { Warning To avoid death, serious injury, or property damage, before dinghy towing the vehicle, always disconnect and secure the negative battery cable and cover the negative battery post and cable with a non-conductive material. If the battery is left connected or the battery cable contacts the post, the Electric Parking Brake may activate during towing, which could cause a crash. 8. Disconnect the negative (–) battery cable. See “Negative Battery Cable Disconnection” in Battery - North America 0 324. 9. Shift the transmission to P (Park). Caution If the steering column is locked, vehicle damage may occur. 10. Move the steering wheel to make sure the steering column is unlocked. 11. If the vehicle has an ignition key, keep it in the towed vehicle in ACC/ACCESSORY to prevent the steering column from locking. If the vehicle is equipped with Keyless Access, keep the RKE transmitter outside of the vehicle and manually lock the doors. Access the vehicle by using the key in the door lock. See Door Locks 0 21. Disconnecting the Towed Vehicle Before disconnecting from the tow vehicle: 1. Park on a level surface. Secure the vehicle with wheel blocks. 2. Re-connect the negative (–) battery. See Battery - North America 0 324. 3. Turn on the ignition with the engine off. For vehicles with a key, turn the ignition to ON/RUN with the engine off. If the vehicle is equipped with Keyless Access, with your foot off the brake pedal, press and hold ENGINE START/STOP for five seconds until the green light comes on in the button. See Ignition Positions (Keyless Access) 0 229 or Ignition Positions (Key Access) 0 227. 4. Set the parking brake. See Electric Parking Brake 0 245. 5. Disconnect from the tow vehicle. 6. Shift the transmission to N (Neutral). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care 7. Shift the transfer case to 2 m (Two-Wheel Drive High). When the shift to 2 m (Two-Wheel Drive High) is complete, the light in the instrument cluster will stop flashing and stay lit. See Four-Wheel-Drive Light 0 119. 8. Start the engine. Check that the vehicle is in 2 m (Two-Wheel Drive High) by starting the engine and shifting the transmission to D (Drive) and then to R (Reverse). There should be movement of the vehicle while shifting. 9. Shift the transmission to P (Park) and turn off the ignition. 10. Release the parking brake and remove the wheel blocks. 11. Reset any lost presets. The outside temperature display will default to 0 °C (32 °F) but will reset with normal usage. Dolly Towing 381 Caution Do not tow this vehicle with two wheels on the ground, or vehicle damage could occur. This damage would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Dolly towing this vehicle is not allowed with either the front or the rear tires on the ground for two-wheel drive or four-wheel drive, regardless of transfer case. Appearance Care Exterior Care Locks Locks are lubricated at the factory. Use a de-icing agent only when absolutely necessary, and have the locks greased after using. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 401. Washing the Vehicle To preserve the vehicle's finish, wash it often and out of direct sunlight. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 382 Vehicle Care { Warning Do not power wash any part of the vehicle’s interior, including the vinyl floor covering. This could damage safety and other systems in the vehicle, which would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Caution Do not use petroleum-based, acidic, or abrasive cleaning agents as they can damage the vehicle's paint, metal, or plastic parts. If damage occurs, it would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Approved cleaning products can be obtained from your dealer. Follow all manufacturer directions regarding correct product usage, necessary safety precautions, and appropriate disposal of any vehicle care product. Caution Avoid using high-pressure washes closer than 30 cm (12 in) to the surface of the vehicle. Use of power washers exceeding 8 274 kPa (1,200 psi) can result in damage or removal of paint and decals. Cleaning Underhood Components Caution Do not power wash any component under the hood that has this e symbol. This could cause damage that would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Solvents or aggressive cleaners may harm underhood components. The usages of these chemicals should be avoided. Recommend water only. A pressure washer may be used, but care must be utilized. The following criteria must be followed: . Water pressure must be kept below 14 000 KPa (2,000 PSI). . Water temperature must be below 80 °C (180 °F). . Spray nozzle with a 40 degree wide angle spray pattern or wider must be used. . Nozzle must be kept at least 30 cm (1 ft) away from all surfaces. Automatic Car Wash Caution Some automatic car washes can cause damage to the vehicle, wheels and ground effects. Automatic car washes are not recommended, due to lack of clearance for the undercarriage and/or wide rear tires and wheels. Caution Automatic car washes can cause damage to the vehicle, wheels, ground effects, and convertible top (if equipped). Do not use automatic car washes due to lack of clearance for the undercarriage, wide rear tires, and wheels. If using an automatic car wash, follow with the car wash instructions. The windshield wiper and rear window wiper, if equipped, Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care must be turned off. Remove any accessories that may be damaged or interfere with the car wash equipment. See Power Assist Steps 0 31 for cleaning information. Rinse the vehicle well, before washing and after, to remove all cleaning agents completely. If they are allowed to dry on the surface, they could stain. Dry the finish with a soft, clean chamois or an all-cotton towel to avoid surface scratches and water spotting. Finish Care Application of aftermarket clearcoat sealant/ wax materials is not recommended. If painted surfaces are damaged, see your dealer to have the damage assessed and repaired. Foreign materials such as calcium chloride and other salts, ice melting agents, road oil and tar, tree sap, bird droppings, chemicals from industrial chimneys, etc., can damage the vehicle's finish if they remain on painted surfaces. Wash the vehicle as soon as possible. If necessary, use non-abrasive cleaners that are marked safe for painted surfaces to remove foreign matter. Occasional hand waxing or mild polishing should be done to remove residue from the paint finish. See your dealer for approved cleaning products. 383 To keep the paint finish looking new, keep the vehicle garaged or covered whenever possible. The bright metal moldings on the vehicle are aluminum, chrome or stainless steel. To prevent damage always follow these cleaning instructions: . Be sure the molding is cool to the touch before applying any cleaning solution. . Use only approved cleaning solutions for aluminum, chrome or stainless steel. Some cleaners are highly acidic or contain alkaline substances and can damage the moldings. . Always dilute a concentrated cleaner according to the manufacturer’s instructions. . Do not use cleaners that are not intended for automotive use. . Use a nonabrasive wax on the vehicle after washing to protect and extend the molding finish. Protecting Exterior Bright Metal Moldings Spray-In Bedliner Care Do not apply waxes or polishes to uncoated plastic, vinyl, rubber, decals, simulated wood, or flat paint as damage can occur. Caution Machine compounding or aggressive polishing on a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish may damage it. Use only non-abrasive waxes and polishes that are made for a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish on the vehicle. Caution Failure to clean and protect the bright metal moldings can result in a hazy white finish or pitting. This damage would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. A spray-in bedliner is a permanent coating that bonds to the truck bed and cannot be removed. Promptly rinse the bedliner surface following a chemical spill to avoid permanent damage. Spray-in bedliners can fade from oxidation, road dirt, heavy-duty hauling, and hard water stains. Clean it periodically by Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 384 Vehicle Care washing off the loose dirt and using a mild detergent. To restore the original appearance, apply the bedliner conditioner available through your dealer. . Ice scrapers or other hard items. . Aftermarket appearance caps or covers while the lamps are illuminated, due to excessive heat generated. Caution Using silicone-based products may damage the bedliner, reduce the slip-resistant texture, and attract dirt. Caution Failure to clean lamps properly can cause damage to the lamp cover that would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses, Emblems, Decals and Stripes Use only lukewarm or cold water, a soft cloth, and a car washing soap to clean exterior lamps, lenses, emblems, decals and stripes. Follow instructions under "Washing the Vehicle" previously in this section. Lamp covers are made of plastic, and some have a UV protective coating. Do not clean or wipe them while they are dry. Do not use any of the following on lamp covers: . Abrasive or caustic agents. . Washer fluids and other cleaning agents in higher concentrations than suggested by the manufacturer. . Solvents, alcohols, fuels, or other harsh cleaners. Shutter System Caution Using wax on low gloss black finish stripes can increase the gloss level and create a non-uniform finish. Clean low gloss stripes with soap and water only. Air Intakes Clear debris from the air intakes, between the hood and windshield, when washing the vehicle. The vehicle may have a shutter system designed to help improve fuel economy. Keep the shutter system clear of debris, snow and ice. If the check engine light is activated, please check to see if the shutter system is clear of debris, snow or ice. Windshield and Wiper Blades Clean the outside of the windshield with glass cleaner. Clean rubber blades using a lint-free cloth or paper towel soaked with windshield washer fluid or a mild detergent. Wash the windshield thoroughly when cleaning the Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care blades. Bugs, road grime, sap, and a buildup of vehicle wash/wax treatments may cause wiper streaking. Replace the wiper blades if they are worn or damaged. Damage can be caused by extreme dusty conditions, sand, salt, heat, sun, snow, and ice. Weatherstrips Apply weatherstrip lubricant on weatherstrips to make them last longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak. Lubricate weatherstrips once a year. Hot, dry climates may require more frequent application. Black marks from rubber material on painted surfaces can be removed by rubbing with a clean cloth. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 401. Tires Use a stiff brush with tire cleaner to clean the tires. Caution (Continued) tire dressing, always wipe off any overspray from all painted surfaces on the vehicle. Wheels and Wheel Trim Use a soft, clean cloth with mild soap and water to clean the wheels. After rinsing thoroughly with clean water, dry with a soft, clean towel. A wax may then be applied. Caution Chrome wheels and chrome wheel trim may be damaged if the vehicle is not washed after driving on roads that have been sprayed with magnesium chloride or calcium chloride. These are used on roads for conditions such as dust and ice. Always wash the chrome with soap and water after exposure. Caution Using petroleum-based tire dressing products on the vehicle may damage the paint finish and/or tires. When applying a (Continued) Caution To avoid surface damage on wheels and wheel trim, do not use strong soaps, chemicals, abrasive polishes, cleaners, (Continued) 385 Caution (Continued) or brushes. Use only GM approved cleaners. Do not drive the vehicle through an automatic car wash that uses silicon carbide tire/wheel cleaning brushes. Damage could occur and the repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Brake System Visually inspect brake lines and hoses for proper hook-up, binding, leaks, cracks, chafing, etc. Inspect disc brake pads for wear and rotors for surface condition. Inspect drum brake linings/shoes for wear or cracks. Inspect all other brake parts. Steering, Suspension, and Chassis Components Visually inspect steering, suspension, and chassis components for damaged, loose, or missing parts or signs of wear at least once a year. Inspect power steering for proper attachment, connections, binding, cracks, chafing, etc. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 386 Vehicle Care Visually check constant velocity joint boots and axle seals for leaks. 2500/3500 Series vehicles, at least every engine oil change lubricate the upper and lower control arm ball joints. 2500/3500 Series vehicles equipped with steering linkage, at least every engine oil change lubricate the tie rod ball joints, idler arm pivot shaft bearings, idler arm socket, and pitman arm socket. Caution Lubrication of applicable suspension points should not be done unless the temperature is −12 °C (10 °F) or higher, or damage could result. Body Component Lubrication Lubricate all key lock cylinders, hood hinges, liftgate hinges, and the steel fuel door hinge unless the components are plastic. Applying silicone grease on weatherstrips with a clean cloth will make them last longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak. Underbody Maintenance Finish Damage At least twice a year, spring and fall, use plain water to flush any corrosive materials from the underbody. Take care to thoroughly clean any areas where mud and other debris can collect. If equipped with power assist steps, extend them and then use a high pressure wash to clean all joints and gaps. Quickly repair minor chips and scratches with touch-up materials available from your dealer to avoid corrosion. Larger areas of finish damage can be corrected in your dealer's body and paint shop. Do not directly power wash the transfer case and/or front/rear axle output seals. High pressure water can overcome the seals and contaminate the fluid. Contaminated fluid will decrease the life of the transfer case and/or axles and should be replaced. Sheet Metal Damage If the vehicle is damaged and requires sheet metal repair or replacement, make sure the body repair shop applies anti-corrosion material to parts repaired or replaced to restore corrosion protection. Original manufacturer replacement parts will provide the corrosion protection while maintaining the vehicle warranty. Chemical Paint Spotting Airborne pollutants can fall upon and attack painted vehicle surfaces causing blotchy, ring-shaped discolorations, and small, irregular dark spots etched into the paint surface. Refer to “Finish Care” previously in this section. Interior Care To prevent dirt particle abrasions, regularly clean the vehicle's interior. Before using cleaners, read and follow all safety instructions on the label. While cleaning the interior, open the doors and windows to get proper ventilation. Newspapers or dark garments can transfer color to the vehicle’s interior. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Caution Caution (Continued) Immediately remove cleaners, hand lotions, sunscreen, and insect repellent from all interior surfaces or permanent damage may result. . Never rub any surface aggressively or . . Caution Use cleaners specifically designed for the surfaces being cleaned to prevent permanent damage to the vehicle. Apply all cleaners directly to a cleaning cloth. Do not spray cleaners on any switches or controls. . . . When using liquid soap cleaners, follow the directions on the specific cleaner or soap solution for dilution instructions. Caution To prevent damage: . . Never use a razor or any other sharp object to remove soil from any interior surface . Never use a brush with stiff bristles. (Continued) with too much pressure. Do not get any exposed electrical components wet. Do not use laundry detergents or dishwashing soaps with degreasers. Do not use solutions that contain strong or caustic soap. Do not heavily saturate the upholstery when cleaning. Do not use solvents or cleaners containing solvents. Do not use disinfecting wipes that are scented or contain bleach. Do not use wipes or cleaners that show a color transfer to the wipe or change the appearance of the interior surface when used. Do not use scented or gel-type hand sanitizers. If hand sanitizer comes in contact with interior surfaces of the vehicle, blot immediately and clean with a soft cloth dampened with a mild soap and water solution. 387 Interior Glass To clean, use a microfiber cloth fabric dampened with water. Wipe droplets left behind with a clean dry cloth. If necessary, use a commercial glass cleaner after cleaning with plain water. Caution To prevent scratching, never use abrasive cleaners on automotive glass. Abrasive cleaners or aggressive cleaning may damage the rear window defogger. Cleaning the windshield with water during the first three to six months of ownership will reduce tendency to fog. Speaker Covers Vacuum around a speaker cover gently, so that the speaker will not be damaged. Clean spots with water and mild soap. Coated Moldings Coated moldings should be cleaned. . When lightly soiled, wipe with a sponge or soft, lint-free cloth dampened with water. . When heavily soiled, use warm soapy water. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 388 Vehicle Care . For solid soils, remove as much as Vinyl/Rubber If equipped with vinyl floor and rubber floor mats, use a soft cloth and/or brush dampened with water to remove dust and loose dirt. For more thorough cleaning, use a mild soap and water solution. { Warning Do not use cleaners that contain silicone, wax-based products, or cleaners that increase gloss on vinyl/rubber floor and mats. These cleaners can permanently change the appearance and feel of the vinyl/rubber and can make the floor slippery. Your foot could slip while operating the vehicle, and you could lose control, resulting in a crash. You or others could be injured. Fabric/Carpet/Suede Start by vacuuming the surface using a soft brush attachment. If a rotating vacuum brush attachment is being used, only use it on the floor carpet. Before cleaning, gently remove as much of the soil as possible: . Gently blot liquids with a paper towel. Continue blotting until no more soil can be removed. possible prior to vacuuming. To clean: 1. Saturate a clean, lint-free colorfast cloth with water. Microfiber cloth is recommended to prevent lint transfer to the fabric or carpet. 2. Remove excess moisture by gently wringing until water does not drip from the cleaning cloth. 3. Start on the outside edge of the soil and gently rub toward the center. Fold the cleaning cloth to a clean area frequently to prevent forcing the soil into the fabric. 4. Continue gently rubbing the soiled area until there is no longer any color transfer from the soil to the cleaning cloth. 5. If the soil is not completely removed, use a mild soap solution followed only by plain water. If the soil is not completely removed, it may be necessary to use a commercial upholstery cleaner or spot lifter. Test a small hidden area for colorfastness before using a commercial upholstery cleaner or spot lifter. If ring formation occurs, clean the entire fabric or carpet. After cleaning, use a paper towel to blot excess moisture. Cleaning High Gloss Surfaces and Vehicle Information and Radio Displays Use a microfiber cloth on high gloss surfaces or vehicle displays. First, use a soft bristle brush to remove dirt that can scratch the surface. Then gently clean by rubbing with a microfiber cloth. Never use window cleaners or solvents. Periodically hand wash the microfiber cloth separately, using mild soap. Do not use bleach or fabric softener. Rinse thoroughly and air dry before next use. Caution Do not attach a device with a suction cup to the display. This may cause damage and would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Vehicle Care Instrument Panel, Leather, Vinyl, Other Plastic Surfaces, Low Gloss Paint Surfaces, and Natural Open Pore Wood Surfaces Use a soft bristle brush to remove dust from knobs and crevices on the instrument cluster. Use a soft microfiber cloth dampened with water to remove dust and loose dirt. For a more thorough cleaning, use a soft microfiber cloth dampened with a mild soap and water solution. Caution Soaking or saturating leather, especially perforated leather, as well as other interior surfaces, may cause permanent damage. Wipe excess moisture from these surfaces after cleaning and allow them to dry naturally. Never use heat, steam, or spot removers. Do not use liquids that contain alcohol or solvents on leather seats. Do not use cleaners that contain silicone or wax-based products. Cleaners containing these solvents can permanently change the appearance and feel of leather or soft trim, and are not recommended. Do not use cleaners that increase gloss, especially on the instrument panel. Reflected glare can decrease visibility through the windshield under certain conditions. Caution Use of air fresheners may cause permanent damage to plastics and painted surfaces. If an air freshener comes in contact with any plastic or painted surface in the vehicle, blot immediately and clean with a soft cloth dampened with a mild soap solution. Damage caused by air fresheners would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Care of Seat Belts Keep belts clean and dry. { Warning Do not bleach or dye seat belt webbing. It may severely weaken the webbing. In a crash, they might not be able to provide adequate protection. Clean and rinse seat belt webbing only with mild soap and lukewarm water. Allow the webbing to dry. 389 Floor Mats { Warning If a floor mat, a liner, or a liner insert is the wrong size or is not properly installed, it can interfere with the pedals. Interference with the pedals can cause unintended acceleration and/or increased stopping distance, which can cause a crash and injury. Make sure the floor mat, liner, or liner insert does not interfere with the pedals. Use the following guidelines for proper floor mat/liner use: . The original equipment floor mats are designed for your vehicle. If the floor mats need to be replaced, it is recommended that GM-certified floor mats are purchased. Non-GM floor mats may not fit properly and may interfere with the pedals. Always check that the floor mats do not interfere with the pedals. . Do not use a floor mat/liner if the vehicle is not equipped with a floor mat retainer on the driver side floor. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 390 Vehicle Care . Use the floor mat/liner insert with the correct side up. Do not turn it over. . Do not place anything on top of the driver side floor mat/liner. . Use only a single floor mat/liner on the driver side. . Do not place one floor mat/liner on top of another. Removing and Replacing the Floor Mats/ Liners Pull up on the rear of the driver side floor mat/liner to unlock each retainer and remove. Reinstall by lining up the floor mat/liner retainer openings over the carpet retainers and snapping into position. Make sure the floor mat/liner is properly secured in place. Verify the floor mat/liner does not interfere with the pedals. Removing and Replacing the Floor Liner Inserts Pull up on the edge of the driver side floor liner insert to unlock each button clip and remove. Reinstall by lining up the floor liner insert button clips over the liner retainers and snapping into position. Make sure the floor liner insert is properly secure in place using all button clips. Verify the floor liner insert does not interfere with the pedals. Cleaning Rubber Floor Mats (All-Weather Mats and Floor Liners) See “Vinyl/Rubber” under Interior Care 0 386 for important cleaning information. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Service and Maintenance Service and Maintenance General Information General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391 Maintenance Schedule Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392 Special Application Services Special Application Services . . . . . . . . . . . 398 Additional Maintenance and Care Additional Maintenance and Care . . . . . 398 Recommended Fluids, Lubricants, and Parts Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 Maintenance Replacement Parts . . . . . . 402 Maintenance Records Maintenance Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404 General Information This maintenance section applies to vehicles with a gasoline engine. For diesel engine vehicles, see "Maintenance Schedule" in the Duramax diesel supplement. Your vehicle is an important investment. This section describes the required maintenance for the vehicle. Follow this schedule to help protect against major repair expenses resulting from neglect or inadequate maintenance. It may also help to maintain the value of the vehicle if it is sold. It is the responsibility of the owner to have all required maintenance performed. Your dealer has trained technicians who can perform required maintenance using genuine replacement parts. They have up-to-date tools and equipment for fast and accurate diagnostics. Many dealers have extended evening and Saturday hours, courtesy transportation, and online scheduling to assist with service needs. Your dealer recognizes the importance of providing competitively priced maintenance and repair services. With trained technicians, the dealer is the place for routine 391 maintenance such as oil changes and tire rotations and additional maintenance items like tires, brakes, batteries, and wiper blades. Caution Damage caused by improper maintenance can lead to costly repairs and may not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Maintenance intervals, checks, inspections, recommended fluids, and lubricants are important to keep the vehicle in good working condition. Do not have chemical flushes that are not approved by GM performed on the vehicle. The use of flushes, solvents, cleaners, or lubricants that are not approved by GM could damage the vehicle, requiring expensive repairs that are not covered by the vehicle warranty. The Tire Rotation and Required Services are the responsibility of the vehicle owner. It is recommended to have your dealer perform these services every 12 000 km/7,500 mi. Proper vehicle maintenance helps to keep the vehicle in good working condition, improves fuel economy, and reduces vehicle emissions. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 392 Service and Maintenance Because of the way people use vehicles, maintenance needs vary. There may need to be more frequent checks and services. The Additional Required Services - Normal are for vehicles that: . Carry passengers and cargo within recommended limits on the Tire and Loading Information label. See Vehicle Load Limits 0 220. . Are driven on reasonable road surfaces within legal driving limits. . Use the recommended fuel. See Recommended Fuel 0 269. Refer to the information in the Maintenance Schedule Additional Required Services Normal chart. The Additional Required Services - Severe are for vehicles that are: . Mainly driven in heavy city traffic in hot weather . Mainly driven in hilly or mountainous terrain . Frequently towing a trailer . Used for high speed or competitive driving . Used for taxi, police, or delivery service Refer to the information in the Maintenance Schedule Additional Required Services Severe chart. Engine Oil Change Maintenance Schedule When the CHANGE ENGINE OIL SOON message displays, have the engine oil and filter changed within the next 1 000 km/ 600 mi. If driven under the best conditions, the engine oil life system may not indicate the need for vehicle service for up to a year. The engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a year and the oil life system must be reset. Your trained dealer technician can perform this work. If the engine oil life system is reset accidentally, service the vehicle within 5 000 km/3,000 mi since the last service. Reset the oil life system when the oil is changed. See Engine Oil Life System 0 313. Owner Checks and Services Engine Air Filter Change Check the engine oil level. See Engine Oil 0 311. When the REPLACE AT NEXT OIL CHANGE message displays, the engine air filter should be replaced at the next engine oil change. When the REPLACE ENGINE AIR FILTER SOON message displays, the engine air filter should be replaced at the earliest convenience. Reset the engine air filter life system after the engine air filter is replaced. See Engine Air Filter Life System 0 314. { Warning Performing maintenance work can be dangerous and can cause serious injury. Perform maintenance work only if the required information, proper tools, and equipment are available. If they are not, see your dealer to have a trained technician do the work. See Doing Your Own Service Work 0 308. Once a Month . Check the tire inflation pressures, including the spare. See Tire Pressure 0 349. . Inspect the tires for wear. See Tire Inspection 0 355. . Check the windshield washer fluid level. See Washer Fluid 0 321. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Service and Maintenance Passenger Compartment Air Filter The passenger compartment air filter removes dust, pollen, and other airborne irritants from outside air that is pulled into the vehicle. The filter should be replaced as part of routine scheduled maintenance. Inspect the passenger compartment air filter every 36 000 km/22,500 miles or two years, whichever comes first. Replace if necessary. More frequent replacement may be needed if the vehicle is driven in areas with heavy traffic, areas with poor air quality, or areas with high dust levels. Replacement may also be needed if there is a reduction in air flow, excessive window fogging, or odors. Power Take Off (PTO) and Extended Idle Use When the vehicle is used with the PTO equipment or used in a way that requires extended idle time, one hour of use shall be deemed the same as 53 km (33 mi). See Driver Information Center (DIC) (Base Level) 0 124 or Driver Information Center (DIC) (Midlevel and Uplevel) 0 125 for hourmeter, if equipped. Air Conditioning Desiccant (Replace Every Seven Years) The air conditioning system requires maintenance every seven years. This service requires replacement of the desiccant to help the longevity and efficient operation of the air conditioning system. This service can be complex. See your dealer. Tire Rotation and Required Services Every 12 000 km/7,500 mi Rotate the tires, if recommended for the vehicle, and perform the following services. See Tire Rotation 0 356. . Check engine oil level and oil life percentage. If needed, change engine oil and filter, and reset oil life system. See Engine Oil 0 311 and Engine Oil Life System 0 313. . Check the air filter life percentage. If necessary, replace the engine air filter and reset the engine air filter life system. See Engine Air Filter Life System 0 314. . Check engine coolant level. See Cooling System 0 316. . Check windshield washer fluid level. See Washer Fluid 0 321. 393 . Check tire inflation pressures, including the spare. See Tire Pressure 0 349. . Inspect tire wear. See Tire Inspection 0 355. . Visually check for fluid leaks. . Inspect brake system. See Exterior Care 0 381. . Visually inspect steering, suspension, and chassis components for damage, including cracks or tears in the rubber boots, loose or missing parts, or signs of wear at least once a year. See Exterior Care 0 381. If equipped with grease fittings, lubricate the suspension and steering components every oil change. . Inspect power steering for proper attachment, connections, binding, leaks, cracks, chafing, etc. . Visually inspect drive shafts for excessive wear, lubricant leaks or damage including: tube dents, cracks, constant velocity joint or universal joint looseness, cracked or missing boots, loose or missing boot clamps, center bearing excessive looseness, missing or loose fasteners. . Check restraint system components. See Safety System Check 0 61. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 394 Service and Maintenance . Visually inspect the fuel system including the evaporative (EVAP) system for damage or leaks. Visually check all fuel pipes, vapor lines, and hoses for proper attachment, connection, routing, and condition. . Visually inspect exhaust system and nearby heat shields for loose or damaged parts. . Lubricate body components. See Exterior Care 0 381. . Check starter switch. See Starter Switch Check 0 327. . Check automatic transmission shift lock . . . . control function. See Automatic Transmission Shift Lock Control Function Check 0 328. Check ignition transmission lock. See Ignition Transmission Lock Check 0 328. Check parking brake and automatic transmission park mechanism. See Park Brake and P (Park) Mechanism Check 0 328. Check accelerator pedal for damage, high effort, or binding. Replace if needed. Visually inspect gas strut for signs of wear, cracks, or other damage. Check the hold open ability of the strut. If the hold open is low, service the gas strut. See Gas Strut(s) 0 329. . Inspect sunroof track and seal, if equipped. See Sunroof 0 44. . Verify spare tire key lock operation and lubricate as needed. See Tire Changing 0 364. . Visually inspect the spare tire to ensure that it is tightly stowed under the vehicle. Push, pull, and try to turn the tire. If the spare tire moves, tighten as necessary. See Tire Changing 0 364. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Service and Maintenance 395 36 000 km /2 2 , 500 m i 4 8 000 km /30, 000 m i 6 0 000 km /37, 500 m i 72 000 km /4 5, 000 m i 84 000 km /52 , 500 m i 9 6 000 km /60, 000 m i 1 08 000 km /67, 500 m i 1 2 0 000 km /75, 000 m i 1 32 000 km /82 , 500 m i 1 4 4 000 km /90, 000 m i 1 5 6 000 km /97, 500 m i 1 6 8 000 km /1 05, 000 m i 1 80 000 km /1 1 2 , 500 m i 1 9 2 000 km /1 2 0, 000 m i 2 04 000 km /1 2 7, 500 m i 2 1 6 000 km /1 35, 000 m i 2 2 8 000 km /1 4 2 , 500 m i 2 4 0 000 km /1 50, 000 m i Rotate tires and perform Required Services. Check engine oil level and oil life percentage. Change engine oil and filter, if needed. Check engine air filter life percentage and status. Change engine air filter, if needed. (1) 2 4 000 km /1 5, 000 m i Maintenance Schedule Additional Required Services - Normal 1 2 000 km /7, 500 m i Additional Required Services @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ Replace passenger compartment air filter. (2) @ @ @ @ @ @ Replace spark plugs. Inspect spark plug wires and/or boots. @ Change transfer case fluid, if equipped with 4WD. (3) @ @ Drain and fill engine cooling system. (4) @ Visually inspect accessory drive belts. (5) @ Replace brake fluid. (6) Replace windshield wiper blades. (7) Replace hood gas struts and tailgate dampener. (8) Replace air conditioning desiccant. (9) @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 396 Service and Maintenance Footnotes — Maintenance Schedule Additional Required Services - Normal (4) Or every five years, whichever comes first. See Cooling System 0 316. (1) Or every four years, whichever comes first. If driving in dusty conditions, inspect the filter at each oil change or more often as needed. See Engine Air Cleaner/Filter 0 315. (5) Or every 10 years, whichever comes first. Inspect for fraying, excessive cracking, or damage; replace, if needed. (2) Or every two years, whichever comes first. More frequent replacement may be needed if the vehicle is driven in areas with heavy traffic, poor air quality, areas with high dust levels or are sensitive to environmental allergens. Filter replacement may also be needed if you notice reduced airflow, windows fogging up, or odors. Your local GM Service location can help you determine when it is the right time to replace your filter. (7) Or every 12 months, whichever comes first. See Wiper Blade Replacement 0 328. (3) Do not directly power wash the transfer case and/or front/rear axle output seals. High pressure water can overcome the seals and contaminate the fluid. Contaminated fluid will decrease the life of the transfer case and/or drive axles and should be replaced. (6) Replace brake fluid every five years. See Brake Fluid 0 323. (8) Or every 10 years, whichever comes first. See Gas Strut(s) 0 329. (9) Replace air conditioning desiccant every seven years. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 36 000 km /2 2 , 500 m i 4 8 000 km /30, 000 m i 60 000 km /37, 500 m i 72 000 km /4 5, 000 m i 84 000 km /52 , 500 m i 96 000 km /60, 000 m i 1 08 000 km /67, 500 m i 1 2 0 000 km /75, 000 m i 1 32 000 km /82 , 500 m i 1 4 4 000 km /90, 000 m i 1 56 000 km /97, 500 m i 1 68 000 km /1 05, 000 m i 1 80 000 km /1 1 2 , 500 m i 1 92 000 km /1 2 0, 000 m i 2 04 000 km /1 2 7, 500 m i 2 1 6 000 km /1 35, 000 m i 2 2 8 000 km /1 4 2 , 500 m i 2 4 0 000 km /1 50, 000 m i Rotate tires and perform Required Services. Check engine oil level and oil life percentage. Change engine oil and filter, if needed. Check engine air filter life percentage and status. Change engine air filter, if needed. (1) 2 4 000 km /1 5, 000 m i Maintenance Schedule Additional Required Services - Severe 397 1 2 000 km /7, 500 m i Service and Maintenance @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ Replace passenger compartment air filter. (2) @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ Replace spark plugs. Inspect spark plug wires and/or boots. @ Change automatic transmission fluid and filter. @ Change transfer case fluid, if equipped with 4WD. (3) @ @ @ @ @ Drain and fill engine cooling system. (4) @ Visually inspect accessory drive belts. (5) @ Replace brake fluid. (6) Replace windshield wiper blades. (7) Replace hood gas struts and tailgate dampener. (8) @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ Replace air conditioning desiccant. (9) Footnotes — Maintenance Schedule Additional Required Services - Severe (1) Or every four years, whichever comes first. If driving in dusty conditions, inspect the filter at each oil change or more often as needed. See Engine Air Cleaner/Filter 0 315. (2) Or every two years, whichever comes first. More frequent replacement may be needed if the vehicle is driven in areas with heavy traffic, poor air quality, areas with high dust levels or are sensitive to environmental allergens. Filter replacement may also be needed if you notice reduced airflow, windows fogging up, or odors. Your local GM Service location can help you determine when it is the right time to replace your filter. (3) Do not directly power wash the transfer case and/or front/rear axle output seals. High pressure water can overcome the seals Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 398 Service and Maintenance and contaminate the fluid. Contaminated fluid will decrease the life of the transfer case and/or drive axles and should be replaced. . Severe Commercial Use Vehicles Only: (4) Or every five years, whichever comes first. See Cooling System 0 316. Lubricate chassis components every oil change. . Have underbody flushing service performed. See “Underbody Maintenance” in Exterior Care 0 381. (5) Or every 10 years, whichever comes first. Inspect for fraying, excessive cracking, or damage; replace, if needed. Additional Maintenance and Care (6) Replace brake fluid every five years. See Brake Fluid 0 323. Your vehicle is an important investment and caring for it properly may help to avoid future costly repairs. To maintain vehicle performance, additional maintenance services may be required. (7) Or every 12 months, whichever comes first. See Wiper Blade Replacement 0 328. (8) Or every 10 years, whichever comes first. See Gas Strut(s) 0 329. (9) Replace air conditioning desiccant every seven years. Special Application Services . Vehicles with Dual Wheels: Check dual wheel nut torque at 160, 1 600, and 10 000 km (100, 1,000, and 6,000 mi) of driving. Repeat this service whenever a tire/wheel is serviced or removed. It is recommended that your dealer perform these services — their trained dealer technicians know your vehicle best. Your dealer can also perform a thorough assessment with a multi-point inspection to recommend when your vehicle may need attention. The following list is intended to explain the services and conditions to look for that may indicate services are required. Battery The 12-volt battery supplies power to start the engine and operate any additional electrical accessories. . To avoid break-down or failure to start the vehicle, maintain a battery with full cranking power. . Trained dealer technicians have the diagnostic equipment to test the battery and ensure that the connections and cables are corrosion-free. Belts . Belts may need replacing if they squeak or show signs of cracking or splitting. . Trained dealer technicians have access to tools and equipment to inspect the belts and recommend adjustment or replacement when necessary. Brakes Brakes stop the vehicle and are crucial to safe driving. . Signs of brake wear may include chirping, grinding, or squealing noises, or difficulty stopping. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Service and Maintenance . Trained dealer technicians have access to tools and equipment to inspect the brakes and recommend quality parts engineered for the vehicle. Fluids Proper fluid levels and approved fluids protect the vehicle’s systems and components. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 401 for GM approved fluids. . Engine oil and windshield washer fluid levels should be checked at every fuel fill. . Instrument cluster lights may come on to indicate that fluids may be low and need to be filled. Hoses Hoses transport fluids and should be regularly inspected to ensure that there are no cracks or leaks. With a multi-point inspection, your dealer can inspect the hoses and advise if replacement is needed. 399 Lamps Tires Properly working headlamps, taillamps, and brake lamps are important to see and be seen on the road. . Signs that the headlamps need attention include dimming, failure to light, cracking, or damage. The brake lamps need to be checked periodically to ensure that they light when braking. . With a multi-point inspection, your dealer can check the lamps and note any concerns. Tires need to be properly inflated, rotated, and balanced. Maintaining the tires can save money and fuel, and can reduce the risk of tire failure. . Signs that the tires need to be replaced include three or more visible treadwear indicators; cord or fabric showing through the rubber; cracks or cuts in the tread or sidewall; or a bulge or split in the tire. . Trained dealer technicians can inspect and recommend the right tires. Your dealer can also provide tire/wheel balancing services to ensure smooth vehicle operation at all speeds. Your dealer sells and services name brand tires. Shocks and Struts Shocks and struts help aid in control for a smoother ride. . Signs of wear may include steering wheel vibration, bounce/sway while braking, longer stopping distance, or uneven tire wear. . As part of the multi-point inspection, trained dealer technicians can visually inspect the shocks and struts for signs of leaking, blown seals, or damage, and can advise when service is needed. Vehicle Care To help keep the vehicle looking like new, vehicle care products are available from your dealer. For information on how to clean and protect the vehicle’s interior and exterior, see Interior Care 0 386 and Exterior Care 0 381. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 400 Service and Maintenance Wheel Alignment Windshield Wiper Blades Wheel alignment is critical for ensuring that the tires deliver optimal wear and performance. . Signs that the alignment may need to be adjusted include pulling, improper vehicle handling, or unusual tire wear. . Your dealer has the required equipment to ensure proper wheel alignment. For safety, appearance, and the best viewing, keep the windshield clean and clear. . Signs of damage include scratches, cracks, and chips. . Trained dealer technicians can inspect the windshield and recommend proper replacement if needed. Wiper blades need to be cleaned and kept in good condition to provide a clear view. . Signs of wear include streaking, skipping across the windshield, and worn or split rubber. . Trained dealer technicians can check the wiper blades and replace them when needed. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Service and Maintenance 401 Recommended Fluids, Lubricants, and Parts Recommended Fluids and Lubricants This maintenance section applies to vehicles with a gasoline engine. If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see “Recommended Fluids and Lubricants” in the Duramax diesel supplement. Fluids and lubricants identified below by name or specification, including fluids or lubricants not listed here, can be obtained from your dealer. Usage Fluid/Lubricant Automatic Transmission (6-Speed Transmission) DEXRON-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid. Automatic Transmission (10-Speed Transmission) DEXRON ULV Automatic Transmission Fluid. Chassis Lubrication Chassis lubricant meeting requirements of NLGI #2, Category LB or GC-LB. Engine Coolant 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and use only DEX-COOL coolant. See Cooling System 0 316. Engine Oil Engine oil meeting the dexos1 specification of the proper SAE viscosity grade. ACDelco dexos1 full synthetic is recommended. See Engine Oil 0 311. Front and Rear Axle Driveshaft Splines See your dealer. Front Axle (Four-Wheel Drive) and Rear Axle See your dealer. Hydraulic Brake System Hydraulic Power Steering System DOT 4 Hydraulic Brake Fluid. See Brake Fluid 0 323. GM Power Steering Fluid. See your dealer. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 402 Service and Maintenance Usage Fluid/Lubricant Key Lock Cylinders, Hood Hinges, Body Door Hinge Pins, Tailgate Hinge and Linkage, Fuel Door Hinge, Tailgate Handle Pivot Points, Hinges, Latch Bolt, and Linkage Transfer Case (Four-Wheel Drive) Windshield Washer Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube. See your dealer. DEXRON-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid. Automotive windshield washer fluid that meets regional freeze protection requirements. Maintenance Replacement Parts Replacement parts identified below by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your dealer. If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. Part GM Part Number ACDelco Part Number 84121219 A3244C 84121217 A3246C Oil Filter 12690385 PF63E Passenger Compartment Air Filter 13508023 CF185 Spark Plugs 12622441 41-114 Engine Air Cleaner/Filter IWith high capacity air cleaner IWithout high capacity air cleaner Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Service and Maintenance Part GM Part Number ACDelco Part Number 84578275 — 84578275 — Wiper Blades IDriver Side – 55 cm (21.7 in) IPassenger Side – 55 cm (21.7 in) 403 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 404 Service and Maintenance Maintenance Records After the scheduled services are performed, record the date, odometer reading, who performed the service, and the type of services performed in the boxes provided. Retain all maintenance receipts. Date Odometer Reading Serviced By Services Performed Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Technical Data 405 Technical Data Vehicle Identification Service Parts Identification Vehicle Identification Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) There may be a large barcode on the certification label on the center pillar that you can scan for the following information: . Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . Model designation . Paint information . Production options Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . . . 405 Service Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . 405 Vehicle Data Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . 406 Engine Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408 This legal identifier is in the front corner of the instrument panel, on the driver side of the vehicle. It can be seen through the windshield from outside. The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) also appears on the Vehicle Certification label and certificates of title and registration. Engine Identification The eighth character in the VIN is the engine code. This code identifies the vehicle's engine, specifications, and replacement parts. See “Engine Specifications” under Capacities and Specifications 0 406 for the vehicle's engine code. If there is not a large barcode on this label, then you will find this same information on a label inside of the glove box. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 406 Technical Data Vehicle Data Capacities and Specifications The following approximate capacities are given in metric and English conversions. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants 0 401. If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. Application Air Conditioning Refrigerant Capacities Metric English For the air conditioning system refrigerant type and charge amount, see the refrigerant label under the hood. See your dealer for more information. Engine Cooling System* 14.6 L 15.4 qt Engine Oil with Filter 7.6 L 8.0 qt 136.3 L 36.0 gal 111.3 L 29.4 gal 136.3 L 36.0 gal 106.0 L 28.0 gal Fuel Tank I2500 Series and 3500 Series Standard Box (Except Double Cab Diesel) I2500 Series and 3500 Series Standard Box (Double Cab Diesel) I2500 Series and 3500 Series Long Box (Except Regular Cab Diesel) I2500 Series and 3500 Series Long Box (Regular Cab Diesel) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Technical Data Capacities Application Metric English 89.0 L 23.5 gal 151.4 L 40.0 gal Transfer Case Fluid 2.3 L 2.4 qt Hydraulic Power Steering Fluid 2.0 L 2.1 qt 190 Y 140 lb ft I3500 Series Chassis Cab – Front Tank I3500 Series Chassis Cab – Rear Tank Wheel Nut Torque All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level, as recommended in this manual. Recheck fluid level after filling. *Engine cooling system capacity values are based on the entire cooling system and its components. Engine Specifications Engine 6.6L V8 (L8T) VIN Code Spark Plug Gap 7 0.95–1.10 mm (0.037–0.043 in) Spark plug gaps are preset by the manufacturer. Re-gapping the spark plug is not recommended and can damage the spark plug. 407 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 408 Technical Data Engine Drive Belt Routing If the vehicle has a diesel engine, see the Duramax diesel supplement. 6.6L Engine (Dual Generator) 6.6L Engine (Single Generator) Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Customer Information Customer Information Customer Information Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . 409 Customer Assistance Offices . . . . . . . . . . . 411 Customer Assistance for Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 GM Mobility Reimbursement Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412 Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . 412 Scheduling Service Appointments . . . . . . 414 Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . . 414 Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415 Publication Ordering Information . . . . . . 416 Radio Frequency Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 Reporting Safety Defects Reporting Safety Defects to the United States Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 Reporting Safety Defects to the Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 Reporting Safety Defects to General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418 Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . Cybersecurity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Infotainment System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418 418 419 419 419 409 Customer Information Customer Satisfaction Procedure Your satisfaction and goodwill are important to your dealer and to Chevrolet. Normally, any concerns with the sales transaction or the operation of the vehicle will be resolved by your dealer's sales or service departments. Sometimes, however, despite the best intentions of all concerned, misunderstandings can occur. If your concern has not been resolved to your satisfaction, the following steps should be taken: STEP ONE : Discuss your concern with a member of dealership management. Normally, concerns can be quickly resolved at that level. If the matter has already been reviewed with the sales, service, or parts manager, contact the owner of your dealership or the general manager. STEP TWO : If after contacting a member of dealership management, it appears your concern cannot be resolved by your dealership without further help, in the U.S., call the Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center at 1-800-222-1020. In Canada, call General Motors of Canada Customer Care Centre at 1-800-263-3777 (English), or 1-800-263-7854 (French). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 410 Customer Information We encourage you to call the toll-free number in order to give your inquiry prompt attention. Have the following information available to give the Customer Assistance representative: . Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). This is available from the vehicle registration or title, or the plate at the top left of the instrument panel and visible through the windshield. . Dealership name and location. . Vehicle delivery date and present mileage. When contacting Chevrolet, remember that your concern will likely be resolved at a dealer's facility. That is why we suggest following Step One first. STEP THREE — U.S. Owners : Both General Motors and your dealer are committed to making sure you are completely satisfied with your new vehicle. However, if you continue to remain unsatisfied after following the procedure outlined in Steps One and Two, you can file with the Better Business Bureau (BBB) AUTO LINE Program to enforce your rights. The BBB AUTO LINE Program is an out-of-court program administered by BBB National Programs, Inc. to settle automotive disputes regarding vehicle repairs or the interpretation of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. Although you may be required to resort to this informal dispute resolution program prior to filing a court action, use of the program is free of charge and your case will generally be heard within 40 days. If you do not agree with the decision given in your case, you may reject it and proceed with any other venue for relief available to you. General Motors reserves the right to change eligibility limitations and/or discontinue its participation in this program. Telephone: 1-800-955-5100 http://www.bbb.org/council/ programs-services/ dispute-handling-and-resolution/bbb-auto-line STEP THREE — Canadian Owners : In the event that you do not feel your concerns have been addressed after following the procedure outlined in Steps One and Two, General Motors of Canada Company wants you to be aware of its participation in a no-charge Mediation/Arbitration Program. General Motors of Canada Company has committed to binding arbitration of owner disputes involving factory-related vehicle service claims. The program provides for the review of the facts involved by an impartial third party arbiter, and may include an informal hearing before the arbiter. The program is designed so that the entire dispute settlement process, from the time you file your complaint to the final decision, should be completed in about 70 days. We believe our impartial program offers advantages over courts in most jurisdictions because it is informal, quick, and free of charge. This program is available in all 50 states and the District of Columbia. Eligibility is limited by vehicle age, mileage, and other factors. For further information concerning eligibility in the Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP), call toll-free 1-800-207-0685, You may contact the BBB AUTO LINE Program using the toll-free telephone number or write them at the following address: BBB AUTO LINE a Division of BBB National Programs, Inc. 1676 International Drive Suite 550 McLean, VA 22102 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Customer Information or call the General Motors Customer Care Centre, 1-800-263-3777 (English), 1-800-263-7854 (French), or write to: From U.S. Virgin Islands: The Mediation/Arbitration Program c/o Customer Care Centre General Motors of Canada Company Mail Code: CA1-163-005 1908 Colonel Sam Drive Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7 Canada Your inquiry should be accompanied by the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). Customer Assistance Offices Chevrolet encourages customers to call the toll-free number for assistance. However, if a customer wishes to write or e-mail Chevrolet, the letter should be addressed to: United States and Puerto Rico Chevrolet Motor Division Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center P.O. Box 33170 Detroit, MI 48232-5170 www.Chevrolet.com 1-800-222-1020 1-800-833-2438 (For Text Telephone Devices (TTYs)) Roadside Assistance: 1-800-243-8872 1-800-496-9994 General Motors of Canada Company Customer Care Centre, Mail Code: CA1-163-005 1908 Colonel Sam Drive Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7 www.gm.ca 1-800-263-3777 (English) 1-800-263-7854 (French) 1-800-263-3830 (For Text Telephone devices (TTYs)) Roadside Assistance: 1-800-268-6800 Overseas Please contact the local General Motors Business Unit. Customer Assistance for Text Telephone (TTY) Users To assist customers who are deaf, hard of hearing, or speech-impaired and who use Text Telephones (TTYs), Chevrolet has TTY equipment available at its Customer Assistance Center. Any TTY user in the U.S. 411 can communicate with Chevrolet by dialing: 1-800-833-2438. TTY users in Canada can dial 1-800-263-3830. Online Owner Center The Chevrolet Owner Center (U.S.) my.chevrolet.com Learn more about your vehicle features, shop for and manage your connected services and OnStar plans, and access diagnostic information specific to your vehicle. Membership Benefits E : Download owner’s manuals and view vehicle-specific how-to videos. G : View maintenance schedules, alerts, and Vehicle Diagnostic Information. Schedule service appointments. I : View service records from your dealership and add your own. D : Select a preferred dealer and view locations, maps, phone numbers, and hours. r : Track your vehicle’s warranty information. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 412 Customer Information J : View active recalls by Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). See Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) 0 405. H : Manage your profile and payment information. View your GM Rewards Card earnings and My Chevrolet Rewards points. F : Chat with online help representatives. Visit my.chevrolet.com and create an account today. Chevrolet Owner Centre (Canada) mychevrolet.ca Visit the Chevrolet Owner Centre at mychevrolet.ca (English) or my.chevrolet.ca (French) to access similar benefits to the U.S. site. GM Mobility Reimbursement Program This program is available to qualified applicants for cost reimbursement, up to certain limits, of eligible aftermarket adaptive equipment required for the vehicle, such as hand controls or a wheelchair/ scooter lift for the vehicle. . Your name, home address, and home To learn about the GM Mobility program, see www.gmmobility.com or call the GM Mobility Assistance Center at 1-800-323-9935. Text Telephone (TTY) users, call 1-800-833-9935. . Odometer reading, Vehicle Identification General Motors of Canada also has a Mobility program. See www.gm.ca, or call 1-800-GM-DRIVE (800-463-7483) for details. TTY users call 1-800-263-3830. Coverage Roadside Assistance Program For U.S.-purchased vehicles, call 1-800-243-8872. (Text Telephone (TTY): 1-888-889-2438.) For Canadian-purchased vehicles, call 1-800-268-6800. Service is available 24 hours a day, 365 days a year. Calling for Assistance When calling Roadside Assistance, have the following information ready: telephone number . Telephone number of your location . Location of the vehicle . Model, year, color, and license plate number of the vehicle Number (VIN), and delivery date of the vehicle . Description of the problem Services are provided for the duration of the vehicle’s powertrain warranty. In the U.S., anyone driving the vehicle is covered. In Canada, a person driving the vehicle without permission from the owner is not covered. Roadside Assistance is not a part of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. General Motors North America and Chevrolet reserve the right to make any changes or discontinue the Roadside Assistance program at any time without notification. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Customer Information General Motors North America and Chevrolet reserve the right to limit services or payment to an owner or driver if they decide the claims are made too often, or the same type of claim is made many times. Services Provided . Emergency Fuel Delivery: Delivery of enough fuel for the vehicle to get to the nearest service station. . Lock-Out Service: Service to unlock the vehicle if you are locked out. A remote unlock may be available if you have OnStar. For security reasons, the driver must present identification before this service is given. . Emergency Tow from a Public Road or Highway: Tow to the nearest Chevrolet dealer for warranty service, or if the vehicle was in a crash and cannot be driven. Assistance is not given when the vehicle is stuck in the sand, mud, or snow. . Flat Tire Change: Service to change a flat tire with the spare tire. The spare tire, if equipped, must be in good condition and properly inflated. It is the owner's responsibility for the repair or replacement of the tire if it is not covered by the warranty. . Battery Jump Start: Service to jump start a dead battery. . Trip Interruption Benefits and Assistance: If your trip is interrupted due to a warranty event, incidental expenses may be reimbursed within the Powertrain warranty period. Items considered are reasonable and customary hotel, meals, rental car, or a vehicle being delivered back to the customer, up to 500 miles. Services Not Included in Roadside Assistance . Impound towing caused by violation of any laws . Legal fines . Mounting, dismounting, or changing of snow tires, chains, or other traction devices Service is not provided if a vehicle is in an area that is not accessible to the service vehicle or is not a regularly traveled or maintained public road, which includes ice and winter roads. Off-road use is not covered. 413 Services Specific to Canadian-Purchased Vehicles . Fuel Delivery: Reimbursement is up to 7 liters. If available, diesel fuel delivery may be restricted. Propane and other fuels are not provided through this service. . Lock-Out Service: Vehicle registration is required. . Trip Interruption Benefits and Assistance: Must be over 150 km from where your trip was started to qualify. Pre-authorization, original detailed receipts, and a copy of the repair orders are required. Once authorization has been received, the Roadside Assistance advisor will help to make arrangements and explain how to receive payment. . Alternative Service: If assistance cannot be provided right away, the Roadside Assistance advisor may give permission to get local emergency road service. You will receive payment, up to $100, after sending the original receipt to Roadside Assistance. Mechanical failures may be covered, however any cost for parts and labor for repairs not covered by the warranty are the owner responsibility. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 414 Customer Information Scheduling Service Appointments When the vehicle requires warranty service, contact your dealer and request an appointment. By scheduling a service appointment and advising the service consultant of your transportation needs, your dealer can help minimize your inconvenience. If the vehicle cannot be scheduled into the service department immediately, keep driving it until it can be scheduled for service, unless, of course, the problem is safety related. If it is, please call your dealership, let them know this, and ask for instructions. If your dealer requests you to bring the vehicle for service, you are urged to do so as early in the work day as possible to allow for same-day repair. Courtesy Transportation Program To enhance your ownership experience, we and our participating dealers are proud to offer Courtesy Transportation, a customer support program for vehicles with the Bumper-to-Bumper (Base Warranty Coverage period in Canada), Federal Emission, Extended Powertrain or Electric specific warranties in both the U.S. and Canada. Several Courtesy Transportation options are available to assist in reducing inconvenience when warranty repairs are required. Courtesy Transportation is not a part of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. A separate manual entitled “Limited Warranty and Owner Assistance Information” furnished with each new vehicle provides detailed warranty coverage information. Transportation Options Warranty service can generally be completed while you wait. However, if you are unable to do so, your dealer may offer the following transportation options: Shuttle Service This includes one-way or round-trip shuttle service within reasonable time and distance parameters of your dealer's area. Public Transportation or Fuel Reimbursement If overnight warranty repairs are needed, and public transportation is used, the expense must be supported by original receipts and within the maximum amount allowed by GM. If U.S. customers arrange their own transportation, limited reimbursement for reasonable fuel expenses may be available. Claim amounts should reflect actual costs and be supported by original receipts. See your dealer for information. Courtesy Rental Vehicle For an overnight warranty repair, the dealer may provide an available courtesy rental vehicle or provide for reimbursement of a rental vehicle. Reimbursement is limited and must be supported by original receipts as well as a signed and completed rental agreement and meet state/provincial, local, and rental vehicle provider requirements. Requirements vary and may include minimum age requirements, insurance coverage, credit card, etc. Additional fees such as fuel, rental vehicle insurance, taxes, levies, usage fees, excessive mileage, or rental usage beyond the completion of the repair are also your responsibility. It may not be possible to provide a like vehicle as a courtesy rental. Additional Program Information All program options, such as shuttle service, may not be available at every dealer. Contact your dealer for specific availability. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Customer Information General Motors reserves the right to unilaterally modify, change, or discontinue Courtesy Transportation at any time and to resolve all questions of claim eligibility pursuant to the terms and conditions described herein at its sole discretion. Collision Damage Repair If the vehicle is involved in a collision and it is damaged, have the damage repaired by a qualified technician using the proper equipment and quality replacement parts. Poorly performed collision repairs diminish the vehicle resale value, and safety performance can be compromised in subsequent collisions. Collision Parts Genuine GM Collision parts are new parts made with the same materials and construction methods as the parts with which the vehicle was originally built. Genuine GM Collision parts are the best choice to ensure that the vehicle's designed appearance, durability, and safety are preserved. The use of Genuine GM parts can help maintain the GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty. Recycled original equipment parts may also be used for repair. These parts are typically removed from vehicles that were total losses in prior crashes. In most cases, the parts being recycled are from undamaged sections of the vehicle. A recycled original equipment GM part may be an acceptable choice to maintain the vehicle's originally designed appearance and safety performance; however, the history of these parts is not known. Such parts are not covered by the GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty, and any related failures are not covered by that warranty. Aftermarket collision parts are also available. These are made by companies other than GM and may not have been tested for the vehicle. As a result, these parts may fit poorly, exhibit premature durability/ corrosion problems, and may not perform properly in subsequent collisions. Aftermarket parts are not covered by the GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty, and any vehicle failure related to such parts is not covered by that warranty. Repair Facility GM also recommends that you choose a collision repair facility that meets your needs before you ever need collision repairs. 415 Your dealer may have a collision repair center with GM-trained technicians and state-of-the-art equipment, or be able to recommend a collision repair center that has GM-trained technicians and comparable equipment. Insuring the Vehicle Protect your investment in the GM vehicle with comprehensive and collision insurance coverage. There are significant differences in the quality of coverage afforded by various insurance policy terms. Many insurance policies provide reduced protection to the GM vehicle by limiting compensation for damage repairs through the use of aftermarket collision parts. Some insurance companies will not specify aftermarket collision parts. When purchasing insurance, we recommend that you ensure that the vehicle will be repaired with GM original equipment collision parts. If such insurance coverage is not available from your current insurance carrier, consider switching to another insurance carrier. If the vehicle is leased, the leasing company may require you to have insurance that ensures repairs with Genuine GM Original Equipment Manufacturer (OEM) parts or Genuine Manufacturer replacement parts. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 416 Customer Information Read the lease carefully, as you may be charged at the end of the lease for poor quality repairs. If a Crash Occurs If there has been an injury, call emergency services for help. Do not leave the scene of a crash until all matters have been taken care of. Move the vehicle only if its position puts you in danger, or you are instructed to move it by a police officer. Give only the necessary information to police and other parties involved in the crash. For emergency towing see Roadside Assistance Program 0 412. Gather the following information: . Driver name, address, and telephone number . Driver license number . Owner name, address, and telephone number . Vehicle license plate number . Vehicle make, model, and model year . Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . Insurance company and policy number . General description of the damage to the other vehicle Choose a reputable repair facility that uses quality replacement parts. See “Collision Parts” earlier in this section. If the airbag has inflated, see What Will You See after an Airbag Inflates? 0 66. Managing the Vehicle Damage Repair Process In the event that the vehicle requires damage repairs, GM recommends that you take an active role in its repair. If you have a pre-determined repair facility of choice, take the vehicle there, or have it towed there. Specify to the facility that any required replacement collision parts be original equipment parts, either new Genuine GM parts or recycled original GM parts. Remember, recycled parts will not be covered by the GM vehicle warranty. Insurance pays the bill for the repair, but you must live with the repair. Depending on your policy limits, your insurance company may initially value the repair using aftermarket parts. Discuss this with the repair professional, and insist on Genuine GM parts. Remember, if the vehicle is leased, you may be obligated to have the vehicle repaired with Genuine GM parts, even if your insurance coverage does not pay the full cost. If another party's insurance company is paying for the repairs, you are not obligated to accept a repair valuation based on that insurance company's collision policy repair limits, as you have no contractual limits with that company. In such cases, you can have control of the repair and parts choices as long as the cost stays within reasonable limits. Publication Ordering Information Service Manuals Service manuals have the diagnosis and repair information on the engine, transmission, axle, suspension, brakes, electrical system, steering system, body, etc. Customer Literature Owner’s manuals are written specifically for owners and are intended to provide basic operational information about the vehicle. The owner’s manual includes the Maintenance Schedule for all models. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Customer Information Customer literature publications available for purchase include owner’s manuals, warranty manuals, and portfolios. Portfolios include an owner’s manual, warranty manual, if applicable, and zip lock bag or pouch. Current and Past Models Service manuals and customer literature are available for many current and past model year GM vehicles. To order, call 1-800-551-4123 Monday–Friday, 8:00 a.m.–6:00 p.m. eastern time For credit card orders only (VISA, MasterCard, or Discover), see Helm, Inc. at: www.helminc.com. Science and Economic Development (ISED) Canada's license-exempt RSS(s) / RSP-100 / ICES-GEN. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. The device may not cause harmful interference. 2. The device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. Changes or modifications to any of these systems by other than an authorized service facility could void authorization to use this equipment. To order by mail, write to: Reporting Safety Defects Helm, Incorporated Attention: Customer Service 47911 Halyard Drive Plymouth, MI 48170 Reporting Safety Defects to the United States Government Make checks payable in U.S. funds. Radio Frequency Statement This vehicle uses license-exempt transmitters / receivers / systems that operate on a radio frequency that complies with Part 15/ Part 18 of the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) rules and with Innovation, If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying General Motors. 417 If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or General Motors. To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA 1200 New Jersey Avenue, S.E. Washington, D.C. 20590 You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov. Reporting Safety Defects to the Canadian Government If you live in Canada, and you believe that the vehicle has a safety defect, notify Transport Canada immediately, Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 418 Customer Information and notify General Motors of Canada Company. Call Transport Canada at 1-800-333-0510; go to: www.tc.gc.ca/recalls (English) www.tc.gc.ca/rappels (French) or write to: Transport Canada Motor Vehicle Safety Directorate Defect Investigations and Recalls Division 80 Noel Street Gatineau, QC J8Z 0A1 Reporting Safety Defects to General Motors In addition to notifying NHTSA (or Transport Canada) in a situation like this, notify General Motors. In the U.S., call 1-800-222-1020, or write: Chevrolet Motor Division Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center P.O. Box 33170 Detroit, MI 48232-5170 In Canada, call 1-800-263-3777 (English) or 1-800-263-7854 (French), or write: General Motors of Canada Company Customer Care Centre, Mail Code: CA1-163-005 1908 Colonel Sam Drive Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7 or average speed. These modules may retain personal preferences, such as radio presets, seat positions, and temperature settings. In Mexico, call 800-466-0811 or 800-508-0000. GM collects information about the use of your vehicle including operational and safety related information. We collect this information to provide, evaluate, improve, and troubleshoot our products and services and to develop new products and services. The protection of vehicle electronics systems and customer data from unauthorized outside electronic access or control is important to GM. GM maintains appropriate security standards, practices, guidelines and controls aimed at defending the vehicle and the vehicle service ecosystem against unauthorized electronic access, detecting possible malicious activity in related networks, and responding to suspected cybersecurity incidents in a timely, coordinated and effective manner. Security incidents could impact your safety or compromise your private data. To minimize security risks, please do not connect your vehicle electronic systems to unauthorized devices or connect your vehicle to any unknown or untrusted networks (such as Bluetooth, WIFI or similar technology). In In other Central America and Caribbean Countries, call 52-555-901-2369. Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy The vehicle has a number of computers that record information about the vehicle’s performance and how it is driven or used. For example, the vehicle uses computer modules to monitor and control engine and transmission performance, to monitor the conditions for airbag deployment and deploy them in a crash, and, if equipped, to provide antilock braking to help the driver control the vehicle. These modules may store data to help the dealer technician service the vehicle or to help GM improve safety or features. Some modules may also store data about how the vehicle is operated, such as rate of fuel consumption Cybersecurity Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Customer Information the event you suspect any security incident impacting your data or the safe operation of your vehicle, please stop operating your vehicle and contact your dealer. Event Data Recorders This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle’s systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record such data as: . How various systems in your vehicle were operating; . Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were buckled/fastened; . How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and, . How fast the vehicle was traveling. These data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur. Note EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash investigation. To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access to the vehicle or the EDR. GM will not access these data or share it with others except: with the consent of the vehicle owner or, if the vehicle is leased, with the consent of the lessee; in response to an official request by police or similar government office; as part of GM's defense of litigation through the discovery process; or, as permitted by law. Data that GM collects or receives may also be used for GM research needs or may be made available to 419 others for research purposes, where a need is shown and the data is not tied to a specific vehicle or vehicle owner. OnStar If the vehicle is equipped with OnStar and has an active service plan, additional data may be collected and transmitted through the OnStar system. This includes information about the vehicle’s operation; collisions involving the vehicle; the use of the vehicle and its features, including infotainment; and the location and approximate GPS speed of the vehicle. Refer to the OnStar Terms and Conditions and Privacy Statement on the OnStar website. See OnStar Additional Information 0 421. Infotainment System If the vehicle is equipped with a navigation system as part of the infotainment system, use of the system may result in the storage of destinations, addresses, telephone numbers, and other trip information. See the infotainment section for information on stored data and for deletion instructions. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 420 OnStar OnStar OnStar Overview The OnStar system status light is next to the OnStar buttons. If the status light is: . Solid Green: System is ready. . Flashing Green: On a call. . Red: Indicates a problem. . Off: System is off. Press Q twice to speak with an OnStar Advisor. = Voice Command Button Q Blue OnStar Button > Red Emergency Button Press Q or call 1-888-4ONSTAR (1-888-466-7827) to speak to an Advisor. OnStar Overview OnStar Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420 OnStar Services Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421 OnStar Additional Information OnStar Additional Information . . . . . . . . . 421 This vehicle may be equipped with a comprehensive, in-vehicle system that can connect to an OnStar Advisor for Emergency, Security, Navigation, Connections, and Diagnostics Services. OnStar services may require a paid service plan and data plan. OnStar requires the vehicle battery and electrical system, cellular service, and GPS satellite signals to be available and operating. OnStar acts as a link to existing emergency service providers. OnStar may collect information about you and your vehicle, including location information. See OnStar User Terms, Privacy Statement, and Software Terms for more details including system limitations at www.onstar.com (U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada). Functionality of the Voice Command button may vary by vehicle and region. Press = to: . Open the OnStar app on the infotainment display. If equipped, the infotainment system has OnStar controls in the embedded OnStar app on the Home Page. Most OnStar functions that can be performed with the buttons can be done using the app. To open the app, touch the OnStar icon on the Home Page. App updates require a corresponding service plan. Features vary by region and model. Features are subject to change. For more information, see my.chevrolet.com/learn or press Q. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 OnStar Or . Give OnStar Turn-by-Turn Navigation voice commands. . Obtain and customize the Wi-Fi hotspot name or SSID and password, if equipped. Press Q to connect to an Advisor to: . Verify account information or update contact information. . Get driving directions. . Receive a Diagnostic check of the vehicle's key operating systems. . Receive Roadside Assistance. . Manage Wi-Fi Settings, if equipped. Press > to get a priority connection to an OnStar Advisor available 24/7 to: . Get help for an emergency. . Be a Good Samaritan or respond to an AMBER Alert. . Get assistance in severe weather or other crisis situations and find evacuation routes. OnStar Services Emergency Emergency Services require an active safety and security plan. With Automatic Crash Response, built-in sensors can automatically alert a specially trained OnStar Advisor who is immediately connected in to the vehicle to help. Press > for a priority connection to an OnStar Advisor who can contact emergency service providers, direct them to your exact location, and relay important information. With OnStar Crisis Assist, specially trained Advisors are available 24 hours a day, 7 days a week, to provide a central point of contact, assistance, and information during a crisis. With Roadside Assistance, Advisors can locate a nearby service provider to help with a flat tire, a battery jump, or an empty gas tank. 421 . With Stolen Vehicle Assistance, OnStar Advisors can use GPS to pinpoint the vehicle and help authorities quickly recover it. . With Remote Ignition Block, if equipped, OnStar can block the engine from being restarted. . With Stolen Vehicle Slowdown, if equipped, OnStar can work with law enforcement to gradually slow the vehicle down. Theft Alarm Notification If equipped, if the doors are locked and the vehicle alarm sounds, a notification by text, e-mail, or phone call will be sent. If the vehicle is stolen, an OnStar Advisor can work with authorities to recover the vehicle. OnStar Additional Information In-Vehicle Audio Messages Security Audio messages may play important information at the following times: If equipped, OnStar provides these services: . Prior to vehicle purchase. Press up an account. Q to set Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 422 OnStar . After change in ownership and at 90 days. Transferring Service Press Q to request account transfer eligibility information. The Advisor can cancel or change account information. Selling/Transferring the Vehicle Call 1-888-4ONSTAR (1-888-466-7827) immediately to terminate your OnStar or connected services if the vehicle is disposed of, sold, transferred, or if the lease ends. Reactivation for Subsequent Owners Press Q and follow the prompts to speak to an Advisor as soon as possible. The Advisor will update vehicle records and explain OnStar or connected service options. How OnStar Service Works Automatic Crash Response, Emergency Services, Crisis Assist, Stolen Vehicle Assistance, Remote Services, and Roadside Assistance are available on most vehicles. Not all OnStar services are available everywhere or on all vehicles. For more information, a full description of OnStar services, system limitations, and OnStar User Terms, Privacy Statement, and Software Terms: . Call 1-888-4ONSTAR (1-888-466-7827). . See www.onstar.com (U.S.). . See www.onstar.ca (Canada). . Call TTY 1-877-248-2080. . Press Q to speak with an Advisor. OnStar or connected services cannot work unless the vehicle is in a place where OnStar has an agreement with a wireless service provider for service in that area. The wireless service provider must also have coverage, network capacity, reception, and technology compatible with OnStar or connected services. Service involving location information about the vehicle cannot work unless GPS signals are available, unobstructed, and compatible with the OnStar hardware. OnStar or connected services may not work if the OnStar equipment is not properly installed or it has not been properly maintained. If equipment or software is added, connected, or modified, OnStar or connected services may not work. Other problems beyond the control of OnStar — such as hills, tall buildings, tunnels, weather, electrical system design and architecture of the vehicle, damage to the vehicle in a crash, or wireless phone network congestion or jamming — may prevent service. See Radio Frequency Statement 0 417. Services for People with Disabilities Advisors provide services to help with physical disabilities and medical conditions. Press Q to help: . Locate a gas station with an attendant to pump gas. . Find a hotel, restaurant, etc., that meets accessibility needs. . Provide directions to the closest hospital or pharmacy in urgent situations. TTY Users OnStar has the ability to communicate to deaf, hard-of-hearing, or speech-impaired customers while in the vehicle. The available TTY system can provide in-vehicle access to all OnStar services, except Virtual Advisor and OnStar Turn-by-Turn Navigation. If equipped, TTY mode can be turned on or off by touching Settings, then Apps, and then Phone. When TTY mode is on, phone calls can be made or received with OnStar using the infotainment display. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 OnStar OnStar Personal Identification Number (PIN) A PIN is needed to access some OnStar services. The PIN will need to be changed the first time when speaking with an Advisor. To change the OnStar PIN, contact an OnStar Advisor by pressing Q or calling 1-888-4ONSTAR. Warranty OnStar equipment may be warranted as part of the vehicle warranty. Languages The vehicle can be programmed to respond in multiple languages. Press Q and ask for an Advisor. Advisors are available in English, Spanish, and French. Available languages may vary by country. Potential Issues OnStar cannot perform Remote Door Unlock or Stolen Vehicle Assistance after the vehicle has been off continuously for an extended period of time without an ignition cycle. To find out the duration of time that applies for the vehicle, contact an OnStar Advisor by pressing Q or calling 1-888-4ONSTAR. If the vehicle has not been started for an extended period of time, OnStar can contact Roadside Assistance or a locksmith to help gain access to the vehicle. Global Positioning System (GPS) . Obstruction of the GPS can occur in a large city with tall buildings; in parking garages; around airports; in tunnels and underpasses; or in an area with very dense trees. If GPS signals are not available, the OnStar system should still operate to call OnStar. However, OnStar could have difficulty identifying the exact location. . In emergency situations, OnStar can use the last stored GPS location to send to emergency responders. A temporary loss of GPS can cause loss of the ability to send a Turn-by-Turn Navigation route. The Advisor may give a verbal route or may ask for a call back after the vehicle is driven into an open area. Cellular and GPS Antennas Cellular reception is required for OnStar to send remote signals to the vehicle. Do not place items over or near the antenna to prevent blocking cellular and GPS signal reception. 423 Unable to Connect to OnStar Message If there is limited cellular coverage or the cellular network has reached maximum capacity, this message may come on. Press Q to try the call again or try again after driving a few miles into another cellular area. Vehicle and Power Issues OnStar services require a vehicle electrical system, wireless service, and GPS satellite technologies to be available and operating for features to function properly. These systems may not operate if the battery is discharged or disconnected. Add-on Electrical Equipment The OnStar system is integrated into the electrical architecture of the vehicle. Do not add any electrical equipment. See Add-On Electrical Equipment 0 303. Added electrical equipment may interfere with the operation of the OnStar system and cause it to not operate. Vehicle Software Updates OnStar or GM may remotely deliver software updates or changes to the vehicle without further notice or consent. These Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 424 OnStar updates or changes may enhance or maintain safety, security, or the operation of the vehicle or the vehicle systems. Software updates or changes may affect or erase data or settings that are stored in the vehicle, such as saved navigation destinations or pre-set radio stations. Neither OnStar nor GM is responsible for any affected or erased data or settings. These updates or changes may also collect personal information. Such collection is described in the OnStar privacy statement or separately disclosed at the time of installation. These updates or changes may also cause a system to automatically communicate with GM servers to collect information about vehicle system status, identify whether updates or changes are available, or deliver updates or changes. An active OnStar agreement constitutes consent to these software updates or changes and agreement that either OnStar or GM may remotely deliver them to the vehicle. Privacy The complete OnStar Privacy Statement may be found at www.onstar.com (U.S.), or www.onstar.ca (Canada). We recommend that you review it. If you have any questions, call 1-888-4ONSTAR (1-888-466-7827) or press Q to speak with an Advisor. Users of wireless communications are cautioned that the privacy of any information sent via wireless cellular communications cannot be assured. Third parties may unlawfully intercept or access transmissions and private communications without consent. OnStar - Software Acknowledgements To obtain the source code under GPL, LGPL, MPL, and other open source licenses, that is contained in this product, please visit http:// opensource.lge.com. In addition to the source code, all referred license terms, warranty disclaimers, and copyright notices are available for download. This offer is valid for a period of three years after our last shipment of this product. This offer is valid to anyone in receipt of this information. *Provided through LG Electronics Inc., who is solely responsible for provisions of related OSS compliance. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Connected Services Connected Services Connected Services Connected Services Navigation Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427 Navigation requires a specific OnStar or connected service plan. Press Q to receive Turn-by-Turn directions or have them sent to the vehicle’s navigation screen, if equipped. Select Turn-by-Turn Directions from the Services tab of the OnStar app to call an Advisor or select a recent or favorite destination. Touch the navigation icons to select home, address, or place. A destination transfer from OnStar will show the detail view of the destination when it is transferred from OnStar to the Navigation application. See www.onstar.com for a coverage map. Services vary by model. Map coverage is available in the United States and Canada. Turn-by-Turn Navigation 1. Press Q to connect to an Advisor. 2. Request directions to be downloaded to the vehicle. 3. Follow the voice-guided commands. 425 Using Voice Commands During a Planned Route Functionality of the Voice Command button, if equipped, may vary by vehicle and region. For some vehicles, press = to open the OnStar app on the infotainment display. Send Destination to Vehicle Directions can be sent to the vehicle’s navigation screen, if equipped. Press Q, then ask the Advisor to download directions to the vehicle’s navigation system, if equipped. After the call ends, the navigation screen will provide prompts to begin driving directions. Routes that are sent to the navigation screen can only be canceled through the navigation system. See www.onstar.com (U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada). Connections The following services help with staying connected. For coverage maps, see www.onstar.com (U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada). Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 426 Connected Services Ensuring Security . Change the default passwords for the Wi-Fi hotspot and myChevrolet mobile application. Make these passwords different from each other and use a combination of letters and numbers to increase the security. . Change the default name of the SSID (Service Set Identifier). This is your network’s name that is visible to other wireless devices. Choose a unique name and avoid family names or vehicle descriptions. Wi-Fi Hotspot (If Equipped) The vehicle may have a built-in Wi-Fi hotspot that provides access to the Internet and web content at 4G LTE speed. Up to seven mobile devices can be connected. A data plan is required. Use the in-vehicle controls only when it is safe to do so. 1. To retrieve Wi-Fi hotspot information, press = to open the OnStar app on the infotainment display, then select Wi-Fi Hotspot. On some vehicles, touch Wi-Fi or Wi-Fi Settings on the screen. 2. The Wi-Fi settings will display the Wi-Fi hotspot name (SSID), password, and on some vehicles, the connection type (no Internet connection, 3G, 4G, 4G LTE), and signal quality (poor, good, excellent). 3. To change the SSID or password, press Q or call 1-888-4ONSTAR to connect with an Advisor. On some vehicles, the SSID and password can be changed in the Wi-Fi Hotspot menu. After initial set-up, your vehicle’s Wi-Fi hotspot will connect automatically to your mobile devices. Manage data usage by turning Wi-Fi on or off on your mobile device, using the myChevrolet mobile app, or by contacting an OnStar Advisor. On some vehicles, Wi-Fi can also be managed from the Wi-Fi Hotspot menu. MyChevrolet Mobile App (If Available) Download the myChevrolet mobile app to compatible Apple and Android smartphones. Chevrolet users can access the following services from a smartphone: . Remotely start/stop the vehicle, if factory-equipped. . Lock/unlock doors, if equipped with automatic locks. . Activate the horn and lamps. . Check the vehicle’s fuel level, oil life, . . . . . . . or tire pressure, if factory-equipped with the Tire Pressure Monitor System. Send destinations to the vehicle. Locate the vehicle on a map (U.S. market only). Turn the vehicle's Wi-Fi hotspot on/off, manage settings, and monitor data consumption, if equipped. Locate a dealer and schedule service. Request roadside assistance. Set a parking reminder with pin drop, take a photo, make a note, and set a timer. Connect with Chevrolet on social media. Features are subject to change. For myChevrolet mobile app information and compatibility, see my.chevrolet.com. An active OnStar or connected service plan may be required. A compatible device, factory-installed remote start, and power locks are required. Data rates apply. See www.onstar.com for details and system limitations. Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Connected Services Remote Services Contact an OnStar Advisor to unlock the doors or sound the horn and flash the lamps. Marketplace OnStar Advisors can provide offers from restaurants and retailers on your route, help locate hotels, or book a room. These services vary by market. Diagnostics By monitoring and reporting on the vehicle's key systems, OnStar Advanced Diagnostics, if equipped, provides a way to keep up on maintenance. Capabilities vary by model. See www.onstar.com for details and system limitations. Features are subject to change. For updates on feature capabilities, see my.chevrolet.com. Message and data rates may apply. 427 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 428 Index Index A Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . 307 Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 Adding a Snow Plow or Similar Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 Additional Information OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421 Additional Maintenance and Care . . . . . . . . 398 Adjustments Lumbar, Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Agreements Trademarks and License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 Air Cleaner/Filter, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315 Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202, 204 Air Filter Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Air Filter, Passenger Compartment . . . . . . . 207 Air Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 Airbag System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . 66 Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . 66 What Will You See after an Airbag Inflates? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . 65 Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Airbags Adding Equipment to the Vehicle . . . . . . . . 71 Passenger Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Servicing Airbag-Equipped Vehicles . . . . . . . 71 System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Alarm Vehicle Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Alert Lane Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Rear Cross Traffic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 Side Blind Zone (SBZA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 All-Season Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 All-Terrain Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154 Antenna Fixed Mast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Multi-band . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244 Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Appearance Care Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 Apple CarPlay and Android Auto . . . . . . . . . .183 Assistance Program, Roadside . . . . . . . . . . . . .412 Assistance Systems for Driving . . . . . . . . . . 263 Assistance Systems for Parking and Backing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Index Audio Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Automatic Dimming Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Emergency Braking (AEB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Headlamp System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Automatic Transmission Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Shift Lock Control Function Check . . . . . . 328 Auxiliary Roof Mounted Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Auxiliary Jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161 Avoiding Untrusted Media Devices . . . . . . . .158 Axle, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 Axle, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 B Battery Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . 147 Load Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Power Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Battery - North America . . . . . . . . . . . . 324, 374 Blade Replacement, Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Blind Spot Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37 Bluetooth Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178, 179 Bluetooth Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161 Brake Parking, Electric . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Brake Pad Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 Antilock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244 Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323 Pad Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Automatic Emergency (AEB) . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Break-In, New Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Bulb Replacement Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) and Cargo Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . 333 Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331 Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Headlamps, Front Turn Signal, Sidemarker, and Parking Lamps . . . . . . 331 License Plate Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334 Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps, and Back-up Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332 Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359 429 C Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 California Perchlorate Materials Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 California Proposition 65 Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324, 374, Back Cover Camera Rear Vision (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 Truck Bed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Canadian Vehicle Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . .406 Carbon Monoxide Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Tailgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 Cargo Tie-Downs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Caution, Danger, and Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2 Center Console Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) and Cargo Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333 Center Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362 Charging Wireless . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 430 Index Check Engine Light (Malfunction Indicator) . . . . 116 Ignition Transmission Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Child Restraints Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Securing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89, 93, 95 Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336 Cleaning Exterior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 Interior Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 Climate Control Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 Dual Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Cluster, Instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415 Compartments Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Connected Services Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427 Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 Connections Connected Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 Control Hill Descent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248 Traction and Electronic Stability . . . . . . . 247 Control Light Hill Descent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Controls Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Convex Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Coolant Engine Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Engine Temperature Warning Light . . . . . 121 Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202, 204 Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . . . . 414 Coverage Explanations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173 Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 Customer Information Publications Ordering Information . . . . . 416 Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . . .409 Cybersecurity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418 D Damage Repair, Collision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .415 Danger, Warning, and Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2 Data Collection Infotainment System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419 OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419 Data Recorders, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419 Database Coverage Explanations . . . . . . . . . .173 Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 Destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Diagnostics Connected Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427 Distracted Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Dome Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 Door Ajar Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Power Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Drive Belt Routing, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408 Driver Teen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 Driver Assistance Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . 124, 125 Driver Mode Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Driver Mode Control Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Index Driving Assistance Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Characteristics and Towing Tips . . . . . . . . 274 Defensive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 If the Vehicle is Stuck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Impaired . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Off-Road . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Vehicle Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 Dual Automatic Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 E E85 or FlexFuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Electric Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 Electric Parking Brake Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Electrical Equipment, Add-On . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 Electrical System Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . 336 Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336 Instrument Panel Fuse Block . . . . . . 339, 341 Overload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334 Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Emergency OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421 Engine Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315 Check Light (Malfunction Indicator) . . . . . 116 Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310 Coolant Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Coolant Temperature Warning Light . . . . 121 Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316 Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408 Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Fan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313 Oil Pressure Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Oil Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Overheated Protection Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 Power Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Running While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 Engine Air Filter Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314 Entry Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Equipment, Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281 Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419 431 Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Extended Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Extender, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61 Exterior Cargo Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Exterior Lamp Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Exterior Lamps Off Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . .147 F Fan Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Filter, Engine Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315 Fixed Mast Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158 Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Flashers, Hazard Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142 Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 FlexFuel E85 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Floor Console Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Floor Mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389 Fluid Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323 Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321 Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 432 Index Folding Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Forward Collision Alert (FCA) System . . . . 263 Four-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 Drive Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Drive System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Frequency Statement Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 Front Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 Front Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Front Seats Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Heated and Ventilated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Fuel Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Economy, Driving for Better . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . 273 Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271, 272 Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Prohibited Fuels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Recommended . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Top Tier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Full-Size Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 Fuses Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . 336 Fuses (cont'd) Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336 Instrument Panel Fuse Block . . . . . . 339, 341 Guidance Problems with the Route . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 G Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331 Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142 HD Radio Technology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Head-up Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 Headlamps Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . 141 Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Headlamps, Front Turn Signal, Sidemarker, and Parking Lamps . . . . . . 331 High-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Lamps On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Heated Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Heated and Ventilated Front Seats . . . . . . . .53 Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37 Heater Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202, 204 Garage Door Opener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135 Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Gas Strut(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 Gauges Engine Coolant Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Engine Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Voltmeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Warning Lights and Indicators . . . . . . . . . 107 General Information Service and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391 Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 Vehicle Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 Glass Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 Global Positioning System (GPS) . . . . . . . . . .172 Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 GM Mobility Reimbursement Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412 H Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Index High-Beam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123 Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218 Hill Descent Control (HDC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248 Hill Descent Control Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119 Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 How to Wear Seat Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . 56 HVAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202, 204 I If the System Needs Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173 Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227, 229 Ignition Transmission Lock Check . . . . . . . . 328 Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 Indicator Vehicle Ahead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Infants and Young Children, Restraints . . . . 74 Information Publication Ordering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416 Infotainment System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419 Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Interior Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1, 148 J Jack Auxiliary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Jump Starting - North America . . . . . . . . . . . 374 K Keyless Entry Remote (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10, 13 Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7, 9 L Labeling, Tire Sidewall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 Lamps Auxiliary Roof Mounted Lamp . . . . . . . . . 144 Daytime Running (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Dome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Exterior Cargo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Exterior Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Exterior Lamps Off Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Exterior Lighting Battery Saver . . . . . . . . 147 License Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334 Malfunction Indicator (Check Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Lane Change Alert (LCA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Lane Departure Warning (LDW) . . . . . . . . . . 268 Lane Departure Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . .119 Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 433 LATCH System Replacing Parts after a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . 89 LATCH, Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 LED Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331 Lighting Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Illumination Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331 Task . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Lights Airbag Readiness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Brake System Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Check Engine (Malfunction Indicator) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Door Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Driver Mode Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Electric Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Electronic Stability Control (ESC), Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Engine Coolant Temperature Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Engine Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 434 Index Lights (cont'd) Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Four-Wheel-Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Front Fog Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 High-Beam On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Hill Descent Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Lane Departure Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Low Fuel Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Seat Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Service Electric Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Traction Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Lock Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Locking Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 Locks Automatic Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .213 Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122 Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Lumbar Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 M Maintenance Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404 Maintenance and Care Additional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392 Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116 Manual Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Manual Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Map Data Updates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173 Maps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Media Avoiding Untrusted Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Memory Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Messages Engine Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Vehicle Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Mirror Rear Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Mirrors Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Mirrors (cont'd) Automatic Dimming Rearview . . . . . . . . . . 38 Blind Spot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Convex . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Manual Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Tilt in Reverse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Trailer Tow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Mirrors, Interior Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Driver Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Monitor System, Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . 350 Multi-band Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158 N Navigation Connected Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425 Destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Using the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Navigation Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Noise Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 O Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Index Odometer (cont'd) Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Off-Road . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214 Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Oil Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311 Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313 Engine Oil Pressure Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Older Children, Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419 OnStar Additional Information . . . . . . . . . . . .421 OnStar Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421 OnStar Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420 OnStar Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421 Operating Mode Overheated Engine Protection . . . . . . . . . 320 Operation Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Outlets Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Overheated Engine Protection Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 P Park Shifting Into . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Shifting Out of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253, 261 Parking Brake and P (Park) Mechanism Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Extended . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Parking or Backing Assistance Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . 115 Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . . . 207 Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Perchlorate Materials Requirements, California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 Personalization Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Phone Apple CarPlay and Android Auto . . . . . . . 183 Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178, 179 Pickup Conversion to Chassis Cab . . . . . . . . 305 Port USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Positioning Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 435 Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Protection, Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Retained Accessory (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Power Assist Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61 Privacy Vehicle Data Recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418 Problems with Route Guidance . . . . . . . . . . .172 Program Courtesy Transportation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414 Prohibited Fuels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Proposition 65 Warning, California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324, 374, Back Cover Publication Ordering Information . . . . . . . . 416 R Radio HD Radio Technology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Radio Data System (RDS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 Radio Frequency Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .417 Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 436 Index Radios AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Satellite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 Rear Camera Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Rear Cross Traffic Alert System . . . . . . . . . . 262 Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Rear Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Rear Vision Camera (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . .253, 254 Rear Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Rearview Mirror Truck Bed Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Recognition Voice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Recommended Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . 401 Records Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404 Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378 Reimbursement Program, GM Mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412 Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . 10, 13 Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Replacement Glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 Replacement Parts Airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402 Replacing Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72 Replacing LATCH System Parts after a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Replacing Seat Belt System Parts after a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Reporting Safety Defects Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418 U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 Restraints Where to Put . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Retained Accessory Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . 232 Reverse Tilt Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Roads Driving, Wet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . .412 Roof Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Rotation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356 Routing, Engine Drive Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408 Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . . . 235 S Safety Defects Reporting Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418 U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 Safety Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 Safety System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61 Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157 Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414 Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55 Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 How to Wear Seat Belts Properly . . . . . . . 56 Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Replacing after a Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Seats Adjustment, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Center Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Heated and Ventilated Front . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Heated, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Lumbar Adjustment, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Power Adjustment, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Index Seats (cont'd) Underseat Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Securing Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . .89, 93, 95 Security Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421 Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Vehicle Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . 307 Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 Doing Your Own Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 Maintenance Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404 Maintenance, General Information . . . . . 391 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405 Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414 Service Electric Parking Brake Light . . . . . . . 118 Services Special Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 Servicing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173 Servicing the Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Shift Lock Control Function Check, Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Side Blind Zone Alert (SBZA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Signals, Turn and Lane-Change . . . . . . . . . . . .143 Snow Plow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 Software Updates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154 Special Application Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 Specifications and Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . .406 Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Start Assist, Hill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Start Vehicle, Remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Starter Switch Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327 Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212 Fluid, Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 Heated Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Wheel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Steering Column Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Steps Power Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Stoplamps and Back-up Lamps Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332 Storage Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Storage Areas Center Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Floor Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Underseat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 437 Storage Compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Struts Gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Surround Vision System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2 Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 System Brake Pad Life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 Engine Air Filter Life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Forward Collision Alert (FCA) . . . . . . . . . . . 263 Global Positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Infotainment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419 Noise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 Rear Cross Traffic Alert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 Surround Vision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 Systems Driver Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 T Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Tailgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23 Taillamps Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332 Task Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Teen Driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 438 Index Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 All-Season . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 All-Terrain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359 Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362 Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 Designations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346 Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360 Full-Size Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355 Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349 Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . 351 Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350 Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356 Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . 347 Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . 360 Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . 361 Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . 358 Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 Top Tier Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Tow/Haul Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Towing Driving Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 Recreational Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378 Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Trailer Sway Control (TSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 Traction Off Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Traction Control/Electronic Stability Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Trademarks and License Agreements . . . . . 193 Trailer Sway Control (TSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 Tow Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Trailer Towing App . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 Trailering App . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 Transfer Case Four-Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Transmission Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Fluid, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Transportation Program, Courtesy . . . . . . . 414 Transporting Items That Can Catch Fire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Truck Bed Camera Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . .41 Truck-Camper Loading Information . . . . . . . 225 Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . . .143 Turn Signal Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332 U Underseat Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . 360 Universal Remote System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Updates Map Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 USB Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158 Using the Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Using the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152 Using This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2 V Vehicle Alarm System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Canadian Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . 405 Chevrolet Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner Manual (GMNA-Localizing-U. S./Canada/Mexico-15546003) - 2022 - CRC - 5/5/21 Index Vehicle (cont'd) Load Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Personalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Speed Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 Vehicle Ahead Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119 Vehicle Care Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349 Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . . . . 418 Vehicle Positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172 Vehicle Security Steering Column Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Ventilation, Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Voice Recognition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173 Voltmeter Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 W Warning Brake System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Caution and Danger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Lane Departure (LDW) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Warnings Hazard Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321 Wheels Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360 Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . 358 Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Windshield Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 Winter Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 Wireless Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 439 ai161972345251_22_CHEV_Silverado_2500HD3500HD_COV_en_US_84720406A_2021MAY14.pdf 1 4/29/2021 3:10:54 PM 2022 Scan to Access M Y CM MY CY CMY K • Owner and Warranty Manuals • Connected Services • myChevrolet Mobile App • How To Videos • Vehicle Diagnostics • Schedule Maintenance • Vehicle Features • Many Additional Resources United States Customer Assistance 1-800-222-1020 Roadside Assistance 1-800-243-8872 Canada Customer Assistance 1-800-263-3777 Roadside Assistance 1-800-268-6800 United States and Canada 84767841 A Connected Services 1-888-4-ONSTAR 2022 Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD C Operating, servicing and maintaining a passenger vehicle or off-highway motor vehicle can expose you to chemicals including engine exhaust, carbon monoxide, phthalates, and lead, which are known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. To minimize exposure, avoid breathing exhaust, do not idle engine except as necessary, service your vehicle in a well-ventilated area and wear gloves or wash your hands frequently when servicing your vehicle. For more information go to www.P65Warnings.ca.gov/passenger-vehicle. Silverado 2500 HD/3500 HD Owner’s Manual